- Latest available (Revised)
- Point in Time (10/07/2003)
- Original (As enacted)
Version Superseded: 15/09/2003
Point in time view as at 10/07/2003. This version of this Act contains provisions that are not valid for this point in time.
There are currently no known outstanding effects for the Finance Act 1995.
Revised legislation carried on this site may not be fully up to date. At the current time any known changes or effects made by subsequent legislation have been applied to the text of the legislation you are viewing by the editorial team. Please see ‘Frequently Asked Questions’ for details regarding the timescales for which new effects are identified and recorded on this site.
An Act to grant certain duties, to alter other duties, and to amend the law relating to the National Debt and the Public Revenue, and to make further provision in connection with Finance.
[1st May 1995]
X1Most Gracious Sovereign,
WE, Your Majesty’s most dutiful and loyal subjects, the Commons of the United Kingdom in Parliament assembled, towards raising the necessary supplies to defray Your Majesty’s public expenses, and making an addition to the public revenue, have freely and voluntarily resolved to give and grant unto Your Majesty the several duties hereinafter mentioned; and do therefore most humbly beseech Your Majesty that it may be enacted, and be it enacted by the Queen’s most Excellent Majesty, by and with the advice and consent of the Lords Spiritual and Temporal, and Commons, in this present Parliament assembled, and by the authority of the same, as follows:—
Editorial Information
X1General amendments to Taxes Acts, Income Tax Acts and/or Corporation Tax Acts made by legislation after 1.2.1991 are noted against Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 c. 1 but not against each Act.
Commencement Information
I1Act partly in force at Royal Assent, partly retrospective and partly prospective; see individual provisions.
(1)The M1Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 1 (the alcoholic liquors dutiable under the Act) in subsections (4) and (5) (definitions of “wine” and “made-wine”) after the words “any liquor” there shall in both cases be inserted “ which is of a strength exceeding 1.2 per cent and which is ”.
(3)In section 1(6) (definition of “cider”) after the word “strength” there shall be inserted “ exceeding 1.2 per cent but ”.
(4)In section 59(1) (prohibition on rendering wine and made-wine sparkling) for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted the following paragraph—
“(b)is wine or made-wine of a strength exceeding 5.5 per cent.”.
(5)Subsections (2) and (4) above—
(a)shall apply in relation to liquor imported into, or produced in, the United Kingdom on or after 1st January 1995, and
(b)as regards any provision about liquor removed to the United Kingdom from the Isle of Man, shall also apply in relation to liquor so removed on or after that date.
(6)Subsection (3) above shall apply in relation to liquor imported into, or made in, the United Kingdom on or after 1st January 1995.
(1)For the Table of rates of duty in Schedule 1 to the M2Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 (wine and made-wine) there shall be substituted the Table in Schedule 1 to this Act.
(2)This section shall be deemed to have come into force on 1st January 1995.
(1)In section 5 of the M3Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 (spirits) for “£19.81” there shall be substituted “ £20.60 ”.
(2)In section 36(1) of that Act (beer) for “£10.45” there shall be substituted “ £10.82 ”.
(3)In section 62(1) of that Act (cider) for “£22.82” there shall be substituted “ £23.78 ”.
(4)This section shall be deemed to have come into force on 1st January 1995.
(1)Subject to the following provisions of this section, where any person proves to the satisfaction of the Commissioners that any dutiable alcoholic liquor on which duty has been paid has been—
(a)used as an ingredient in the production or manufacture of a product falling within subsection (2) below, or
(b)converted into vinegar,
he shall be entitled to obtain from the Commissioners the repayment of the duty paid thereon.
(2)The products falling within this subsection are—
(a)any beverage of an alcoholic strength not exceeding 1.2 per cent.,
(b)chocolates for human consumption which contain alcohol such that 100 kilograms of the chocolates would not contain more than 8.5 litres of alcohol, or
(c)any other food for human consumption which contains alcohol such that 100 kilograms of the food would not contain more than 5 litres of alcohol.
(3)A repayment of duty shall not be made under this section in respect of any liquor except to a person who—
(a)is the person who used the liquor as an ingredient in a product falling within subsection (2) above or, as the case may be, who converted it into vinegar;
(b)carries on a business as a wholesale supplier of products of the applicable description falling within that subsection or, as the case may be, of vinegar;
(c)produced or manufactured the product or vinegar for the purposes of that business;
(d)makes a claim for the repayment in accordance with the following provisions of this section; and
(e)satisfies the Commissioners as to the matters mentioned in paragraphs (a) to (c) above and that the repayment claimed does not relate to any duty which has been repaid or drawn back prior to the making of the claim.
(4)A claim for repayment under this section shall take such form and be made in such manner, and shall contain such particulars, as the Commissioners may direct, either generally or in a particular case.
(5)Except so far as the Commissioners otherwise allow, a person shall not make a claim for a repayment under this section unless—
(a)the claim relates to duty paid on liquor used as an ingredient or, as the case may be, converted into vinegar in the course of a period of three months ending not more than one month before the making of the claim; and
(b)the amount of the repayment which is claimed is not less than £250.
(6)The Commissioners may by order made by statutory instrument increase the amount for the time being specified in subsection (5)(b) above; and a statutory instrument containing an order under this subsection shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
(7)There may be remitted by the Commissioners any duty charged either—
(a)on any dutiable alcoholic liquor imported into the United Kingdom at a time when it is contained as an ingredient in any chocolates or food falling within subsection (2)(b) or (c) above; or
(b)on any dutiable alcoholic liquor used as an ingredient in the manufacture or production in an excise warehouse of any such chocolates or food.
(8)This section shall be construed as one with the M4Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979, and references in this section to chocolates or food do not include references to any beverages.
Valid from 01/07/2005
(1)The liquors on which duty is charged under the M5Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 shall not include any denatured alcohol; and any duty so charged on liquor which has become denatured alcohol before the requirement to pay the duty takes effect shall be remitted.
(2)In this section—
“denatured alcohol” means any dutiable alcoholic liquor which has been subjected to the process of being mixed in the prescribed manner with a prescribed substance; and
“prescribed” means prescribed by the Commissioners by regulations made by statutory instrument.
(3)The power of the Commissioners to make regulations defining denatured alcohol for the purposes of this section shall include—
(a)power, in prescribing any substance or any manner of mixing a substance with a liquor, to do so by reference to such circumstances or other factors, or to the approval or opinion of such persons (including the authorities of another member State), as they may consider appropriate;
(b)power to make different provision for different cases; and
(c)power to make such supplemental, incidental, consequential and transitional provision as the Commissioners think fit;
and a statutory instrument containing any regulations under this section shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of either House of Parliament.
(4)Sections 14 to 16 of the M6Finance Act 1994 (review and appeals) shall have effect in relation to any decision which—
(a)is made under or for the purposes of any regulations under this section, and
(b)is a decision given to any person as to whether a manner of mixing any substance with any liquor is to be, or to continue to be, approved in his case, or as to the conditions subject to which it is so approved,
as if that decision were a decision specified in Schedule 5 to that Act.
(5)Schedule 2 to this Act (which contains amendments for or in connection with the application to all denatured alcohol of provisions of the Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 relating to methylated spirits and also makes a consequential amendment of the M7Finance Act 1994) shall have effect.
(6)This section and Schedule 2 to this Act shall come into force on such day as the Commissioners may by order made by statutory instrument appoint, and different days may be appointed under this subsection for different purposes.
(7)An order under subsection (6) above may make such transitional provisions and savings as appear to the Commissioners to be appropriate in connection with the bringing into force by such an order of any provision for any purposes.
(8)This section shall be construed as one with the M8Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979.
(1)In section 6(1) of the M9Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 for “£0.3314” (duty on light oil) and “£0.2770” (duty on heavy oil) there shall be substituted “ £0.3526 ” and “ £0.3044 ” respectively.
(2)In section 8 of that Act (duty on road fuel gas) the following subsection shall be substituted for subsections (3) to (5)—
“(3)The rate of the duty under this section shall be £0.3314 a kilogram.”
(3)In section 11(1) of that Act (rebate on heavy oil) for “£0.0116” (fuel oil) and “£0.0164” (gas oil) there shall be substituted “ £0.0166 ” and “ £0.0214 ” respectively.
(4)In section 14(1) of that Act (rebate on light oil for use as furnace fuel) for “£0.0116” there shall be substituted “ £0.0166 ”.
(5)This section shall be deemed to have come into force at 6 o’clock in the evening of 29th November 1994.
Commencement Information
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 6(1) of the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979, as amended by section 6 above, for “£0.3526” (duty on light oil) and “£0.3044” (duty on heavy oil) there shall be substituted “ £0.3614 ” and “ £0.3132 ” respectively.
(2)This section shall be deemed to have come into force on 1st January 1995.
(1)In the definition of “road vehicle” in section 27(1) of the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (road vehicle not to include vehicle of a kind specified in Schedule 1) for the words “of a kind specified in Schedule 1 to this Act” there shall be substituted “ which is an excepted vehicle within the meaning given by Schedule 1 to this Act. ”
(2)The following Schedule shall be substituted for Schedule 1 to that Act—
1(1)A vehicle is an excepted vehicle while—
(a)it is not used on a public road, and
(b)no licence under the M10Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 is in force in respect of it.
(2)A vehicle in respect of which there is current a certificate or document in the form of a licence issued under regulations under section 22(2) of the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 shall be treated for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) above as a vehicle in respect of which a licence under that Act is in force.
2(1)A vehicle is an excepted vehicle if it is—
(a)an agricultural tractor, or
(b)an off-road tractor.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above “agricultural tractor” means a tractor used on public roads solely for purposes relating to agriculture, horticulture, forestry or activities falling within sub-paragraph (3) below.
(3)The activities falling within this sub-paragraph are—
(a)cutting verges bordering public roads;
(b)cutting hedges or trees bordering public roads or bordering verges which border public roads.
(4)In sub-paragraph (1) above “off-road tractor” means a tractor which is not an agricultural tractor (within the meaning given by sub-paragraph (2) above) and which is—
(a)designed and constructed primarily for use otherwise than on roads, and
(b)incapable by reason of its construction of exceeding a speed of twenty-five miles per hour on the level under its own power.
3(1)A vehicle is an excepted vehicle if it is a light agricultural vehicle.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above “light agricultural vehicle” means a vehicle which—
(a)has a revenue weight not exceeding 1,000 kilograms,
(b)is designed and constructed so as to seat only the driver,
(c)is designed and constructed primarily for use otherwise than on roads, and
(d)is used solely for purposes relating to agriculture, horticulture or forestry.
(3)In sub-paragraph (2)(a) above “revenue weight” has the meaning given by section 60A of the M11Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994.
4An agricultural engine is an excepted vehicle.
5A vehicle is an excepted vehicle if—
(a)it is used only for purposes relating to agriculture, horticulture or forestry,
(b)it is used on public roads only in passing between different areas of land occupied by the same person, and
(c)the distance it travels on public roads in passing between any two such areas does not exceed 1.5 kilometres.
6A mowing machine is an excepted vehicle.
7A vehicle is an excepted vehicle when it is—
(a)being used, or
(b)going to or from the place where it is to be or has been used,
for the purpose of clearing snow from public roads by means of a snow plough or similar device (whether or not forming part of the vehicle).
8A vehicle is an excepted vehicle if it is constructed or adapted, and used, solely for the conveyance of machinery for spreading material on roads to deal with frost, ice or snow (with or without articles or material used for the purposes of the machinery).
9(1)A mobile crane is an excepted vehicle.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above “mobile crane” means a vehicle which is designed and constructed as a mobile crane and which—
(a)is used on public roads only as a crane in connection with work carried on at a site in the immediate vicinity or for the purpose of proceeding to and from a place where it is to be or has been used as a crane, and
(b)when so proceeding does not carry any load except such as is necessary for its propulsion or equipment.
10(1)A digging machine is an excepted vehicle.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above “digging machine” means a vehicle which is designed, constructed and used for the purpose of trench digging, or any kind of excavating or shovelling work, and which—
(a)is used on public roads only for that purpose or for the purpose of proceeding to and from the place where it is to be or has been used for that purpose, and
(b)when so proceeding does not carry any load except such as is necessary for its propulsion or equipment.
11(1)A works truck is an excepted vehicle.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above “works truck” means a goods vehicle which is designed for use in private premises and is used on public roads only—
(a)for carrying goods between private premises and a vehicle on a road within one kilometre of those premises,
(b)in passing from one part of private premises to another,
(c)in passing between private premises and other private premises in a case where the premises are within one kilometre of each other, or
(d)in connection with road works at the site of the works or within one kilometre of the site of the works.
(3)In sub-paragraph (2) above “goods vehicle” means a vehicle constructed or adapted for use and used for the conveyance of goods or burden of any description, whether in the course of trade or not.
12(1)A vehicle is an excepted vehicle if it is—
(a)a road construction vehicle, and
(b)used or kept solely for the conveyance of built-in road construction machinery (with or without articles or material used for the purposes of the machinery).
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above “road construction vehicle” means a vehicle—
(a)which is constructed or adapted for use for the conveyance of built-in road construction machinery, and
(b)which is not constructed or adapted for the conveyance of any other load except articles and material used for the purposes of such machinery.
(3)In sub-paragraphs (1) and (2) above “built-in road construction machinery”, in relation to a vehicle, means road construction machinery built in as part of, or permanently attached to, the vehicle.
(4)In sub-paragraph (3) above “road construction machinery” means a machine or device suitable for use for the construction or repair of roads and used for no purpose other than the construction or repair of roads.
13A road roller is an excepted vehicle.
14In this Schedule “public road” means a road which is repairable at the public expense.”
(3)This section shall come into force on 1st July 1995.
Commencement Information
Marginal Citations
In section 8 of the M12Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (road fuel gas) subsection (7) (no charge on use of gas if delivered or stocked before 3rd July 1972) shall be omitted.
(1)For the Table of rates of duty in Schedule 1 to the M13Tobacco Products Duty Act 1979 there shall be substituted—
1. Cigarettes | An amount equal to 20 per cent. of the retail price plus £55.58 per thousand cigarettes. |
2. Cigars | £82.56 per kilogram. |
3. Hand-rolling tobacco | £85.94 per kilogram. |
4. Other smoking tobacco and chewing tobacco | £36.30 per kilogram.” |
(2)This section shall be deemed to have come into force at 6 o’clock in the evening of 29th November 1994.
Commencement Information
Marginal Citations
(1)For the Table of rates of duty in Schedule 1 to the M14Tobacco Products Duty Act 1979, as substituted by section 10 above, there shall be substituted—
1. Cigarettes | An amount equal to 20 per cent. of the retail price plus £57.64 per thousand cigarettes. |
2. Cigars | £85.61 per kilogram. |
3. Hand-rolling tobacco | £85.94 per kilogram. |
4. Other smoking tobacco and chewing tobacco | £37.64 per kilogram.” |
(2)This section shall be deemed to have come into force on 1st January 1995.
(1)In section 7(1) of the M15Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 (which specifies 37.50 per cent. as the rate of pool betting duty) for “37.50 per cent.” there shall be substituted “ 32.50 per cent. ”
(2)This section shall apply in relation to any pool betting duty the requirement to pay which takes effect on or after 6th May 1995.
Marginal Citations
(1)In the M16Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 for the Table set out at the end of section 23 (amount of duty) there shall be substituted—
(1) Period (in months) for which licence granted | (2) Small prize or five-penny machines | (3) Other machines |
---|---|---|
£ | £ | |
1 | 60 | 150 |
2 | 105 | 275 |
3 | 155 | 400 |
4 | 205 | 520 |
5 | 250 | 645 |
6 | 295 | 755 |
7 | 340 | 880 |
8 | 390 | 1,005 |
9 | 435 | 1,115 |
10 | 480 | 1,235 |
11 | 510 | 1,305 |
12 | 535 | 1,375 |
(2)This section shall apply in relation to any gaming machine licence for which an application is made on or after 1st December 1994.
Marginal Citations
(1)Schedule 3 to this Act (which contains amendments for or in connection with the application of the provisions of the M17Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 relating to gaming machine licence duty to amusement machines that are not gaming machines and also makes a consequential amendment of the M18Customs and Excise Management Act 1979) shall have effect.
(2)Schedule 3 to this Act shall have effect (subject to subsection (3) below) in relation only to the provision of a machine at a time on or after 1st November 1995 and to licences for periods beginning on or after that date and the duty on such licences.
(3)Where a gaming machine licence has been granted before 1st November 1995 for a period ending on or after that date, that licence shall have effect on and after that date, for so long as it remains in force, as an amusement machine licence authorising the provision, in accordance with the licence, of the machines the provision of which was authorised by the licence immediately before that date.
(1)Section 30 of the M19Finance Act 1994 (rate of air passenger duty) shall be deemed to have been enacted with the following modifications.
(2)The following subsection shall be substituted for subsection (2) (£5 if journey ends in member State or territory for whose external relations it is responsible)—
“(2)The rate is £5 if that place is in the area specified in subsection (3) below and in—
(a)the United Kingdom or another EEA State, or
(b)any territory for whose external relations the United Kingdom or another member State is responsible.”
(3)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (8)—
“(9)In this section “EEA State” means a State which is a Contracting Party to the EEA Agreement but until the EEA Agreement comes into force in relation to Liechtenstein does not include the State of Liechtenstein; and “EEA Agreement” here means the Agreement on the European Economic Area signed at Oporto on 2nd May 1992 as adjusted by the Protocol signed at Brussels on 17th March 1993.”
(1)In Schedule 6 to the M20Finance Act 1994 (air passenger duty: administration and enforcement) after paragraph 11 there shall be inserted—
“ Assessment of interest11A(1)Where by virtue of paragraph 7 above duty due from any person for an accounting period carries interest, the Commissioners may assess that person to an amount of interest in accordance with this paragraph.
(2)Notice of the assessment shall be given to the person liable for the interest or a representative of his.
(3)The amount of the interest shall be calculated by reference to a period ending on a date (“the due date”) no later than the date of the notice.
(4)The notice shall specify—
(a)the amount of the duty which carries the interest assessed (“the specified duty”);
(b)the amount of the interest assessed (“the specified interest”);
(c)the due date; and
(d)a date by which that amount is required to be paid (“the payment date”).
(5)Sub-paragraphs (6) and (7) below apply where the specified duty or any part of it is unpaid on the date of the notice.
(6)If the unpaid amount or any part of it is paid by the payment date, the payment shall be treated for the purposes of paragraph 7 above as made on the due date.
(7)To the extent that the unpaid amount is not paid by the payment date, an assessment may be made under this paragraph in respect of any interest on the unpaid amount which accrues after the due date.
(8)For the purposes of sub-paragraphs (6) and (7) above, a payment—
(a)which purports to be a payment of the unpaid amount or any part of it, but
(b)which is insufficient to discharge both the liability to pay the unpaid amount and the liability to pay the specified interest,
shall be treated as made in discharge (or partial discharge) of the liability to pay the specified interest before it is treated as discharging to any extent the liability to pay the unpaid amount.
(9)A notice of interest assessed under this paragraph may be combined in one document with notification of an assessment under section 12 of this Act which relates to the specified duty.
(10)A notice which is so combined must comply with the requirements of this paragraph which relate to a notice which is not so combined.
(11)The specified interest shall be recoverable as if it were duty due from the person assessed to that interest.
(12)For the purposes of this paragraph a person is a representative of another if—
(a)he is that other’s personal representative;
(b)he is that other’s trustee in bankruptcy or is a receiver or liquidator appointed in relation to that other or in relation to any of his property; or
(c)he is a person acting in some other representative capacity in relation to that other.”
(2)In Schedule 5 to the 1994 Act (decisions subject to review and appeal) in paragraph 9 (decisions under Chapter IV of Part I of that Act) the word “and” immediately preceding sub-paragraph (d) shall be omitted and after that sub-paragraph there shall be inserted—
“(e)any decision with respect to the amount of any interest specified in an assessment under paragraph 11A of Schedule 6;”.
(3)In section 16 of the 1994 Act (appeals to a tribunal) at the beginning of subsection (8) (meaning of “ancillary matter” for the purposes of that section) there shall be inserted “ Subject to subsection (9) below ” and after that subsection there shall be inserted—
“(9)References in this section to a decision as to an ancillary matter do not include a reference to a decision of a description specified in paragraph 9(e) of Schedule 5 to this Act.
(10)Nothing in this section shall be taken to confer on an appeal tribunal any power to vary an amount of interest specified in an assessment under paragraph 11A of Schedule 6 to this Act except in so far as it is necessary to reduce it to the amount which is appropriate under paragraph 7 of that Schedule.”
(4)This section shall apply in relation to accounting periods ending on or after 1st January 1995.
In section 386(1) of the M21Insolvency Act 1986 (categories of preferential debts) and in Article 346(1) of the M22Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989 (equivalent provision for Northern Ireland) after “lottery duty” there shall be inserted “ , air passenger duty ”.
(1)Schedule 1 to the M23Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 (annual rates of duty) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph 1(b) (rate for vehicle constructed after 1946 and for which no other rate is specified) for “£130” there shall be substituted “ £135 ”.
(3)In paragraph 3(1)(a) (rate for hackney carriage with seating capacity under nine) for “£130” there shall be substituted “ £135 ”.
(4)In paragraph 10 (trailer supplement)—
(a)in sub-paragraph (2) for “£130” there shall be substituted “ £135 ”;
(b)in sub-paragraph (3) for “£360” there shall be substituted “ £370 ”.
(5)This section shall apply in relation to licences taken out on or after 30th November 1994.
Marginal Citations
Schedule 4 to this Act (which contains other provisions relating to vehicle excise and registration) shall have effect.
(1)In Part X of the M24Customs and Excise Management Act 1979, after section 137 (recovery of duties, &c.) insert—
(1)Where a person pays to the Commissioners an amount by way of excise duty which is not due to them, the Commissioners are liable to repay that amount.
(2)The Commissioners shall not be required to make any such repayment unless a claim is made to them in such form, and supported by such documentary evidence, as may be prescribed by them by regulations; and regulations under this subsection may make different provision for different cases.
(3)It is a defence to a claim for repayment that the repayment would unjustly enrich the claimant.
(4)No claim for repayment may be made after the expiry of the period of six years beginning with the date of the payment or, if later, the date on which the claimant (or, where the right to repayment has been assigned or otherwise transmitted, any predecessor in title of his) discovered, or could with reasonable diligence have discovered, that the amount was not due.
(5)Except as provided by this section the Commissioners are not liable to repay an amount paid to them by way of excise duty by reason of the fact that it was not due to them.”.
(2)In section 17(5) of the M25Customs and Excise Management Act 1979, after paragraph (b) (restriction on repayment of sums overpaid in error) insert—
“Paragraph (b) above does not apply to a claim for repayment under section 137A below.”.
(3)Section 29 of the M26Finance Act 1989 (recovery of overpaid excise duty and car tax) shall cease to have effect so far as it relates to excise duty.
(4)In section 14(1) of the M27Finance Act 1994 (decisions subject to review and appeal), after paragraph (b) insert—
“(bb)any decision of the Commissioners on a claim under section 137A of the Customs and Excise Management Act 1979 for repayment of excise duty;”.
(5)The provisions of this section have effect in relation to payments made on or after such date as the Commissioners of Customs and Excise may appoint by order made by statutory instrument.
Commencement Information
I9S. 20 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect in relation to payments made on or after 1.12.1995 by S.I. 1995/2892, art. 2
Marginal Citations
Textual Amendments
(1)In subsection (1) of section 21 of the M28Value Added Tax Act 1994 (value of imported goods), for “and (3)” there shall be substituted “ to (4) ”; and after subsection (3) there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(4)For the purposes of this Act, the value of any goods falling within subsection (5) below which are imported from a place outside the member States shall be taken to be an amount equal to 14.29 per cent. of the amount which, apart from this subsection, would be their value for those purposes.
(5)The goods which fall within this subsection are—
(a)any work of art which was obtained by any person before 1st April 1973 otherwise than by his producing it himself or by succession on the death of the person who produced it;
(b)any work of art which was—
(i)exported from the United Kingdom before 1st April 1973,
(ii)exported from the United Kingdom on or after that date and before 1st January 1993 by a person who, had he supplied it in the United Kingdom at the date when it was exported, would not have had to account for VAT on the full value of the supply, or
(iii)exported from the United Kingdom on or after 1st January 1993 by such a person to a place which, at the time, was outside the member States,
being, in each case, a work of art which has not been imported between the time when it was exported and the importation in question;
(c)any antique more than one hundred years old, being neither a work of art nor pearls or loose gem stones; and
(d)collectors’ pieces of zoological, botanical, mineralogical, anatomical, historical, archaeological, paleontological or ethnographic interest.
(6)In this section “work of art” means goods falling within any of the following descriptions, that is to say—
(a)paintings, drawings and pastels executed by hand but not comprised in manufactured articles that have been hand-painted or hand-decorated;
(b)original engravings, lithographs and other prints;
(c)original sculptures and statuary, in any material.
(7)An order under section 2(2) may contain provision making such alteration of the percentage for the time being specified in subsection (4) above as the Treasury consider appropriate in consequence of any increase or decrease by that order of the rate of VAT.”
(2)This section shall have effect in relation to goods imported at any time on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
Marginal Citations
(1)In subsection (1) of section 47 of the M29Value Added Tax Act 1994 (agents etc.), for “the goods may” there shall be substituted “ then, if the taxable person acts in relation to the supply in his own name, the goods shall ”.
(2)After subsection (2) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(2A)Where, in the case of any supply of goods to which subsection (1) above does not apply, goods are supplied through an agent who acts in his own name, the supply shall be treated both as a supply to the agent and as a supply by the agent.”
(3)In subsection (3) of that section, the words “goods or” shall be omitted.
(4)This section shall have effect—
(a)so far as it amends section 47(1) of that Act, in relation to goods acquired or imported on or after the day on which this Act is passed; and
(b)for other purposes, in relation to any supply taking place on or after that day.
Marginal Citations
(1)After section 50 of the M30Value Added Tax Act 1994 there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)The Treasury may by order provide, in relation to any such description of supplies to which this section applies as may be specified in the order, for a taxable person to be entitled to opt that, where he makes supplies of that description, VAT is to be charged by reference to the profit margin on the supplies, instead of by reference to their value.
(2)This section applies to the following supplies, that is to say—
(a)supplies of works of art, antiques or collectors’ items;
(b)supplies of motor vehicles;
(c)supplies of second-hand goods; and
(d)any supply of goods through a person who acts as an agent, but in his own name, in relation to the supply.
(3)An option for the purposes of an order under this section shall be exercisable, and may be withdrawn, in such manner as may be required by such an order.
(4)Subject to subsection (7) below, the profit margin on a supply to which this section applies shall be taken, for the purposes of an order under this section, to be equal to the amount (if any) by which the price at which the person making the supply obtained the goods in question is exceeded by the price at which he supplies them.
(5)For the purposes of this section the price at which a person has obtained any goods and the price at which he supplies them shall each be calculated in accordance with the provisions contained in an order under this section; and such an order may, in particular, make provision stipulating the extent to which any VAT charged on a supply, acquisition or importation of any goods is to be treated as included in the price at which those goods have been obtained or are supplied.
(6)An order under this section may provide that the consideration for any services supplied in connection with a supply of goods by a person who acts as an agent, but in his own name, in relation to the supply of the goods is to be treated for the purposes of any such order as an amount to be taken into account in computing the profit margin on the supply of the goods, instead of being separately chargeable to VAT as comprised in the value of the services supplied.
(7)An order under this section may provide for the total profit margin on all the goods of a particular description supplied by a person in any prescribed accounting period to be calculated by—
(a)aggregating all the prices at which that person obtained goods of that description in that period together with any amount carried forward to that period in pursuance of paragraph (d) below;
(b)aggregating all the prices at which he supplies goods of that description in that period;
(c)treating the total profit margin on goods supplied in that period as being equal to the amount (if any) by which, for that period, the aggregate calculated in pursuance of paragraph (a) above is exceeded by the aggregate calculated in pursuance of paragraph (b) above; and
(d)treating any amount by which, for that period, the aggregate calculated in pursuance of paragraph (b) above is exceeded by the aggregate calculated in pursuance of paragraph (a) above as an amount to be carried forward to the following prescribed accounting period so as to be included, for the period to which it is carried forward, in any aggregate falling to be calculated in pursuance of paragraph (a) above.
(8)An order under this section may—
(a)make different provision for different cases; and
(b)make provisions of the order subject to such general or special directions as may, in accordance with the order, be given by the Commissioners with respect to any matter to which the order relates.”
(2)Section 32 of that Act (relief on supply of certain second-hand goods) shall cease to have effect on such day as the Commissioners of Customs and Excise may by order made by statutory instrument appoint.
Marginal Citations
(1) Section 43 of the M31Value Added Tax Act 1994 (groups of companies) shall be amended as follows.
(2)[F2After subsection (1) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(1A)Paragraph (a) of subsection (1) above shall not apply in relation to any supply of goods or services by one member of a group to another unless both the body making the supply and the body supplied continue to be members of that group until—
(a)in the case of a supply of goods which are to be removed in pursuance of the supply, a time after the removal;
(b)in the case of any other supply of goods, a time after the goods have been made available, in pursuance of the supply, to the body supplied; or
(c)in the case of a supply of services, a time after the services have been performed.”];
and in subsection (1)(b), for “other supply” there shall be substituted “ supply which is a supply to which paragraph (a) above does not apply and is a supply ”.
(3)In subsection (5) (applications to be treated or to cease to be treated as members of a group etc.), for the words after paragraph (d) there shall be substituted—
“unless the Commissioners refuse the application under subsection (5A) below.”
(4)After subsection (5) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5A)If it appears to the Commissioners necessary to do so for the protection of the revenue, they may—
(a)refuse any application made to the effect mentioned in paragraph (a) or (c) of subsection (5) above; or
(b)refuse any application made to the effect mentioned in paragraph (b) or (d) of that subsection in a case that does not appear to them to fall within subsection (6) below.”
(5)Subsection (2) above has effect in relation to—
(a)any supply made on or after 1st March 1995, and
(b)any supply made before that date in the case of which both the body making the supply and the body supplied continued to be members of the group in question until at least that date,
and subsections (3) and (4) above have effect in relation to applications made on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
Textual Amendments
F2Words in s. 25(2) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in s. 31(5) of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. IV(5)
Marginal Citations
Prospective
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F3S. 26 repealed (with effect in accordance with art. 1(2) of the amending S.I.) by The Value Added Tax (Buildings and Land) Order 2008 (S.I. 2008/1146), arts. 1(1), 5(1) (with Sch. 2)
(1)Section 81 of the M32Value Added Tax Act 1994 (which includes provision as to the setting off of credits) shall be amended as follows.
(2)For subsection (4) there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(4A)Subsection (3) above shall not require any such amount as is mentioned in paragraph (a) of that subsection (“the credit”) to be set against any such sum as is mentioned in paragraph (b) of that subsection (“the debit”) in any case where—
(a)an insolvency procedure has been applied to the person entitled to the credit;
(b)the credit became due after that procedure was so applied; and
(c)the liability to pay the debit either arose before that procedure was so applied or (having arisen afterwards) relates to, or to matters occurring in the course of, the carrying on of any business at times before the procedure was so applied.
(4B)Subject to subsection (4C) below, the following are the times when an insolvency procedure is to be taken, for the purposes of this section, to be applied to any person, that is to say—
(a)when a bankruptcy order, winding-up order, adminis-tration order or award of sequestration is made in relation to that person;
(b)when that person is put into administrative receivership;
(c)when that person, being a corporation, passes a resolution for voluntary winding up;
(d)when any voluntary arrangement approved in accordance with Part I or VIII of the Insolvency Act 1986, or Part II or Chapter II of Part VIII of the M33Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989, comes into force in relation to that person;
(e)when a deed of arrangement registered in accordance with the M34Deeds of Arrangement Act 1914 or Chapter I of Part VIII of that Order of 1989 takes effect in relation to that person;
(f)when that person’s estate becomes vested in any other person as that person’s trustee under a trust deed.
(4C)In this section references, in relation to any person, to the application of an insolvency procedure to that person shall not include—
(a)the making of a bankruptcy order, winding-up order, administration order or award of sequestration at a time when any such arrangement or deed as is mentioned in subsection (4B)(d) to (f) above is in force in relation to that person;
(b)the making of a winding-up order at any of the following times, that is to say—
(i)immediately upon the discharge of an administration order made in relation to that person;
(ii)when that person is being wound up voluntarily;
(iii)when that person is in administrative receivership;
or
(c)the making of an administration order in relation to that person at any time when that person is in administrative receivership.
(4D)For the purposes of this section a person shall be regarded as being in administrative receivership throughout any continuous period for which (disregarding any temporary vacancy in the office of receiver) there is an administrative receiver of that person, and the reference in subsection (4B) above to a person being put into administrative receivership shall be construed accordingly.”
(3)In subsection (5) (definitions), for “subsection (4) above” there shall be substituted “ this section ”.
(4)This section shall have effect in relation to amounts becoming due from the Commissioners of Customs and Excise at times on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
(1)In section 30 of the M35Value Added Tax Act 1994 (zero-rated supplies) for subsection (5) (transactions described in Schedule 8 to the Act to be treated as supplies) there shall be substituted—
“(5)The export of any goods by a charity to a place outside the member States shall for the purposes of this Act be treated as a supply made by the charity—
(a)in the United Kingdom, and
(b)in the course or furtherance of a business carried on by the charity.”
(2)This section shall have effect in relation to transactions occurring on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
Marginal Citations
In section 18 of the M36Value Added Tax Act 1994 (place and time of acquisition or supply of goods subject to warehousing regime) for subsection (5) (regulations about payment of VAT on supply of such goods) there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(5)The Commissioners may by regulations make provision for enabling a taxable person to pay the VAT he is required to pay by virtue of paragraph (b) of subsection (4) above at a time later than that provided for by that paragraph.
(5A)Regulations under subsection (5) above may in particular make provision for either or both of the following—
(a)for the taxable person to pay the VAT together with the VAT chargeable on other supplies by him of goods and services;
(b)for the taxable person to pay the VAT together with any duty of excise deferment of which has been granted to him under section 127A of the M37Customs and Excise Management Act 1979;
and they may make different provision for different descriptions of taxable person and for different descriptions of goods.”
(1)Section 57 of the M38Value Added Tax Act 1994 (determination of consideration for fuel supplied for private use) shall be amended as follows.
(2)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (1)—
“(1A)Where the prescribed accounting period is a period of 12 months, the consideration appropriate to any vehicle is that specified in relation to a vehicle of the appropriate description in the second column of Table A below.”
(3)In subsection (2) (consideration where prescribed accounting period is period of 3 months) for “second” there shall be substituted “ third ”.
(4)In subsection (3) (consideration where prescribed accounting period is period of one month) for “third” there shall be substituted “ fourth ”.
(5)The following Table shall be substituted for Table A—
Description of vehicle (Type of engine and cylinder capacity in cubic centimetres) | 12 month period | 3 month period | 1 month period |
---|---|---|---|
£ | £ | £ | |
Diesel engine 2000 or less | 605 | 151 | 50 |
More than 2000 | 780 | 195 | 65 |
Any other type of engine 1400 or less | 670 | 167 | 55 |
More than 1400 but not more than 2000 | 850 | 212 | 70 |
More than 2000 | 1260 | 315 | 105” |
(6)This section shall apply in relation to prescribed accounting periods beginning on or after 6th April 1995.
(7)Nothing in this section shall be taken to prejudice any practice by which the consideration appropriate to a vehicle is arrived at where a prescribed accounting period beginning before 6th April 1995 is a period of 12 months.
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 84(2) of the M39Value Added Tax Act 1994 (appeal not to be entertained unless amounts shown in returns paid, except in certain cases) the words “, except in the case of an appeal against a decision with respect to the matter mentioned in section 83(l),” shall be omitted.
(2)This section shall apply in relation to appeals brought after the day on which this Act is passed.
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 67 of the M40Value Added Tax Act 1994 (failure to notify and unauthorised issue of invoices) in subsection (4) (the specified percentage)—
(a)in paragraph (a) for “10 per cent.” there shall be substituted “ 5 per cent. ”;
(b)in paragraph (b) for “20 per cent.” there shall be substituted “ 10 per cent. ”; and
(c)in paragraph (c) for “30 per cent.” there shall be substituted “ 15 per cent. ”
(2)Section 15(3A) of the Finance Act 1985 (provision which is repealed by the M411994 Act and which corresponds to section 67(4)) shall have effect subject to the amendments made by subsection (1) above.
(3)Subject to subsection (4) below, subsections (1) and (2) above shall apply where a penalty is assessed on or after 1st January 1995.
(4)Subsections (1) and (2) above shall not apply in the case of a supplementary assessment if the original assessment was made before 1st January 1995.
(1)The M42Value Added Tax Act 1994 shall have effect, and be deemed always to have had effect, as if it had been enacted as follows.
[F4(2)Section 35(1) (refund of VAT to persons constructing certain buildings) shall be deemed to have been enacted with the word “building” substituted for the word “ dwelling ” in each place where it occurs.]
(3)Paragraph 5(5) and (6)(b) of Schedule 4 and paragraph 7(b) of Schedule 6 (which contain references to paragraph 5(3) of Schedule 4 which should be references to paragraph 5(4) of that Schedule) shall be deemed to have been enacted—
(a)in the case of paragraph 5(5) and (6)(b), with “sub-paragraph (4) above” substituted for “ sub-paragraph (3) above ”, in each case; and
(b)in the case of paragraph 7(b), with “paragraph 5(4)” substituted for “ paragraph 5(3) ”.
(4)In paragraph 9 of Schedule 13 (which contains transitional provisions relating to bad debt relief), the following sub-paragraph shall be deemed to have been enacted instead of sub-paragraph (2) of that paragraph, that is to say—
“(2)Claims for refunds of VAT shall not be made in accordance with section 36 of this Act in relation to—
(a)any supply made before 1st April 1989; or
(b)any supply as respects which a claim is or has been made under section 22 of the 1983 Act.”
(5)In paragraph 13 of Schedule 14 (consequential amendment of the M43Finance Act 1994), the following sub-paragraph shall be deemed to have been enacted instead of sub-paragraph (a) of that paragraph, that is to say—
“(a)in subsection (4) for “25 and 29 of the Finance Act 1985” and “40 of the Value Added Tax Act 1983” there shall be substituted, respectively, “85 and 87 of the Value Added Tax Act 1994” and “83 of that Act”;”.
Textual Amendments
F4S. 33(2) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in s. 30(4) of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. IV(4)
Marginal Citations
Schedule 5 to this Act (which relates to insurance premium tax) shall have effect.
(1)Income tax shall be charged for the year 1995-96, and for that year—
(a)the lower rate shall be 20 per cent.,
(b)the basic rate shall be 25 per cent., and
(c)the higher rate shall be 40 per cent.
(2)For the year 1995-96 section 1(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 shall apply as if the amount specified in paragraph (aa) were £3,200 (the lower rate limit); and accordingly section 1(4) of that Act (indexation) so far as relating to that paragraph shall not apply for the year 1995-96.
Section 257 of the Taxes Act 1988 (personal allowance) shall apply for the year 1995-96 as if—
(a)the amount specified in subsection (2) (persons of 65 or upwards) were £4,630, and
(b)the amount specified in subsection (3) (persons of 75 or upwards) were £4,800;
and accordingly section 257C(1) of that Act (indexation) so far as relating to section 257(2) and (3) shall not apply for the year 1995-96.
Corporation tax shall be charged for the financial year 1995 at the rate of 33 per cent.
For the financial year 1995—
(a)the small companies’ rate shall be 25 per cent., and
(b)the fraction mentioned in section 13(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 (marginal relief for small companies) shall be one fiftieth.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F5S. 39 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165(1), Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
(1)The following section shall be inserted after section 42 of the Taxes Act 1988—
(1)The Board may by regulations make provision for the charging, assessment, collection and recovery on or from prescribed persons falling within subsection (2) below of prescribed amounts in respect of the tax which is or may become chargeable under Schedule A on the income of any person who has his usual place of abode outside the United Kingdom (“the non-resident”).
(2)A person falls within this subsection if he is—
(a)a person by whom any such sums are payable to the non-resident as fall, or would fall, to be treated as receipts of a Schedule A business carried on by the non-resident; or
(b)a person who acts on behalf of the non-resident in connection with the management or administration of any such business.
(3)A person on whom any obligation to make payments to the Board is imposed by regulations under this section shall be entitled—
(a)to be indemnified by the non-resident for all such payments; and
(b)to retain, out of any sums otherwise due from him to the non-resident, or received by him on behalf of the non-resident, amounts sufficient for meeting any liabilities under the regulations to make payments to the Board which have been discharged by that person or to which he is subject.
(4)Without prejudice to the generality of the preceding provisions of this section, regulations under this section may include any or all of the following provisions, that is to say—
(a)provision for the amount of any payment to be made to the Board in respect of the tax on any income to be calculated by reference to such factors as may be prescribed;
(b)provision for the determination in accordance with any such regulations of the period for which, the circumstances in which and the times at which any payments are to be made to the Board;
(c)provision for requiring the payment of interest on amounts which are not paid to the Board at the times required under any such regulations;
(d)provision as to the certificates to be given in prescribed circumstances to the non-resident by a person falling within subsection (2) above, and as to the particulars to be included in any such certificate;
(e)provision for the making of repayments of tax to the non-resident and for such repayments to be made in prescribed cases to persons falling within subsection (2) above;
(f)provision for the payment of interest by the Board on sums repaid under any such regulations;
(g)provision for the rights and obligations arising under any such regulations to depend on the giving of such notices and the making of such claims and determinations as may be prescribed;
(h)provision for the making and determination of applications for requirements of any such regulations not to apply in certain cases, and for the variation or revocation, in prescribed cases, of the determinations made on such applications;
(i)provision for appeals with respect to questions arising under any such regulations;
(j)provision requiring prescribed persons falling within subsection (2)(b) above to register with the Board;
(k)provision requiring persons registered with the Board and other prescribed persons falling within subsection (2) above to make returns and supply prescribed information to the Board and to make available prescribed books, documents and other records for inspection on behalf of the Board;
(l)provision for the partnership, as such, to be treated as the person falling within subsection (2) above in a case where a liability to make any payment under the regulations arises from amounts payable or things done in the course of a business carried on by any persons in partnership;
(m)provision which, in relation to payments to be made by virtue of this section in respect of any tax or to any sums retained in respect of such payments, applies (with or without modifications) any enactment or subordinate legislation having effect apart from this section with respect to cases in which tax is or is treated as deducted from any income.
(5)Interest required to be paid by any regulations under this section shall be paid without deduction of tax and shall not be taken into account in computing any income, profits or losses for any tax purposes.
(6)Regulations under this section may—
(a)make different provision for different cases; and
(b)contain such supplementary, incidental, consequential and transitional provision as appears to the Board to be appropriate;
and the provision that may be made by virtue of paragraph (b) above may include provision which, in connection with any other provision made by any such regulations, modifies the operation in any case of section 59A of the Management Act or Schedule 21 to the Finance Act 1995 (payments on account of income tax).
(7)In this section—
“prescribed” means prescribed by, or determined by an officer of the Board in accordance with, regulations made by the Board under this section; and
“subordinate legislation” has the same meaning as in the M44Interpretation Act 1978.
(8)This section shall have effect—
(a)as if references in this section to a Schedule A business included references to any activities which would be comprised in a Schedule A business if they were carried on by an individual, rather than by a company; and
(b)in relation to companies that carry on such activities, as if the reference in subsection (1) above to tax which is or may become chargeable under Schedule A included a reference to tax which is or may become chargeable under Case VI of Schedule D.”
(2)In the Table in section 98 of the Management Act (penalties in respect of certain information provisions), after the entry in the first column relating to section 42 of the Taxes Act 1988 and after the entry in the second column relating to section 41(2) of the Taxes Act 1988, there shall, in each case, be inserted the following entry—
“regulations under section 42A;”.
(3)Section 43 of the Taxes Act 1988 (payments to non-residents of amounts chargeable under Schedule A) shall not have effect in relation to any payment made on or after 6th April 1996.
Marginal Citations
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F6S. 41 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165(1), Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F7(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2)That Act shall be further amended as follows—
(a)in section 353(1B), in the words after paragraph (b), for “sections 237(5)(b) and 355(4)” there shall be substituted “ section 237(5)(b) ”;
F7(b). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F7(c). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F7(d). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F7(e). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)Subject to subsections (4) to (6) below, this section shall have effect in relation to any payment of interest made on or after 6th April 1995.
(4)Where—
(a)the profits or gains of any source of income that ceases in the course of the year 1995-96 are taxed, by virtue of section 39(5) or 41(9) above, without reference to the Schedule A that has effect by virtue of section 39(1) above, and
(b)that source of income includes any land, caravan or house-boat with respect to which the condition specified in section 355(1)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988 would be satisfied in the case of any loan,
this section shall not apply to any payment of interest on that loan which is made before the time in the year 1995-96 when that source of income ceases.
(5)Subject to paragraph 19(3) of Schedule 6 to this Act, no relief in respect of any payment of interest before 6th April 1995 shall be given under section 355(4) of the Taxes Act 1988 (income against which relief available) against any income for the year 1995-96 or any subsequent year of assessment except in a case where the income falls within subsection (4)(a) above.
[F8(6)Schedule 7 to this Act (which makes amendments in relation to corporation tax which are consequential on this section) shall have effect in relation to accounting periods ending after 31st March 1995.]
Textual Amendments
F7S. 42(1)(2)(b)-(e) repealed (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 20 Pt. III(7) Note 4 of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 139, Sch. 20 Pt. III(7) Note 4
F8S. 42(6) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F9Ss. 43-45 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F9Ss. 43-45 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F9Ss. 43-45 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
(1)Chapter IA of Part V of the M45Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (roll-over relief on re-investment) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 164A (relief on re-investment for individuals) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (12)—
“(13)Where an acquisition is made on or after 29th November 1994 section 164H shall be ignored in deciding whether it is an acquisition of a qualifying investment for the purposes of this section.”
(3)In section 164F (failure of conditions of relief) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (2)—
“(2A)In deciding for the purposes of subsection (2)(b) above whether a company is a qualifying company at a time falling on or after 29th November 1994 section 164H shall be ignored.”
(4)In section 164I (qualifying trades) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(4A)In deciding whether a trade complies with this section at a time falling on or after 29th November 1994 paragraphs (g) and (h) of subsection (2) above shall be ignored.”
Marginal Citations
(1)Chapter IA of Part V of the M46Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (roll-over relief on re-investment) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 164A after subsection (13) (inserted by section 46 above) there shall be inserted—
“(14)This section is subject to sections 164FF and 164FG.”
(3)In section 164F after subsection (10B) there shall be inserted—
“(10C)Subsection (10A) above is subject to sections 164FF and 164FG.”
(4)After section 164F there shall be inserted—
(1)This section applies where—
(a)a claim is made under subsection (2) of section 164A or subsection (10A) of section 164F; and
(b)the qualifying investment as respects which the claim is made is acquired by a disposal to which section 58 applies.
(2)The amounts by reference to which the reduction is determined shall be treated as including the amount of the consideration which the claimant would under this Act be treated as having given for the qualifying investment if he had, immediately upon acquiring the qualifying investment, disposed of it on a disposal which was not a no gain/no loss disposal.
(3)Where—
(a)the claimant makes a disposal, which is not a no gain/no loss disposal, of the qualifying investment, and
(b)any disposal after 31st March 1982 and before he acquired the qualifying investment was a no gain/no loss disposal,
nothing in paragraph 1 of Schedule 3, section 35 or section 55 shall operate to defeat the reduction falling to be made under section 164A(2)(b) or, as the case may be, section 164F(10A)(b) in the consideration for the acquisition of the qualifying investment.
(4)Where—
(a)the claimant makes a disposal of the qualifying investment and that disposal is a disposal to which section 58 applies, and
(b)any disposal after 31st March 1982 and before the claimant acquired the qualifying investment was a no gain/no loss disposal,
nothing in the application of paragraph 1 of Schedule 3, section 35 or section 55 to the person to whom the claimant makes the disposal of the qualifying investment shall operate to defeat the reduction made under section 164A(2)(b) or, as the case may be, section 164F(10A)(b).
(5)For the purposes of this section a no gain/no loss disposal is one on which by virtue of any of the enactments specified in section 35(3)(d) neither a gain nor a loss accrues.”
(5)After section 164FF (inserted by subsection (4) above) there shall be inserted—
(1)This section applies where—
(a)a reduction is claimed by a person as respects a qualifying investment under subsection (2) of section 164A or subsection (10A) of section 164F; and
(b)any other reduction has been or is being claimed by that person under either subsection as respects that investment.
(2)Subject to subsection (5) below, the reductions shall be treated as claimed separately in such sequence as the claimant elects or an officer of the Board in default of an election determines.
(3)In relation to a later claim as respects the qualifying investment under either subsection, the subsection shall have effect as if each of the relevant amounts were reduced by the aggregate of any reductions made in the amount or value of the consideration for the acquisition of that investment by virtue of any earlier claims as respects that investment.
(4)In subsection (3) above “the relevant amounts” means—
(a)if the claim is under section 164A(2), the amounts referred to in subsection (2)(a)(ii) and (iii) and any amount required to be included by virtue of section 164FF(2); and
(b)if the claim is under section 164F(10A), the amounts referred to in subsection (10A)(a)(i) and (ii) and any amount required to be included by virtue of section 164FF(2).
(5)A claim that has become final shall be treated as made earlier than any claim that has not become final.
(6)For the purposes of subsection (5) above, a claim becomes final when—
(a)it may no longer be amended, or
(b)it is finally determined,
whichever occurs first.”
(6)Subsection (4) above (and subsections (1) to (3) above so far as relating to subsection (4) above) shall apply to a claim as respects a qualifying investment if—
(a)the qualifying investment is acquired on or after 20th June 1994; or
(b)the claim is under section 164A(2) and relates to a disposal on or after that day; or
(c)the claim is under subsection (10A) of section 164F and relates to a gain which (apart from that subsection) would accrue on or after that day.
(7)Subsection (5) above (and subsections (1) to (3) above so far as relating to subsection (5) above) shall apply to a claim as respects a qualifying investment if—
(a)the qualifying investment is acquired on or after 20th June 1994; or
(b)the claim is under section 164A(2) and relates to a disposal on or after that day; or
(c)the claim is under subsection (10A) of section 164F and relates to a gain which (apart from that subsection) would accrue on or after that day; or
(d)there is another claim as respects that qualifying investment which is under section 164A(2) and which relates to a disposal on or after that day; or
(e)there is another claim as respects that qualifying investment which is under subsection (10A) of section 164F and which relates to a gain which (apart from that subsection) would accrue on or after that day.
(8)Any such adjustment as is appropriate in consequence of this section may be made (whether by discharge or repayment of tax, the making of an assessment or otherwise).
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 175 of the M47Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (replacement of business assets by members of a group), after subsection (2) there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(2A)Section 152 shall apply where—
(a)the disposal is by a company which, at the time of the disposal, is a member of a group of companies,
(b)the acquisition is by another company which, at the time of the acquisition, is a member of the same group, and
(c)the claim is made by both companies,
as if both companies were the same person.
(2B)Section 152 shall apply where a company which is a member of a group of companies but is not carrying on a trade—
(a)disposes of assets (or an interest in assets) used, and used only, for the purposes of the trade which (in accordance with subsection (1) above) is treated as carried on by the members of the group which carry on a trade, or
(b)acquires assets (or an interest in assets) taken into use, and used only, for those purposes,
as if the first company were carrying on that trade.
(2C)Section 152 shall not apply if the acquisition of, or of the interest in, the new assets—
(a)is made by a company which is a member of a group of companies, and
(b)is one to which any of the enactments specified in section 35(3)(d) applies.”
(2)In section 247 of the M48Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (roll-over relief on compulsory acquisition of land), after subsection (5) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5A)Subsections (2A) and (2C) of section 175 shall apply in relation to this section as they apply in relation to section 152 (but as if the reference in subsection (2C) to the new assets were a reference to the new land).”
(3)Subject to subsection (4) below—
(a)the subsection inserted into section 175 of the M49Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 by subsection (1) above as subsection (2A) shall be deemed always to have had effect; and
(b)the earlier enactments corresponding to that section shall be deemed to have contained provision to the same effect as that subsection (2A).
(4)Paragraph (c) of that subsection (2A) shall not apply unless the claim is made on or after 29th November 1994.
(5)The subsection inserted into section 175 of the M50Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 by subsection (1) above as subsection (2B) shall apply where the disposal or the M51acquisition is on or after 29th November 1994; and the subsection so inserted as subsection (2C) shall apply where the acquisition is on or after that date.
(6)The subsection inserted into section 247 of the M52Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 by subsection (2) above shall apply—
(a)so far as it relates to section 175(2A), where the disposal or the acquisition is on or after 29th November 1994; and
(b)so far as it relates to section 175(2C), where the acquisition is on or after that date.
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 179 of the M53Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (de-grouping charges), after subsection (2) there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(2A)Where—
(a)a company that has ceased to be a member of a group of companies (“the first group”) acquired an asset from another company which was a member of that group at the time of the acquisition,
(b)subsection (2) above applies in the case of that company’s ceasing to be a member of the first group so that subsection (1) above does not have effect as respects the acquisition of that asset,
(c)the company that made the acquisition subsequently ceases to be a member of another group of companies (“the second group”), and
(d)there is a connection between the two groups,
subsection (1) above shall have effect in relation to the company’s ceasing to be a member of the second group as if it had been the second group of which both companies had been members at the time of the acquisition.
(2B)For the purposes of subsection (2A) above there is a connection between the first group and the second group if, at the time when the chargeable company ceases to be a member of the second group, the company which is the principal company of that group is under the control of—
(a)the company which is the principal company of the first group or, if that group no longer exists, which was the principal company of that group when the chargeable company ceased to be a member of it;
(b)any company which controls the company mentioned in paragraph (a) above or which has had it under its control at any time in the period since the chargeable company ceased to be a member of the first group; or
(c)any company which has, at any time in that period, had under its control either—
(i)a company which would have fallen within paragraph (b) above if it had continued to exist, or
(ii)a company which would have fallen within this paragraph (whether by reference to a company which would have fallen within that paragraph or to a company or series of companies falling within this sub-paragraph).”
(2)After subsection (9) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(9A)Section 416(2) to (6) of the Taxes Act (meaning of control) shall have effect for the purposes of subsection (2B) above as it has effect for the purposes of Part XI of that Act; but a person carrying on a business of banking shall not for the purposes of that subsection be regarded as having control of any company by reason only of having, or of the consequences of having exercised, any rights of that person in respect of loan capital or debt issued or incurred by the company for money lent by that person to the company in the ordinary course of that business.”
(3)This section has effect in relation to a company in any case in which the time of the company’s ceasing to be a member of the second group is on or after 29th November 1994.
Marginal Citations
In section 117 of the M54Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (qualifying corporate bonds) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (2)—
“(2A)Where it falls to be decided whether at any time on or after 29th November 1994 a security (whenever issued) is a corporate bond for the purposes of this section, a security which falls within paragraph 2(2)(c) of Schedule 11 to the M55Finance Act 1989 (quoted indexed securities) shall be treated as not being a corporate bond within the definition in subsection (1) above.”]
Textual Amendments
F10S. 50 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3)
Marginal Citations
Schedule 8 to this Act has effect in relation to companies carrying on life assurance business, as follows—
Part I contains general amendments,
Part II contains amendments of provisions relating to overseas life insurance companies, and
Part III contains supplementary provisions.
F11(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2)F12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)F13. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4)In section 59(3)(b) of the Inheritance Tax Act 1984 (interests of insurance companies acquired before 14th March 1975 to be qualifying interests in possession), for the words from “if” onwards there shall be substituted “if the company is an insurance company (within the meaning of Chapter I of Part XII of the M56Taxes Act 1988) and either—
(i)is authorised to carry on long term business under section 3 or 4 of the M57Insurance Companies Act 1982; or
(ii)carries on through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom the whole or any part of any long term business which it is authorised to carry on by an authorisation granted outside the United Kingdom for the purposes of the first long term insurance Directive;
and in paragraph (b) above “long term business” and “the first long term insurance Directive” have the same meanings as in that Act of 1982. ”
(5)Subsections (1) to (3) above shall have effect in relation to any accounting period ending after 30th June 1994; and subsection (4) above shall have effect for the purposes of the making, on an anniversary or other occasion after that date, of any charge to tax under section 64 or 65 of the M58Inheritance Tax Act 1984.
Textual Amendments
F11S. 52(1) repealed (1.12.2001) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 109, Sch.
F12S. 52(2) repealed (24.7.2002 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s.141, Sch.40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2
F13S. 52(3) repealed (24.7.2002 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3 Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s.141, Sch.40 Pt. 3(13) Note 2
Marginal Citations
(1)The amendments specified in Schedule 9 to this Act (which relate to enactments referring to the transfer of the whole or part of the long term business of an insurance company) shall have effect.
(2)This section and that Schedule shall have effect in relation to any transfers sanctioned or authorised after 30th June 1994.
Schedule 10 to this Act (which makes provision about friendly societies) shall have effect.
(1)Subject to subsections (2) and (3) below—
(a)paragraph 21 of Schedule 15 to the Taxes Act 1988 (certification of policies and of standard forms etc.) shall not apply, in relation to any time on or after [F14the appointed date], for determining whether a policy is or would be a qualifying policy at that time; and
(b)no certificate may be issued under that paragraph at any time on or after that date except, in the case of a certificate under sub-paragraph (1)(a) of that paragraph, in relation to a time before that date.
(2)Subsection (1) above shall not affect the right of any person to bring or continue with an appeal under paragraph 21(3) of that Schedule against either a refusal before [F14the appointed date] to certify any policy or a refusal on or after that date to certify any policy in relation to times before that date.
(3)A certificate issued—
(a)before [F14the appointed date] in pursuance of paragraph 21(1)(a) of that Schedule, or
(b)in pursuance of a determination on an appeal determined after that date by virtue of subsection (2) above,
shall, in relation to any time on or after that date or, as the case may be, the date on which it is issued, be conclusive evidence that the policy to which it relates is (subject to any variation of the policy) a qualifying policy.
(4)Paragraph 22 of that Schedule (certificates from body issuing policy) shall cease to have effect in relation to any time on or after [F14the appointed date].
(5)Paragraph 24 of that Schedule (policies issued by non-resident companies) shall have effect in relation to times on or after [F14the appointed date]—
(a)with the substitution of the following sub-paragraphs for sub-paragraph (2)—
“(2)Subject to section 55(3) of the Finance Act 1995 (transitional provision for the certification of certain policies), a new non-resident policy that falls outside sub-paragraph (2A) below shall not be a qualifying policy until such time as the conditions in sub-paragraph (3) are fulfilled with respect to it.
(2A)A policy falls outside this sub-paragraph unless, at the time immediately before [F14the appointed day], it was a qualifying policy by virtue of sub-paragraphs (2)(b) and (4) of this paragraph, as they had effect in relation to that time.”; and
(b)with the omission, in sub-paragraph (3), of the word “first” and of sub-paragraph (4).
(6)In paragraph 25 of that Schedule (policies substituted for policies issued by non-resident companies), for sub-paragraph (2) there shall be substituted the following sub-paragraph—
“(2)The modifications are the following—
(a)if, apart from paragraph 24, the old policy or any related policy (within the meaning of paragraph 17(2)(b)) of which account falls to be taken would have been a qualifying policy, that policy shall be assumed to have been a qualifying policy for the purposes of paragraph 17(2); and
(b)if, apart from this paragraph, the new policy would be a qualifying policy, it shall not be such a policy unless the circumstances are as specified in paragraph 17(3); and
(c)in paragraph 17(3)(c) the words “either by a branch or agency of theirs outside the United Kingdom or” shall be omitted;
and references in this sub-paragraph to being a qualifying policy shall have effect, in relation to any time before [F14the appointed date], as including a reference to being capable of being certified as such a policy.”
(7)In paragraph 27(1) of that Schedule, except so far as it has effect for the purposes of any case to which paragraph 21 of that Schedule applies by virtue of the preceding provisions of this section, for “paragraphs 21 and” there shall be substituted “ paragraph ”.
(8)In section 553 of the Taxes Act 1988 (which contains provisions referring to paragraph 24(3) or (4) of Schedule 15 to that Act)—
(a)in subsection (2), for the words from “neither” to “fulfilled” there shall be substituted “ the conditions in paragraph 24(3) of Schedule 15 to this Act are not fulfilled ”; and
(b)in subsection (7), for “either sub-paragraph (3) or sub-paragraph (4)” there shall be substituted “ sub-paragraph (3) ”;
but this subsection shall not affect the operation of Chapter II of Part XIII of that Act in relation to any policy in relation to which the conditions in paragraph 24(4) of Schedule 15 to that Act, as it then had effect, were fulfilled at times in accounting periods before those in relation to which section 103 of the Finance Act 1993 (which repealed section 445 of the M59Taxes Act 1988) had effect.
[F15(9)In this section “the appointed date” means such date as may be specified for the purpose in an order made by the Board.]
Textual Amendments
F14Words in s. 55(1)(a)(2)(3)(a)(4)(5)(a)(6) substituted (29.4.1996) by 1996 c. 8, s. 162(1)(a)
F15S. 55(9) inserted (29.4.1996) by 1996 c. 8, s. 162(1)(b)
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 547 of the Taxes Act 1988 (charging of certain gains arising in connection with insurance policies etc.), in subsection (5A), for “subsection (7)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (6A) or (7) ”; and after subsection (6) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(6A)Subsection (6) above shall not apply in relation to a gain treated as arising in connection with a contract for a life annuity in any case where the Board are satisfied, on a claim made for the purpose—
(a)that the company liable to make payments under the contract (“the grantor”) has not, at any time (“a relevant time”) between the date on which it entered into the contract and the date on which the gain is treated as arising, been resident in the United Kingdom;
(b)that at all relevant times the grantor has—
(i)as a body deriving its status as a company from the laws of a territory outside the United Kingdom,
(ii)as a company with its place of management in such a territory, or
(iii)as a company falling, under the laws of such a territory, to be regarded, for any other reason, as resident or domiciled in that territory,
been within a charge to tax under the laws of that territory;
(c)that that territory is a territory within the European Economic Area when the gain is treated as arising;
(d)that the charge to tax mentioned in paragraph (b) above has at all relevant times been such a charge made otherwise than by reference to profits as (by disallowing their deduction in computing the amount chargeable) to require sums payable and other liabilities arising under contracts of the same class as the contract in question to be treated as sums or liabilities falling to be met out of amounts subject to tax in the hands of the grantor;
(e)that the rate of tax fixed for the purposes of that charge in relation to the amounts subject to tax in the hands of the grantor (not being amounts arising or accruing in respect of investments that are of a particular description for which a special relief or exemption is generally available) has at all relevant times been at least 20 per cent.; and
(f)that none of the grantor’s obligations under the contract in question to pay any sum or to meet any other liability arising under that contract is or has been the subject, in whole or in part, of any reinsurance contract relating to anything other than the risk that the annuitant will die or will suffer any sickness or accident;
and subsection (6) above shall also not apply where the case would fall within paragraphs (a) to (f) above if references to a relevant time did not include references to any time when the contract fell to be regarded as forming part of so much of any basic life assurance and general annuity business the income and gains of which were subject to corporation tax as was being carried on through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom.”
(2)In section 553 of that Act (non-resident policies and off-shore capital redemption policies), in subsection (6), for “subsection (7)” there shall be substituted “ subsections (6A) and (7) ”; and after that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(6A)Paragraphs (a) and (b) of subsection (6) above do not apply to a gain in a case where the Board are satisfied, on a claim made for the purpose—
(a)that the insurer has not, at any time (“a relevant time”) between the making of the insurance and the date on which the gain is treated as arising, been resident in the United Kingdom;
(b)that at all relevant times the insurer has—
(i)as a body deriving its status as a company from the laws of a territory outside the United Kingdom,
(ii)as a company with its place of management in such a territory, or
(iii)as a company falling, under the laws of such a territory, to be regarded, for any other reason, as resident or domiciled in that territory,
been within a charge to tax under the laws of that territory;
(c)that that territory is a territory within the European Economic Area when the gain is treated as arising;
(d)that the charge to tax mentioned in paragraph (b) above has at all relevant times been such a charge made otherwise than by reference to profits as (by disallowing their deduction in computing the amount chargeable) to require sums payable and other liabilities arising under policies of the same class as the policy in question to be treated as sums or liabilities falling to be met out of amounts subject to tax in the hands of the insurer;
(e)that the rate of tax fixed for the purposes of that charge in relation to the amounts subject to tax in the hands of the insurer (not being amounts arising or accruing in respect of investments that are of a particular description for which a special relief or exemption is generally available) has at all relevant times been at least 20 per cent.; and
(f)that none of the insurer’s obligations under the policy in question to pay any sum or to meet any other liability arising under that policy is or has been the subject, in whole or in part, of any reinsurance contract relating to anything other than the risk that the person whose life is insured by the policy will die or will suffer any sickness or accident;
and paragraphs (a) and (b) of subsection (6) above shall also not apply where the case would fall within paragraphs (a) to (f) above if references to a relevant time did not include references to any time when the conditions required to be fulfilled in relation to that time for the purposes of subsection (7) below were fulfilled.”
(3)For the purpose of securing that section 547(5) of the Taxes Act 1988 has effect in other cases (in addition to those specified in sections 547(6A) and 553(6A)) where it appears to the Board appropriate for section 547(6) or 553(6) to be disapplied by reference to tax chargeable under the laws of a territory outside the United Kingdom, the Board may by regulations provide that the cases described in subsection (6A) of each of sections 547 and 553 of that Act are to be treated as including cases, being cases which would not otherwise fall within the subsection, where the conditions specified in the regulations are fulfilled in relation to any time (including one before the making of the regulations).
(4)This section shall apply in relation to any gain arising on or after 29th November 1994 and in relation to any gain arising before that date the income tax on which has not been the subject of an assessment that became final and conclusive before that date. M60M61
(1)In section 552 of the Taxes Act 1988 (duties of insurers of life policies etc.), the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (2) in relation to times on or after the day on which this Act is passed—
“(2A)Where the obligations under any policy or contract of the body that issued, entered into or effected it (“the original insurer”) are at any time the obligations of another body (“the transferee”) to whom there has been a transfer of the whole or any part of a business previously carried on by the original insurer, this section shall have effect in relation to that time, except where the chargeable event—
(a)happened before the transfer, and
(b)in the case of a death or assignment, is an event of which the notification mentioned in subsection (1) above was given before the transfer,
as if the policy or contract had been issued, entered into or effected by the transferee.”
(2)In that section, the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(4A)The Board may by regulations—
(a)make provision as to the form which is to be taken by certificates under this section (including provision enabling such a certificate to be delivered otherwise than in the form of a document); and
(b)make such provision as they think fit for securing that they are able to ascertain whether there has been or is likely to be any contravention of the requirements of this section and to verify any such certificate.
(4B)Regulations by virtue of subsection (4A)(b) above may include, in particular, provision requiring persons to whom premiums under any policy are or have at any time been payable to supply information to the Board and to make available books, documents and other records for inspection on behalf of the Board.
(4C)Regulations under subsection (4A) above may—
(a)make different provision for different cases; and
(b)contain such supplementary, incidental, consequential and transitional provision as appears to the Board to be appropriate.”
(3)In the second column of the Table in section 98 of the Management Act (penalties in respect of certain information provisions), for the entry relating to section 552 of the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be substituted the following entries—
“section 552(1) to (4);
regulations under section 552(4A);”.
Schedule 11 to this Act has effect for the purpose of enabling income withdrawals to be made under a personal pension scheme where the purchase of an annuity is deferred.
(1)Part XIV of the Taxes Act 1988 (pension schemes etc.) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 591 (discretionary approval of retirement benefits schemes) the following subsection shall be substituted for subsection (3)—
“(3)In subsection (2)(g) above “insurance company” has the meaning given by section 659B.”
(3)In section 599 (charge to tax: commutation of entire pension in special circumstances) the following subsection shall be substituted for subsection (8)—
“(8)In subsection (7) above “insurance company” has the meaning given by section 659B.”
(4)In section 630 (personal pension schemes: interpretation) the following definition shall be substituted for the definition of “authorised insurance company”—
““authorised insurance company” has the meaning given by section 659B.”
(5)The following sections shall be inserted after section 659A—
(1)In sections 591(2)(g) and 599(7) “insurance company” means one of the following—
(a)a person authorised under section 3 or 4 of the M62Insurance Companies Act 1982 (or any similar previous enactment) to carry on long term business;
(b)a friendly society carrying on long term business;
(c)an EC company falling within subsection (3) below.
(2)In Chapter IV of this Part “authorised insurance company” means a company that is an insurance company within the meaning given by subsection (1) above.
(3)An EC company falls within this subsection if it—
(a)lawfully carries on long term business, or lawfully provides long term insurance, in the United Kingdom, and
(b)fulfils the requirement under subsection (5) below or that under subsection (6) below or that under subsection (7) below.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3) above an EC company—
(a)lawfully carries on long term business in the United Kingdom if it does so through a branch in respect of which such of the requirements of Part I of Schedule 2F to the M63Insurance Companies Act 1982 as are applicable have been complied with;
(b)lawfully provides long term insurance in the United Kingdom if such of those requirements as are applicable have been complied with in respect of the insurance.
(5)The requirement under this subsection is that—
(a)a person who falls within subsection (8) below is for the time being appointed by the company to be responsible for securing the discharge of the duties mentioned in subsection (9) below, and
(b)his identity and the fact of his appointment have been notified to the Board by the company.
(6)The requirement under this subsection is that there are for the time being other arrangements with the Board for a person other than the company to secure the discharge of those duties.
(7)The requirement under this subsection is that there are for the time being other arrangements with the Board designed to secure the discharge of those duties.
(8)A person falls within this subsection if—
(a)he is not an individual and has a business establishment in the United Kingdom, or
(b)he is an individual and is resident in the United Kingdom.
(9)The duties are the following duties that fall to be discharged by the company—
(a)any duty to pay by virtue of section 203 and regulations made under it tax charged under section 597(3);
(b)any duty to pay tax charged under section 599(3) and (7);
(c)any duty imposed by regulations made under section 605;
(d)any duty to pay by virtue of section 203 and regulations made under it tax charged under section 648A(1).
(10)For the purposes of this section—
(a)references to an EC company shall be construed in accordance with section 2(6) of the M64Insurance Companies Act 1982;
(b)references to long term business shall be construed in accordance with section 1(1) of that Act;
(c)references to the provision of long term insurance in the United Kingdom shall be construed in accordance with section 96A(3A) of that Act;
(d)a friendly society is a friendly society within the meaning of the M65Friendly Societies Act 1992 (including any society that by virtue of section 96(2) of that Act is to be treated as a registered friendly society within the meaning of that Act).
(1)This section shall have effect where—
(a)in accordance with section 659B(5) a person is for the time being appointed to be responsible for securing the discharge of duties, or
(b)in accordance with section 659B(6) there are for the time being arrangements for a person to secure the discharge of duties.
(2)In such a case the person concerned—
(a)shall be entitled to act on the company’s behalf for any of the purposes of the provisions relating to the duties;
(b)shall secure (where appropriate by acting on the company’s behalf) the company’s compliance with and discharge of the duties;
(c)shall be personally liable in respect of any failure of the company to comply with or discharge any such duty as if the duties imposed on the company were imposed jointly and severally on the company and the person concerned.”
(1)Section 59(2) above and the new section 659B, so far as relating to section 591(2)(g), shall apply in relation to a scheme not approved by virtue of section 591 before the day on which this Act is passed.
(2)Section 59(3) above and the new section 659B, so far as relating to section 599(7), shall apply where tax is charged under section 599 on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
(3)Section 59(4) above and the new section 659B, so far as relating to Chapter IV of Part XIV, shall apply in relation to a scheme not approved under that Chapter before the day on which this Act is passed.
(4)Subsection (5) below applies where—
(a)a scheme is approved under Chapter IV of Part XIV before the day on which this Act is passed,
(b)on or after that day the person who established the scheme proposes to amend it, and
(c)the scheme as proposed to be amended would make provision such that, if the scheme had not been approved before that day, section 59(4) above and the new section 659B (so far as relating to that Chapter) would allow the Board to approve it.
(5)The Board may at their discretion approve the amendment notwithstanding anything in Chapter IV of Part XIV, and if the amendment is made—
(a)section 59(4) above and the new section 659B, so far as relating to that Chapter, shall apply in relation to the scheme, and
(b)any question as to the validity of the Board’s approval of the scheme shall be determined accordingly.
(1)After section 591B of the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted—
(1)Where an approval of a scheme to which this section applies ceases to have effect, tax shall be charged in accordance with this section.
(2)The tax shall be charged under Case VI of Schedule D at the rate of 40 per cent. on an amount equal to the value of the assets which immediately before the date of the cessation of the approval of the scheme are held for the purposes of the scheme (taking that value as it stands immediately before that date).
(3)Subject to section 591D(4), the person liable for the tax shall be the administrator of the scheme in his capacity as such.
(4)This section applies to a retirement benefits scheme in respect of which either of the conditions set out below is satisfied.
(5)The first condition is satisfied in respect of a scheme if, immediately before the date of the cessation of the approval of the scheme, the number of individuals who are members of the scheme is less than twelve.
(6)The second condition is satisfied in respect of a scheme if at any time within the period of one year ending with the date of the cessation of the approval of the scheme, a person who is or has been a controlling director of a company which has contributed to the scheme is a member of the scheme.
(7)For the purposes of subsection (6) above a person is a controlling director of a company if he is a director of it and within section 417(5)(b) in relation to it.
(1)For the purposes of section 591C(2) the value of an asset is, subject to subsection (2) below, its market value, construing “market value” in accordance with section 272 of the 1992 Act.
(2)Where an asset held for the purposes of a scheme is a right or interest in respect of any money lent (directly or indirectly) to any person mentioned in subsection (3) below, the value of the asset shall be treated as being the amount owing (including any unpaid interest) on the money lent.
(3)The persons are—
(a)any employer who has at any time contributed to the scheme;
(b)any company connected with such an employer;
(c)any member of the scheme;
(d)any person connected with any member of the scheme.
(4)Where the administrator of the scheme is constituted by persons who include a person who is an approved independent trustee in relation to a scheme, that person shall not be liable for tax chargeable by virtue of section 591C.
(5)A person is an approved independent trustee in relation to a scheme only if he is—
(a)approved by the Board to act as a trustee of the scheme; and
(b)not connected with—
(i)a member of the scheme;
(ii)any other trustee of the scheme; or
(iii)an employer who has contributed to the scheme.
(6)For the purposes of section 596A(9) income and gains accruing to a scheme shall not be regarded as brought into charge to tax merely because tax is charged in relation to the scheme in accordance with section 591C.
(7)The reference in section 591C(1) to an approval of a scheme ceasing to have effect is a reference to—
(a)the scheme ceasing to be an approved scheme by virtue of section 591A(2);
(b)the approval of the scheme being withdrawn under section 591B(1); or
(c)the approval of the scheme no longer applying by virtue of section 591B(2);
and any reference in section 591C to the date of the cessation of the approval of the scheme shall be construed accordingly.
(8)For the purposes of section 591C and this section a person is a member of a scheme at a particular time if at that time a benefit—
(a)is being provided under the scheme, or
(b)may be so provided,
in respect of any past or present employment of his.
(9)Section 839 shall apply for the purposes of this section.”
(2)After section 239 of the M66Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 there shall be inserted—
(1)This section applies where tax is charged in accordance with section 591C of the Taxes Act (tax on certain retirement benefits schemes whose approval ceases to have effect).
(2)For the purposes of this Act the assets which at the relevant time are held for the purposes of the scheme—
(a)shall be deemed to be acquired at that time for a consideration equal to the amount on which tax is charged by virtue of section 591C(2) of the Taxes Act by the person who would be chargeable in respect of a chargeable gain accruing on a disposal of the assets at that time; but
(b)shall not be deemed to be disposed of by any person at that time;
and in this subsection “the relevant time” means the time immediately before the date of the cessation of the approval of the scheme.
(3)Expressions used in subsection (2) above and in section 591C of the Taxes Act have the same meanings in that subsection as in that section.”
(3)This section shall apply in relation to any approval of a retirement benefits scheme which ceases to have effect on or after 2nd November 1994 other than an approval ceasing to have effect by virtue of a notice given before that day under section 591B(1) of the Taxes Act 1988.
Marginal Citations
(1)The Taxes Act 1988 shall be amended as follows.
(2)After section 326B there shall be inserted—
(1)Subsection (2) below applies where—
(a)an individual, within the period of six months from the day on which a tax-exempt special savings account held by him matured, opens another account (“a follow-up account”) which is a tax-exempt special savings account at the time it is opened; and
(b)the total amount deposited in the matured account, before it matured, exceeded £3,000.
(2)In relation to the follow-up account section 326B(2)(a) shall apply as if the reference to £3,000 were a reference to the total amount so deposited.
(3)For the purposes of subsection (1) above a tax-exempt special savings account held by an individual matures when a period of five years throughout which the account was a tax-exempt special savings account comes to an end.
(4)An account is not connected with another account for the purposes of section 326A(8) merely because one of them is a follow-up account.”
(3)In section 326C(1) (regulations about tax-exempt special savings accounts) after paragraph (c) there shall be inserted—
“(cc)providing that subsection (2) of section 326BB does not apply in relation to a follow-up account unless at such time as may be prescribed by the regulations the building society or institution with which the account is held has a document of a prescribed description containing such information as the regulations may prescribe;
(cd)requiring building societies and other institutions operating tax-exempt special savings accounts which mature to give to the individuals who have held them certificates containing such information as the regulations may prescribe;”.
(4)In section 326C(1)(e) for “and 326B” there shall be substituted “ 326B and 326BB ”.
(5)In section 326C after subsection (1) there shall be inserted—
“(1A)In paragraph (cc) of subsection (1) above “document” includes a record kept by means of a computer; and regulations made by virtue of that paragraph may prescribe different documents for different cases.
(1B)Subsection (3) of section 326BB applies for the purposes of subsection (1) above as it applies for the purposes of subsection (1) of that section.”
(6)In section 326C(2) for “section 326B” there shall be substituted “ sections 326B and 326BB ”.
(1)Section 326A of the M67Taxes Act 1988 (tax-exempt special savings accounts) shall be amended as mentioned in subsections (2) and (3) below.
(2)In subsection (4) (account must be with building society or institution authorised under Banking Act 1987) after “1987” there shall be inserted “ or a relevant European institution ”.
F16(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4)The following section shall be inserted after section 326C of the Taxes Act 1988 (regulations about tax-exempt special savings accounts etc.)—
(1)Without prejudice to the generality of section 326C(1), the Board may make regulations providing that an account held with a relevant European institution shall not be a tax-exempt special savings account at the time it is opened, or shall cease to be a tax-exempt special savings account at a given time, unless at the time concerned one of the following three requirements is fulfilled.
(2)The first requirement is that—
(a)a person who falls within subsection (5) below is appointed by the institution to be responsible for securing the discharge of prescribed duties which fall to be discharged by the institution, and
(b)his identity and the fact of his appointment have been notified to the Board by the institution.
(3)The second requirement is that there are other arrangements with the Board for a person other than the institution to secure the discharge of such duties.
(4)The third requirement is that there are other arrangements with the Board designed to secure the discharge of such duties.
(5)A person falls within this subsection if—
(a)he is not an individual and has a business establishment in the United Kingdom, or
(b)he is an individual and is resident in the United Kingdom.
(6)Different duties may be prescribed as regards different institutions or different descriptions of institution.
(7)The regulations may provide that—
(a)the first requirement shall not be treated as fulfilled unless the person concerned is of a prescribed description;
(b)the appointment of a person in pursuance of that requirement shall be treated as terminated in prescribed circumstances.
(8)The regulations may provide that—
(a)the second requirement shall not be treated as fulfilled unless the person concerned is of a prescribed description;
(b)arrangements made in pursuance of that requirement shall be treated as terminated in prescribed circumstances.
(9)The regulations may provide as mentioned in subsection (10) below as regards a case where—
(a)in accordance with the first requirement a person is at any time appointed to be responsible for securing the discharge of duties, or
(b)in accordance with the second requirement there are at any time arrangements for a person to secure the discharge of duties.
(10)In such a case the regulations may provide that the person concerned—
(a)shall be entitled to act on the institution’s behalf for any of the purposes of the provisions relating to the duties;
(b)shall secure (where appropriate by acting on the institution’s behalf) the institution’s compliance with and discharge of the duties;
(c)shall be personally liable in respect of any failure of the institution to comply with or discharge any such duty as if the duties imposed on the institution were imposed jointly and severally on the institution and the person concerned.
(11)Regulations under this section may include provision that section 326B(3) shall have effect as if the reference to subsection (1) included a reference to the regulations.
(12)In this section “prescribed” means prescribed by the regulations.”
(5)Subsection (2) above shall apply in relation to accounts opened after such day as the Board may by order made by statutory instrument appoint.
Textual Amendments
F16S. 63(3) repealed (1.12.2001) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 109, Sch.
Commencement Information
I10S. 63 in force at Royal Assent but the day appointed for the application of s. 63(2) in relation to tax-exempt special savings accounts opened after that day is 1.1.1996 by S.I. 1995/3236, art. 2
Marginal Citations
(1)The following section shall be inserted after section 333 of the Taxes Act 1988 (personal equity plans)—
(1)Regulations under section 333 may include provision that a European institution cannot be a plan manager unless one of the following three requirements is fulfilled.
(2)The first requirement is that—
(a)a person who falls within subsection (5) below is for the time being appointed by the institution to be responsible for securing the discharge of prescribed duties which fall to be discharged by the institution, and
(b)his identity and the fact of his appointment have been notified to the Board by the institution.
(3)The second requirement is that there are for the time being other arrangements with the Board for a person other than the institution to secure the discharge of such duties.
(4)The third requirement is that there are for the time being other arrangements with the Board designed to secure the discharge of such duties.
(5)A person falls within this subsection if—
(a)he is not an individual and has a business establishment in the United Kingdom, or
(b)he is an individual and is resident in the United Kingdom.
(6)Different duties may be prescribed as regards different institutions or different descriptions of institution.
(7)The regulations may provide that—
(a)the first requirement shall not be treated as fulfilled unless the person concerned is of a prescribed description;
(b)the appointment of a person in pursuance of that requirement shall be treated as terminated in prescribed circumstances.
(8)The regulations may provide that—
(a)the second requirement shall not be treated as fulfilled unless the person concerned is of a prescribed description;
(b)arrangements made in pursuance of that requirement shall be treated as terminated in prescribed circumstances.
(9)The regulations may provide as mentioned in subsection (10) below as regards a case where—
(a)in accordance with the first requirement a person is for the time being appointed to be responsible for securing the discharge of duties, or
(b)in accordance with the second requirement there are for the time being arrangements for a person to secure the discharge of duties.
(10)In such a case the regulations may provide that the person concerned—
(a)shall be entitled to act on the institution’s behalf for any of the purposes of the provisions relating to the duties;
(b)shall secure (where appropriate by acting on the institution’s behalf) the institution’s compliance with and discharge of the duties;
(c)shall be personally liable in respect of any failure of the institution to comply with or discharge any such duty as if the duties imposed on the institution were imposed jointly and severally on the institution and the person concerned.
(11)In this section—
(a)“European institution” has the same meaning as in the M68Banking Co-ordination (Second Council Directive) Regulations 1992;
(b)“prescribed” means prescribed by the regulations.
(12)The preceding provisions of this section shall apply in the case of a relevant authorised person as they apply in the case of a European institution; and “relevant authorised person” here means a person who is an authorised person for the purposes of the M69Financial Services Act 1986 by virtue of section 31 of that Act.”
(2)In section 151 of the M70Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (personal equity plans) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (2)—
“(2A)Section 333A of the Taxes Act (personal equity plans: tax representatives) shall apply in relation to regulations under subsection (1) above as it applies in relation to regulations under section 333 of that Act.”
Schedule 12 to this Act (which contains provisions about contractual savings schemes) shall have effect.
(1)Chapter III of Part VII of the Taxes Act 1988 as it has effect in relation to shares issued on or after 1st January 1994 (the enterprise investment scheme) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 292 (which denies relief where parallel trades are involved) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(5)This section shall not apply where the shares mentioned in subsection (1) above are issued on or after 29th November 1994.”
(3)In section 293 (qualifying companies) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (8A) (which defines “the relevant period” for certain purposes)—
“(8B)In arriving at the relevant period for the purposes of sections 294 to 296 any time falling on or after 29th November 1994 shall be ignored; and subsection (8A) above shall have effect subject to the preceding provisions of this subsection.”
(4)In section 305 (reorganisation of share capital) the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(5)Subsection (2) above shall not apply where the reorganisation occurs on or after 29th November 1994.
(6)Subsection (2) above shall not apply by virtue of subsection (3) above where the rights are disposed of on or after 29th November 1994.”
Schedule 13 to this Act (which contains amendments relating to chargeable gains as regards the enterprise investment scheme) shall have effect.
(1)Chapter III of Part VII of the Taxes Act 1988 as it has effect in relation to shares issued before 1st January 1994 (the business expansion scheme) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 289 (the relief) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (12) (which defines “the relevant period” for the purposes of the Chapter)—
“(12A)In arriving at the relevant period for the purposes of sections 294 to 296 any time falling on or after 29th November 1994 shall be ignored; and subsection (12) above shall have effect subject to the preceding provisions of this subsection.”
(3)In section 305 (reorganisation of share capital) the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(5)Subsection (2) above shall not apply where the reorganisation occurs on or after 29th November 1994.
(6)Subsection (2) above shall not apply by virtue of subsection (3) above where the rights are disposed of on or after 29th November 1994.”
In section 150 of the M71Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (business expansion schemes) the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (8) (which disapplies provisions about exchanges, reconstructions or amalgamations in certain circumstances)—
“(8A)Subsection (8) above shall not have effect to disapply section 135 or 136 where—
(a)the new holding consists of new ordinary shares carrying no present or future preferential right to dividends or to a company’s assets on its winding up and no present or future preferential right to be redeemed,
(b)the new shares are issued on or after 29th November 1994 and after the end of the relevant period, and
(c)the condition in subsection (8B) below is fulfilled.
(8B)The condition is that at some time before the issue of the new shares—
(a)the company issuing them issued eligible shares, and
(b)a certificate in relation to those eligible shares was issued by the company for the purposes of subsection (2) of section 306 of the Taxes Act and in accordance with that section.
(8C)In subsection (8A) above—
(a)“new holding” shall be construed in accordance with sections 126, 127, 135 and 136;
(b)“relevant period” means the period found by applying section 289(12)(a) of the Taxes Act by reference to the company issuing the shares referred to in subsection (8) above and by reference to those shares.”
Marginal Citations
(1)After section 842 of the Taxes Act 1988 (investment trusts) there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)In the Tax Acts “venture capital trust” means a company which is not a close company and which is for the time being approved for the purposes of this section by the Board; and an approval for the purposes of this section shall have effect as from such time as may be specified in the approval, being a time which, if it falls before the time when the approval is given, is no earlier than—
(a)in the case of an approval given in the year 1995-96, 6th April 1995; or
(b)in any other case, the time when the application for approval was made.
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section, the Board shall not approve a company for the purposes of this section unless it is shown to their satisfaction in relation to the most recent complete accounting period of the company—
(a)that the company’s income in that period has been derived wholly or mainly from shares or securities;
(b)that at least 70 per cent. by value of the company’s investments has been represented throughout that period by shares or securities comprised in qualifying holdings of the company;
(c)that at least 30 per cent. by value of the company’s qualifying holdings has been represented throughout that period by holdings of eligible shares;
(d)that no holding in any company, other than a venture capital trust or a company which would qualify as a venture capital trust but for paragraph (e) below, has at any time during that period represented more than 15 per cent. by value of the company’s investments;
(e)that the shares making up the company’s ordinary share capital (or, if there are such shares of more than one class, those of each class) have throughout that period been quoted on the Stock Exchange; and
(f)that the company has not retained more than 15 per cent. of the income it derived in that period from shares and securities.
(3)Where, in the case of any company, the Board are satisfied that the conditions specified in subsection (2) above are fulfilled in relation to the company’s most recent complete accounting period, they shall not approve the company for the purposes of this section unless they are satisfied that the conditions will also be fulfilled in relation to the accounting period of the company which is current when the application for approval is made.
(4)The Board may approve a company for the purposes of this section notwithstanding that conditions specified in subsection (2) above are not fulfilled with respect to that company in relation to its most recent complete accounting period if they are satisfied—
(a)in the case of any of the conditions specified in paragraphs (a), (d), (e) and (f) of that subsection which are not fulfilled, that the conditions will be fulfilled in relation to the accounting period of the company which is current when the application for approval is made or in relation to its next accounting period;
(b)in the case of any of the conditions specified in paragraphs (b) and (c) of that subsection which are not fulfilled, that the conditions will be fulfilled in relation to an accounting period of the company beginning no more than three years after the time when they give their approval or, if earlier, when the approval takes effect; and
(c)in the case of every condition which is not fulfilled but with respect to which the Board are satisfied as mentioned in paragraph (a) or (b) above, that the condition will continue to be fulfilled in relation to accounting periods following the period in relation to which they are satisfied as so mentioned.
(5)For the purposes of subsection (2)(b) to (d) above the value of any holding of investments of any description shall be taken—
(a)unless—
(i)it is added to by a further holding of investments of the same description, or
(ii)any such payment is made in discharge, in whole or in part, of any obligation attached to the holding as (by discharging the whole or any part of that obligation) increases the value of the holding,
to be its value when acquired, and
(b)where it is so added to or such a payment is made, to be its value immediately after the most recent addition or payment.
(6)The Board may withdraw their approval of a company for the purposes of this section wherever it at any time appears to them that there are reasonable grounds for believing—
(a)that the conditions for the approval of the company were not fulfilled at the time of the approval;
(b)in a case where the Board were satisfied for the purposes of subsection (3) or (4) above that a condition would be fulfilled in relation to any period, that that condition is one which will not be or, as the case may be, has not been fulfilled in relation to that period;
(c)in the case of a company approved in pursuance of subsection (4) above, that the company has not fulfilled such other conditions as may be prescribed by regulations made by the Board in relation to, or to any part of, the period of three years mentioned in subsection (4)(b) above; or
(d)that the company’s most recent complete accounting period or its current one is a period in relation to which there has been or will be a failure of a condition specified in subsection (2) above to be fulfilled, not being a failure which, at the time of the approval, was allowed for in relation to that period by virtue of subsection (4) above.
(7)Subject to subsections (8) and (9) below, the withdrawal of the approval of any company for the purposes of this section shall have effect as from the time when the notice of the withdrawal is given to the company.
(8)If, in the case of a company approved for the purposes of this section in exercise of the power conferred by subsection (4) above, the approval is withdrawn at a time before all the conditions specified in subsection (2) above have been fulfilled with respect to that company in relation either—
(a)to a complete accounting period of twelve months, or
(b)to successive complete accounting periods constituting a continuous period of twelve months or more,
the withdrawal of the approval shall have the effect that the approval shall, for all purposes, be deemed never to have been given.
(9)A notice withdrawing the approval of a company for the purposes of this section may specify a time falling before the time mentioned in subsection (7) above as the time as from which the withdrawal is to be treated as having taken effect for the purposes of section 100 of the 1992 Act; but the time so specified shall be no earlier than the beginning of the accounting period in relation to which it appears to the Board that the condition by reference to which the approval is withdrawn has not been, or will not be, fulfilled.
(10)Notwithstanding any limitation on the time for making assessments, an assessment to any tax chargeable in consequence of the withdrawal of any approval given for the purposes of this section may be made at any time before the end of the period of three years beginning with the time when the notice of withdrawal is given.
(11)The following provisions of section 842 shall apply as follows for the purposes of this section as they apply for the purposes of that section, that is to say—
(a)subsections (1A) and (2) of that section shall apply in relation to subsection (2)(d) above (but with the omission of subsection (2)(a) of that section) as they apply in relation to subsection (1)(b) of that section;
(b)subsections (2A) to (2C) of that section shall apply in relation to subsection (2)(f) above as they apply in relation to subsection (1)(e) of that section; and
(c)without prejudice to their application in relation to provisions applied by paragraph (a) or (b) above, subsections (3) and (4) of that section shall apply in relation to any reference in this section to a holding or an addition to a holding as they apply in relation to any such reference in that section.
(12)In this section, and in the provisions of section 842 as applied for the purposes of this section, “securities”, in relation to any company—
(a)includes any liability of the company in respect of a loan (whether secured or not) which has been made to the company on terms that do not allow any person to require the loan to be repaid, or any stock or security relating to that loan to be re-purchased or redeemed, within the period of five years from the making of the loan or, as the case may be, the issue of the stock or security; but
(b)does not include any stock or security relating to a loan which has been made to the company on terms which allow any person to require the loan to be repaid, or the stock or security to be re-purchased or redeemed, within that period.
(13)Schedule 28B shall have effect for construing the references in this section to a qualifying holding.
(14)In this section “eligible shares” means shares in a company which are comprised in the ordinary share capital of the company and carry no present or future preferential right to dividends or to the company’s assets on its winding up and no present or future preferential right to be redeemed.”
(2)Schedule 14 to this Act (meaning of “qualifying holdings”) shall be inserted, before Schedule 29 to the Taxes Act 1988, as Schedule 28B to that Act, and shall be construed accordingly.
(1)In Chapter IV of Part VII of the Taxes Act 1988 (special provisions), after section 332 there shall be inserted the following section—
Schedule 15B shall have effect for conferring relief from income tax in respect of investments in venture capital trusts and distributions by such trusts.”
(2)Schedule 15 to this Act (relief in respect of holdings in a venture capital trust) shall be inserted, before Schedule 16 to the Taxes Act 1988, as Schedule 15B to that Act, and shall be construed accordingly.
(3)In the Table in section 98 of the Management Act (penalties in respect of certain information provisions)—
(a)after the entry in the first column relating to paragraph 14(5) of Schedule 15 to the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted the following entry—
“Schedule 15B, paragraph 5(2);”
and
(b)after the entry in the second column relating to paragraph 14(4) of Schedule 15 to the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted the following entry—
“Schedule 15B, paragraph 5(1);”.
(4)This section has effect for the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
(1)The M72Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 shall be amended as follows.
(2)In section 100(1) (exemption from charge for gains accruing to authorised unit trusts, investment trusts etc.), after “investment trust” there shall be inserted “ a venture capital trust ”.
(3)In Chapter III of Part IV (miscellaneous provisions relating to securities), after section 151 there shall be inserted the following sections—
(1)A gain or loss accruing to an individual on a qualifying disposal of any ordinary shares in a company which—
(a)was a venture capital trust at the time when he acquired the shares, and
(b)is still such a trust at the time of the disposal,
shall not be a chargeable gain or, as the case may be, an allowable loss.
(2)For the purposes of this section a disposal of shares is a qualifying disposal in so far as—
(a)it is made by an individual who has attained the age of eighteen years;
(b)the shares disposed of were not acquired in excess of the permitted maximum for any year of assessment; and
(c)that individual acquired those shares for bona fide commercial purposes and not as part of a scheme or arrangement the main purpose of which, or one of the main purposes of which, is the avoidance of tax.
(3)Schedule 5C shall have effect for providing relief in respect of gains invested in venture capital trusts.
(4)In determining for the purposes of this section whether a disposal by any person of shares in a venture capital trust relates to shares acquired in excess of the permitted maximum for any year of assessment, it shall be assumed (subject to subsection (5) below)—
(a)as between shares acquired by the same person on different days, that those acquired on an earlier day are disposed of by that person before those acquired on a later day; and
(b)as between shares acquired by the same person on the same day, that those acquired in excess of the permitted maximum are disposed of by that person before he disposes of any other shares acquired on that day.
(5)It shall be assumed for the purposes of subsection (1) above that a person who disposes of shares in a venture capital trust disposes of shares acquired at a time when it was not such a trust before he disposes of any other shares in that trust.
(6)References in this section to shares in a venture capital trust acquired in excess of the permitted maximum for any year of assessment shall be construed in accordance with the provisions of Part II of Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act; and the provisions of that Part of that Schedule shall apply (with subsections (4) and (5) above) for identifying the shares which are, in any case, to be treated as representing shares acquired in excess of the permitted maximum.
(7)In this section and section 151B “ordinary shares”, in relation to a company, means any shares forming part of the company’s ordinary share capital (within the meaning of the Taxes Act).
(1)Sections 104, 105 and 107 shall not apply to any shares in a venture capital trust which are eligible for relief under section 151A(1).
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section, where—
(a)an individual holds any ordinary shares in a venture capital trust,
(b)some of those shares fall within one of the paragraphs of subsection (3) below, and
(c)others of those shares fall within at least one other of those paragraphs,
then, if there is within the meaning of section 126 a reorganisation affecting those shares, section 127 shall apply separately in relation to the shares (if any) falling within each of the paragraphs of that subsection (so that shares of each kind are treated as a separate holding of original shares and identified with a separate new holding).
(3)The kinds of shares referred to in subsection (2) above are—
(a)any shares in a venture capital trust which are eligible for relief under section 151A(1) and by reference to which any person has been given or is entitled to claim relief under Part I of Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act;
(b)any shares in a venture capital trust which are eligible for relief under section 151A(1) but by reference to which no person has been given, or is entitled to claim, any relief under that Part of that Schedule;
(c)any shares in a venture capital trust by reference to which any person has been given, or is entitled to claim, any relief under that Part of that Schedule but which are not shares that are eligible for relief under section 151A(1); and
(d)any shares in a venture capital trust that do not fall within any of paragraphs (a) to (c) above.
(4)Where—
(a)an individual holds ordinary shares in a company (“the existing holding”),
(b)there is, by virtue of any such allotment for payment as is mentioned in section 126(2)(a), a reorganisation affecting the existing holding, and
(c)immediately following the reorganisation, the shares or the allotted holding are shares falling within any of paragraphs (a) to (c) of subsection (3) above,
sections 127 to 130 shall not apply in relation to the existing holding.
(5)Sections 135 and 136 shall not apply where—
(a)the exchanged holding consists of shares falling within paragraph (a) or (b) of subsection (3) above; and
(b)that for which the exchanged holding is or is treated as exchanged does not consist of ordinary shares in a venture capital trust.
(6)Where—
(a)the approval of any company as a venture capital trust is withdrawn, and
(b)the withdrawal of the approval is not one to which section 842AA(8) of the Taxes Act applies,
any person who at the time when the withdrawal takes effect is holding shares in that company which (apart from the withdrawal) would be eligible for relief under section 151A(1) shall be deemed for the purposes of this Act, at that time, to have disposed of and immediately re-acquired those shares for a consideration equal to their market value at that time.
(7)The disposal that is deemed to take place by virtue of subsection (6) above shall be deemed for the purposes of section 151A to take place while the company is still a venture capital trust; but, for the purpose of applying sections 104, 105 and 107 to the shares that are deemed to be re-acquired, it shall be assumed that the re-acquisition for which that subsection provides takes place immediately after the company ceases to be such a trust.
(8)For the purposes of this section—
(a)shares are eligible for relief under section 151A(1) at any time when they are held by an individual whose disposal of the shares at that time would (on the assumption, where it is not the case, that the individual attained the age of eighteen years before that time) be a disposal to which section 151A(1) would apply; and
(b)shares shall not, in relation to any time, be treated as shares by reference to which relief has been given under Part I of Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act if that time falls after—
(i)any relief given by reference to those shares has been reduced or withdrawn,
(ii)any chargeable event (within the meaning of Schedule 5C) has occurred in relation to those shares, or
(iii)the death of a person who held those shares immediately before his death;
and
(c)the references, in relation to sections 135 and 136, to the exchanged holding is a reference to the shares in company B or, as the case may be, to the shares or debentures in respect of which shares or debentures are issued under the arrangement in question.”
(4)Schedule 16 to this Act (relief on re-investment in venture capital trusts) shall be inserted before Schedule 6, as Schedule 5C, and shall be construed accordingly.
(5)In section 257(1) (gifts to charities etc.), after paragraph (b) there shall be inserted—
“and the disposal is not one in relation to which section 151A(1) has effect.”
(6)In section 260, after the subsection (6A) inserted by Schedule 13 to this Act (no reduction in the case of a disposal which is a chargeable event for the purposes of Schedule 5B), there shall be inserted—
“(6B)Subsection (3) above does not apply, so far as any gain accruing in accordance with paragraphs 4 and 5 of Schedule 5C is concerned, in relation to the disposal which constitutes the chargeable event by virtue of which that gain accrues.”
(7)In section 288(1) (interpretation), after the definition of “trading stock” there shall be inserted the following definition—
““venture capital trust” has the meaning given by section 842AA of the Taxes Act;”.
(8)Subsection (2) above shall have effect in relation to gains accruing on or after 6th April 1995 and the other provisions of this section have effect for the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
Marginal Citations
(1)The Treasury may by regulations make such provision as they may consider appropriate for—
(a)giving effect to any relief for which provision is made by Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act 1988 or section 151A of, and Schedule 5C to, the M73Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992; and
(b)preventing such relief from being given except where a claim is made in accordance with the regulations and where such other requirements as may be imposed by the regulations have been complied with.
(2)Without prejudice to the generality of subsection (1) above, regulations under this section may make provision—
(a)as to the making of applications for approvals under section 842AA of the Taxes Act 1988 and otherwise as to the procedure in relation to any such applications and the giving of such approvals;
(b)as to the procedure to be followed in connection with the withdrawal of any such approval;
(c)as to the manner in which, and the persons by whom, relief is to be claimed;
(d)as to the obligations of a company which is a venture capital trust if it should appear to the company that the conditions for it to continue to be approved as such a trust are not satisfied;
(e)as to the accounts, records, returns and other information to be kept, and furnished or otherwise made available to the Board, by companies which are or have been venture capital trusts and by persons who hold or have held shares in such companies; and
(f)as to the persons liable to account for any tax becoming due where the approval of a company as a venture capital trust is withdrawn.
(3)Regulations under this section may make provision, in relation to tax credits to which any persons are entitled in respect of distributions of venture capital trusts—
(a)for the credits not to be set against income tax but to be claimed by and paid to the trusts; and
(b)for amounts equal to the credits to be paid by the trusts to the persons who receive or are entitled to receive the distributions;
and any such regulations may provide for sections 234 and 252 of the Taxes Act 1988 (information relating to distributions and rectification of excessive tax credit) to have effect, in relation to the distributions of venture capital trusts or, as the case may be, any provision made by virtue of paragraph (a) or (b) above, with such modifications as may be specified in the regulations.
(4)Regulations under this section may apply the following provisions of the Management Act, as they have effect in the case of repayments in respect of income tax, in relation to cases where amounts are paid to any person in pursuance of regulations made by virtue of subsection (3) above, that is to say—
(a)[F17section 29(1)(c)] (excessive relief);
(b)section 30 (tax repaid in error);
(c)[F18section 86] (interest); and
(d)section 95 (incorrect return or accounts).
[F19and section 86 of that Act may be so applied with such modifications as respects the relevant date as may be specified in the regulations.]
(5)In the Table in section 98 of the Management Act (penalties in respect of certain information provisions), at the end of the entries in the second column there shall be inserted the following entry—
“regulations under section 73 of the Finance Act 1995;”.
(6)In this section “venture capital trust” has the meaning given by section 842AA of the Taxes Act 1988.
Textual Amendments
F17Words in s. 73(4)(a) substituted (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 18 para. 17 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 132, Sch. 18 para. 16(a)
F18Words in s. 73(4)(c) substituted (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 18 para. 17 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 132, Sch. 18 para. 16(b)
F19Words in s. 73(4) added (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 18 para. 17 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 132, Sch. 18 para. 16(c)
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C1S. 73 modified (24.7.2002) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 109, Sch. 33 para. 14(1)
Marginal Citations
(1)Schedule 17 to this Act has effect with respect to settlements and the liability of the settlor, as follows—
Part I inserts new provisions in place of sections 660 to 676 and 683 to 685 of the Taxes Act 1988,
Part II makes minor and consequential amendments of that Act, and
Part III contains consequential amendments of other enactments.
(2)The amendments made by Schedule 17 have effect for the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment and apply to every settlement, wherever and whenever it was made or entered into.
Part XVI of the Taxes Act 1988 (deceased persons’ estates) shall have effect with the amendments specified in Schedule 18 to this Act.
[F20(1)In section 246D of the Taxes Act 1988 (foreign income dividends), after subsection (3) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(3A)Without prejudice to subsection (3) above, a foreign income dividend paid as mentioned in that subsection to personal representatives shall not be treated for the purposes of income tax as income of the personal representatives as such.”]
(2)In section 547 of that Act (method of charging certain gains to tax)—
(a)in subsection (1)(c) (case where rights vested in personal representatives), after “gain” there shall be inserted “ (so far as it is not otherwise comprised in that income) ”; and
(b)after subsection (7) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(7A)Where, in the case of any gain—
(a)this section has effect by virtue of subsection (5A) or (7) above with the omission of subsection (5) above, and
(b)the rights conferred by the contract or policy were vested immediately before the happening of the chargeable event in question in personal representatives within the meaning of Part XVI,
the gain shall be deemed for the purposes of income tax to be income of the personal representatives as such.”
(3)In section 553 of that Act (non-resident policies), after subsection (7) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(7A)Where, in the case of a gain to which subsection (6)(a) and (b) above applies, the rights conferred by the policy were vested immediately before the happening of the chargeable event in question in personal representatives within the meaning of Part XVI, the gain shall be deemed for the purposes of income tax to be income of the personal representatives as such.”
(4)After section 699 of that Act there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)In this section “a relevant amount” means so much of any amount which a person is deemed by virtue of this Part to receive or to have a right to receive as is or would be paid out of sums which—
(a)are included in the aggregate income of the estate of the deceased by virtue of any of sections 246D(3), 249(5), 421(2) and 547(1)(c); and
(b)are sums in respect of which the personal representatives are not directly assessable to United Kingdom income tax.
(2)In determining for the purposes of this Part whether any amount is a relevant amount—
(a)such apportionments of any sums to which subsection (1)(a) and (b) above applies shall be made between different persons with interests in the residue of the estate as are just and reasonable in relation to their different interests; and
(b)subject to paragraph (a) above, the assumption in section 701(3A)(b) shall apply, but (subject to that) it shall be assumed that payments are to be made out of other sums comprised in the aggregate income of the estate before they are made out of any sums to which subsection (1)(a) and (b) above applies.
(3)In the case of a foreign estate, and notwithstanding anything in section 695(4)(b) or 696(6), a relevant amount shall be deemed—
(a)to be income of such amount as would, after deduction of income tax for the year in which it is deemed to be paid, be equal to the relevant amount; and
(b)to be income that has borne tax at the applicable rate.
(4)Sums to which subsection (1)(a) and (b) above applies shall be assumed, for the purpose of determining the applicable rate in relation to any relevant amount, to bear tax—
(a)in the case of sums included by virtue of section 246D(3), 249(5) or 421(2), at the lower rate, and
(b)in the case of sums included by virtue of section 547(1)(c), at the basic rate.
(5)No repayment shall be made of any income tax which by virtue of this Part is treated as having been borne by the income that is represented by a relevant amount.
(6)For the purposes of sections 348 and 349(1) the income represented by a relevant amount shall be treated as not brought into charge to income tax.”
(5)In section 701 of that Act (interpretation), after subsection (10), there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(10A)Amounts to which section 699A(1)(a) and (b) applies shall be disregarded in determining whether an estate is a United Kingdom estate or a foreign estate, except that any estate the aggregate income of which comprises only such amounts shall be a United Kingdom estate.”
(6)This section has effect for the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
Textual Amendments
F20S. 76(1) repealed (31.7.1997 with effect as mentioned in s. 36 and Sch. 6 of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(11) Note (with s. 3(3))
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F21S. 77 repealed (31.7.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 8 Pt. II(13) Note of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(13) (with s. 3(3))
(1)After the section 51A of the Taxes Act 1988 inserted by section 77 above there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)The Treasury may by regulations provide for persons to whom payments of interest on relevant gilt-edged securities are made without deduction of tax to be required to make periodic returns to an officer of the Board of—
(a)amounts of any payments of such interest made to that person, and
(b)amounts of tax for which, assuming the payments to bear tax at the basic rate for the relevant year of assessment, that person is to be accountable under the regulations in respect of those payments;
and any such regulations may further provide for the amounts of tax required to be included in any such return to become due, at the time when the return is required to be made, from the person required to make it.
(2)Regulations made by the Treasury for the purposes of this section may—
(a)specify such periods as the Treasury may consider appropriate as the periods for which returns are to be made, and in respect of which any person is to account for tax, under the regulations;
(b)make provision for enabling returns under the regulations to be combined with returns under Schedule 16 and for requiring particulars of claims and calculations made for the purposes of the regulations to be set out in the returns;
(c)provide, in respect of any period for which a return is to be made by any person under the regulations, for that person to be obliged, before the end of the period, to make a payment on account of amounts that may become due from him in respect of that period;
(d)impose a requirement for a special return to be made for the purposes of any obligation imposed by virtue of paragraph (c) above;
(e)provide for the amount which, under the regulations, is to be due from any person in respect of any period to be reduced by reference to amounts which—
(i)are paid by or on behalf of that person under contracts or arrangements relating to transfers of gilt-edged securities; and
(ii)are or fall to be treated as representative of interest on those securities;
(f)authorise amounts in respect of which there is an obligation to account for tax under the regulations to be treated for specified purposes of the Tax Acts as payments on which a person has borne income tax by deduction;
(g)make provision for the assessment of amounts due under the regulations and for the repayment in specified circumstances of amounts paid under the regulations;
(h)make provision for interest to be payable, at such rate as may be determined by or under the regulations, on amounts that have become due under the regulations but have not been paid;
(i)make provision, where payments of interest on any relevant gilt-edged securities would be comprised in the income of a member of Lloyd’s, for obligations that may be imposed by regulations under this section on the person to whom the interest is paid to be imposed, instead, on such other person as may be described in the regulations.
(3)Regulations made by the Treasury for the purposes of this section may—
(a)include provision which for the purposes of the regulations makes any provision corresponding, with or without modifications, to any of the provisions of Schedule 16;
(b)make provision modifying the operation of Schedule 19AB in relation to cases where payments of interest on relevant gilt-edged securities are made without deduction of tax to companies carrying on pension business;
(c)include provision which requires obligations and liabilities under the regulations to be treated as obligations and liabilities to which provisions of Schedule 23 to the Finance Act 1995 (UK representatives) apply; and
(d)include provision which, for any of the purposes of the regulations, applies provisions of sections 126 and 127 of, and Schedule 23 to, that Act in relation to times before those provisions otherwise come into force.
(4)Regulations made by the Treasury for the purposes of this section may—
(a)make different provision for different cases; and
(b)contain such supplementary, incidental, consequential and transitional provision as appears to the Treasury to be appropriate;
and subsection (3) of section 178 of the M74Finance Act 1989 (extent of powers to set rates of interest) shall apply for the purposes of the power conferred by virtue of subsection (2)(h) above as it applies for the purposes of the power to make regulations under that section.
(5)In this section “relevant gilt-edged securities” means securities which are gilt-edged securities within the meaning of section 51A, other than any to which a direction of the Treasury under section 50 relates.
(6)In this section “relevant year of assessment”—
(a)in relation to a manufactured payment, means the year of assessment in which it is received by the person to whom it is paid; and
(b)in relation to any other payment of interest, means the year of assessment in which the payment is made;
and in this subsection “manufactured payment” means any payment which for the purposes of Schedule 23A is a payment of manufactured interest.”
(2)In the Table in section 98 of the Management Act (penalties in respect of certain information provisions), immediately before the entry in the second column relating to section 124(3) of the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted the following entry—
“regulations under section 51B;”.]
Textual Amendments
F22S. 78 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 37(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(3) Note
Marginal Citations
(1)In Chapter II of Part XVII of the Taxes Act 1988 (transfers of securities) after section 727 insert—
(1)Where securities are transferred under an agreement to sell them, and under the same or any related agreement the transferor or a person connected with him—
(a)is required to buy back the securities, or
(b)acquires an option, which he subsequently exercises, to buy back the securities,
section 713(2) and (3) and section 716 do not apply to the transfer by the transferor or the transfer back.
(2)For the purposes of this section agreements are related if they are entered into in pursuance of the same arrangement (regardless of the date on which either agreement is entered into).
(3)Section 839 (connected persons) applies for the purposes of this section.
(4)References in this section to buying back securities include buying similar securities.
For this purpose securities are similar if they entitle their holders—
to the same rights against the same persons as to capital and interest, and
to the same remedies for the enforcement of those rights,
notwithstanding any difference in the total nominal amounts of the respective securities or in the form in which they are held or the manner in which they can be transferred.
(5)For the purposes of this section—
(a)a person connected with the transferor who is required to buy securities sold by the transferor shall be treated as being required to buy the securities back, and
(b)a person connected with the transferor who acquires an option to buy securities sold by the transferor shall be treated as acquiring an option to buy the securities back,
notwithstanding that it was not he who sold them.”.
(2)In section 728 of the Taxes Act 1988 (information) in subsections (1) and (5) for “sections 710 to 727” substitute “ sections 710 to 727A ”.
(3)The above amendments have effect where the agreement to sell the securities is entered into on or after the date on which this Act is passed.
(4)If the appointed day for the purposes of section 737A of the Taxes Act 1988 in relation to any description of securities falls after the date on which this Act is passed, the reference in subsection (3) above to the date on which this Act is passed shall be construed in relation to an agreement relating to securities of that description and to which section 737A would apply if it were in force as a reference to that appointed day.
(1)After section 730 of the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted the following sections—
(1)Subject to subsection (8) below, this section applies where—
(a)a person (“the original owner”) has transferred any securities to another person (“the interim holder”) under an agreement to sell them;
(b)the original owner or a person connected with him is required to buy them back either—
(i)in pursuance of an obligation to do so imposed by that agreement or by any related agreement, or
(ii)in consequence of the exercise of an option acquired under that agreement or any related agreement;
and
(c)the sale price and the repurchase price are different.
(2)The difference between the sale price and the repurchase price shall be treated for the purposes of the Tax Acts—
(a)where the repurchase price is more than the sale price, as a payment of interest made by the repurchaser on a deemed loan from the interim holder of an amount equal to the sale price; and
(b)where the sale price is more than the repurchase price, as a payment of interest made by the interim holder on a deemed loan from the repurchaser of an amount equal to the repurchase price.
(3)Where any amount is deemed under subsection (2) above to be a payment of interest, that payment shall be deemed for the purposes of the Tax Acts to be one that becomes due at the time when the repurchase price becomes due and, accordingly, is treated as paid when that price is paid.
(4)Where any amount is deemed under subsection (2) above to be a payment of interest, the repurchase price shall be treated for the purposes of the Tax Acts (other than this section and sections 737A and 737C) and (in cases where section 263A of the 1992 Act does not apply) for the purposes of the 1992 Act—
(a)in a case falling within paragraph (a) of that subsection, as reduced by the amount of the deemed payment; and
(b)in a case falling within paragraph (b) of that subsection, as increased by the amount of the deemed payment.
(5)For the purposes of section 209(2)(d) and (da) any amount which is deemed under subsection (2)(a) above to be a payment of interest shall be deemed to be interest in respect of securities issued by the repurchaser and held by the interim holder.
(6)Any amount which—
(a)is deemed under subsection (2) above to be a payment of interest, and
(b)does not fall (apart from this subsection) to be treated as yearly interest,
shall be treated for the purposes of section 338 as if the reference to yearly interest in subsection (3)(a) of that section included a reference to that amount.
(7)The Treasury may by regulations provide for any amount which is deemed under subsection (2) above to be received as a payment of interest to be treated, in such circumstances and to such extent as may be described in the regulations, as comprised in income that is eligible for relief from tax by virtue of section 438, 592(2), 608(2)(a), 613(4), 614(2), (3) or (4), 620(6) or 643(2).
(8)Except where regulations under section 737E otherwise provide, this section does not apply if—
(a)the agreement or agreements under which provision is made for the sale and repurchase are not such as would be entered into by persons dealing with each other at arm’s length; or
(b)all of the benefits or risks arising from fluctuations, before the repurchase takes place, in the market value of the securities sold accrue to, or fall on, the interim holder.
(9)In this section references to the repurchase price are to be construed—
(a)in cases where section 737A applies, and
(b)in cases where section 737A would apply if it were in force in relation to the securities in question,
as references to the repurchase price which is or, as the case may be, would be applicable by virtue of section 737C(3)(b), (9) or (11)(c).
(1)For the purposes of section 730A agreements are related if they are entered into in pursuance of the same arrangement (regardless of the date on which either agreement is entered into).
(2)References in section 730A to buying back securities—
(a)shall include references to buying similar securities; and
(b)in relation to a person connected with the original owner, shall include references to buying securities sold by the original owner or similar securities,
notwithstanding (in each case) that the securities bought have not previously been held by the purchaser; and references in that section to repurchase or to a repurchaser shall be construed accordingly.
(3)In section 730A and this section “securities” has the same meaning as in section 737A.
(4)For the purposes of this section securities are similar if they entitle their holders—
(a)to the same rights against the same persons as to capital, interest and dividends, and
(b)to the same remedies for the enforcement of those rights,
notwithstanding any difference in the total nominal amounts of the respective securities or in the form in which they are held or the manner in which they can be transferred.
(5)Section 839 (connected persons) applies for the purposes of section 730A.”
[F23(2)In section 729 of that Act (sale and repurchase of securities), after subsection (5) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5A)This section shall not apply where section 737A applies; and this section shall be disregarded in determining whether the condition in subsection (2)(b) of that section is fulfilled in any case.”]
(3)In subsections (3)(b), (9) and (11)(c) of section 737C of that Act (adjustment of repurchase price), for “the Tax Acts other than section 737A and of the 1992 Act” there shall be substituted, in each case, “ section 730A ”; and after subsection (11) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(11A)The deemed increase of the repurchase price which is made for the purposes of section 730A by subsection (3)(b), (9) or (11)(c) above shall also have effect—
(a)for all the purposes of the Tax Acts, other than section 737A, and
(b)in cases where section 263A of the 1992 Act does not apply, for the purposes of the 1992 Act,
wherever in consequence of that increase there is for the purposes of section 730A no difference between the sale price and the repurchase price.”
(4)After section 263 of the M75Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)Subject to subsections (2) to (4) below, in any case falling within subsection (1) of section 730A of the Taxes Act (treatment of price differential on sale and repurchase of securities) and in any case which would fall within that subsection if the sale price and the repurchase price were different—
(a)the acquisition of the securities in question by the interim holder and the disposal of those securities by him to the repurchaser, and
(b)except where the repurchaser is or may be different from the original owner, the disposal of those securities by the original owner and any acquisition of those securities by the original owner as the repurchaser,
shall be disregarded for the purposes of capital gains tax.
(2)Subsection (1) above does not apply in any case where the repurchase price of the securities in question falls to be calculated for the purposes of section 730A of the Taxes Act by reference to provisions of section 737C of that Act that are not in force in relation to those securities when the repurchase price becomes due.
(3)Subsection (1) above does not apply if—
(a)the agreement or agreements under which provision is made for the sale and repurchase are not such as would be entered into by persons dealing with each other at arm’s length; or
(b)any of the benefits or risks arising from fluctuations, before the repurchase takes place, in the market value of the securities sold accrues to, or falls on, the interim holder.
(4)Subsection (1) above does not apply in relation to any disposal or acquisition of qualifying corporate bonds in a case where the securities disposed of by the original owner or those acquired by him, or by any other person, as the repurchaser are not such bonds.
(5)Expressions used in this section and in section 730A of the Taxes Act have the same meanings in this section as in that section.”
(5)This section shall have effect where the agreement to sell the securities is entered into on or after the date on which this Act is passed.
Textual Amendments
F23S. 80(2) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in s. 159(1) of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(21) Note 1
Marginal Citations
(1)Section 731 of the Taxes Act 1988 (application of sections 732 to 734) is amended as follows.
(2)After subsection (2) insert—
“(2A)The relevant provisions do not apply where the first buyer is required under the arrangements for the purchase of the securities to make to the person from whom he purchased the securities, not later than the date on which he subsequently sells the securities, a payment of an amount representative of the interest, or is treated by virtue of section 737A(5) as required to make such a payment.”.
(3)In consequence of the above amendment—
(a)in subsection (2) for “Subject to subsections (3) to (10) below” substitute “ Subject to subsections (2A) to (10) ” below, and for “relate” substitute “ apply ”;
(b)in subsection (3) for “relate to cases” substitute “ apply ”.
(4)The above amendments have effect where the date on which the payment referred to in the inserted subsection (2A) is required to be made, or treated as required to be made, is after the passing of this Act.
Textual Amendments
F24S. 82 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 10 para. 7(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, ss. 76, 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(10) Note 1; S.I. 1997/991, art. 2
(1)Immediately before section 738 of the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted the following sections—
(1)The Treasury may by regulations provide for any manufactured payment made to any person to be treated, in such circumstances and to such extent as may be described in the regulations, as comprised in income of that person that is eligible for relief from tax by virtue of section 438, 592(2), 608(2)(a), 613(4), 614(2), (3) or (4), 620(6) or 643(2).
(2)In this section “manufactured payment” means any manufactured dividend, manufactured interest or manufactured overseas dividend, within the meaning of Schedule 23A.
(1)The Treasury may by regulations make provision for all or any of sections 727A, 730A and 737A to 737C to have effect with modifications in relation to cases involving any arrangement for the sale and repurchase of securities where—
(a)the obligation to make the repurchase is not performed or the option to repurchase is not exercised;
(b)provision is made by or under any agreement for different or additional securities to be treated as, or as included with, securities which, for the purposes of the repurchase, are to represent securities transferred in pursuance of the original sale;
(c)provision is made by or under any agreement for any securities to be treated as not included with securities which, for the purposes of the repurchase, are to represent securities transferred in pursuance of the original sale;
(d)provision is made by or under any agreement for the sale price or repurchase price to be determined or varied wholly or partly by reference to fluctuations, occurring in the period after the making of the agreement for the original sale, in the value of securities transferred in pursuance of that sale, or in the value of securities treated as representing those securities; or
(e)provision is made by or under any agreement for any person to be required, in a case where there are any such fluctuations, to make any payment in the course of that period and before the repurchase price becomes due.
(2)The Treasury may by regulations make provision for all or any of sections 727A, 730A and 737A to 737C to have effect with modifications in relation to cases where—
(a)arrangements, corresponding to those made in cases involving an arrangement for the sale and repurchase of securities, are made by any agreement, or by one or more related agreements, in relation to securities that are to be redeemed in the period after their sale; and
(b)those arrangements are such that the person making the sale or a person connected with him (instead of being required to repurchase the securities or acquiring an option to do so) is granted rights in respect of the benefits that will accrue from their redemption.
(3)The Treasury may by regulations provide that section 730A is to have effect with modifications in relation to cases involving any arrangement for the sale and repurchase of securities where there is an agreement relating to the sale or repurchase which is not such as would be entered into by persons dealing with each other at arm’s length.
(4)The powers conferred by subsections (1) and (2) above shall be exercisable in relation to section 263A of the 1992 Act as they are exercisable in relation to section 730A of this Act.
(5)Regulations made for the purposes of this section may—
(a)make different provision for different cases; and
(b)contain such supplementary, incidental, consequential and transitional provision as appears to the Treasury to be appropriate.
(6)The supplementary, incidental and consequential provision that may be made by regulations under this section shall include—
(a)in the case of regulations relating to section 730A, provision modifying subsections (3)(b), (9), (11)(c) and (11A) of section 737C; and
(b)in the case of regulations relating to section 263A of the 1992 Act, provision modifying the operation of that Act in relation to cases where by virtue of the regulations any acquisition or disposal is excluded from those which are to be disregarded for the purposes of capital gains tax.
(7)In this section “modifications” includes exceptions and omissions; and any power under this section to provide for an enactment to have effect with modifications in any case shall include power to provide for it not to apply (if it otherwise would do) in that case.
(8)References in this section to a case involving an arrangement for the sale and repurchase of securities are references to any case where—
(a)a person makes a sale of any securities under any agreement (“the original sale”); and
(b)that person or a person connected with him either—
(i)is required under that agreement or any related agreement to buy them back; or
(ii)acquires, under that agreement or any related agreement, an option to buy them back.
(9)Section 730B shall apply for the purposes of this section as it applies for the purposes of section 730A.”
(2)In section 182(1) of the M76Finance Act 1993 and section 229 of the M77Finance Act 1994 (powers to modify provisions relating to Lloyd’s), the following paragraph shall be inserted, in each case, after paragraph (c)—
“(ca)for modifying the application of this Chapter in relation to cases where assets forming part of a premiums trust fund are the subject of—
(i)any such arrangement as is mentioned in section 129(1), (2) or (2A) of the Taxes Act 1988 (stock lending etc.); or
(ii)any such arrangements or agreements as are mentioned in section 737E(2) and (8) of the Taxes Act 1988 (sale and repurchase of securities etc.);”.
Textual Amendments
F25S. 84 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 10 para. 7(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, ss. 76, 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(10) Note 1; S.I. 1997/991, art. 2
Textual Amendments
F26S. 85 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 10 para. 7(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, ss. 76, 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(10) Note 1; S.I. 1997/991, art. 2
(1)In section 481(4) of the Taxes Act 1988 (meaning of “relevant deposit” for the purposes of provisions relating to the deduction of tax), after paragraph (c) there shall be inserted “or
(d)any interest in respect of the deposit is income arising to the trustees of a discretionary or accumulation trust in their capacity as such;”
and for “subsection (5)” there shall be substituted “ any of subsections (5) to (5B) ”.
(2)After subsection (4) of section 481 of that Act there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(4A)For the purposes of the relevant provisions a trust is a discretionary or accumulation trust if it is such that some or all of any income arising to the trustees would fall (unless treated as income of the settlor or applied in defraying expenses of the trustees) to be comprised for the year of assessment in which it arises in income to which section 686 applies.”
(3)In section 481(5)(k) of that Act (declaration by virtue of which deposit is not a relevant deposit)—
(a)the word “that” before sub-paragraph (i) shall be omitted;
(b)in sub-paragraph (i), at the beginning there shall be inserted “ in a case falling within subsection (4)(a) or (b) above, that ”;
(c)in sub-paragraph (ii), after “above” there shall be inserted “ , that ”; and
(d)after sub-paragraph (ii) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(iii)in a case falling within subsection (4)(d) above, that, at the time when the declaration is made, the trustees are not resident in the United Kingdom and do not have any reasonable grounds for believing that any of the beneficiaries of the trust is an individual who is ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom or a company which is resident in the United Kingdom.”
(4)After subsection (5A) of section 481 of that Act there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5B)In a case falling within subsection (4)(d) above, a deposit shall not be taken to be a relevant deposit in relation to a payment of interest in respect of that deposit if—
(a)the deposit was made before 6th April 1995; and
(b)the deposit-taker has not, at any time since that date but before the making of the payment, been given a notification by the Board or any of the trustees in question that interest in respect of that deposit is income arising to the trustees of a discretionary or accumulation trust.”
(5)In section 482(2) of that Act (contents of declaration under section 481(5)(k)), for paragraph (a) there shall be substituted the following paragraph—
“(a)if made under sub-paragraph (i) or (iii), contain an undertaking by the person making it that where—
(i)the individual or any of the individuals in respect of whom it is made becomes ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom,
(ii)the trustees or any company in respect of whom it is made become or becomes resident in the United Kingdom, or
(iii)an individual who is ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom or a company which is resident in the United Kingdom becomes or is found to be a beneficiary of a trust to which the declaration relates,
the person giving the undertaking will notify the deposit-taker accordingly; and”.
(6)After subsection (5) of section 482 of that Act there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5A)The persons who are to be taken for the purposes of section 481(5)(k)(iii) and subsection (2) above to be the beneficiaries of a discretionary or accumulation trust shall be every person who, as a person falling wholly or partly within any description of actual or potential beneficiaries, is either—
(a)a person who is, or will or may become, entitled under the trust to receive the whole or any part of any income under the trust; or
(b)a person to or for the benefit of whom the whole or any part of any such income may be paid or applied in exercise of any discretion conferred by the trust;
and for the purposes of this subsection references, in relation to a trust, to income under the trust shall include references to so much (if any) of any property falling to be treated as capital under the trust as represents amounts originally received by the trustees as income.”
(7)In section 482(6) of that Act (definitions for the purposes of section 481(5)), in the definition of “appropriate person”, for “as a personal representative in his capacity as such” there shall be substituted “ in his capacity as a personal representative or as a trustee of a discretionary or accumulation trust ”.
(8)In section 482(11) of that Act (power to make regulations), after paragraph (aa) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(ab)with respect to—
(i)the manner and form in which a notification for the purposes of section 481(5B) is to be given or may be withdrawn, and
(ii)the circumstances in which the deposit-taker is to be entitled to delay acting on such a notification,
and”.
(9)In section 482A(1) of that Act (power to make regulations excluding audit requirements in certain cases), after “United Kingdom” there shall be inserted “ , or investments of trustees who are not resident in the United Kingdom, ”.
(10)The preceding provisions of this section apply in relation to any payments made on or after 6th April 1996.
(11)Notwithstanding the repeal of section 67 of the Taxes Act 1988 by the M78Finance Act 1994 or anything contained in the transitional provisions relating to that repeal, where—
(a)this section has effect so as to require any deposit made before 6th April 1996 to be treated in relation to payments made after a time falling before 6th April 1998 as a relevant deposit for the purposes of section 480A(1) of the Taxes Act 1988, and
(b)section 67(2) of that Act does not otherwise apply in relation to the liability to deduction of tax that begins at that time,
section 67(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 shall apply in respect of payments made before that time as if the deposit were a source of income that the trustees in question ceased to possess at that time.
(12)An officer of the Board may, by notice to any of the trustees of a trust, require the trustees to provide the Board with the following, that is to say—
(a)information about any notification given by any of the trustees for the purposes of subsection (5B) of section 481 of the Taxes Act 1988; and
(b)such information as the Board may reasonably require for the purposes of themselves giving a notification under that subsection with respect to any income arising to the trustees;
and section 98 of the Management Act (penalties in respect of special returns) shall have effect with a reference to this subsection inserted at the end of the first column of the Table.
(13)Where a notice given by the Board before the passing of this Act requires any such information as is mentioned in subsection (12) above to be provided to the Board, and the period within which that information was required to be so provided does not expire until at least one month after the passing of this Act, that notice shall have effect as if given after the passing of this Act in accordance with that subsection.
(14)Without prejudice to section 20(2) of the Interpretation Act 1978 (references to other enactments) and subject to any provision to the contrary made in exercise of any power to make, revoke or amend any subordinate legislation, the enactments and subordinate legislation having effect, apart from this section, in relation to any provisions of the M79Taxes Act 1988 amended by this section shall be assumed, in cases where this section applies, to have the corresponding effect in relation to those provisions as so amended.
(15)In this section “subordinate legislation” has the same meaning as in the M80Interpretation Act 1978.
(1)In subsection (2) of section 209 of the Taxes Act 1988 (meaning of “distribution” for the purposes of the Corporation Tax Acts), after paragraph (d) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(da)any interest or other distribution out of assets of the company (“the issuing company”) in respect of securities issued by that company which are held by another company where—
(i)the issuing company is a 75 per cent. subsidiary of the other company or both are 75 per cent. subsidiaries of a third company, and
(ii)the whole or any part of the distribution represents an amount which would not have fallen to be paid to the other company if the companies had been companies between whom there was (apart from in respect of the securities in question) no relationship, arrangements or other connection (whether formal or informal),
except so much, if any, of any such distribution as does not represent such an amount or as is a distribution by virtue of paragraph (d) above or an amount representing the principal secured by the securities;”.
(2)In paragraph (e) of that subsection—
(a)for “paragraph (d)” there shall be substituted “ paragraph (d) or (da) ”; and
(b)sub-paragraphs (iv) and (v) (distribution in respect of securities of subsidiaries of non-resident companies etc.) shall be omitted;
and, in subsection (3) of that section, for “subsection (2)(d)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (2)(d), (da) ”.
(3)After subsection (8) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(8A)For the purposes of paragraph (da) of subsection (2) above subsections (2) to (4) of section 808A shall apply as they apply for the purposes of a special relationship provision such as is mentioned in that section but as if—
(a)the references in those subsections to the relationship in question were references to any relationship, arrangements or other connection between the issuing company and the other company mentioned in sub-paragraph (ii) of that paragraph; and
(b)the provision in question required no account to be taken, in the determination of any of the matters mentioned in subsection (8B) below, of (or of any inference capable of being drawn from) any other relationship, arrangements or connection (whether formal or informal) between the issuing company and any person, except where that person—
(i)has no relevant connection with the issuing company, or
(ii)is a company that is a member of the same UK grouping as the issuing company.
(8B)The matters mentioned in subsection (8A)(b) above are the following—
(a)the appropriate level or extent of the issuing company’s overall indebtedness;
(b)whether it might be expected that the issuing company and a particular person would have become parties to a transaction involving the issue of a security by the issuing company or the making of a loan, or a loan of a particular amount, to that company; and
(c)the rate of interest and other terms that might be expected to be applicable in any particular case to such a transaction.
(8C)For the purposes of subsection (8A) above a person has a relevant connection with the issuing company if he is connected with it within the terms of section 839 or that person (without being so connected to the issuing company) is—
(a)an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary of the issuing company; or
(b)a company of which the issuing company is an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary.
(8D)For the purposes of subsection (8A) above any question as to what constitutes the UK grouping of which the issuing company is a member or as to the other members of that grouping shall be determined as follows—
(a)where the issuing company has no effective 51 per cent. subsidiaries and is not an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary of a company resident in the United Kingdom, the issuing company shall be taken to be a member of a UK grouping of which it is itself the only member;
(b)where the issuing company has one or more effective 51 per cent. subsidiaries and is not an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary of a company resident in the United Kingdom, the issuing company shall be taken to be a member of a UK grouping of which the only members are the issuing company and its effective 51 per cent. subsidiaries; and
(c)where the issuing company is an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary of a company resident in the United Kingdom (“the UK holding company”), the issuing company shall be taken to be a member of a UK grouping of which the only members are—
(i)the UK holding company or, if there is more than one company resident in the United Kingdom of which the issuing company is an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary, such one of them as is not itself an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary of any of the others, and
(ii)the effective 51 per cent. subsidiaries of the company which is a member of that grouping by virtue of sub-paragraph (i) above.
(8E)For the purposes of subsections (8C) and (8D) above section 170(7) of the 1992 Act shall apply for determining whether a company is an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary of another company but shall so apply as if the question whether the effective 51 per cent. subsidiaries of a company resident in the United Kingdom (“the putative holding company”) include either—
(a)the issuing company, or
(b)a company of which the issuing company is an effective 51 per cent. subsidiary,
were to be determined without regard to any beneficial entitlement of the putative holding company to any profits or assets of any company resident outside the United Kingdom.
(8F)References in subsections (8D) and (8E) above to a company that is resident in the United Kingdom shall not include references to a company which is a dual resident company for the purposes of section 404.”
(4)In section 212 of that Act (exceptions from the definition of a “distribution” for certain interest and other payments)—
(a)in subsection (1), in paragraph (b), after “within” there shall be inserted “ paragraph (da) of section 209(2) or ”;
(b)in subsection (3)—
(i)at the beginning there shall be inserted “ Without prejudice to subsection (4) below, ”; and
(ii)at the end there shall be inserted “ and does not apply in relation to any interest or distribution falling within section 209(2)(da) if that interest or distribution is otherwise outside the matters in respect of which that company is within the charge to corporation tax. ”; and
(c)after subsection (3) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(4)Where any interest or other distribution is paid to a charity (within the meaning of section 506) or to any of the bodies mentioned in section 507, the interest or distribution so paid shall not be a distribution for the purposes of the Corporation Tax Acts if it would otherwise fall to be treated as such a distribution by virtue only of paragraph (da) of section 209(2).”
(5)In section 710(3)(a) of that Act (meaning of securities), for “section 209(2)(e)(iv) or (v)” there shall be substituted “ section 209(2)(da) ”.
[F27(6)In paragraph 5(5) of Schedule 4 to that Act (deep discount securities), for “section 209(2)(d)” there shall be substituted “ section 209(2)(d), (da) ”.]
(7)This section has effect, subject to subsection (8) below, in relation to any interest or other distribution paid on or after 29th November 1994.
(8)This section shall not have effect in relation to any interest or other distribution paid before 1st April 1995 in respect of any security if the security is one in the case of which a notice given before 29th November 1994 under Regulation 2(2) of the M81Double Taxation Relief (Taxes on Income) (General) Regulations 1970 was in force immediately before 29th November 1994 as regards payments of interest or other distributions made in respect of that security.
Textual Amendments
F27S. 87(6) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3)
Marginal Citations
(1)In sections 63 to 66 of the M82Finance Act 1993 (deemed periodic disposal of certain debts), for “the resident company”, wherever occurring, substitute “ the creditor company ”.
(2)After section 62 of that Act insert—
In sections 63 to 66 below as they apply by virtue of section 61 above—
(a)“the creditor company” means the company identified in subsection (1) of that section as the person entitled to the debt (referred to there as “the resident company”); and
(b)“the commencement date” means 1st April 1993.”.
(3)In section 63 of that Act, omit subsection (12) (meaning of “commencement date”).
(4)The above amendments shall be deemed always to have had effect.
(5)Anything done before the passing of this Act under or by reference to the provisions of sections 63 to 66 of the Finance Act 1993 as originally enacted shall have effect as if done under or by reference to those provisions as amended by this section.]
Textual Amendments
F28S. 88 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
Marginal Citations
(1)A debt is a qualifying debt for the purposes of sections 63 to 66 of the M83Finance Act 1993 (deemed periodic disposal of certain debts) at any time if, at that time, the person entitled to the debt is a company which—
(a)is resident in the United Kingdom, and
(b)is an associated company of a company (whether or not itself resident in the United Kingdom) which carries on a banking business in the United Kingdom,
and the debt is not an exempted debt as defined by the following provisions.
(2)A debt is an exempted debt for those purposes at any time if at that time it is held by the company entitled to it for the purposes of long term insurance business.
(3)A debt is an exempted debt for those purposes at any time if each of the first, second and third conditions mentioned below—
(a)is fulfilled at that time,
(b)has been fulfilled throughout so much of the period of the debt as falls before that time, and
(c)is likely to be fulfilled throughout so much of that period as falls after that time.
(4)The first condition is that the terms of the debt provide that any interest carried by it shall be at a rate which falls into one, and one only, of the following categories—
(a)a fixed rate which is the same throughout the period of the debt,
(b)a rate which bears to a standard published rate the same fixed relationship throughout that period, and
(c)a rate which bears to a published index of prices the same fixed relationship throughout that period.
(5)The second condition is that those terms provide for any such interest to be payable as it accrues at intervals of 12 months or less.
(6)The third condition is that the terms of the debt are not such—
(a)in the case of a debt on a security, that the security is a deep discount or deep gain security, or
(b)in any other case, that if the debt were a debt on a security it would be a deep discount or deep gain security.
In this subsection “deep discount security” has the same meaning as in Schedule 4 to the Taxes Act 1988 and “deep gain security” has the same meaning as in Schedule 11 to the M84Finance Act 1989, disregarding paragraph 1(4)(c) of that Schedule.
(7)In this section—
“associated company” shall be construed in accordance with section 416 of the Taxes Act 1988;
“long term insurance business” means insurance business of any of the classes specified in Schedule 1 to the M85Insurance Companies Act 1982; and
“published index of prices” means the retail prices index or any similar general index of prices which is published by, or by an agent of, the government of any territory outside the United Kingdom.
(8)In sections 63 to 66 of the M86Finance Act 1993 as they apply by virtue of this section “the creditor company” means the company identified in subsection (1) above as the person entitled to the debt.
(9)In sections 63 to 66 of the M87Finance Act 1993 as they apply by virtue of this section “the commencement date” means—
(a)in relation to a debt not falling within subsection (10) below, 29th November 1994; and
(b)in relation to a debt falling within that subsection, 1st April 1996.
(10)A debt falls within this subsection if the person liable for it is—
(a)an institution which is a higher education institution for the purposes of section 65 of the Further and Higher Education Act 1992 or Article 30 of the M88Education and Libraries (Northern Ireland) Order 1993,
(b)an institution which is an institution within the higher education sector for the purposes of the M89Further and Higher Education (Scotland) Act 1992, or
(c)a registered housing association within the meaning of the Housing Associations Act 1985 or Part II of the M90Housing (Northern Ireland) Order 1992,
and that person was so liable at the end of 28th November 1994.]
Textual Amendments
F29S. 89 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
Marginal Citations
(1)In Chapter VI of Part IV of the Taxes Act 1988 (provisions relating to the Schedule D charge: discontinuance, &c.), after section 109 insert—
(1)Where in connection with a trade, profession or vocation formerly carried on by him which has been permanently discontinued a person makes, within seven years of the discontinuance, a payment to which this section applies, he may, by notice given within twelve months from the 31st January next following the year of assessment in which the payment is made, claim relief from income tax on an amount of his income for that year equal to the amount of the payment.
(2)This section applies to payments made wholly and exclusively—
(a)in remedying defective work done, goods supplied or services rendered in the course of the former trade, profession or vocation or by way of damages (whether awarded or agreed) in respect of any such defective work, goods or services; or
(b)in defraying the expenses of legal or other professional services in connection with any claim that work done, goods supplied or services rendered in the course of the former trade, profession or vocation was or were defective;
(c)in insuring against any liabilities arising out of any such claim or against the incurring of such expenses; or
(d)for the purpose of collecting a debt taken into account in computing the profits or gains of the former trade, profession or vocation.
(3)Where a payment of any of the above descriptions is made in circumstances such that relief under this section is available, the following shall be treated as sums to which section 103 applies (whether or not they would be so treated apart from this subsection)—
(a)in the case of a payment within paragraph (a) or (b) of subsection (2) above, any sum received, by way of the proceeds of insurance or otherwise, for the purpose of enabling the payment to be made or by means of which it is reimbursed,
(b)in the case of a payment within paragraph (c) of that subsection, any sum (not falling within paragraph (a) above) received by way of refund of premium or otherwise in connection with the insurance, and
(c)in the case of a payment within paragraph (d) of that subsection, any sum received to meet the costs of collecting the debt;
and no deduction shall be made under section 105 in respect of any such sums.
Where such a sum is received in a year of assessment earlier than that in which the related payment is made, it shall be treated as having been received in that later year and not in the earlier year; and any such adjustment shall be made, by way of modification of any assessment or discharge or repayment of tax, as is required to give effect to this subsection.
(4)Where a trade, profession or vocation carried on by a person has been permanently discontinued and subsequently an unpaid debt which was taken into account in computing the profits or gains of that trade, profession or vocation and to the benefit of which he is entitled—
(a)is proved to be bad, or
(b)is released, in whole or in part, as part of a relevant arrangement or compromise (within the meaning of section 74),
he shall be treated as making a payment to which this section applies of an amount equal to the amount of the debt or, as the case may be, the amount released or, if he was entitled to only part of the benefit of the debt, to an appropriate proportion of that amount.
If any sum is subsequently received by him in payment of a debt for which relief has been given by virtue of this subsection, the sum shall be treated as one to which section 103 applies; and no deduction shall be made under section 105 in respect of any such sum.
(5)Where in the case of a trade, profession or vocation which has subsequently been permanently discontinued a deduction was made in computing the profits or losses of the trade, profession or vocation in respect of an expense not actually paid (an “unpaid expense”), then—
(a)if relief under this section in connection with that trade, profession or vocation is claimed in respect of any year of assessment, the amount of the relief shall be reduced by the amount of any unpaid expenses at the end of that year;
(b)for the purposes of the application of paragraph (a) above in relation to a subsequent year of assessment, any amount by which relief under this section has been reduced by virtue of that paragraph shall be treated as having been paid in respect of the expense in question; and
(c)if subsequently any amount is in fact paid in respect of an expense in respect of which a reduction has been made under paragraph (a), that amount (or, if less, the amount of the reduction) shall be treated as a payment to which this section applies.
(6)Relief shall not be given under this section in respect of an amount for which relief has been given or is available under any other provision of the Income Tax Acts.
In applying this subsection relief available under section 105 shall be treated as given in respect of other amounts before any amount in respect of which relief is available under this section.
(7)This section does not apply for the purposes of corporation tax.”.
(2)Section 109A(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (inserted by subsection (1) above) has effect as respects the years 1994-95 and 1995-96 with the substitution for the words “twelve months from the 31st January next following” of the words “ two years after ”.
(3)In section 110(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (interpretation, &c.) for “sections 103 to 109” substitute “ sections 103 to 109A ”.
(4)Where under section 109A of the Taxes Act 1988 (inserted by subsection (1) above) a person makes a claim for relief for a year of assessment in respect of an amount which is available for relief under that section, he may in the notice by which the claim is made make a claim to have so much of that amount as cannot be set off against his income for the year (the “excess relief”) treated for the purposes of capital gains tax as an allowable loss accruing to him in that year.
(5)No relief shall be available by virtue of subsection (4) above in respect of so much of the excess relief as exceeds the amount on which the claimant would be chargeable to capital gains tax for that year if the following (and the effect of that subsection) were disregarded—
(a)any allowable losses falling to be carried forward to that year from a previous year for the purposes of section 2(2) of the M91Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992;
(b)section 3(1) of that Act (the annual exempt amount); and
(c)any relief against capital gains tax under section 72 of the M92Finance Act 1991 (deduction of trading losses).
(6)In section 105(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 (deductions allowed against post-cessation receipts: exclusion of amounts allowed elsewhere), after “any other provision of the Tax Acts” insert “ or by virtue of section 90(4) of the Finance Act 1995 ”.
(7)This section has effect in relation to payments made or treated as made (see subsection (4) of section 109A of the Taxes Act 1988 inserted by subsection (1) above) on or after 29th November 1994.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F30Ss. 91-93 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F30Ss. 91-93 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F30Ss. 91-93 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
Textual Amendments
(1)Chapter IV of Part IV of the M93Finance Act 1994 (changes for facilitating self-assessment) shall be deemed to have been enacted with the following modification.
(2)In section 218 (commencement etc. of Chapter IV, sections 213(4) and (8) and 214(4) and (6) of which relate to capital allowances) the following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (1)—
“(1A)In a case where—
(a)a trade is set up and commenced by a company, and
(b)it is not set up and commenced before 6th April 1994,
sections 213(4) and (8) and 214(4) and (6) have effect only if it is set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1995.”
(1)In subsection (2) of section 7 of the Management Act (notice of liability)—
(a)for the words “a person who is” there shall be substituted the words “ persons who are ”; and
(b)for the words “a trustee” there shall be substituted the words “ the relevant trustees ”.
(2)After subsection (8) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(9)For the purposes of this Act the relevant trustees of a settlement are—
(a)in relation to income, the persons who are trustees when the income arises and any persons who subsequently become trustees; and
(b)in relation to chargeable gains, the persons who are trustees in the year of assessment in which the chargeable gains accrue and any persons who subsequently become trustees.”
(3)In subsection (1) of section 8A of that Act (trustee’s return)—
(a)for the words “a trustee” there shall be substituted the words “ the relevant trustees ”; and
(b)for the words “the trustee”, in the first place where they occur, there shall be substituted the words “ any relevant trustee ”.
(4)After subsection (4) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5)The following references, namely—
(a)references in section 9 or 28C of this Act to a person to whom a notice has been given under this section being chargeable to tax; and
(b)references in section 29 of this Act to such a person being assessed to tax,
shall be construed as references to the relevant trustees of the settlement being so chargeable or, as the case may be, being so assessed.”
(5)At the beginning of Part XI of that Act (miscellaneous and supplemental) there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)Subject to the following provisions of this section, anything which for the purposes of this Act is done at any time by or in relation to any one or more of the relevant trustees of a settlement shall be treated for those purposes as done at that time by or in relation to the other or others of those trustees.
(2)Subject to subsection (3) below, where the relevant trustees of a settlement are liable—
(a)to a penalty under section 7, 12B, 93, 95 or 97AA of this Act or paragraph 2A of Schedule 1A to this Act, or to interest under section 103A of this Act on such a penalty;
(b)to make a payment in accordance with an assessment under section 30 of this Act, or to make a payment under section 59A or 59B of this Act;
(c)to a surcharge under section 59C of this Act, or to interest under that section on such a surcharge; or
(d)to interest under section 86 of this Act,
the penalty, interest, payment or surcharge may be recovered (but only once) from any one or more of those trustees.
(3)No amount may be recovered by virtue of subsection (2)(a) or (c) above from a person who did not become a relevant trustee until after the relevant time, that is to say—
(a)in relation to so much of a penalty under section 93(3) or 97AA(1)(b) of this Act as is payable in respect of any day, or to interest under section 103A of this Act on so much of such a penalty as is so payable, the beginning of that day;
(b)in relation to a penalty under any other provision of this Act mentioned in subsection (2)(a) above, or to interest under section 103A of this Act on such a penalty, the time when the relevant act or omission occurred; and
(c)in relation to a surcharge under subsection (2) or (3) of section 59C of this Act, or to interest under that section on such a surcharge, the beginning of the day mentioned in that subsection;
and in paragraph (b) above “the relevant act or omission” means the act or omission which caused the penalty to become payable.
(4)In a case where—
(a)subsection (2)(a) above applies in relation to a penalty under section 93 of this Act, or
(b)subsection (2)(c) above applies in relation to a surcharge under section 59C of this Act,
subsection (8) of section 93 or, as the case may be, subsection (9) of section 59C of this Act shall have effect as if the reference to the taxpayer were a reference to each of the relevant trustees.”
(6)In section 118 of that Act (interpretation), after the definition of “the principal Act” there shall be inserted the following definition—
““the relevant trustees”, in relation to a settlement, shall be construed in accordance with section 7(9) of this Act.”
(7)Unless the contrary intention appears, this section, sections 104 to 115 below and Schedule 20 to this Act—
(a)so far as they relate to income tax and capital gains tax, have effect as respects the year 1996-97 and subsequent years of assessment, and
(b)so far as they relate to corporation tax, have effect as respects accounting periods ending on or after the appointed day for the purposes of Chapter III of Part IV of the M94Finance Act 1994.
(1)In each of the following, namely—
(a)subsection (1A) of section 8 of the Management Act (personal return); and
(b)subsection (1A) of section 8A of that Act (trustee’s return),
there shall be inserted at the end the words “ and the amounts referred to in that subsection are net amounts, that is to say, amounts which take into account any relief, allowance or repayment of tax for which a claim is made and give credit for any income tax deducted at source and any tax credit to which section 231 of the principal Act applies ”.
(2)In subsection (1B) of section 8 of that Act, for the word “loss” there shall be substituted the words “ loss, tax, credit ”.
(3)After subsection (4) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5)In this section and sections 8A, 9 and 12AA of this Act, any reference to income tax deducted at source is a reference to income tax deducted or treated as deducted from any income or treated as paid on any income.”
(4)In subsection (1) of section 9 of that Act (returns to include self-assessment), for the words “on the basis of the information contained in the return” there shall be substituted the following paragraphs—
“(a)on the basis of the information contained in the return; and
(b)taking into account any relief, allowance or repayment of tax a claim for which is included in the return and giving credit for any income tax deducted at source and any tax credit to which section 231 of the principal Act applies,”.
[F39(5)In subsection (1) of section 11AA of that Act (return of profits to include self-assessment), for the words “on the basis of the information contained in the return” there shall be substituted the following paragraphs—
“(a)on the basis of the information contained in the return; and
(b)taking into account any relief, allowance or repayment of tax a claim for which is included in the return,”.]
(6)For subsection (1) of section 12AA of that Act (partnership return) there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(1)Where a trade, profession or business is carried on by two or more persons in partnership, for the purpose of facilitating the establishment of the following amounts, namely—
(a)the amount in which each partner chargeable to income tax for any year of assessment is so chargeable, and
(b)the amount in which each partner chargeable to corporation tax for any period is so chargeable,
an officer of the Board may act under subsection (2) or (3) below (or both).
(1A)The amounts referred to in paragraphs (a) and (b) of subsection (1) above are net amounts, that is to say, amounts which—
(a)take into account any relief, allowance or repayment of tax for which a claim is made; and
(b)in the case of the amount referred to in paragraph (a) of that subsection, give credit for any income tax deducted at source and any tax credit to which section 231 of the principal Act applies.”
(7)For subsection (1) of section 12AB of that Act (partnership return to include partnership statement) there shall be substituted the following subsection—
“(1)Every return under section 12AA of this Act shall include a statement (a partnership statement) of the following amounts, namely—
(a)in the case of each period of account ending within the period in respect of which the return is made—
(i)the amount of income or loss from each source which, on the basis of the information contained in the return and taking into account any relief or allowance a section 42(7) claim for which is included in the return, has accrued to or has been sustained by the partnership for that period,
(ii)each amount of income tax which, on that basis, has been deducted or treated as deducted from any income of the partnership, or treated as paid on any such income, for that period,
(iii)the amount of each tax credit which, on that basis, has accrued to the partnership for that period, and
(iv)the amount of each charge which, on that basis, was a charge on the income of the partnership for that period; and
(b)in the case of each such period and each of the partners, the amount which, on that basis and (where applicable) taking into account any such relief or allowance, is equal to his share of that income, loss, tax, credit or charge.”
(8)In subsection (5) of that section, after the definition of “period of account” there shall be inserted the following definitions—
““section 42(7) claim” means a claim under any of the provisions mentioned in section 42(7) of this Act;
“tax credit” means a tax credit to which section 231 of the principal Act applies.”
Textual Amendments
F39S. 104(5) repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 27 Pt. III(28) Note of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(28) Note; S.I. 1998/3173, art. 2
(1)In subsection (1) of section 12B of the Management Act (records to be kept for purposes of returns), for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted the following paragraph—
“(b)preserve those records until the end of the relevant day, that is to say, the day mentioned in subsection (2) below or, where a return is required by a notice given on or before that day, whichever of that day and the following is the latest, namely—
(i)where enquiries into the return or any amendment of the return are made by an officer of the Board, the day on which, by virtue of section 28A(5) or 28B(5) of this Act, those enquiries are treated as completed; and
(ii)where no enquiries into the return or any amendment of the return are so made, the day on which such an officer no longer has power to make such enquiries.”
(2)In subsection (2) of that section, the words from “or, where a return” to the end shall cease to have effect.
(3)After that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(2A)Any person who—
(a)is required, by such a notice as is mentioned in subsection (1) above given at any time after the end of the day mentioned in subsection (2) above, to make and deliver a return for a year of assessment or other period; and
(b)has in his possession at that time any records which may be requisite for the purpose of enabling him to make and deliver a correct and complete return for the year or period,
shall preserve those records until the end of the relevant day, that is to say, the day which, if the notice had been given on or before the day mentioned in subsection (2) above, would have been the relevant day for the purposes of subsection (1) above.”
(4)In subsection (3) of that section—
(a)in paragraph (a), after the words “subsection (1)” there shall be inserted the words “ or (2A) ”; and
(b)in paragraph (b), for the words “the day mentioned in subsection (2) above” there shall be substituted the words “ the end of the relevant day ”.
(5)In subsection (4) of that section, after the words “subsection (1)” there shall be inserted the words “ or (2A) ”.
(6)In subsection (5) of that section—
(a)at the beginning there shall be inserted the words “ Subject to subsection (5A) below, ”; and
(b)after the words “subsection (1)” there shall be inserted the words “ or (2A) ”.
(7)After that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5A)Subsection (5) above does not apply where the records which the person fails to keep or preserve are records which might have been requisite only for the purposes of claims, elections or notices which are not included in the return.”
(1)For section 15 of the Management Act there shall be substituted the following section—
(1)Every employer, when required to do so by notice from an officer of the Board, shall, within the time limited by the notice, prepare and deliver to the officer a return relating to persons who are or have been employees of his, containing the information required under the following provisions of this section.
(2)An employer shall not be required to include in his return information relating to any year of assessment if the notice is given more than five years after the 31st January next following that year.
(3)A notice under subsection (1) above—
(a)shall specify the employees for whom a return is to be made and may, in particular, specify individuals (by name or otherwise) or all employees of an employer or all his employees who are or have been in employment to which Chapter II of Part V of the principal Act applies; and
(b)shall specify the years of assessment or other periods with respect to which the information is to be provided.
(4)A notice under subsection (1) above may require the return to state the name and place of residence of an employee to whom it relates.
(5)A notice under subsection (1) above may require the return to contain, in respect of an employee to whom it relates, the following particulars—
(a)in the case of relevant payments made by the employer, particulars of the payments;
(b)in the case of relevant payments not falling within paragraph (a) above the making of which by another person has been arranged by the employer—
(i)particulars of the payments; and
(ii)the name and business address of the other person; and
(c)in the case of relevant payments not falling within either of the preceding paragraphs, the name and business address of any person who has, to the employer’s knowledge, made the payments.
(6)Any payments made to an employee in respect of his employment are relevant payments for the purposes of this section, including—
(a)payments to him in respect of expenses (including sums put at his disposal and paid away by him);
(b)payments made on his behalf and not repaid; and
(c)payments to him for services rendered in connection with a trade or business, whether the services were rendered in the course of his employment or not.
(7)Where, for the purposes of his return, an employer apportions expenses incurred partly in or in connection with a particular matter and partly in or in connection with other matters—
(a)the return shall contain a statement that the sum included in the return is the result of such an apportionment; and
(b)if required to do so by notice from an officer of the Board, the employer shall prepare and deliver to the officer, within the time limited by the notice, a return containing full particulars as to the amount apportioned and the manner in which, and the grounds on which, the apportionment has been made.
(8)A notice under subsection (1) above may require the return—
(a)to state in respect of an employee to whom it relates whether any benefits are or have been provided for him (or for any other person) by reason of his employment, such as may give rise to charges to tax under the relevant sections, that is to say, sections 141, 142, 143, 144A, 145, 146 and 154 to 165 of the principal Act (miscellaneous benefits in cash or in kind); and
(b)if such benefits are or have been provided, to contain such particulars of those benefits as may be specified in the notice.
(9)Where such benefits are provided the notice may, without prejudice to subsection (8)(b) above, require the return to contain the following particulars—
(a)in the case of benefits which are or have been provided by the employer, particulars of the amounts which may be chargeable to tax by virtue of the relevant sections;
(b)in the case of benefits not falling within paragraph (a) above the provision of which by another person is or has been arranged by the employer—
(i)particulars of the amounts which may be so chargeable; and
(ii)the name and business address of the other person; and
(c)in the case of benefits not falling within either of the preceding paragraphs, the name and business address of any person who has, to the employer’s knowledge, provided the benefits.
(10)Where it appears to an officer of the Board that a person has, in any year of assessment, been concerned in making relevant payments to, or providing benefits to or in respect of, employees of another, the officer may at any time up to five years after the 31st January next following that year by notice require that person—
(a)to deliver to the officer, within the time limited by the notice, such particulars of those payments or benefits, or of the amounts which may be chargeable to tax in respect of the benefits, as may be specified in the notice (so far as known to him); and
(b)to include with those particulars the names and addresses (so far as known to him) of the employees concerned.
(11)In determining, in pursuance of a notice under subsection (1) or (10) above, amounts which may be chargeable to tax by virtue of the relevant sections, a person—
(a)shall not make—
(i)any deduction or other adjustment which he is unable to show, by reference to information in his possession or otherwise available to him, is authorised or required by the relevant sections; or
(ii)any deduction authorised by section 141(3), 142(2), 145(3) or 156(8) of the principal Act; but
(b)subject to that, shall make all such deductions and other adjustments as may be authorised or required by the relevant sections.
(12)Where the employer is a body of persons, the secretary of the body or other officer (by whatever name called) performing the duties of secretary shall be treated as the employer for the purposes of this section.
Where the employer is a body corporate, that body corporate, as well as the secretary or other officer, shall be liable to a penalty for failure to comply with this section.
(13)In this section—
“arranged” includes guaranteed and in any way facilitated;
“employee” means an office holder or employee whose emoluments fall to be assessed under Schedule E, and related expressions are to be construed accordingly;
“relevant payments” has the meaning given by subsection (6) above; and
“the relevant sections” has the meaning given by subsection (8)(a) above.”
(2)This section has effect as respects payments made or benefits provided on or after 6th April 1996.
(1)After subsection (1) of section 42 of the Management Act (procedure for making claims etc.) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(1A)Subject to subsection (3) below, a claim for a relief, an allowance or a repayment of tax shall be for an amount which is quantified at the time when the claim is made.”
(2)In subsection (2) of that section, for the words “subsection (3)” there shall be substituted the words “ subsections (3) and (3A) ”.
(3)In subsection (3) of that section, for the words “Subsection (2)” there shall be substituted the words “ Subsections (1A) and (2) ”.
(4)After subsection (3) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(3A)Where a person makes a claim requiring relief for a loss incurred or treated as incurred, or a payment made, in one year of assessment (“the later year”) to be given in an earlier year of assessment (“the earlier year”)—
(a)subsection (2) above shall not apply in relation to the claim;
(b)the claim shall be made in relation to the later year;
(c)the claim shall be for an amount equal to the difference between—
(i)the amount in which he has been assessed to tax under section 9 of this Act for the earlier year; and
(ii)the amount in which he would have been so assessed if the claim could have been, and had been, included in a return made under section 8 or 8A of this Act for that year; and
(d)effect shall be given to the claim in relation to the later year, whether by repayment or set-off, or by an addition to the aggregate amount given by section 59B(1)(b) of this Act, or otherwise.
(3B)Where no notice under section 8 or 8A of this Act has been given to the person for the earlier year, subsection (3A)(c) above shall have effect as if—
(a)sub-paragraph (i) referred to the amount in which he would have been assessed to tax under section 9 of this Act for that year if such a notice had been so given; and
(b)sub-paragraph (ii) referred to the amount in which he would have been so assessed if such a notice had been so given and the claim could have been, and had been, included in a return made under section 8 or 8A of this Act for that year.”
[F40(5)In subsection (4) of that section, there shall be inserted at the beginning the words “ Subject to subsection (4A) below, ”.]
[F40(6)After subsection (4) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(4A)Subsection (4) above shall not apply where—
(a)the company is wholly exempt from corporation tax or is only not so exempt in respect of trading income; and
(b)the tax credit is not one in respect of which a payment on account may be claimed by the company under Schedule 19AB to the principal Act.”]
(7)In subsection (5) of that section, for the words “subsections (2) and (4) above” there shall be substituted the words “ this section ”.
(8)In subsection (7)(a) of that section, for the words “sections 84” there shall be substituted the words “ sections 62A, 84 ”.
(9)In subsection (10) of that section, after the words “This section” there shall be inserted the words “ (except subsection (1A) above) ”.
(10)In subsection (11) of that section, paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding that paragraph shall cease to have effect.
(11)Schedule 1A to that Act (claims etc. not included in returns) shall have effect subject to the amendments specified in Schedule 20 to this Act.
Textual Amendments
F40S. 107(5)(6) repealed (31.7.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 4 paras. 2, 3 of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(9) Note 1 (with s. 3(3)); S. 107(5)(6) expressed to be repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 27 Pt. III(28) Note of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(28) Note; S.I. 1998/3173, art. 2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F41S. 108 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
(1)In section 59C of the Management Act (surcharges on unpaid income tax and capital gains tax), in subsection (4) (exceptions to surcharge), for the words “or 95” there shall be substituted the words “ , 95 or 95A ”.
(2)That section of that Act shall apply in relation to any income tax or capital gains tax which—
(a)is charged by an assessment made on or after 6th April 1998; and
(b)is for the year 1995-96 or an earlier year of assessment,
as it applies in relation to any income tax or capital gains tax which becomes payable in accordance with section 55 or 59B of that Act and is for the year 1996-97 or a subsequent year of assessment.
(1)For section 86 of the Management Act there shall be substituted the following section—
(1)The following, namely—
(a)any amount on account of income tax which becomes due and payable in accordance with section 59A(2) of this Act, and
(b)any income tax or capital gains tax which becomes due and payable in accordance with section 55 or 59B of this Act,
shall carry interest at the rate applicable under section 178 of the M95Finance Act 1989 from the relevant date until payment.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1)(a) above the relevant date is whichever of the dates mentioned in section 59A(2) of this Act is applicable; and for the purposes of subsection (1)(b) above the relevant date is—
(a)in any such case as is mentioned in subsection (3) of section 59B of this Act, the last day of the period of three months mentioned in that subsection; and
(b)in any other case, the date mentioned in subsection (4) of that section.
(3)Subsection (1) above applies even if the relevant date is a non-business day within the meaning of section 93 of the M96Bills of Exchange Act 1882.
(4)Subsection (5) below applies where as regards a year of assessment—
(a)any person makes a claim under subsection (3) or (4) of section 59A of this Act in respect of the amounts (the section 59A amounts) payable by him in accordance with subsection (2) of that section, and
(b)an amount (the section 59B amount) becomes payable by him in accordance with section 59B(3), (4) or (5) of this Act.
(5)Interest shall be payable under this section as if each of the section 59A amounts had been equal to—
(a)the aggregate of that amount and 50 per cent. of the section 59B amount, or
(b)the amount which would have been payable in accordance with subsection (2) of section 59A of this Act if the claim under subsection (3) or (4) of that section had not been made,
whichever is the less.
(6)In determining for the purposes of subsections (4) and (5) above what amount (if any) is payable by any person in accordance with section 59B(3), (4) or (5) of this Act—
(a)it shall be assumed that both of the section 59A amounts have been paid, and
(b)no account shall be taken of any amount which has been paid on account otherwise than under section 59A(2) of this Act or is payable by way of capital gains tax.
(7)Subsection (8) below applies where as regards any person and a year of assessment—
(a)amounts (the section 59A amounts) become payable by him in accordance with section 59A(2) of this Act, and
(b)an amount (the section 59B amount) becomes repayable to him in accordance with section 59B (3), (4) or (5) of this Act.
(8)So much of any interest payable under this section on either of the section 59A amounts as is not attributable to the amount by which that amount exceeds 50 per cent. of the section 59B amount shall be remitted.
(9)In determining for the purposes of subsections (7) and (8) above what amount (if any) is repayable to any person in accordance with section 59B(3), (4) or (5) of this Act, no account shall be taken of any amount which has been paid on account otherwise than under section 59A(2) of this Act or is payable by way of capital gains tax.”
(2)That section of that Act shall apply in relation to any income tax or capital gains tax which—
(a)is charged by an assessment made on or after 6th April 1998; and
(b)is for the year 1995-96 or an earlier year of assessment,
as it applies in relation to any income tax or capital gains tax which becomes due and payable in accordance with section 55 or 59B of that Act and is for the year 1996-97 or a subsequent year of assessment.
(3)In that section of that Act as it so applies, “the relevant date” means the 31st January next following the year of assessment.
[F42(4)So far as it relates to partnerships whose trades, professions or businesses were set up and commenced before 6th April 1994, subsection (1) above has effect as respects the year 1997-98 and subsequent years of assessment.]
Textual Amendments
Marginal Citations
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F43S. 111 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
(1)After section 374 of the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)This section applies where, in the case of any loan, interest on the loan never has been relevant loan interest or the borrower never has been a qualifying borrower.
(2)Without prejudice to subsection (3) below, in relation to a payment of interest—
(a)as respects which either of the conditions mentioned in paragraphs (a) and (b) of section 374(1) is fulfilled, and
(b)from which a deduction was made as mentioned in section 369(1),
section 369 shall have effect as if the payment of interest were a payment of relevant loan interest made by a qualifying borrower.
(3)Nothing in subsection (2) above shall be taken as regards the borrower as entitling him to make any deduction or to retain any amount deducted and, accordingly, where any amount has been deducted, he shall be liable to make good that amount and an officer of the Board may make such assessments as may in his judgment be required for recovering that amount.
(4)The Management Act shall apply to an assessment under subsection (3) above as if it were an assessment to income tax for the year of assessment in which the deduction was made and as if—
(a)the assessment were among those specified in section 55(1) of that Act (recovery of tax not postponed);
(b)the assessment were made for the purpose of making good to the Crown a loss of tax wholly attributable to such a failure or error as is mentioned in subsection (1) of section 88 of that Act (interest on tax recovered to make good loss due to taxpayer’s fault); and
(c)for the purposes of that section the date when the tax ought to have been paid were the 1st December following the year of assessment.
(5)If the borrower fraudulently or negligently makes any false statement or representation in connection with the making of any deduction, he shall be liable to a penalty not exceeding the amount deducted.”
(2)In subsection (2) of section 375 of that Act (interest ceasing to be relevant loan interest etc.), after paragraph (a) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(aa)as respects which any of the conditions mentioned in section 374(1) is fulfilled, and”.
(3)For subsection (4) of that section there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(4)The Management Act shall apply to an assessment under subsection (3) above as it applies, by virtue of subsection (4) of section 374A, to an assessment under subsection (3) of that section.
(4A)If there is any unreasonable delay in the giving of a notice under subsection (1) above, the borrower shall be liable to a penalty not exceeding so much of the aggregate amount that he is liable to make good under subsection (3) above as is attributable to that delay.”
(4)After subsection (8) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(8A)In any case where an amount to which a person is not entitled is paid to him by the Board in pursuance of regulations made by virtue of subsection (8) above, regulations may—
(a)provide for an officer of the Board to make such assessments as may in his judgment be required for recovering that amount from that person; and
(b)make provision corresponding to that made by subsection (4A) above and subsections (4) and (5) of section 374A.”
(5)This section applies in relation to deductions made by borrowers, and payments made by the Board, after the passing of this Act.
(1)After subsection (2) of section 16 of the M97Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (computation of losses) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(2A)A loss accruing to a person in a year of assessment shall not be an allowable loss for the purposes of this Act unless, in relation to that year, he gives a notice to an officer of the Board quantifying the amount of that loss; and sections 42 and 43 of the Management Act shall apply in relation to such a notice as if it were a claim for relief.”
(2)Deductions under that Act in respect of allowable losses shall be given preference as follows—
(a)a deduction in respect of a loss accruing to a person in the year 1996-97 or a subsequent year of assessment shall be preferred to a deduction in respect of a loss accruing to him in an earlier year of assessment; and
(b)a deduction in respect of a loss accruing to a company in an accounting period ending on or after the appointed day for the purposes of Chapter III of Part IV of the M98Finance Act 1994 shall be preferred to a deduction in respect of a loss accruing to the company in an accounting period ending before that day.
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C2S. 113(2) excluded (27.7.1999) by 1992 c. 12, s. 71(2C) (as substituted (27.7.1999) by 1999 c. 16, s. 75(1))
Marginal Citations
(1)For subsection (1) of section 65 of the M99Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (liability for tax of trustees and personal representatives) there shall be substituted the following subsection—
“(1)Subject to subsection (3) below, capital gains tax chargeable in respect of chargeable gains accruing to the trustees of a settlement or capital gains tax due from the personal representatives of a deceased person may be assessed and charged on and in the name of any one or more of the relevant trustees or the relevant personal representatives.”
(2)After subsection (2) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(3)Where section 80 applies as regards the trustees of a settlement (“the migrating trustees”), nothing in subsection (1) above shall enable any person—
(a)who ceased to be a trustee of the settlement before the end of the relevant period, and
(b)who shows that, when he ceased to be a trustee of the settlement, there was no proposal that the trustees might become neither resident nor ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom,
to be assessed and charged to any capital gains tax which is payable by the migrating trustees by virtue of section 80(2).
(4)In this section—
“the relevant period” has the same meaning as in section 82;
“the relevant trustees”, in relation to any chargeable gains, means the trustees in the year of assessment in which the chargeable gains accrue and any subsequent trustees of the settlement, and “the relevant personal representatives” has a corresponding meaning.”
Marginal Citations
(1)In subsection (7) of section 7 of the Management Act (notice of liability), for the words “income from which” there shall be substituted the words “ income on which ”.
(2)In subsection (3) of section 9 of that Act (returns to include self-assessment), the words “the following provisions of” shall cease to have effect.
(3)Section 11A of that Act (notice of liability to capital gains tax) shall cease to have effect.
(4)In subsection (2) of section 12AA of that Act (partnership return), for the words “such accounts and statements” there shall be substituted the words “ such accounts, statements and documents, relating to information contained in the return, ”.
(5)In subsection (1)(c) of section 30B of that Act (amendment of partnership statement where loss of tax discovered), after the word “relief” there shall be inserted the words “ or allowance ”.
(6)In subsection (6) of section 59B of that Act (payment of income tax and capital gains tax), for the words “under section 29 of this Act shall” there shall be substituted the words “ otherwise than under section 9 of this Act shall, unless otherwise provided, ”.
(7)In subsection (1) of section 100B of that Act (appeals against penalty determinations), after the words “95A of this Act” there shall be inserted the word “ and ”.
(8)In section 103A of that Act (interest on penalties), for the words “Part II or VA” there shall be substituted the words “ Part II, IV or VA ”.
(9)Section 73 of the Taxes Act 1988 (single assessments for purposes of Cases III, IV and V of Schedule D) shall cease to have effect.
(10)In sections 536 and 537B of that Act (taxation of royalties where owner abroad)—
(a)in subsection (2) (exemption from requirement to deduct tax from royalties), the words “are shown on a claim to” shall cease to have effect; and
(b)in subsection (4) (deduction of tax where agent’s commission unknown), the words from “and in that case” to the end shall cease to have effect.
(11)In Schedule 3 to that Act (machinery for assessment, charge and payment of income tax under Schedule C and, in certain cases, Schedule D), in paragraph 6E, sub-paragraphs (1) and (3) shall cease to have effect.
(12)Section 7 of the M100Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (time for payment of capital gains tax) shall cease to have effect.
(13)Subsection (3) above has effect as respects the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
Marginal Citations
(1)The provisions of the Management Act specified in Schedule 21 to this Act shall have effect subject to the transitional provisions contained in that Schedule.
(2)Section 198 of the M101Finance Act 1994 (which is superseded by this section) shall cease to have effect.
(1)Section 215 of the M102Finance Act 1994 (treatment of partnerships) shall have effect, and shall be deemed always to have had effect, as if—
(a)for the section set out in subsection (1) of that section there were substituted the section set out in subsection (2) below;
(b)after the said subsection (1) there were inserted the subsection set out in subsection (3) below;
(c)in subsection (2) of section 215, the word “ and ” were inserted immediately after paragraph (a), and paragraph (c) and the word “and” immediately preceding that paragraph were omitted; and
(d)in subsection (3) of that section, in paragraph (a), for the words from “in subsection (3)” to the end there were substituted the words “ subsections (3) and (4) ”.
(2)Subject to subsection (4) below, the section referred to in subsection (1)(a) above is as follows—
(1)Where a trade or profession is carried on by persons in partnership, the partnership shall not, unless the contrary intention appears, be treated for the purposes of the Tax Acts as an entity which is separate and distinct from those persons.
(2)So long as a trade or profession is carried on by persons in partnership, and any of those persons is chargeable to income tax, the profits or gains or losses arising from the trade or profession (“the actual trade or profession”) shall be computed for the purposes of income tax in like manner as if—
(a)the partnership were an individual; and
(b)that individual were an individual resident in the United Kingdom.
(3)A person’s share in the profits or gains or losses arising from the actual trade or profession which for any period are computed in accordance with subsection (2) above shall be determined according to the interests of the partners during that period.
(4)Where a person’s share in any profits or gains or losses is determined in accordance with subsection (3) above, sections 60 to 63A shall apply as if—
(a)that share of the profits or gains or losses derived from a trade or profession carried on by him alone;
(b)that trade or profession (“the deemed trade or profession”) had been set up and commenced by him at the time when he became a partner or, where the actual trade or profession was previously carried on by him alone, the time when the actual trade or profession was set up and commenced;
(c)as regards each year of assessment, any accounting date or accounting change of the actual trade or profession were also an accounting date or accounting change of the deemed trade or profession;
(d)subsection (2) of section 62 applied in relation to any accounting change of the deemed trade or profession if, and only if, on the assumption that the partnership were an individual, that subsection would apply in relation to the corresponding accounting change of the actual trade or profession; and
(e)the deemed trade or profession were permanently discontinued by him at the time when he ceases to be a partner or, where the actual trade or profession is subsequently carried on by him alone, the time when the actual trade or profession is permanently discontinued.
(5)Where section 62(2) does not apply in relation to any accounting change of the deemed trade or profession which is made or treated as made in the year of assessment next following or next but one following the commencement year, sections 60(3)(a) and 61(2)(a) shall apply as if the old date in that year were the accounting date.
(6)For the purpose of determining whether, on the assumption that the partnership were an individual, section 62(2) would apply in relation to an accounting change of the actual trade or profession—
(a)a notice may be given under subsection (3) of section 62A; and
(b)an appeal may be brought under subsection (6) of that section,
by such one of the partners as may be nominated by them for the purposes of this subsection.
(7)Where—
(a)subsections (2) and (3) above apply in relation to the profits or gains or losses of a trade or profession carried on by persons in partnership; and
(b)other income or other relievable losses accrue to those persons by virtue of their being partners,
those subsections shall apply as if references to the profits or gains or losses arising from the trade or profession included references to that other income or those other relievable losses.
(8)Where a person’s share in any untaxed income from one or more sources, or in any relievable losses, is determined in accordance with subsection (3) as applied by subsection (7) above, sections 60 to 63A shall apply as if—
(a)that share of that income or of those losses were profits or gains or losses of a trade or profession carried on by that person alone;
(b)that trade or profession (“the second deemed trade or profession”) had been set up and commenced by him at the time when he became a partner;
(c)paragraphs (c) and (d) of subsection (4) and subsection (5) above applied in relation to the second deemed trade or profession as they apply in relation to the other deemed trade or profession;
(d)the second deemed trade or profession were permanently discontinued by him at the time when he ceases to be a partner; and
(e)each source of the income were treated as continuing until the second deemed trade or profession is treated as permanently discontinued.
(9)Where—
(a)the basis period for any year of assessment is given by section 62(2)(b) in the case of a person’s second deemed trade or profession, or such a trade or profession is treated as permanently discontinued in any year of assessment; and
(b)the amount falling to be deducted under subsection (1) or (3) of section 63A exceeds that person’s share, as determined in accordance with subsection (3) as applied by subsection (7) above, in any untaxed income,
the amount of the excess shall be deducted in computing that person’s income for that year.
(10)Subsections (1) to (3) above apply in relation to persons in partnership by whom a business which is not a trade or profession is carried on as they apply in relation to persons in partnership by whom a trade or profession is carried on.
(11)In subsections (2) and (3) above as applied by subsection (10) above, references to the profits or gains or losses arising from the trade or profession shall have effect as references to any income or relievable losses arising from the business.
(12)In this section—
“accounting change” and “the old date” have the meanings given by section 62(1);
“accounting date” has the meaning given by section 60(5);
“the commencement year”, in relation to the deemed trade or profession or the second deemed trade or profession, means the year of assessment in which that trade or profession is deemed to have been set up and commenced;
“income” means any income (whether or not chargeable under Schedule D);
“untaxed income” means income which is not—
income from which income tax has been deducted;
income from or on which income tax is treated as having been deducted or paid; or
income chargeable under Schedule F.
(13)In this section—
(a)any reference to sections 60 to 63A includes a reference to those sections as applied in relation to losses by section 382(3) and (4) and section 385(1); and
(b)any reference to a person becoming or ceasing to be a partner is a reference to his beginning or, as the case may be, ceasing to carry on the actual trade or profession in partnership with other persons.”
(3)The subsection referred to in subsection (1)(b) above is as follows—
“(1A)In subsection (2) of section 110 of that Act (interpretation of sections 103 to 109A), for the words from “any event” to the end there shall be substituted the following paragraphs—
(a)any event which, under section 113 or 337(1), is to be treated as equivalent to the permanent discontinuance of a trade, profession or vocation; or
(b)in relation to a trade or profession carried on by a person in partnership with other persons, any event which, under subsection (4) of section 111, is to be treated as equivalent to the permanent discontinuance of his deemed trade or profession (within the meaning of that subsection)”.
(4)As respects the year 1994-95, the section set out in subsection (2) above shall have effect as if, in subsection (2) of that section, paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding that paragraph were omitted.
Section 209 of the M103Finance Act 1994 (loss relief: general) shall have effect, and shall be deemed always to have had effect, as if for subsection (7) (commencement of subsections (3) to (5)) there were substituted the following subsections—
“(7)Subsections (1), (2) and (6) above—
(a)except in their application to a trade set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1994, have effect in relation to losses sustained in the year 1996-97 and subsequent years of assessment; and
(b)in their application to a trade so set up and commenced, have effect in relation to losses sustained in the year 1994-95 and subsequent years of assessment.
(8)Subsections (3) to (5) above—
(a)except in their application to a trade set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1994, have effect in relation to losses sustained in the year 1997-98 and subsequent years of assessment; and
(b)in their application to a trade so set up and commenced, have effect in relation to losses sustained in the year 1994-95 and subsequent years of assessment.
(9)Any reference in subsection (7) or (8) above to a trade includes a reference to a profession, vocation or employment.”
Section 210 of the M104Finance Act 1994 (relief for losses on unquoted shares) shall have effect, and shall be deemed always to have had effect, as if, in subsection (2) (commencement), for the words “as respects” there were substituted the words “ in relation to losses incurred in ”.
(1)In section 401 of the Taxes Act 1988 (relief for pre-trading expenditure)—
(a)in subsection (1), for the words from “treated” to the end there shall be substituted the words “ treated as incurred on the day on which the trade, profession or vocation is first carried on by him ”; and
(b)subsection (2) shall cease to have effect.
(2)This section has effect as respects trades, professions and vocations which are set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1995.
In section 72(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 (apportionments etc. for purposes of Cases I, II and VI of Schedule D) for the words “months, or fractions of months,” there shall be substituted the word “ days ”.
(1)Schedule 20 to the M105Finance Act 1994 (changes for facilitating self-assessment: transitional provisions and savings) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In sub-paragraph (4) of paragraph 2 (Cases I and II of Schedule D), after the words “which arise” there shall be inserted the words “after the end of—
(a)the basis period for the year 1996-97; or
(b)in the case of a trade or profession carried on by a person in partnership with other persons, the basis period of the partnership for that year,
and (in either case) ”.
(3)After that sub-paragraph there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraphs—
“(4A)In calculating the amount of the profits or gains of the basis period for the year 1997-98 which arise as mentioned in sub-paragraph (4) above, any deduction of a capital allowance and any addition of a balancing charge shall be ignored.
(4B)Sub-paragraph (4A) above does not apply in the case of a trade or profession carried on by persons who include both an individual and a company.”
(4)At the beginning of sub-paragraph (5) of paragraph 10 (double taxation relief) there shall be inserted the words “ Subject to sub-paragraph (5A) below, ”.
(5)After that sub-paragraph there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(5A)Where the period on the profits or gains of which income tax is chargeable under Case IV or V of Schedule D for the year 1995-96 is that year, sub-paragraph (5) above shall have effect as if for the words from “50 per cent.” to the end there were substituted the words “the amount of foreign tax paid on income arising, or (as the case may require) received in the United Kingdom, in that year”.”
Schedule 22 to this Act shall have effect for preventing the exploitation of, and (in certain cases) penalising attempts to exploit, the transitional provisions set out in paragraphs 2(2) and (4), 4(2) and 6(2)(a) and (4) of Schedule 20 to the M106Finance Act 1994 (changes for facilitating self-assessment: transitional provisions and savings).
(1)In Chapter VI of Part IV of the Taxes Act 1988 (discontinuance and change of basis of computation), after section 110 there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)Where there is a change of residence by an individual who is carrying on any trade, profession or vocation wholly or partly outside the United Kingdom and otherwise than in partnership with others, tax shall be chargeable, and loss relief may be claimed, as if the change—
(a)constituted the permanent discontinuance of the trade, profession or vocation; and
(b)was immediately followed, in so far as the trade, profession or vocation continues to be carried on by that individual, by the setting up and commencement of a new one;
but nothing in this subsection shall prevent any portion of a loss sustained before the change from being carried forward under section 385 and set against profits or gains arising or accruing after the change.
(2)For the purposes of this section there is a change of residence by an individual if—
(a)not being resident in the United Kingdom, he becomes so resident; or
(b)being so resident, he ceases to be so resident.”
(2)This section shall have effect as respects the year 1997-98 and subsequent years of assessment and also, in relation only to a trade, profession or vocation set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1994, as respects the years 1995-96 and 1996-97.
(1)The provisions of the Taxes Act 1988 to which sections 215 and 216 of the M107Finance Act 1994 (partnerships and change of ownership of trade etc.) relate shall have effect as respects the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment as if subsection (5)(b) of section 215 (amendments not to apply until the year 1997-98 to partnerships controlled abroad) were omitted; and the M108Taxes Act 1988 shall have effect—
(a)as respects the year 1997-98 and subsequent years of assessment, and
(b)in its application with the amendments made by those sections to partnerships whose trades, professions or businesses were set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1994, as respects the years 1995-96 and 1996-97,
with the further amendments specified in the following provisions of this section.
(2)For subsections (1) to (3) of section 112 (partnerships controlled abroad) there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(1)So long as a trade, profession or business is carried on by persons in partnership and any of those persons is not resident in the United Kingdom, section 111 shall have effect for the purposes of income tax in relation to the partner who is not so resident as if—
(a)the reference in subsection (2)(b) to an individual resident in the United Kingdom were a reference to an individual who is not so resident; and
(b)in subsection (4)(a), after “carried on” there were inserted “in the United Kingdom”.
(1A)Where—
(a)any persons are carrying on a trade, profession or business in partnership,
(b)the trade, profession or business is carried on wholly or partly outside the United Kingdom,
(c)the control and management of the trade, profession or business is situated outside the United Kingdom, and
(d)any of the partners who is an individual resident in the United Kingdom satisfies the Board that he is not domiciled in the United Kingdom or that, being a Commonwealth citizen or a citizen of the Republic of Ireland, he is not ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom,
section 111 shall have effect in accordance with subsection (1) above as if that partner were not resident in the United Kingdom and, in addition (as respects that partner as an individual who is in fact resident in the United Kingdom), his interest as a partner, so far as it entitles him to a share of any profits or gains arising from the carrying on of the trade, profession or business otherwise than within the United Kingdom, shall be treated for the purposes of Case V of Schedule D as if it were a possession outside the United Kingdom.
(1B)Where any persons are carrying on a trade or profession in partnership, the trade or profession is carried on wholly or partly outside the United Kingdom and an individual who is one of the partners changes his residence (within the meaning of section 110A), it shall be assumed for income tax purposes—
(a)that that individual ceased to be a partner at the time of the change and became one again immediately afterwards; and
(b)in relation to matters arising after the change, that the time when he became a partner is the time immediately after the change;
but nothing in this subsection shall, in relation to that individual, prevent any portion of a loss sustained before the change from being carried forward under section 385 and set against profits or gains arising or accruing after the change.”
(3)In that section—
(a)in subsection (4)(a), for “or is deemed to reside outside the United Kingdom” there shall be substituted “ outside the United Kingdom or which carries on any trade, profession or business the control and management of which is situated outside the United Kingdom ”; and
(b)in subsection (6), for “this section” there shall be substituted “ subsections (4) and (5) above ”.
(4)In section 114(1) (partnerships including companies), after the word “company”, in the second place where it occurs, there shall be inserted “ and, subject to section 115(4), as if that company were resident in the United Kingdom ”.
(5)In section 115 (provisions supplementary to section 114), for subsections (4) and (5) there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(4)So long as a trade, profession or business is carried on by persons in partnership and any of those persons is a company which is not resident in the United Kingdom, section 114 shall have effect in relation to that company as if—
(a)the reference in subsection (1) to a company resident in the United Kingdom were a reference to a company that is not so resident; and
(b)in subsection (2), after “carried on” there were inserted “in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency”.
(5)Where the partners in a partnership include a company, subsections (4) and (5) of section 112 shall apply for the purposes of corporation tax as well as for the purposes of income tax, and section 114 shall have effect accordingly.”
(1)Schedule 23 to this Act shall have effect for imposing obligations and liabilities in relation to income tax F44... and capital gains tax on a branch or agency which, under this section, is the UK representative of a person who is not resident in the United Kingdom (“the non-resident”).
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section and to section 127 below, a branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the non-resident carries on (whether solely or in partnership) any trade, profession or vocation shall, for the purposes of this section and Schedule 23 to this Act, be the non-resident’s UK representative in relation to the following amounts, that is to say—
(a)the amount of any such income from the trade, profession or vocation as arises, directly or indirectly, through or from that branch or agency;
(b)the amount of any income from property or rights which are used by, or held by or for, that branch or agency; [F45and]
(c)amounts which, by reference to that branch or agency, are chargeable to capital gains tax under section 10 of the M109Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (non-residents) F46... ; F47...
F47(d). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)For the purposes of this section and Schedule 23 to this Act, the non-resident’s UK representative in relation to any amount shall continue to be the non-resident’s UK representative in relation to that amount even after ceasing to be a branch or agency through which the non-resident carries on the trade, profession or vocation in question.
(4)For the purposes of this section and Schedule 23 to this Act, the non-resident’s UK representative in relation to any amount shall be treated, where he would not otherwise be so treated, as if he were a separate and distinct person from the non-resident.
(5)Where the branch or agency through which the non-resident carries on the trade, profession or vocation is one carried on by persons in partnership, the partnership, as such, shall be deemed for the purposes of this section and Schedule 23 to this Act to be the non-resident’s UK representative in relation to the amounts mentioned in subsection (2) above.
(6)Where a trade or profession carried on by the non-resident through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom is one carried on by him in partnership, the trade or profession carried on through that branch or agency shall be deemed, for the purposes of this section and Schedule 23 to this Act, to include the deemed trade or profession from which the non-resident’s share in the partnership’s profits, gains or losses is treated for the purposes of section 111 or 114 of the Taxes Act 1988 as deriving.
(7)For the purposes of this section and Schedule 23 to this Act where—
(a)a trade or profession carried on by the non-resident in the United Kingdom is one carried on by him in partnership, and
(b)any member of that partnership is resident in the United Kingdom,
the deemed trade or profession from which the non-resident’s share in the partnership’s profits, gains or losses is treated for the purposes of section 111 or 114 of the Taxes Act 1988 as deriving shall be treated (in addition, where subsection (6) above also applies, to being treated as included in a trade or profession carried on through any such branch or agency as is mentioned in that subsection) as a trade carried on in the United Kingdom through the partnership as such.
[F48(8)In this section, “branch or agency” means any factorship, agency, receivership, branch or management.]
(9)This section and Schedule 23 to this Act apply—
(a)for the purposes of income tax and capital gains tax, in relation to the year 1996-97 and subsequent years of assessment; F49...
F49(b). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
[F50(10)This section does not apply in relation to income tax chargeable on income of a company otherwise than as a trustee.]
Textual Amendments
F44Words in s. 126(1) repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(2), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
F45Word in s. 126(2)(b) inserted (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(3)(a)
F46Words in s. 126(2)(c) repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(3)(b), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
F47S. 126(2)(d) and preceding word repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(3)(c), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
F48S. 126(8) substituted (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(4)
F49S. 126(9)(b) and preceding word repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(5), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
F50S. 126(10) inserted (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 4(6)
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C3S. 126(6)(7) amended (31.7.1998) by 1998 c. 36, s. 46(3), Sch. 7 para. 10
Marginal Citations
(1)For the purposes of section 126 above and Schedule 23 to this Act, none of the following persons shall be capable of being the non-resident’s UK representative in relation to income or other amounts falling within paragraphs [F51(a) to (c)] of section 126(2) above, that is to say—
(a)where the income arises from, or the other amounts are chargeable by reference to, so much of any business as relates to transactions carried out through a person who (though an agent of the non-resident) does not act in relation to the transactions in the course of carrying on a regular agency for the non-resident, that agent;
(b)where the income arises from, or the other amounts are chargeable by reference to, so much of any business as relates to transactions carried out through a broker and falling within subsection (2) below, that broker;
(c)where the income arises from, or the other amounts are chargeable by reference to, so much of any business as relates to investment transactions carried out through an investment manager and falling within subsection (3) below, that manager; and
(d)where the non-resident is a member of Lloyd’s and the income arises from, or the other amounts are chargeable by reference to, his underwriting business, any person who, in relation to or to matters connected with that income or those amounts, has been the non-resident’s members’ agent or the managing agent of the syndicate in question.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1)(b) above where any income arises from, or other amounts are chargeable by reference to, so much of any business as relates to any transaction carried out through a broker, that transaction shall be taken, in relation to the income or other amounts (“the taxable sums”), to fall within this subsection if—
(a)at the time of the transaction, the broker was carrying on the business of a broker;
(b)the transaction was carried out by the broker on behalf of the non-resident in the ordinary course of that business;
(c)the remuneration which the broker received for the provision of the services of a broker to the non-resident in respect of that transaction was at a rate not less than that which would have been customary for that class of business; and
(d)the non-resident does not fall (apart from this paragraph) to be treated as having the broker as his UK representative in relation to any income or other amounts not included in the taxable sums but chargeable to tax for the same chargeable period.
(3)For the purposes of subsection (1)(c) above where any income arises from, or other amounts are chargeable by reference to, so much of any business as relates to any investment transaction, that transaction shall be taken, in relation to that income or those amounts (“the taxable sums”), to have been carried out through an investment manager and to fall within this subsection if—
(a)the transaction was carried out on behalf of the non-resident by a person (“the manager”) who at the time was carrying on a business of providing investment management services;
(b)the transaction was carried out in the ordinary course of that business;
(c)the manager, when he acted on behalf of the non-resident in relation to the transaction, did so in an independent capacity;
(d)the requirements of subsection (4) below are satisfied in relation to the transaction;
(e)the remuneration which the manager received for the provision to the non-resident of the investment management services in question was at a rate which was not less than that which would have been customary for that class of business; and
(f)the non-resident does not fall (apart from this paragraph) to be treated as having the manager as his UK representative in relation to any income or other amounts not included in the taxable sums but chargeable to tax for the same chargeable period.
(4)Subject to subsections (9) to (11) below, the requirements of this subsection are satisfied in relation to any transaction if—
(a)there is a qualifying period in relation to which it has been or is the intention of the manager and the persons connected with him that the non-resident’s relevant excluded income should, as to at least 80 per cent., consist of amounts to which neither the manager nor any such person has a beneficial entitlement; and
(b)to the extent that there is a failure to fulfil that intention, that failure—
(i)is attributable (directly or indirectly) to matters outside the control of the manager and persons connected with him; and
(ii)does not result from a failure by the manager or any of those persons to take such steps as may be reasonable for mitigating the effect of those matters in relation to the fulfilment of that intention.
(5)For the purposes of this section any reference to the relevant excluded income of the non-resident for a qualifying period is a reference to the aggregate of such of the profits and gains of the non-resident for the chargeable periods comprised in the qualifying period as—
(a)derive from transactions carried out by the manager while acting on the non-resident’s behalf; and
(b)for the purposes of section 128 F52... below would fall (apart from the requirements of subsection (4) above) to be treated as excluded income for any of those chargeable periods.
(6)For the purposes of this section any reference to an amount of relevant excluded income to which a person has a beneficial entitlement is a reference to so much of any amount to which he has or may acquire a beneficial entitlement by virtue of—
(a)any interest of his (whether or not an interest giving a right to an immediate payment of a share in the profits or gains) in property in which the whole or any part of that income is represented, or
(b)any interest of his in or other rights in relation to the non-resident,
as is or would be attributable to that income.
(7)For the purposes of subsections (4) to (6) above references to a qualifying period, in relation to any transaction, are references to any period consisting in or including the chargeable period for which the taxable sums are chargeable to tax, being, in a case where it is not that chargeable period, a period of not more than five years comprising two or more complete chargeable periods.
(8)Where there is a transaction which would fall within subsection (3) above but for its being a transaction in relation to which the requirements of subsection (4) above are not satisfied, this section shall have effect as if the transaction did fall within subsection (3) above but only in relation to so much of the amount of the taxable sums as does not represent any amount of the non-resident’s relevant excluded income to which the manager or a person connected with him has or has had any beneficial entitlement.
(9)Subsections (10) and (11) below shall apply, where amounts arise or accrue to the non-resident as a participant in a collective investment scheme, for the purpose of determining whether a transaction carried out for the purposes of that scheme, in so far as it is a transaction in respect of which any such amounts arise or accrue to him, is one in relation to which the requirements of subsection (4) above are satisfied.
(10)Those requirements shall be deemed to be satisfied in relation to the transaction wherever the collective investment scheme is such that, if the following assumptions applied, namely—
(a)that all transactions carried out for the purposes of the scheme were carried out on behalf of a company constituted for the purposes of the scheme and resident outside the United Kingdom, and
(b)that the participants did not have any rights in respect of the amounts arising or accruing in respect of those transactions other than the rights which, if they held shares in the company on whose behalf the transactions are assumed to be carried out, would be their rights as shareholders,
the assumed company would not, in relation to the chargeable period in which the taxable sums are chargeable to tax, be regarded for tax purposes as a company carrying on a trade in the United Kingdom.
(11)Where, on those assumptions, the assumed company would be so regarded for tax purposes, subsections (4) to (8) above shall have effect in relation to the transaction as if, applying those assumptions—
(a)references to the non-resident were references to the assumed company; and
(b)the following subsection were substituted for subsection (5) above, namely—
“(5)In subsection (4) above the reference to the assumed company’s relevant excluded income for a qualifying period is a reference to the aggregate of the amounts which would, for the chargeable periods comprised in the qualifying period, be chargeable to tax on that company as profits deriving from the transactions carried out by the manager and assumed to be carried out on the company’s behalf.”
(12)In this section “investment transactions” means—
(a)transactions in shares, stock, futures contracts, options contracts or securities of any description not mentioned in this paragraph, but excluding futures contracts or options contracts relating to land,
(b)transactions consisting in the buying or selling of any foreign currency or in the placing of money at interest, and
(c)such other transactions as the Treasury may by regulations designate for the purposes of this section;
and the power to make regulations for the purposes of paragraph (c) above shall be exercisable by statutory instrument subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
(13)For the purposes of subsection (12) above a contract is not prevented from being a futures contract or an options contract by the fact that any party is or may be entitled to receive or liable to make, or entitled to receive and liable to make, only a payment of a sum (as opposed to a transfer of assets other than money) in full settlement of all obligations.
(14)The preceding provisions of this section shall have effect in the case of a person who acts as a broker or provides investment management services as part only of a business as if that part were a separate business.
(15)For the purposes of this section—
(a)a person shall be taken to carry out a transaction on behalf of another where he undertakes the transaction himself, whether on behalf of or to the account of that other, and also where he gives instructions for it to be so carried out by another; and
(b)the references to the income arising from so much of a business as relates to transactions carried out through a branch or agency on behalf of the non-resident shall include references to income from property or rights which, as a result of the transactions, are used by, or held by or for, that branch or agency.
(16)In paragraph (d) of subsection (1) above—
(a)the reference to a member of Lloyd’s is a reference to any person who is a member within the meaning of Chapter III of Part II of the Finance Act 1993 or a corporate member within the meaning of Chapter V of Part IV of the M110Finance Act 1994, and
(b)the references to a members’ agent and to a managing agent shall also be construed in accordance with section 184 of that Act of 1993 or, as the case may be, section 230 of that Act of 1994.
(17)In this section—
“branch or agency” has the same meaning as in [F53section 126 above];
[F54“collective investment scheme” has the meaning given by section 235 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 and “participant”, in relation to such a scheme, shall be construed in accordance with that section;]
and section 839 of the Taxes Act 1988 (connected persons) shall apply for the purposes of this section.
(18)For the purposes of this section a person shall not be regarded as acting in an independent capacity when acting on behalf of the non-resident unless, having regard to its legal, financial and commercial characteristics, the relationship between them is a relationship between persons carrying on independent businesses that deal with each other at arm’s length.
(19)This section applies—
(a)for the purposes of income tax and capital gains tax, in relation to the year 1996-97 and subsequent years of assessment; F55...
F55(b). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F51Words in s. 127(1) substituted (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 5(2)
F52Words in s. 127(5)(b) repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 5(3), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
F53Words in s. 127(17) substituted (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 5(4)
F54S. 127(17): definition of “collective investment scheme” substituted (1.12.2001) for definitions of “collective investment scheme” and “participant” by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 89
F55S. 127(19)(b) and preceding word repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 5(5), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
Marginal Citations
(1)Subject to subsection (5) below, the income tax chargeable for any year of assessment on the total income of any person who is not resident in the United Kingdom shall not exceed the sum of the following amounts, that is to say—
(a)the amount of tax which, apart from this section, would be chargeable on that total income if—
(i)the amount of that income were reduced by the amount of any excluded income; and
(ii)there were disregarded any relief under Chapter I of Part VII of the Taxes Act 1988 to which that person is entitled for that year by virtue of section 278(2) of that Act or of any arrangements having effect by virtue of section 788 of that Act;
and
(b)the amount of tax deducted from so much of any excluded income as is income the tax on which is deducted at source.
(2)For the purposes of this section income arising for any year to a person who is not resident in the United Kingdom is excluded income in so far as it—
(a)falls within subsection (3) below; and
(b)is not income in relation to which that person has a UK representative for the purposes of section 126 above and Schedule 23 to this Act.
(3)Income falls within this subsection if—
(a)it is chargeable to tax under [F56Schedule C,] Case III of Schedule D or Schedule F;
(b)it is chargeable to tax under Case VI of Schedule D by virtue of section 56 of the Taxes Act 1988 (transactions in deposits);
[F57(cc)it is chargeable to tax under Part 9 of ITEPA 2003 (pension income) because section 577 or 605 of that Act applies to it (UK social security pensions and retirement annuity contracts);
(cd)it arises from a source in the United Kingdom and is chargeable to tax under Part 9 of ITEPA 2003 because section 609, 610 or 611 of that Act applies to it (certain employment-related annuities);
(ce)it is a taxable benefit listed in Table A in section 660 of ITEPA 2003, other than income support or jobseeker’s allowance, chargeable to tax under Part 10 of that Act (social security income);]
(d)without being chargeable as mentioned in [F58paragraphs (a) to (ce)] above or chargeable in accordance with section 171(2) of the M111Finance Act 1993 (profits of the underwriting business of a member of Lloyd’s), it is income arising as mentioned in subsection (1)(b) or (c) of section 127 above; or
(e)it is income of such other description as the Treasury may by regulations designate for the purposes of this subsection;
and the power to make regulations for the purposes of paragraph (e) above shall be exercisable by statutory instrument subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
(4)In subsection (1)(b) above—
(a)the reference to excluded income the tax on which is deducted at source is a reference to excluded income from which an amount in respect of income tax is or is treated as deducted, on which any such amount is treated as paid or in respect of which there is a tax credit, and
(b)the reference, in relation to any such income, to the amount of income tax deducted shall be construed, accordingly, as a reference to the amount which is or is treated as deducted or which is treated as paid or, as the case may be, to the amount of that credit.
(5)This section shall not apply to the income tax chargeable for any year of assessment on the income of trustees not resident in the United Kingdom if there is a relevant beneficiary of the trust who is either—
(a)an individual ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom, or
(b)a company resident in the United Kingdom.
(6)In subsection (5) above, the reference to a relevant beneficiary, in relation to a trust, is a reference to any person who, as a person falling wholly or partly within any description of actual or potential beneficiaries, is either—
(a)a person who is, or will or may become, entitled under the trust to receive the whole or any part of any income under the trust; or
(b)a person to or for the benefit of whom the whole or any part of any such income may be paid or applied in exercise of any discretion conferred by the trust;
and for the purposes of this subsection references, in relation to a trust, to income under the trust shall include references to so much (if any) of any property falling to be treated as capital under the trust as represents amounts originally received by the trustees as income.
(7)This section shall apply, subject to subsections (8) and (9) below, in relation to the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
(8)This section shall have effect in relation to the year 1995-96 as if the following paragraphs were substituted for paragraph (b) of subsection (2) above, that is to say—
“(aa)arises on or after 6th April 1995; and
(b)is not income in relation to which that person would have a UK representative for the purposes of section 126 above and Schedule 23 to this Act if sections 126 and 127 above and that Schedule applied for the year 1995-96.”
(9)This section shall have effect in relation to the year 1995-96 as if—
(a)the income falling within paragraphs (a) and (b) of subsection (3) above did not include any income arising otherwise than from a transaction falling within subsection (10) below; and
(b)the reference in paragraph (d) of subsection (3) above to income arising as mentioned in subsection (1)(b) or (c) of section 127 above were a reference to any income which would be such income if that section applied in relation to the year 1995-96.
(10)A transaction falls within this subsection if—
(a)it is either—
(i)a transaction carried out on behalf of the non-resident by a person who, at the time of the transaction, was carrying on the business of a broker; or
(ii)an investment transaction carried out on behalf of the non-resident by a person (“the manager”) who at the time was carrying on a business of providing investment management services;
(b)it was carried out by the broker or manager on behalf of the non-resident in the ordinary course of the business referred to in paragraph (a) above; and
(c)the remuneration which the broker or manager received in respect of that transaction for the provision to the non-resident of the services of a broker or, as the case may be, for the provision of the investment management services in question was at a rate not less than that which would have been customary for that class of business.
[F59(11)In this section—
“investment transaction” has the same meaning as in section 127 above;
“ITEPA 2003” means the Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003.]
Textual Amendments
F56Words in s. 128(3)(a) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 7 paras. 31-35 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, ss. 79, 205, Sch. 7 paras. 31-35, Sch. 41 Pt. V(2)
F57S. 128(3)(cc)-(ce) substituted for s. 128(3)(c) (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 6 para. 226(2) (with Sch. 7)
F58Words in s. 128(3)(d) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 6 para. 226(3) (with Sch. 7)
F59S. 128(11) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 6 para. 226(4) (with Sch. 7)
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C4S. 128 modified (29.4.1996) by 1988 c. 1, s. 689A(5) (as inserted (29.4.1996) by 1996 c. 8, s. 73, Sch. 6 para. 16)
Marginal Citations
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F60S. 129 repealed (with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1.1.2003 in accordance with s. 155(2) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 27 para. 7, Sch. 43 Pt. 3(6)
Schedule 24 to this Act (which amends the provisions of the M112Finance Act 1993 relating to exchange gains and losses and other provisions connected with exchange gains and losses) shall have effect.
Marginal Citations
F61. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F61S. 131 repealed (24.7.2002 with effect as mentioned in s.79(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), ss 79, 141, Sch. 23 para. 22(2), Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2 (with Sch. 23 para. 25)
F62. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F62S. 132 repealed (24.7.2002 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(13) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 141, Sch. 40 Pt 3(13) Note 2
Schedule 25 to this Act (which contains amendments of Chapter IV of Part XVII of the Taxes Act 1988 and connected amendments) shall have effect.
(1)Section 759 of the Taxes Act 1988 (material interests in offshore funds) shall be amended as mentioned in subsections (2) and (3) below.
(2)In subsection (1)—
(a)for the words “of the following, namely” there shall be substituted “ collective investment scheme which is constituted by ”;
(b)for the word “and” immediately preceding paragraph (c) there shall be substituted “ or ”; and
(c)for the words “company, unit trust scheme or arrangements” there shall be substituted “ collective investment scheme ”.
(3)After subsection (1) there shall be inserted—
“(1A)In this section “collective investment scheme” has the same meaning as in the M113Financial Services Act 1986.”
(4)In Schedule 27 to the Taxes Act 1988 (distributing funds) in Part I (the distribution test) in paragraph 1(2) for paragraphs (a) and (b) there shall be substituted—
“(a)there is no income of the fund and there are no United Kingdom equivalent profits of the fund, or
(b)the amount of the gross income of the fund does not exceed 1 per cent. of the average value of the fund’s assets held during the account period,”.
(5)Section 212 of the M114Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (annual deemed disposal of certain holdings, including holdings consisting of a relevant interest in an offshore fund) shall be amended as mentioned in subsections (6) and (7) below.
(6)In subsection (5) (meaning of “relevant interest in an offshore fund”) for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted—
“(b)it would be such an interest if either or both of the assumptions mentioned in subsection (6A) below were made.”
(7)Immediately before subsection (7) there shall be inserted—
“(6A)The assumptions referred to in subsection (5)(b) above are—
(a)that the companies, unit trust schemes and arrangements referred to in paragraphs (a) to (c) of subsection (1) of section 759 of the Taxes Act are not limited to those which are also collective investment schemes;
(b)that the shares and interests excluded by subsections (6) and (8) of that section are limited to shares or interests in trading companies.”
(8)Subsections (1) to (3) above shall apply where it falls to be decided—
(a)whether a material interest is, at any time on or after 29th November 1994, a material interest in an offshore fund;
(b)whether a company, unit trust scheme or arrangements in which any person has an interest which is a material interest is, at any time on or after that day, an offshore fund.
(9)Subsection (4) above shall apply in relation to account periods ending on or after 29th November 1994.
(10)Subsections (5) to (7) above shall apply where it falls to be decided whether an interest is, at any time on or after 29th November 1994, a relevant interest in an offshore fund.
Schedule 26 to this Act (which makes provision for the purposes of corporation tax about deductions following a change in the ownership of an investment company) shall have effect.
(1)In Schedule 8 to the Taxes Act 1988 (profit-related pay schemes) paragraph 19 (ascertainment of profits) shall be amended in accordance with subsections (2) to (4) below.
(2)In sub-paragraph (6) (cases where scheme may provide for departure from requirements applicable to profit and loss account) paragraphs (g) to (k) (extraordinary items) shall be omitted.
(3)After paragraph (ff) of sub-paragraph (6) there shall be inserted—
“(l)any exceptional items which fall within sub-paragraph (6A) below and should in accordance with any accounting practices regarded as standard be shown separately on the face of the profit and loss account.”
(4)After sub-paragraph (6) there shall be inserted—
“(6A)The items are—
(a)profits or losses on the sale or termination of an operation;
(b)costs of a fundamental reorganisation or restructuring having a material effect on the nature and focus of the employment unit’s operations;
(c)profits or losses on the disposal of fixed assets; and
(d)the effect on tax of any of the items mentioned in paragraphs (a) to (c) above.”
(5)Subject to subsections (6) to (10) below, subsections (2) to (4) above shall have effect in relation to the preparation, for the purposes of a scheme, of a profit and loss account in respect of a period beginning on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
(6)Subsections (2) to (4) above shall not have effect in relation to an existing scheme unless, before the end of the period of 6 months beginning with the day on which this Act is passed, the scheme is altered to take account of the amendments made by those subsections.
(7)Subsections (8) to (10) below apply where, before the end of the period mentioned in subsection (6) above, an existing scheme is altered as mentioned in that subsection.
(8)The provision made by the scheme in compliance with paragraph 20(1) of Schedule 8 to the Taxes Act 1988 shall not prevent a profit and loss account being prepared in accordance with the alteration.
(9)Where the distributable pool would but for this subsection be determined by reference—
(a)to an amount shown in a profit and loss account prepared in accordance with the altered scheme, and
(b)to an amount shown in a profit and loss account (“an earlier account”) prepared in accordance with the scheme in a form in which it stood before the alteration,
then, for the purposes of the determination of the pool, the amount shown in the earlier account shall be recalculated using the same method as that used to calculate the amount mentioned in paragraph (a) above.
(10)The alteration of the existing scheme shall be treated as being within subsection (8) of section 177B of the Taxes Act 1988 (alterations which are registrable and which once registered cannot give rise to Board’s power of cancellation).
(11)In subsections (6) to (10) above “an existing scheme” means a scheme which, immediately before the day on which this Act is passed, is registered under Chapter III of Part V of the Taxes Act 1988.
(12)After paragraph 19 of Schedule 8 to the Taxes Act 1988 there shall be inserted—
“19A(1)The Treasury may by order amend paragraph 19 above so as to add to, delete or vary any of the items mentioned in sub-paragraph (6) of that paragraph.
(2)In this paragraph references to an order are references to an order under sub-paragraph (1) above.
(3)Subject to sub-paragraphs (4) to (8) below, any amendment or amendments made by virtue of an order shall have effect in relation to the preparation, for the purposes of a scheme, of a profit and loss account in respect of a period beginning on or after the day on which the order comes into force.
(4)Any amendment or amendments made by virtue of an order shall not have effect in relation to an existing scheme unless, before the end of the period of 6 months beginning with the day on which the order comes into force, the scheme is altered to take account of the amendment or amendments.
(5)Sub-paragraphs (6) to (8) below apply where, before the end of the period mentioned in sub-paragraph (4) above, an existing scheme is altered as mentioned in that sub-paragraph.
(6)The provision made by the scheme in compliance with paragraph 20(1) below shall not prevent a profit and loss account being prepared in accordance with the alteration.
(7)Where the distributable pool would but for this sub-paragraph be determined by reference—
(a)to an amount shown in a profit and loss account prepared in accordance with the altered scheme, and
(b)to an amount shown in a profit and loss account (“an earlier account”) prepared in accordance with the scheme in a form in which it stood before the alteration,
then, for the purposes of the determination of the pool, the amount shown in the earlier account shall be recalculated using the same method as that used to calculate the amount mentioned in paragraph (a) above.
(8)The alteration of the existing scheme shall be treated as being within subsection (8) of section 177B.
(9)An order may include such supplementary, incidental or consequential provisions as appear to the Treasury to be necessary or expedient.
(10)In this paragraph “an existing scheme”, in relation to an order, means a scheme which, immediately before the day on which the order comes into force, is a registered scheme.”]
Textual Amendments
F63S. 136 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 18 Pt. VI(3) Notes 1,2 of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(3) Notes 1-3
[F64(1)In Schedule 8 to the Taxes Act 1988 (profit-related pay schemes) paragraph 8(a) (employees working less than 20 hours a week excluded by scheme from receiving profit-related pay) shall be omitted.]
F65(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F65(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4)In Part V of Schedule 9 to the Taxes Act 1988 (profit sharing schemes) in paragraph 36(1)(a) (certain full-time employees and directors must be eligible to participate in scheme on similar terms) for the words “a full-time employee” there shall be substituted “ an employee ”.
(5)In Schedule 5 to the M115Finance Act 1989 (employee share ownership trusts) in paragraph 4(2)(c) (trust deed must provide that certain persons are beneficiaries if they work at rate of at least 20 hours a week) for the words “at that given time he worked as an employee or” there shall be substituted “ in the case of a director, at that given time he worked as a ”.
[F64(6)Subsection (1) above shall apply in relation to any scheme not registered before the day on which this Act is passed.]
(7)[F66Subsection] (4) above shall apply in relation to any scheme not approved before the day on which this Act is passed.
F67(8). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(9)Subsection (5) above shall apply in relation to trusts established on or after the day on which this Act is passed; and for this purpose a trust is established when the deed under which it is established is executed.
Textual Amendments
F64S. 137(1)(6) repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in s. 61(2)(3)) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(3) Notes 1-3
F65S. 137(2)(3) repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
F66Word in s. 137(7) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 6 para. 227 (with Sch. 7)
F67S. 137(8) repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 505 of the Taxes Act 1988 (charities: general) in subsection (1) (exemptions) after paragraph (e) there shall be inserted—
“(f)exemption from tax under Schedule D in respect of profits accruing to a charity from a lottery if—
(i)the lottery is promoted and conducted in accordance with section 3 or 5 of the M116Lotteries and Amusements Act 1976 or Article 133 or 135 of the M117Betting, Gaming, Lotteries and Amusements (Northern Ireland) Order 1985; and
(ii)the profits are applied solely to the charity’s purposes.”
(2)Subsection (1) above shall apply to chargeable periods beginning—
(a)in the case of a company, after 31st March 1995; and
(b)in any other case, after 5th April 1995.
(1)Subsection (4) of section 559 of the Taxes Act 1988 (which requires deductions to be made from payments to certain sub-contractors in the construction industry) shall have effect in relation to payments made on or after the appointed day with the substitution for “ 25 per cent. ” of “the relevant percentage”; and after that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(4A)In subsection (4) above “the relevant percentage”, in relation to a payment, means such percentage (not exceeding the percentage which is the basic rate for the year of assessment in which the payment is made) as the Treasury may by order determine.”
(2)Chapter IV of Part XIII of the Taxes Act 1988 (sub-contractors in the construction industry) shall be further amended in accordance with Schedule 27 to this Act.
(3)In this section and that Schedule “the appointed day” means such day, not being a day before 1st August 1998, as the Treasury may by order made by statutory instrument appoint; and different days may be appointed under this subsection for different purposes.
Subordinate Legislation Made
P1S. 139(3): S. 139(3) power exercised (23.11.1998) by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 2
S. 139(3): S. 139(3) power exercised (1.8.1999) by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 2
S. 139(3): Power partly exercised: 6.8.1999 appointed for specified provisions by S.I. 1999/2156, art. 2
S. 139(3): Power partly exercised: 6.4.2000 appointed for specified provisions by S.I. 2000/922, art. 2
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C5S. 139(3) extended (31.7.1998) by 1998 c. 36, s. 57, Sch. 8 para. 7
(1)In section 100 of the Taxes Act 1988 (valuation of trading stock on discontinuance of trade), in paragraph (a) of subsection (1), for the words from “realised” to the end of the paragraph there shall be substituted “ determined in accordance with subsections (1A) to (1C) below; and ”; and after that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(1A)Subject to subsections (1B) and (1C) below and to paragraph 2 of Schedule 12 to the M118Finance Act 1988 (gilt-edged securities and other financial trading stock), the value of any trading stock falling to be valued under paragraph (a) of subsection (1) above shall be taken—
(a)except where the person to whom it is sold or transferred is connected with the person who makes the sale or transfer, to be the amount (“the price actually received for it”) which is in fact realised on the sale or, as the case may be, which is in fact the value of the consideration given for the transfer; and
(b)if those persons are connected with each other, to be what would have been the price actually received for it had the sale or transfer been a transaction between independent persons dealing at arm’s length.
(1B)In a case falling within subsection (1)(a) above—
(a)stock consisting of debts to which section 88A(2) applies shall have the value for which paragraph (a) of subsection (1A) above provides even where the persons in question are connected with each other; and
(b)stock sold in circumstances in which the amount realised on the sale would be taken to be an amount determined in accordance with paragraph 5 of Schedule 5 shall be taken to have the value so determined, instead of the value for which subsection (1A)(a) or (b) above provides.
(1C)If—
(a)trading stock is sold or transferred to a person in circumstances where paragraph (b) of subsection (1A) above would apply (apart from this subsection) for determining the value of the stock so sold or transferred,
(b)the amount which would be taken in accordance with that paragraph to be the value of all of the stock sold or transferred to that person is more than the acquisition value of that stock and also more than the price actually received for it, and
(c)both parties to the sale or transfer, by notice signed by them and sent to the inspector no later than two years after the end of the chargeable period in which the trade is discontinued, elect that this subsection shall apply,
then the stock sold or transferred to that person shall be taken to have a value equal to whichever is the greater (taking all the stock so sold or transferred together) of its acquisition value and the price actually received for it or, in a case where they are the same, to either of them.
(1D)In subsection (1C) above “acquisition value”, in relation to any trading stock, means the amount which, in computing for any tax purposes the profits or gains of the discontinued trade, would have been deductible as representing the acquisition value of that stock if—
(a)the stock had, immediately before the discontinuance, been sold in the course of the trade for a price equal to whatever would be its value in accordance with subsection (1A)(b) above; and
(b)the period for which those profits or gains were to be computed began immediately before the sale.
(1E)Where any trading stock falls to be valued under subsection (1)(a) above, the amount determined in accordance with subsections (1A) to (1C) above to be the amount to be brought into account as the value of that stock in computing profits or gains of the discontinued trade shall also be taken, for the purpose of making any deduction in computing the profits or gains of any trade carried on by the purchaser, to be the cost of that stock to the purchaser.
(1F)For the purposes of this section two persons are connected with each other if—
(a)they are connected with each other within the meaning of section 839;
(b)one of them is a partnership and the other has a right to a share in the partnership;
(c)one of them is a body corporate and the other has control over that body;
(d)both of them are partnerships and some other person has a right to a share in each of them; or
(e)both of them are bodies corporate or one of them is a partnership and the other is a body corporate and, in either case, some other person has control over both of them;
and in this subsection the references to a right to a share in a partnership are references to a right to a share of the assets or income of the partnership and “control” has the meaning given by section 840.
(1G)In this section “purchaser”, in relation to a transfer otherwise than by sale, means the person to whom the transfer is made.”
(2)This section applies in relation to any case in which a trade is discontinued at a time on or after 29th November 1994.
Marginal Citations
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F68S. 141 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
The following sections shall be inserted after section 329 of the Taxes Act 1988—
(1)In a case where—
(a)an agreement is made settling a claim or action for damages for personal injury,
(b)under the agreement the damages are to consist wholly or partly of periodical payments, and
(c)under the agreement the person entitled to the payments is to receive them as the annuitant under one or more annuities purchased for him by the person against whom the claim or action is brought or, if he is insured against the claim concerned, by his insurer,
the agreement is for the purposes of this section a qualifying agreement.
(2)In a case where—
(a)an agreement is made settling a claim or action for damages for personal injury,
(b)under the agreement the damages are to consist wholly or partly of periodical payments, and
(c)a later agreement is made under which the person entitled to the payments is from a future date to receive them as the annuitant under one or more annuities purchased for him by the person against whom the claim or action is brought or, if he is insured against the claim concerned, by his insurer,
the agreement mentioned in paragraph (c) above is for the purposes of this section a qualifying agreement.
(3)Subsection (4) below applies where—
(a)a person receives a sum as the annuitant under an annuity purchased for him pursuant to a qualifying agreement, or
(b)a person receives a sum on behalf of the annuitant under an annuity purchased for the annuitant pursuant to a qualifying agreement.
(4)Where this subsection applies the sum shall not be regarded as the recipient’s or annuitant’s income for any purposes of income tax and accordingly shall be paid without any deduction under section 349(1).
(5)Subsections (6) to (10) below apply for the purposes of subsection (1) above.
(6)The periodical payments may be for the life of the claimant, for a specified period or of a specified number or minimum number or include payments of more than one of those descriptions.
(7)The amounts of the periodical payments (which need not be at a uniform rate or payable at uniform intervals) may be—
(a)specified in the agreement, with or without provision for increases of specified amounts or percentages,
(b)subject to adjustment in a specified manner so as to preserve their real value, or
(c)partly specified as mentioned in paragraph (a) and partly subject to adjustment as mentioned in paragraph (b) above.
(8)The annuity or annuities must be such as to provide sums which as to amount and time of payment correspond to the periodical payments described in the agreement.
(9)Personal injury includes any disease and any impairment of a person’s physical or mental condition.
(10)A claim or action for personal injury includes—
(a)such a claim or action brought by virtue of the M119Law Reform (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act 1934;
(b)such a claim or action brought by virtue of the M120Law Reform (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act (Northern Ireland) 1937;
(c)such a claim or action brought by virtue of the M121Damages (Scotland) Act 1976;
(d)a claim or action brought by virtue of the M122Fatal Accidents Act 1976;
(e)a claim or action brought by virtue of the M123Fatal Accidents (Northern Ireland) Order 1977.
(11)For the purposes of subsection (2) above—
(a)subsections (6), (9) and (10) above apply;
(b)subsection (7) above applies as if the reference to the agreement were to that mentioned in subsection (2)(a) above;
(c)subsection (8) above applies as if the reference to periodical payments described in the agreement were to periodical payments described in the agreement mentioned in subsection (2)(a) above and falling to be made after the later agreement takes effect.
(12)This section does not apply unless the sum concerned is received after the day on which the Finance Act 1995 is passed, but it is immaterial when—
(a)the agreement mentioned in subsection (1) above is made or takes effect, or
(b)either of the agreements mentioned in subsection (2) above is made or takes effect.
(1)In a case where—
(a)an agreement is made settling a claim or action for damages for personal injury,
(b)under the agreement the damages are to consist wholly or partly of periodical payments,
(c)the person against whom the claim or action is brought (or, if he is insured against the claim concerned, his insurer) purchases one or more annuities, and
(d)a later agreement is made under which the annuity is, or the annuities are, assigned in favour of the person entitled to the payments so as to secure that from a future date he receives the payments as the annuitant under the annuity or annuities,
the agreement mentioned in paragraph (d) above is for the purposes of this section a qualifying agreement.
(2)Subsection (3) below applies where—
(a)a person receives a sum as the annuitant under an annuity assigned in his favour pursuant to a qualifying agreement, or
(b)a person receives a sum on behalf of the annuitant under an annuity assigned in the annuitant’s favour pursuant to a qualifying agreement.
(3)Where this subsection applies the sum shall not be regarded as the recipient’s or annuitant’s income for any purposes of income tax and accordingly shall be paid without any deduction under section 349(1).
(4)For the purposes of subsection (1) above—
(a)subsections (6), (9) and (10) of section 329A apply;
(b)subsections (7) and (8) of section 329A apply as if references to the agreement were to that mentioned in subsection (1)(a) above.
(5)This section does not apply unless the sum concerned is received after the day on which the Finance Act 1995 is passed, but it is immaterial when either of the agreements mentioned in subsection (1) above is made or takes effect.”]
Textual Amendments
F69S. 142 repealed (29.4.1996) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(16)
Marginal Citations
(1)In Schedule 20 to the M124Finance Act 1993 (Lloyd’s underwriters: special reserve funds) paragraph 2 (general requirements about special reserve funds) shall be deemed to have been enacted with the modification in subsection (2) below.
(2)For sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) there shall be substituted—
“(2)The arrangements must be such as to secure that—
(a)any income arising to the trustee or trustees of the special reserve fund shall be added to the capital of the fund and held on the same trusts as the fund; and
(b)except as required or permitted by this Schedule, no payments shall be made into or out of the special reserve fund.”
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 842A of the Taxes Act 1988 (meaning of “local authority” in the Tax Acts) in subsection (2) (England and Wales) after paragraph (g) insert—
“(h)a residuary body established by order under section 22(1) of the M125Local Government Act 1992;”.
(2)This section shall be deemed to have come into force on 29th November 1994.
Commencement Information
Marginal Citations
(1)In section 119(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (rent, &c., payable in connection with mines, quarries and similar concerns), the words from “and, subject to subsection (2) below, shall be subject to deduction of income tax” to the end shall cease to have effect.
(2)In section 121 of that Act (management expenses of owner of mineral rights), for subsections (1) and (2) (right to repayment where tax paid by deduction, &c.) substitute—
“(1)Where for any year of assessment rights to work minerals in the United Kingdom are let, the lessor shall be entitled to deduct, in determining the amount chargeable to income tax in respect of the rents or royalties for that year, any sums wholly, exclusively and necessarily disbursed by him as expenses of management or supervision of those minerals in that year.”.
(3)The provisions of this section have effect in relation to payments made after the passing of this Act.
F70(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F70(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)After subsection (4) of that section there shall be inserted—
“(5)Subsections (6) to (9) below apply if—
(a)a claim is made for the allowance of an unrelievable field loss; and
(b)the person to whom the loss accrued made a claim or election for the allowance of any expenditure unrelated to that field; and
(c)that claim or election was received by the Board on or after 29th November 1994; and
(d)the whole or a part of the expenditure to which the claim or election relates is allowed and, accordingly, falls to be taken into account under section 2(8)(a) of this Act for a chargeable period (whether beginning before or after 29th November 1994).
(6)Subject to subsection (7) below, where this subsection applies, from the amount which, apart from this subsection, would be the amount of the unrelievable field loss referred to in paragraph (a) of subsection (5) above there shall be deducted an amount equal to so much of any expenditure unrelated to the field as is allowed on a claim or election as mentioned in paragraph (d) of that subsection.
(7)If—
(a)claims are made for the allowance of more than one unrelievable field loss derived from the same abandoned field, and
(b)the person to whom the loss accrued is the same in respect of each of the unrelievable field losses,
subsection (6) above shall have effect as if the deduction referred to in that subsection fell to be made from the aggregate amount of those losses.
(8)Where subsection (7) above applies, the deduction shall be set against the unrelievable field losses in the order in which the claims for the allowance of each of those losses were received by the Board.
(9)In subsections (5) and (6) above, “expenditure unrelated to the field” means—
(a)expenditure allowable under any of sections 5, 5A and 5B of this Act;
(b)expenditure allowable under this section (derived from a different abandoned field); or
(c)expenditure falling within section 65 of the M126Finance Act 1987 which is accepted by the Board as allowable in accordance with Schedule 14 to that Act;
and, in relation to expenditure falling within section 65 of the M127Finance Act 1987, “election” means an election under Part I of Schedule 14 to that Act.”
Textual Amendments
F70S. 146(1)(2) repealed (11.5.2001 with effect as mentioned in s. 101(5) of the amending Act) by 2001 c. 9, s. 110, Sch. 33 Pt. 3(2) Note 2
Marginal Citations
(1)In Schedule 8 to the M128Oil Taxation Act 1975 (procedural provisions as to allowance of unrelievable field losses), in paragraph 4 (claims)—
(a)in sub-paragraph (1) (which requires a participator to make a claim to the Board within a time limit), for the words from “and must be made” to “that is to say” there shall be substituted “ at any time after ” and the words from “and the date” to the end of the sub-paragraph shall be omitted; and
(b)in sub-paragraph (2) the words “within the time allowed for making the original claim” shall be omitted.
(2)This section applies to claims made on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
Marginal Citations
(1)In Schedule 17 to the M129Finance Act 1980 (transfer of interests in oil fields) paragraph 7 (transfer of unused losses from the old to the new participator) shall be amended as follows.
(2)At the beginning of sub-paragraph (2) there shall be inserted “ Subject to the following provisions of this paragraph ”.
(3)After sub-paragraph (2) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraphs—
“(3)If, in the case of a transfer of the whole or part of an interest on or after 29th November 1994,—
(a)the old participator made a claim or election for the allowance of any expenditure unrelated to the field, and
(b)the claim or election was received by the Board on or after that date, and
(c)the expenditure allowed on the claim or election fell to be taken into account in computing the assessable profit or allowable loss of the old participator for the transfer period or any earlier chargeable period,
then, from the sum which, apart from this sub-paragraph, would be the aggregate of all the losses transferred to the new participator under this paragraph there shall be deducted (subject to sub-paragraphs (5) and (6) below) so much of the expenditure referred to in paragraph (a) above as is allowed on the claim or election (and, accordingly, the amount so deducted shall not fall to be transferred to the new participator under this paragraph).
(4)In this paragraph “expenditure unrelated to the field” means expenditure allowable under any of the following provisions—
(a)section 5 (abortive exploration expenditure);
(b)section 5A (exploration and appraisal expenditure);
(c)section 5B (research expenditure);
(d)section 6 (unrelievable loss from abandoned field); and
(e)section 65 of the M130Finance Act 1987 (cross-field allowance of certain expenditure incurred on new fields);
and, in relation to any such expenditure, “claim” means a claim under Schedule 7 or Schedule 8 and “election” means an election under Part I of Schedule 14 to the M131Finance Act 1987 and, in relation to such an election, expenditure shall be regarded as allowed if it is accepted by the Board as allowable in accordance with that Schedule.
(5)Where, in accordance with sub-paragraph (1) above, only a part of a loss (corresponding to the part of the interest transferred) falls to be transferred under this paragraph, only a corresponding part of the expenditure referred to in sub-paragraph (3) above shall be deducted under that sub-paragraph.
(6)Where the amount of the deduction under sub-paragraph (3) above equals or exceeds the sum from which it is to be deducted, no part of any loss shall be transferred to the new participator under this paragraph.”
(1)Section 42 of the M132Finance Act 1930 (relief from transfer stamp duty in case of transfer of property as between associated bodies corporate) shall be amended as mentioned in subsections (2) to (5) below.
(2)In subsection (2) (as substituted by section 27(2) of the M133Finance Act 1967) for the words from “that the effect” to the end of the subsection there shall be substituted “that—
(a)the effect of the instrument is to convey or transfer a beneficial interest in property from one body corporate to another, and
(b)the bodies in question are associated at the time the instrument is executed.”
(3)The following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (2) (as so substituted)—
“(2A)For the purposes of this section bodies corporate are associated at a particular time if at that time one is the parent of the other or another body corporate is the parent of each.
(2B)For the purposes of this section one body corporate is the parent of another at a particular time if at that time the first body is beneficial owner of not less than 75 per cent. of the ordinary share capital of the second body.”
(4)In subsection (3) (as so substituted) for “(2)” there shall be substituted “ (2B) ”, and the words from “with the substitution” to the end shall be omitted.
(5)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (3) (as so substituted)—
“(4)In this section “ordinary share capital”, in relation to a body corporate, means all the issued share capital (by whatever name called) of the body corporate, other than capital the holders of which have a right to a dividend at a fixed rate but have no other right to share in the profits of the body corporate.”
(6)In section 27 of the M134Finance Act 1967 (which relates to section 42 of the M135Finance Act 1930) in subsection (3)(c) for the words from “a change” to “third body corporate” there shall be substituted “ the transferor or a third body corporate ceasing to be the transferee’s parent (within the meaning of the said section 42) ”.
(7)This section shall apply in relation to instruments executed on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
(1)Section 11 of the M136Finance Act (Northern Ireland) 1954 (relief from stamp duty in case of transfer of property between associated bodies corporate) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (2)(c)(iii) for the words from “a change” to “third body corporate” there shall be substituted “ the transferor or a third body corporate ceasing to be the transferee’s parent ”.
(3)The following subsections shall be substituted for subsection (3)—
“(3)For the purposes of this section a body corporate is associated with another body corporate at a particular time if at that time one is the parent of the other or another body corporate is the parent of each.
(3AA)For the purposes of this section one body corporate is the parent of another at a particular time if at that time the first body is beneficial owner of not less than 75 per cent. of the ordinary share capital of the second body.”
(4)In subsection (3A) for the words “paragraphs (i) and (ii) of subsection (3)” there shall be substituted “ subsection (3AA) ”, and the words from “with the substitution” to the end shall be omitted.
(5)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (3A)—
“(3AB)In this section “ordinary share capital”, in relation to a body corporate, means all the issued share capital (by whatever name called) of the body corporate, other than capital the holders of which have a right to a dividend at a fixed rate but have no other right to share in the profits of the body corporate.”
(6)This section shall apply in relation to instruments executed on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
Marginal Citations
(1)Stamp duty under [F71Part II of Schedule 13 to the Finance Act 1999 (lease)] shall not be chargeable on an instrument which is—
(a)a [F72lease],
(b)an agreement for a [F72lease], or
(c)an agreement with respect to a letting,
as respects which the condition in subsection (2) below is satisfied. [F73This subsection is subject to subsection (4A) below.]
(2)The condition is that it is shown to the satisfaction of the Commissioners of Inland Revenue that—
(a)the lessor is a body corporate and the lessee is another body corporate,
(b)those bodies are associated at the time the instrument is executed,
(c)in the case of an agreement, the agreement is for the [F74lease] or letting to be granted to the lessee or to a body corporate which is associated with the lessee at the time the instrument is executed, and
(d)the instrument is not executed in pursuance of or in connection with an arrangement falling within subsection (3) below.
(3)An arrangement falls within this subsection if it is one under which—
(a)the consideration, or any part of the consideration, for the [F74lease] or agreement was to be provided or received (directly or indirectly) by a person other than a body corporate which at the relevant time was associated with either the lessor or the lessee, or
(b)the lessor and the lessee were to cease to be associated by reason of the lessor or a third body corporate ceasing to be the lessee’s parent;
and the relevant time is the time of the execution of the instrument.
(4)Without prejudice to the generality of paragraph (a) of subsection (3) above, an arrangement shall be treated as within that paragraph if it is one under which the lessor or the lessee or a body corporate associated with either at the relevant time was to be enabled to provide any of the consideration, or was to part with any of it, by or in consequence of the carrying out of a transaction which involved (or transactions any of which involved) a payment or other disposition by a person other than a body corporate associated with the lessor or the lessee at the relevant time.
[F75(4A)An instrument shall not be exempt from stamp duty by virtue of subsection (1) above if at the time the instrument is executed arrangements are in existence by virtue of which at that or some later time any person has or could obtain, or any persons together have or could obtain, control of the lessee but not of the lessor.]
(5)An instrument mentioned in subsection (1) above shall not be treated as duly stamped unless—
(a)it is duly stamped in accordance with the law that would apply but for that subsection, or
(b)it has, in accordance with section 12 of the M137Stamp Act 1891, been stamped with a particular stamp denoting either that it is not chargeable with any duty or that it is duly stamped.
(6)In this section—
(a)references to the lessor are to the person granting the [F76lease] or (in the case of an agreement) agreeing to grant the [F76lease] or letting;
(b)references to the lessee are to the person being granted the [F76lease] or (in the case of an agreement) agreeing for the [F76lease] or letting to be granted to him or another.
(7)For the purposes of this section bodies corporate are associated at a particular time if at that time one is the parent of the other or another body corporate is the parent of each.
(8)For the purposes of this section one body corporate is the parent of another at a particular time if at that time the first body.
[F77(a)] is beneficial owner of not less than 75 per cent. of the ordinary share capital of the second body.
[F77(b)is beneficially entitled to not less than 75 per cent of any profits available for distribution to equity holders of the second body; and
F77(c)would be beneficially entitled to not less than 75 per cent of any assets of the second body available for distribution to its equity holders on a winding-up.]
(9)In subsection (8) above “ ”, in relation to a body corporate, means all the issued share capital (by whatever name called) of the body corporate, other than capital the holders of which have a right to a dividend at a fixed rate but have no other right to share in the profits of the body corporate.
(10)The ownership referred to in [F78paragraph (a) of] subsection (8) above is ownership either directly or through another body corporate or other bodies corporate, or partly directly and partly through another body corporate or other bodies corporate; and Part I of Schedule 4 to the M138Finance Act 1938 (determination of amount of capital held through other bodies corporate) shall apply for the purposes of [F79that paragraph].
[F80(10A)Schedule 18 to the M139Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 shall apply for the purposes of paragraphs (b) and (c) of subsection (8) as it applies for the purposes of paragraphs (a) and (b) of section 413(7) of that Act; but this is subject to subsection (10B).
F80(10B)In determining for the purposes of this section whether a body corporate is the parent of the lessor, paragraphs 5(3) and 5B to 5E of Schedule 18 to the Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 shall not apply for the purposes of paragraph (b) or (c) of subsection (8) above.
F80(10C)In this section, “control” shall be construed in accordance with section 840 of the M140Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988.]
(11)This section shall apply in relation to instruments executed on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
Textual Amendments
F71Words in s. 151(1) substituted (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned s. 112(6) of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 112(4)(6), Sch. 14 para. 33(a) (with s. 122(1)-(3))
F72Words in s. 151(1)(a)(b) substituted (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned s. 112(6) of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 112(4)(6), Sch. 14 para. 33(b) (with s. 122(1)-(3))
F73Words in s. 151(1) inserted (28.7.2000 with effect as mentioned in s. 125(7) of the amending Act) by 2000 c. 17, s. 125(2)(7)
F74Words in s. 151(2)(c)(3)(a) substituted (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned s. 112(6) of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 112(4)(6), Sch. 14 para. 33(b) (with s. 122(1)-(3))
F75S. 151(4A) inserted (28.7.2000 with effect as mentioned in s. 125(7) of the amending Act) by 2000 c. 17, s. 125(3)(7)
F76Words in s. 151(6)(a)(b) substituted (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned s. 112(6) of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 112(4)(6), Sch. 14 para. 33(b) (with s. 122(1)-(3))
F77S. 151(8)(b)(c) and “(a)” in s. 151(8) inserted (28.7.2000 with effect as mentioned in s. 125(7) of the amending Act) by 2000 c. 17, s. 125(4)(7)
F78Words in s. 151(10) inserted (28.7.2000 with effect as mentioned in s. 125(7) of the amending Act) by 2000 c. 17, s. 125(5)(a)(7)
F79Words in s. 151(10) substituted (28.7.2000 with effect as mentioned in s. 125(7) of the amending Act) by 2000 c. 17, s. 125(5)(b)(7)
F80S. 151(10A)-(10C) inserted (28.7.2000 with effect as mentioned in s. 125(7) of the amending Act) by 2000 c. 17, s. 125(6)(7)
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C6S. 151 restricted (retrospective to 24.4.2002) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 111(4)(b)(10), Sch. 34
Marginal Citations
(1)The Treasury may, by regulations, make such provision as they consider appropriate for securing that the enactments specified in subsection (2) below have effect in relation to—
(a)open-ended investment companies of any such description as may be specified in the regulations,
(b)holdings in, and the assets of, such companies, and
(c)transactions involving such companies,
in a manner corresponding, subject to such modifications as the Treasury consider appropriate, to the manner in which they have effect in relation to unit trusts, to rights under, and the assets subject to, such trusts and to transactions for purposes connected with such trusts.
(2)The enactments referred to in subsection (1) above are—
(a)the Tax Acts and the M141Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992; and
(b)the enactments relating to stamp duty and [F81stamp duty reserve tax].
(3)The power of the Treasury to make regulations under this section in relation to any such enactments shall include power to make provision which does any one or more of the following, that is to say—
(a)identifies the payments which are or are not to be treated, for the purposes of any prescribed enactment, as the distributions of open-ended investment companies;
(b)modifies the operation of Chapters II, III and VA of Part VI of the Taxes Act 1988 in relation to open-ended investment companies or in relation to payments falling to be treated as the distributions of such companies;
(c)applies and adapts any of the provisions of [F82the enactments relating to stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax] for the purpose of making in relation to transactions involving open-ended investment companies any provision corresponding (with or without modifications) to that which applies under [F83those enactments] in the case of equivalent transactions involving unit trusts;
(d)provides for any or all of the provisions of sections 75 to 77 of the M142Finance Act 1986 to have effect or not to have effect in relation to open-ended investment companies or the undertakings of, or any shares in, such companies;
(e)so modifies the operation of any prescribed enactment in relation to any such companies as to secure that arrangements for treating the assets of an open-ended investment company as assets comprised in separate pools are given an effect corresponding, in prescribed respects, to that of equivalent arrangements constituting the separate parts of an umbrella scheme;
(f)requires prescribed enactments to have effect in relation to an open-ended investment company as if it were, or were not, a member of the same group of companies as one or more other companies;
(g)identifies the holdings in open-ended investment companies which are, or are not, to be treated for the purposes of any prescribed enactment as comprised in the same class of holdings;
(h)preserves a continuity of tax treatment where, in connection with any scheme of re-organisation, assets of one or more unit trusts become assets of one or more open-ended investment companies, or vice versa;
(i)treats the separate parts of the undertaking of an open-ended investment company in relation to which provision is made by virtue of paragraph (e) above as distinct companies for the purposes of any regulations under this section;
(j)amends, adapts or applies the provisions of any subordinate legislation made under or by reference to any enactment modified by the regulations.
(4)The power to make regulations under this section shall be exercisable by statutory instrument and shall include power—
(a)to make different provision for different cases; and
(b)to make such incidental, supplemental, consequential and transitional provision as the Treasury may think fit.
(5)A statutory instrument containing regulations under this section shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
(6)In this section—
“the enactments relating to stamp duty” means the M143Stamp Act 1891, and any enactment (including any Northern Ireland legislation) which amends or is required to be construed together with that Act;
[F84“the enactments relating to stamp duty reserve tax” means Part IV of the Finance Act 1986 and any enactment which amends or is required to be construed as one with that Part;]
“Northern Ireland legislation” shall have the meaning given by section 24(5) of the M144Interpretation Act 1978;
[F85“open-ended investment company” shall have the meaning given by section 236 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000;]
“prescribed” means prescribed by regulations under this section;
“subordinate legislation” means any subordinate legislation within the meaning of the M145Interpretation Act 1978 or any order or regulations made by statutory instrument under Northern Ireland legislation; and
“umbrella scheme” shall have the meaning given by section 468 of the Taxes Act 1988;
and references in this section to the enactments relating to stamp duty, or to any of them, or to Part IV of the Finance Act 1986 shall have effect as including references to enactments repealed by sections 107 to 110 of the M146Finance Act 1990.
(7)Any reference in this section to unit trusts has effect—
(a)for the purposes of so much of this section as confers power in relation to the enactments specified in paragraph (a) of subsection (2) above, as a reference to authorised unit trusts (within the meaning of section 468 of the Taxes Act 1988), and
(b)for the purposes of so much of this section as confers power in relation to the enactments specified in paragraph (b) of that subsection, as a reference to any unit trust scheme (within the meaning given by section 57 of the M147Finance Act 1946).
(8)For the purposes of this section the enactments which shall be taken to make provision in relation to companies that are members of the same group of companies shall include any enactments which make provision in relation to a case—
(a)where one company has, or in relation to another company is, a subsidiary, or a subsidiary of a particular description, or
(b)where one company controls another or two or more companies are under the same control. M148
Textual Amendments
F81Words in s. 152(2)(b) substituted (6.2.2000) by 1999 c. 16, s. 122(4), Sch. 19 para. 13(1)(2)
F82Words in s. 152(3)(c) substituted (6.2.2000) by 1999 c. 16, s. 122(4), Sch. 19 para. 13(1)(3)(a)
F83Words in s. 152(3)(c) substituted (6.2.2000) by 1999 c. 16, s. 122(4), Sch. 19 para. 13(1)(3)(b)
F84S. 152(6): definition of “the enactments relating to stamp duty reserve tax” inserted (6.2.2000) by 1999 c. 16, s. 122(4), Sch. 19 para. 13(1)(4)
F85S. 152(6): definition of “open-ended investment company” substituted (1.12.2001) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 90
Marginal Citations
Textual Amendments
F86S. 153 repealed (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 20 Pt. VII Notes 1, 2 of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 139, Sch. 20 Pt. VII Notes 1, 2
(1)The cultivation of short rotation coppice shall be regarded for the purposes of the Tax Acts and the M149Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 as farming (and, where relevant, as husbandry or agriculture) and not as forestry; and land in the United Kingdom on which the activity is carried on shall accordingly be regarded for those purposes as farm land or agricultural land, as the case may be, and not as woodlands.
(2)For the purposes of the M150 Inheritance Tax Act 1984 the cultivation of short rotation coppice shall be regarded as agriculture; and accordingly for those purposes—
(a)land on which short rotation coppice is cultivated shall be regarded as agricultural land, and
(b)buildings used in connection with the cultivation of short rotation coppice shall be regarded as farm buildings.
(3)In subsections (1) and (2) “short rotation coppice” means a perennial crop of tree species planted at high density, the stems of which are harvested above ground level at intervals of less than ten years.
(4)Subsection (1) and subsection (3) so far as relating to subsection (1) shall be deemed to have come into force on 29th November 1994.
(5)Subsection (2) and subsection (3) so far as relating to subsection (2) shall have effect in relation to transfers of value or other events occuring on or after 6th April 1995.
(1)In section 116 of the Inheritance Tax Act 1984 (relief for transfers of agricultural property) in subsection (2) (rate of relief) the word “either” shall be omitted and at the end of paragraph (b) there shall be inserted “or
(c)the interest of the transferor in the property immediately before the transfer does not carry either of the rights mentioned in paragraph (a) above because the property is let on a tenancy beginning on or after 1st September 1995;”.
[F87(2)After subsection (2) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(2A)In the application of this section as respects property in Scotland, the reference in subsection (2)(c) above to a tenancy beginning on or after 1st September 1995 includes a reference to its being acquired on or after that date by right of succession (the date of acquisition being taken to be the date on which the successor gives relevant notice under section 12 of the M151Agricultural Holdings (Scotland) Act 1991).”]
(3)Subsections (1) and (2) above shall apply in relation to transfers of value made, and other events occurring, on or after 1st September 1995.
Textual Amendments
F87S. 155(2) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in s. 185(3)(6) of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. VI
Marginal Citations
(1)Section 67 of the M152Taxes Management Act 1970 (proceedings for tax in sheriff court) shall be amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (1) (tax not exceeding a specified sum recoverable in sheriff court) for the words from “where” to “the tax” there shall be substituted “ tax due and payable under any assessment ”.
(3)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (1)—
“(1A)An officer of the Board who is authorised by the Board to do so may address the court in any proceedings under this section.”
(4)This section shall apply in relation to proceedings commenced after the day on which this Act is passed.
(1)If, whether before or after the passing of this Act—
(a)any person (“the depositor”) has received any sum on the making, on or after 6th April 1990, of a withdrawal for cash of a tax deposit made before that date,
(b)the whole or any part of any qualifying tax liability has been discharged by any payment made otherwise than by the application of a tax deposit, and
(c)that payment was made in the period beginning one month before the withdrawal and ending one month afterwards,
the depositor shall be entitled to receive compensation under this section from the Board.
(2)In this section “qualifying tax liability”, in relation to a tax deposit, means so much of any liability as is—
(a)a liability of any person for any tax for the year 1990-91 or any subsequent year of assessment, or for interest on such tax;
(b)a liability that relates to tax for a year of assessment during the whole or any part of which that person was married to the depositor; and
(c)a liability of such a description that, if it had been a liability of the depositor (and the withdrawal were to be disregarded), the whole or any part of it could have been discharged, immediately before the time of the payment mentioned in subsection (1)(b) above, by the application of that deposit and of accrued interest thereon.
(3)Subject to the following provisions of this section, the amount of the compensation to which the depositor is entitled under this section in the case of any deposit withdrawn for cash shall be equal to the difference between—
(a)the sum received as mentioned in subsection (1)(a) above on the withdrawal; and
(b)the sum that would have been received if interest had accrued on the relevant part of the sum received at the rate applicable under the relevant terms to sums applied in the payment of tax, instead of at the rate applicable to a withdrawal for cash.
(4)In subsection (3) above, the reference to the relevant part of the sum received on the withdrawal of a deposit is a reference to the following amount, that is to say—
(a)in a case where the sum received on the withdrawal is equal to or smaller than the amount of the liability discharged by the payment mentioned in subsection (1)(b) above, the amount equal to such part of the sum actually received as does not represent interest that has accrued under the relevant terms; and
(b)in any other case, to the amount which would have been the amount specified in paragraph (a) above if the sum actually received on the withdrawal had been equal to the amount of qualifying tax liability so discharged.
(5)The amount of compensation to which any person is entitled under this section shall also include an amount equal to interest, for the period from the withdrawal mentioned in subsection (1)(a) above until the payment of the compensation, on the amount determined in accordance with subsection (3) above; and a liability to compensation under this section shall not bear interest apart from in accordance with this subsection.
(6)Section 178 of the M153Finance Act 1989 (interest rates) shall apply to subsection (5) above for determining the rate of the interest treated, by virtue of that subsection, as included in any compensation under this section; and any regulations under that section which are in force at the passing of this Act shall be deemed, subject to the powers of the Treasury under that section, to have effect in relation to this section as they have effect in relation to the enactments specified in subsection (2)(f) of that section (interest on overdue tax).
(7)The part of any compensation under this section that represents interest under subsection (5) above shall not be treated as included in the income of the depositor for the purposes of income tax; but the remainder shall be chargeable to income tax under Case III of Schedule D.
(8)No compensation shall be paid under this section unless a claim for it has been made to the Board.
(9)Where any claim is made under this section with respect to any withdrawal for cash of a tax deposit—
(a)this section shall have effect if there is, in the period mentioned in subsection (1)(c) above, more than one such payment as is mentioned in subsection (1)(b) above as if (subject to paragraph (b) below) all the payments in that period were, for the purposes of that claim, to be aggregated and treated as one such payment; and
(b)the amount of compensation payable under this section on that claim shall be computed without regard to so much of any payment discharging a qualifying tax liability as, in pursuance of any claim under this section, has been or is to be so taken into account as to affect the amount of compensation payable in the case of any other withdrawal.
(10)Sums required by the Board for paying compensation under this section shall be issued to the Board by the Treasury out of the National Loans Fund.
(11)A withdrawal for cash of a tax deposit shall be taken for the purposes of this section to occur at the same time as, under the relevant terms, it is deemed to occur for the purposes of the calculation of interest on the amount withdrawn.
(12)This section shall be construed as one with the Tax Acts, and in this section—
(a)references to a tax deposit are references to the whole or any part of any deposit in respect of which a certificate of tax deposit has been issued by the Treasury under section 12 of the M154National Loans Act 1968; and
(b)references to the relevant terms, in relation to a tax deposit, are references to the terms applicable to that deposit and to the certificate issued in respect of it.
Section 10 of the M155Exchequer and Audit Departments Act 1866 (Commissioners of Customs and Excise and of Inland Revenue to deduct repayments from gross revenues) shall have effect, and be deemed always to have had effect, as if the reference in that section to repayments included references to—
(a)payments in respect of any actual or deemed credits relating to any tax or duty; and
(b)payments of any interest on sums which are or are deemed to be repayments for the purposes of that section.
Marginal Citations
(1)In Part I of the M156Ports Act 1991 (transfer of statutory port undertakings), after section 15 (duty to provide information for purposes of levy) insert—
(1)Where a notice of assessment has been served under section 14(2) above on a former relevant port authority (“the authority”), the authority may, within the period mentioned in section 14(3) above, by notice in writing request the appropriate Minister to reconsider the amount of the assessment.
The request shall set out the grounds on which the authority allege that the amount assessed is incorrect.
(2)If it appears to the Minister that there are reasonable grounds for believing that the amount of the assessment may be excessive, he may direct that section 14(3) and (4) above shall not apply to the whole amount of the assessment but only to such lesser amount as he may specify.
(3)If a request for reconsideration is duly made, the appropriate Minister shall reconsider the amount of the assessment and may confirm or reduce it.
An appeal lies to the High Court or, in Scotland, to the Court of Session as the Court of Exchequer in Scotland from any decision of the Minister under this subsection.
(4)The appropriate Minister may reconsider the amount of an assessment under section 14(2) above in any other case, if he thinks fit, and may confirm or reduce it.
(5)When the amount of the assessment is finally determined—
(a)if the amount of the assessment is less than the amount paid by the authority, the appropriate Minister shall make such payment to the authority as is required to put the authority in the same position as if the reduced amount had been specified in the original assessment;
(b)if a further amount is payable by the authority, section 14(3) and (4) above shall apply in relation to that amount as if the reference to the date of issue of the notice of assessment were a reference to the date of the determination.
(6)Except as provided by this section a notice of assessment under section 14(2) above shall not be questioned in any legal proceedings whatsoever.”.
(2)Sections 115 to 120 of the M157Finance Act 1990 (levy on privatisation of certain ports) shall cease to have effect.
(3)An Order in Council under paragraph 1(1)(b) of Schedule 1 to the M158Northern Ireland Act 1974 (legislation for Northern Ireland in the interim period) which states that it is made only for purposes corresponding to those of subsection (1) above—
(a)shall not be subject to paragraph 1(4) and (5) of that Schedule (affirmative resolution of both Houses of Parliament), but
(b)shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of either House of Parliament.
Textual Amendments
F88S. 160 repealed (19.11.1998) by 1998 c. 43, s. 1(1), Sch. 1 Pt. IV Group 5
(1)In this Act “the Taxes Act 1988” means the M159Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988.
(2)In Part III of this Act “the Management Act” means the M160Taxes Management Act 1970.
(3)Part V of this Act shall be construed as one with the M161Stamp Act 1891.
The provisions specified in Schedule 29 to this Act (which include provisions which are already spent) are hereby repealed to the extent specified in the third column of that Schedule, but subject to any provision of that Schedule.
This Act may be cited as the Finance Act 1995.
Section 2.
Description of wine or made-wine | Rates of duty per hectolitre |
---|---|
£ | |
Wine or made-wine of a strength not exceeding 4 per cent. | 23.41 |
Wine or made-wine of a strength exceeding 4 per cent. but not exceeding 5.5 per cent. | 42.14 |
Wine or made-wine of a strength exceeding 5.5 per cent. but not exceeding 15 per cent. and not being sparkling | 140.44 |
Sparkling wine or sparkling made-wine of a strength exceeding 5.5 per cent. but not exceeding 15 per cent. | 200.64 |
Wine or made-wine of a strength exceeding 15 per cent. but not exceeding 22 per cent. | 200.64” |
Description of wine or made-wine | Rates of duty per litre of alcohol in the wine or made-wine |
---|---|
£ | |
Wine or made-wine of a strength exceeding 22 per cent. | 20.60” |
Valid from 01/07/2005
Section 5.
1U.K.In section 4(1) of the M162Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 (interpretation)—
(a)for the definition of “authorised methylator” there shall be substituted the following definition—
““authorised denaturer” means a person authorised under section 75(1) below to denature dutiable alcoholic liquor;”
(b)in the definition of “British compounded spirits”, for “methylated spirits” there shall be substituted “ denatured alcohol ”;
(c)after the definition of “compounder” there shall be inserted the following definition—
““denatured alcohol” means denatured alcohol within the meaning of section 5 of the Finance Act 1995, and references to denaturing a liquor are references to subjecting it to any process by which it becomes denatured alcohol;”
(d)for the definition of “licensed methylator” there shall be substituted the following definition—
““licensed denaturer” means a person holding a licence under section 75(2) below;”.
2U.K.Section 9 of that Act (remission of duty on spirits for methylation) shall cease to have effect.
3U.K.In section 10 of that Act (remission of duty on spirits), for “methylated spirits” there shall be substituted “ denatured alcohol ”.
4U.K.In section 24(1)(a) of that Act (restriction on distiller or rectifier carrying on other trades), for “methylated spirits” there shall be substituted “ denatured alcohol ”.
5U.K.In sections 75, 77, 79 and 80 of that Act (which contain provisions regulating methylation)—
(a)for the words “methylate”, “methylates”, “methylator” and “methylators”, wherever they occur, and for the word “methylated”, where it occurs outside the expression “methylated spirits”, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ denature ”, “ denatures ”, “ denaturer ”, “ denaturers ” and “ denatured ”;
(b)for the words “methylation” and “methylating”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted, in each case, “ denaturing ”;
(c)for the word “spirits”, wherever it occurs outside the expression “methylated spirits”, there shall be substituted “ dutiable alcoholic liquor ”;
(d)for the words “methylated spirits”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted “ denatured alcohol ”.
6U.K.In section 77(2) of that Act (provisions supplemental to powers to make regulations), after paragraph (a) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(aa)frame any provision of the regulations with respect to the supply, receipt or use of denatured alcohol by reference to matters to be contained from time to time in a notice published in accordance with the regulations by the Commissioners and having effect until withdrawn in accordance with the regulations; and”.
7U.K.For section 78 of that Act (additional provisions relating to methylated spirits) there shall be substituted the following section—
(1)This subsection applies if, at any time when an account is taken and a balance struck of the quantity of any kind of denatured alcohol in the possession of an authorised or licensed denaturer, there is a difference between—
(a)the quantity (“the actual amount”) of the dutiable alcoholic liquor of any description in the denatured alcohol in his possession; and
(b)the quantity (“the proper amount”) of dutiable alcoholic liquor of that description which, according to any such accounts as are required to be kept by virtue of any regulations under section 77 above, ought to be in the denatured alcohol in his possession.
(2)Subsection (1) above shall not apply if the difference constitutes—
(a)an excess of the actual amount over the proper amount of not more than 1 per cent. of the aggregate of—
(i)the quantity of dutiable alcoholic liquor of the description in question in the balance of dutiable alcoholic liquor struck when an account was last taken; and
(ii)the quantity of dutiable alcoholic liquor of that description which has since been lawfully added to the denaturer’s stock;
or
(b)a deficiency such that the actual amount is less than the proper amount by not more than 2 per cent. of that aggregate.
(3)If, where subsection (1) above applies, the actual amount exceeds the proper amount, the relevant amount of any dutiable alcoholic liquor of the description in question which is in the possession of the denaturer shall be liable to forfeiture; and for this purpose the relevant amount is the amount corresponding to the amount of the excess or such part of that amount as the Commissioners consider appropriate.
(4)If, where subsection (1) above applies, the actual amount is less than the proper amount, the denaturer shall, on demand by the Commissioners, pay on the amount of the deficiency, or on such part of it as the Commissioners may specify in the demand, the duty payable on dutiable alcoholic liquor of the description comprised in the deficiency.
(5)If any person—
(a)supplies to another, in contravention of any regulations under section 77 above, any denatured alcohol containing dutiable alcoholic liquor of any description, or
(b)uses any such denatured alcohol in contravention of any such regulations,
that person shall, on demand by the Commissioners, pay on the amount of dutiable alcoholic liquor of that description comprised, at the time of its supply or use, in the denatured alcohol that is so supplied or used, or on such part of it as the Commissioners may specify, the duty payable on dutiable alcoholic liquor of that description.
(6)Any supply of denatured alcohol to a person who—
(a)by virtue of any regulations under section 77 above is prohibited from receiving it unless authorised to do so by or under the regulations, and
(b)is not so authorised in the case of the denatured alcohol supplied to him,
shall be taken for the purposes of subsection (5) above to be a supply in contravention of those regulations.
(7)A demand made for the purposes of subsection (4) or (5) above shall be combined, as if there had been a default such as is mentioned in that section, with an assessment and notification under section 12 of the M163Finance Act 1994 (assessments to excise duty) of the amount of duty due in consequence of the making of the demand.”
8U.K.In paragraph 3(1)(d) of Schedule 5 to the Finance Act 1994 (decisions under or for the purposes of section 9 or 10 of the M164Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 to be subject to review and appeal), for “section 9 or 10 (remission of duty on spirits for methylation or” there shall be substituted “ section 10 (remission of duty on spirits ”.
Section 14.
1U.K.The M165Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 shall be amended in accordance with paragraphs 2 to 11 below.
Marginal Citations
2(1)In section 21 (gaming machine licences)—U.K.
(a)in subsection (1), for the words “gaming machine” and “for gaming” there shall be substituted, respectively, “ amusement machine ” and “ for play ”;
(b)in subsection (2), for “a gaming machine licence” there shall be substituted “ an amusement machine licence ”; and
(c)in subsection (3), for “A gaming machine licence” there shall be substituted “ An amusement machine licence ”.
(2)In subsection (3A) of that section (excepted machines), for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted the following paragraphs—
“(b)a five-penny machine which is a prize machine without being a gaming machine or which (if it is a gaming machine) is a small-prize machine, or
(c)a thirty-five-penny machine which is not a prize machine.”
3(1)In subsection (1) of section 22 (duty on gaming machine licences), for “gaming machine” there shall be substituted “ amusement machine ”.U.K.
(2)In subsection (2) of that section (meaning of “small-prize machine”), for “a gaming machine is a small-prize machine if” there shall be substituted “ an amusement machine is a small-prize machine if it is a prize machine and ”.
4(1)In subsection (1) of section 23 (determination of rate of duty by reference to Table), for “a gaming machine licence” there shall be substituted “ an amusement machine licence ”.U.K.
(2)In subsection (2) of that section—
(a)in paragraph (b), for “or column 3” there shall be substituted “ , column 3 or column 4 ”; and
(b)in the words after that paragraph, for the words “gaming” and “or the rate in column 3” there shall be substituted, respectively, “ amusement ” and “ , the rate in column 3 or the rate in column 4 ”.
(3)For the Table in that subsection (as substituted by section 13 of this Act) there shall be substituted the following Table—
(1) Period (in months) for which licence granted | (2) Machines that are not gaming machines | (3) Gaming machines that are small-prize machines or are five-penny machines without being small-prize machines | (4) Other machines |
---|---|---|---|
£ | £ | £ | |
1 | 30 | 60 | 150 |
2 | 50 | 105 | 275 |
3 | 75 | 155 | 400 |
4 | 95 | 205 | 520 |
5 | 120 | 250 | 645 |
6 | 140 | 295 | 755 |
7 | 160 | 340 | 880 |
8 | 185 | 390 | 1,005 |
9 | 205 | 435 | 1,115 |
10 | 225 | 480 | 1,235 |
11 | 240 | 510 | 1,305 |
12 | 250 | 535 | 1,375” |
5U.K.In section 24 (restrictions on provision of gaming machines)—
(a)for the words “Gaming machines”, “gaming machines” and “gaming machine”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ Amusement machines ”, “ amusement machines ” and “ amusement machine ”;
(b)for the word “a”, where it occurs before “gaming machine” in subsection (5)(f), there shall be substituted “ an ”; and
(c)for the words “for gaming”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted “ for play ”.
6(1)For subsections (1) to (3) of section 25 (meaning of “gaming machine”) there shall be substituted the following subsections—U.K.
“(1)A machine is an amusement machine for the purposes of this Act if—
(a)the machine is constructed or adapted for the playing of any game (whether a game of chance, a game of skill or a game of chance and skill combined);
(b)the game is one played by means of the machine (whether automatically or by the operation of the machine by the player or players);
(c)a player pays to play the game (except where he has an opportunity to play without payment as a result of having previously played successfully) either by inserting a coin or token into the machine or in some other way;
(d)the machine automatically—
(i)applies some or all of the rules of the game or displays or records scores in the game; and
(ii)determines when a player who has paid to play a game by means of the machine can no longer play without paying again;
and
(e)the machine is a gaming machine, a video machine or a pinball machine.
(1A)A machine constructed or adapted for the playing of a game is a gaming machine for the purposes of this Act if—
(a)it is a prize machine;
(b)the game which is played by means of the machine is a game of chance, a game of chance and skill combined or a pretended game of chance or of chance and skill combined; and
(c)the outcome of the game is determined by the chances inherent in the action of the machine, whether or not provision is made for manipulation of the machine by a player;
and for the purposes of this subsection a game in which the elements of chance can be overcome by skill shall be treated as a game of chance and skill combined if there is an element of chance in the game that cannot be overcome except by superlative skill.
(1B)A machine constructed or adapted for the playing of a game is a video machine for the purposes of this Act if—
(a)a micro-processor is used to control some or all of the machine’s functions; and
(b)the playing of the game involves information or images being communicated or displayed to the player or players by means of any description of screen, other than one consisting only in a blank surface onto which light is projected.
(1C)For the purposes of this Act an amusement machine is a prize machine unless it is constructed or adapted so that a person playing it once and successfully either receives nothing or receives only—
(a)an opportunity, afforded by the automatic action of the machine, to play again (once or more often) without paying, or
(b)a prize, determined by the automatic action of the machine and consisting in either—
(i)money of an amount not exceeding the sum payable to play the machine once, or
(ii)a token which is, or two or more tokens which in the aggregate are, exchangeable for money of an amount not exceeding that sum.”
(2)In subsection (4) of that section (machines playable by more than one person), for “a gaming machine” there shall be substituted “ a machine of any description ”.
(3)For subsections (5) to (9) of that section there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(5)For the purposes of sections 21 to 24 above a machine (the actual machine) in relation to which the number determined in accordance with subsection (5A) below is more than one shall be treated (instead of as one machine) as if it were a number of machines (accountable machines) equal to the number so determined.
(5A)That number is—
(a)except where paragraph (b) below applies, the number of individual playing positions provided on the machine for persons to play simultaneously (whether or not while participating in the same game); and
(b)where—
(i)that machine is a video machine but not a gaming machine, and
(ii)the number of such playing positions is more than the number of different screens used for the communication or display of information or images to any person or persons playing a game by means of the machine,
the number of such screens.
(6)Subsection (5) above does not apply in the case of any machine which is an excepted machine for the purposes of section 21 above or in the case of a pinball machine.
(7)Any question whether the accountable machines are, or are not, machines falling within any of the following descriptions, that is to say—
(a)gaming machines,
(b)prize machines,
(c)small-prize machines, or
(d)five-penny machines,
shall be determined according to whether or not the actual machine is a machine of that description, with the accountable machines being taken to be machines of the same description as the actual machine.”
7U.K.After section 25 there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)The Treasury may by order modify the provisions of section 25 above—
(a)by adding to the machines for the time being specified in subsection (1)(e) of that section any description of machines which it appears to them, having regard to the use to which the machines are put, to be appropriate for the protection of the revenue so to add to those machines; or
(b)by deleting any description of machines for the time being so specified.
(2)An order under this section may make such incidental, consequential or transitional provision as the Treasury think fit, including provision modifying section 21 or section 25(5A) above for the purpose of—
(a)specifying the circumstances (if any) in which a machine added to section 25(1)(e) above is to be an excepted machine for the purposes of section 21 above; or
(b)determining the number which, in the case of a machine so added, is to be taken into account for the purposes of section 25(5) above.”
8(1)In section 26 (supplementary provisions)—U.K.
(a)for the words “gaming machine licence duty” in subsection (1) there shall be substituted “ amusement machine licence duty ”;
(b)for the words “a gaming machine” and “gaming machines”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ an amusement machine ” and “ amusement machines ”; and
(c)for the words “for gaming”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted “ for play ”.
(2)In subsection (2) of that section—
(a)after the definition of “United Kingdom” there shall be inserted the following definitions—
““video machine” has the meaning given by section 25(1B) above;
“prize machine” has the meaning given by section 25(1C) above;” and
(b)F89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)After subsection (2) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(2A)References in sections 21 to 25 above and in this section and Schedule 4 to this Act to a game, in relation to any machine, include references to a game in the nature of a quiz or puzzle and to a game which is played solely by way of a pastime or against the machine, as well as one played wholly or partly against one or more contemporaneous or previous players.”
Textual Amendments
F89Sch. 3 para. 8(2)(b) repealed (24.7.2002 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 1(3) Note of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 141, Sch. 40 Pt. 1(3) Note
9(1)In sections 31 and 33(2) (protection of officers and savings for prohibitions of gaming etc.), for the words “gaming machine licences”, in each case, there shall be substituted “ amusement machine licences ”.U.K.
(2)In section 32(3) (orders subject to affirmative procedure), for “or 14(3)” there shall be substituted “ , 14(3) or 25A ”.
(3)In section 33(1) (interpretation), in the definition of “gaming”, the words “(except where it refers to a machine provided for gaming)” shall be omitted.
10U.K.In Schedule 3 (bingo duty)—
(a)in paragraph 5(1)(b), for “a gaming machine licence” there shall be substituted “ an amusement machine licence ”; and
(b)in paragraph 6, for “a gaming machine” there shall be substituted “ an amusement machine ”.
11(1)In Schedule 4 (supplementary provisions in relation to gaming machine licence duty)—U.K.
(a)for the words “gaming machine” and “gaming machines”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted, respectively, “ amusement machine ” and “ amusement machines ”; and
(b)for the indefinite article, wherever it occurs before an expression amended by paragraph (a) above, there shall be substituted “ An ” or “ an ”, as the case may require.
(2)In paragraph 1(2) of that Schedule (conditions of exemption for charitable entertainments etc.)—
(a)in paragraph (a), for “of gaming by means of any machine” there shall be substituted “ from any amusement machines ”; and
(b)in paragraph (b), for “and any other provided for gaming” there shall be substituted “ and any other amusement machines provided ”.
(3)In paragraph 2(2)(c) of that Schedule (conditions of exemption for pleasure fairs), for “and any other provided for gaming” there shall be substituted “ and any other amusement machines provided ”.
(4)In paragraph 4 of that Schedule—
(a)for the words “small-prize machines”, wherever they occur, there shall be substituted “ relevant machines ”; and
(b)after sub-paragraph (7) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(7A)An amusement machine is a relevant machine for the purposes of this paragraph unless it is a gaming machine which is not a small-prize machine.”;
and in relation to the winter period beginning with November 1995, sub-paragraph(4) of that paragraph shall have effect as if the references by virtue of this paragraph to an amusement machine licence included references to a gaming machine licence.
(5)After paragraph 7 of that Schedule there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
7A(1)The Commissioners may make and publish arrangements setting out the circumstances in which, and the conditions subject to which, a person to whom an amusement machine licence is granted for a period of twelve months may, at his request and if the Commissioners think fit, be permitted to pay the duty on that licence by regular instalments during the period of the licence, instead of at the time when it is granted.
(2)Arrangements under this paragraph shall provide for the amount of each instalment to be such that the aggregate amount of all the instalments to be paid in respect of any licence is an amount equal to 105 per cent. of what would have been the duty on that licence apart from this paragraph.
(3)Sub-paragraph (4) below applies if a person who has been permitted, in accordance with arrangements under this paragraph, to pay the duty on any amusement machine licence by instalments—
(a)fails to pay any instalment at the time when it becomes due in accordance with the arrangements; and
(b)does not make good that failure within seven days of being required to do so by notice given by the Commissioners.
(4)Where this sub-paragraph applies—
(a)the licence shall be treated as having ceased to be in force as from the time when the instalment became due;
(b)the person to whom the licence was granted shall become liable to any unpaid duty to which he would have been liable under paragraph 11(1C) below if he had surrendered the licence at that time; and
(c)any amusement machines found on the premises to which the licence related shall be liable to forfeiture.
(5)Sections 14 to 16 of the M166Finance Act 1994 (review and appeals) shall have effect in relation to any decision of the Commissioners refusing an application for permission to pay duty by instalments in accordance with arrangements under this paragraph as if that decision were a decision of a description specified in Schedule 5 to that Act.”
(6)In paragraph 11 of that Schedule (surrender), after sub-paragraph (1B) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(1C)Where, in a case where duty is being paid in accordance with arrangements made under paragraph 7A above, the amount of duty actually paid on a licence that is surrendered is less than the amount which would have been paid on that licence if the period for which it was granted had been reduced by the number of complete months in that period which have not expired when the licence is surrendered, the difference between those amounts shall be treated as unpaid duty.”
(7)Paragraph 13 of that Schedule (labelling and marking of machines) shall cease to have effect.
(8)In paragraph 14 of that Schedule (power to enter premises), for the words “for gaming” there shall be substituted “ for play ”.
(9)In paragraph 16 of that Schedule (enforcement), after sub-paragraph (1) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(1A)This paragraph does not apply to any contravention or failure to comply with arrangements under paragraph 7A above or to any failure or refusal to comply with a requirement made under or for the purposes of any such arrangements.”
(10)In paragraph 17 of that Schedule (warrants etc.)—
(a)in sub-paragraph (1), for the words “for gaming” there shall be substituted “ for play ”; and
(b)in sub-paragraph (2)(a), for the words from “(including” to “by means of it)” there shall be substituted “ (including any machine appearing to the officer to be an amusement machine or to be capable of being used as such) ”.
12U.K.In section 102(3)(a) of the M167Customs and Excise Management Act 1979 (penalty for failure to deliver up a licence), for “a gaming machine licence” there shall be substituted “ an amusement machine licence ”.
Section 19.
1U.K.In this Schedule “the 1994 Act” means the M168Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994.
Marginal Citations
2U.K.The following paragraphs of Schedule 2 to the 1994 Act (exempt vehicles) shall be omitted—
(a)paragraph 1 (electrically propelled vehicles);
(b)paragraph 12 (road construction vehicles);
(c)paragraph 13 (road rollers);
(d)paragraph 14 (snow clearing vehicles);
(e)paragraph 15 (gritting vehicles);
(f)paragraph 16 (street cleansing vehicles);
(g)paragraph 17 (tower wagons used solely in connection with street lighting);
(h)paragraph 21 (vehicles used for short journeys between different parts of person’s land).
3U.K.In Schedule 2 to the 1994 Act the following shall be inserted after paragraph 3—
3AA vehicle is an exempt vehicle when it is being used for police purposes.”
4U.K.In Schedule 2 to the 1994 Act the following shall be inserted after paragraph 20—
20AA vehicle is an exempt vehicle if—
(a)it is used only for purposes relating to agriculture, horticulture or forestry,
(b)it is used on public roads only in passing between different areas of land occupied by the same person, and
(c)the distance it travels on public roads in passing between any two such areas does not exceed 1.5 kilometres.”
5U.K.This Part of this Schedule shall come into force on 1st July 1995.
6(1)In Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act (annual rates of duty) the following paragraph shall be substituted for paragraph 1 (annual rate of duty where no other rate specified)—U.K.
“1(1)The annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable to a vehicle in respect of which no other annual rate is specified by this Schedule is—
(a)if it was constructed after 1946, the general rate;
(b)if it was constructed before 1947, the reduced rate.
(2)The general rate is £135.
(3)The reduced rate is 50 per cent. of the general rate.
(4)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (3) is an amount—
(a)which is not a multiple of £5, and
(b)which on division by five does not produce a remainder of £2.50,
the rate is the amount arrived at rounded (either up or down) to the nearest amount which is a multiple of £5.
(5)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (3) is an amount which on division by five produces a remainder of £2.50, the rate is the amount arrived at increased by £2.50.”
F90(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F90Sch. 4 para. 6(2) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in s. 18(5) of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. II(3)
7U.K.F91. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F91Sch. 4 para. 7 repealed (with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 1(5) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 141, Sch. 40 Pt 1(5) Note 2
8U.K.In Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act the following shall be substituted for Part III (hackney carriages)—
3(1)The annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable to a bus is—
(a)if its seating capacity is nine to sixteen, the same as the basic goods vehicle rate;
(b)if its seating capacity is seventeen to thirty-five, 133 per cent. of the basic goods vehicle rate;
(c)if its seating capacity is thirty-six to sixty, 200 per cent. of the basic goods vehicle rate;
(d)if its seating capacity is over sixty, 300 per cent. of the basic goods vehicle rate.
(2)In this paragraph “bus” means a vehicle which—
(a)is a public service vehicle (within the meaning given by section 1 of the M169Public Passenger Vehicles Act 1981), and
(b)is not an excepted vehicle.
(3)For the purposes of this paragraph an excepted vehicle is—
(a)a vehicle which has a seating capacity under nine,
(b)a vehicle which is a community bus,
(c)a vehicle used under a permit granted under section 19 of the M170Transport Act 1985 (educational and other bodies) and used in circumstances where the requirements mentioned in subsection (2) of that section are met, or
(d)a vehicle used under a permit granted under section 10B of the M171Transport Act (Northern Ireland) 1967 (educational and other bodies) and used in circumstances where the requirements mentioned in subsection (2) of that section are met.
(4)In sub-paragraph (3)(b) “community bus” means a vehicle—
(a)used on public roads solely in accordance with a community bus permit (within the meaning given by section 22 of the M172Transport Act 1985), and
(b)not used for providing a service under an agreement providing for service subsidies (within the meaning given by section 63(10)(b) of that Act).
(5)For the purposes of this paragraph the seating capacity of a vehicle shall be determined in accordance with regulations made by the Secretary of State.
(6)In sub-paragraph (1) references to the basic goods vehicle rate are to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 9, to a rigid goods vehicle which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 7,500 kilograms.
(7)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (1)(b), (c) or (d) is an amount—
(a)which is not a multiple of £10, and
(b)which on division by ten does not produce a remainder of £5,
the rate is the amount arrived at rounded (either up or down) to the nearest amount which is a multiple of £10.
(8)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (1)(b), (c) or (d) is an amount which on division by ten produces a remainder of £5, the rate is the amount arrived at increased by £5.”
9(1)Part IV of Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act (special machines) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)For the heading “SPECIAL MACHINES” there shall be substituted “ SPECIAL VEHICLES ”.
(3)In paragraph 4(1) (annual rate of £35) for the words “special machine is £35” there shall be substituted “ special vehicle is the same as the basic goods vehicle rate ”.
(4)In paragraph 4(2) (definition of “special machine”)—
(a)for the words “ “special machine” means” there shall be substituted “ “special vehicle” means a vehicle which has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and is ”;
(b)paragraphs (a), (b) and (f) (tractors, agricultural engines and mowing machines) shall be omitted;
(c)after paragraph (e) there shall be inserted—
“(ee)a road roller.”
(5)Paragraph 4(3) (definition of “tractor”) shall be omitted.
(6)The following sub-paragraph shall be inserted after sub-paragraph (6) of paragraph 4—
“(7)In sub-paragraph (1) the reference to the basic goods vehicle rate is to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 9, to a rigid goods vehicle which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 7,500 kilograms.”
F9210U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F92Sch. 4 para. 10 repealed (1.4.2001 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 33 Pt. I(3) Note 2 of the amending Act) by 2001 c. 9, s. 110, Sch. 33 Pt. 1(3) Note 2
11(1)Paragraph 5 of Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act (recovery vehicles) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) (annual rate of duty of £85) for the words “is £85” there shall be substituted “is—
(a)if it has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 12,000 kilograms, the same as the basic goods vehicle rate;
(b)if it has a revenue weight exceeding 12,000 kilograms and not exceeding 25,000 kilograms, 300 per cent. of the basic goods vehicle rate;
(c)if it has a revenue weight exceeding 25,000 kilograms, 500 per cent. of the basic goods vehicle rate.”
(3)The following sub-paragraphs shall be inserted after sub-paragraph (5)—
“(6)In sub-paragraph (1) references to the basic goods vehicle rate are to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 9, to a rigid goods vehicle which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 7,500 kilograms.
(7)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (1)(b) or (c) is an amount—
(a)which is not a multiple of £10, and
(b)which on division by ten does not produce a remainder of £5,
the rate is the amount arrived at rounded (either up or down) to the nearest amount which is a multiple of £10.
(8)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (1)(b) or (c) is an amount which on division by ten produces a remainder of £5, the rate is the amount arrived at increased by £5.”
F9312U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F93Sch. 4 para. 12 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 1 para. 17(1) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. I(3), Note; S.I. 1998/3092, art. 2
13(1)Paragraph 7 of Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act (haulage vehicles) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) for paragraphs (a) and (b) (rate of £100 for showmen’s vehicles and of £330 for other haulage vehicles) there shall be substituted—
“(a)if it is a showman’s vehicle, the same as the basic goods vehicle rate;
(b)in any other case, the general haulage vehicle rate.”
(3)The following sub-paragraphs shall be inserted after sub-paragraph (2)—
“(3)In sub-paragraph (1) the reference to the basic goods vehicle rate is to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 9, to a rigid goods vehicle which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 7,500 kilograms.
(4)In sub-paragraph (1) the reference to the general haulage vehicle rate is to 75 per cent. of the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 11, to a tractive unit which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 12,000 kilograms and not exceeding 16,000 kilograms.
(5)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (4) is an amount—
(a)which is not a multiple of £10, and
(b)which on division by ten does not produce a remainder of £5,
the rate is the amount arrived at rounded (either up or down) to the nearest amount which is a multiple of £10.
(6)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (4) is an amount which on division by ten produces a remainder of £5, the rate is the amount arrived at increased by £5.”
14(1)Part VIII of Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act (goods vehicles) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)Paragraph 8 (basic rate) shall be omitted.
(3)In paragraph 9(1) (rates of duty for rigid goods vehicles)—
(a)at the beginning there shall be inserted “ Subject to sub-paragraphs (2) and (3), ”;
(b)for the words “a plated gross weight (or, in Northern Ireland, a relevant maximum weight) exceeding 7,500 kilograms” there shall be substituted “ a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms ”;
(c)in paragraph (a) for the words “plated gross weight (or relevant maximum weight)” there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”.
(4)The following table shall be substituted for the table in paragraph 9(1)—
“Revenue weight of vehicle | Rate | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
(1) | (2) | (3) | (4) | (5) |
Exceeding | Not Exceeding | Two axle vehicle | Three axle vehicle | Four or more axle vehicle |
kgs 3,500 7,500 12,000 13,000 14,000 15,000 17,000 19,000 21,000 23,000 25,000 27,000 29,000 31,000 | kgs 7,500 12,000 13,000 14,000 15,000 17,000 19,000 21,000 23,000 25,000 27,000 29,000 31,000 44,000 | £ 150 290 450 630 810 1,280 1,280 1,280 1,280 1,280 1,280 1,280 1,280 1,280 | £ 150 290 470 470 470 470 820 990 1,420 2,160 2,260 2,260 2,260 2,260 | £ 150 290 340 340 340 340 340 340 490 800 1,420 2,240 3,250 4,250” |
(5)For sub-paragraph (2) of paragraph 9 there shall be substituted the following sub-paragraphs—
“(2)The annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable—
(a)to any rigid goods vehicle which is a showman’s goods vehicle with a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms but not exceeding 44,000 kilograms, and
(b)to any rigid goods vehicle which is an island goods vehicle with a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms,
shall be the basic goods vehicle rate.
(3)The annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable to a rigid goods vehicle which has a revenue weight exceeding 44,000 kilograms and is not an island goods vehicle shall be the heavy tractive unit rate.
(4)In sub-paragraph (2) the reference to the basic goods vehicle rate is to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1), to a rigid goods vehicle which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 7,500 kilograms.
(5)In sub-paragraph (3) the reference to the heavy tractive unit rate is to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 11, to a tractive unit which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 38,000 kilograms and not exceeding 44,000 kilograms.”
(6)In paragraph 10(1) (trailer supplement) for the words “plated gross weight (or relevant maximum weight)”—
(a)in the first place where they occur, there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”; and
(b)in the second and third places where they occur, there shall be substituted “ plated gross weight ”.
(7)In paragraph 10(2) (lower rate of trailer supplement)—
(a)the words “(or relevant maximum weight)” shall be omitted; and
(b)for “£135” there shall be substituted “ an amount equal to the amount of the general rate specified in paragraph 1(2) ”.
(8)In paragraph 10(3) (higher rate of trailer supplement)—
(a)the words “(or relevant maximum weight)” shall be omitted; and
(b)for “£370” there shall be substituted “ an amount equal to 275 per cent. of the amount of the general rate specified in paragraph 1(2) ”.
(9)In paragraph 10 the following sub-paragraphs shall be inserted after sub-paragraph (3)—
“(3A)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (3) is an amount—
(a)which is not a multiple of £10, and
(b)which on division by ten does not produce a remainder of £5,
the amount of the trailer supplement is the amount arrived at rounded (either up or down) to the nearest amount which is a multiple of £10.
(3B)Where an amount arrived at in accordance with sub-paragraph (3) is an amount which on division by ten produces a remainder of £5, the amount of the trailer supplement is the amount arrived at increased by £5.”
(10)Paragraph 10(4) (reference to paragraph 12) shall be omitted.
(11)In paragraph 11(1) (rates of duty for tractive units)—
(a)at the beginning there shall be inserted “ Subject to sub-paragraphs (2) and (3), ”;
(b)for the words “a plated train weight (or, in Northern Ireland, a relevant maximum train weight) exceeding 7,500 kilograms” there shall be substituted “ a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms ”;
(c)in paragraph (a) for the words “plated train weight (or relevant maximum train weight)” there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”.
(12)The following table shall be substituted for the table in paragraph 11(1)—
“Revenue weight of tractive unit | Rate for tractive unit with two axles | Rate for tractive unit with three or more axles | |||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
(1) | (2) | (3) | (4) | (5) | (6) | (7) | (8) |
Exceeding | Not exceeding | Any no. of semi-trailer axles | 2 or more semi-trailer axles | 3 or more semi-trailer axles | Any no. of semi-trailer axles | 2 or more semi-trailer axles | 3 or more semi-trailer axles |
kgs 3,500 7,500 12,000 16,000 20,000 23,000 26,000 28,000 31,000 33,000 34,000 36,000 38,000 | kgs 7,500 12,000 16,000 20,000 23,000 26,000 28,000 31,000 33,000 34,000 36,000 38,000 44,000 | £ 150 290 440 500 780 1,150 1,150 1,680 2,450 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 | £ 150 290 440 440 440 570 1,090 1,680 2,450 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 | £ 150 290 440 440 440 440 440 1,050 1,680 1,680 2,750 3,100 3,100 | £ 150 290 440 440 440 570 1,090 1,680 2,450 2,450 2,450 2,730 2,730 | £ 150 290 440 440 440 440 440 640 970 1,420 2,030 2,730 2,730 | £ 150 290 440 440 440 440 440 440 440 550 830 1,240 1,240” |
(13)For sub-paragraph (2) of paragraph 11 there shall be substituted the following sub-paragraphs—
“(2)The annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable—
(a)to any tractive unit which is a showman’s goods vehicle with a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms but not exceeding 44,000 kilograms, and
(b)to any tractive unit which is an island goods vehicle with a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms,
shall be the basic goods vehicle rate.
(3)The annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable to a tractive unit which has a revenue weight exceeding 44,000 kilograms and is not an island goods vehicle shall be the heavy tractive unit rate.
(4)In sub-paragraph (2) the reference to the basic goods vehicle rate is to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 9, to a rigid goods vehicle which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 3,500 kilograms and not exceeding 7,500 kilograms.
(5)In sub-paragraph (3) the reference to the heavy tractive unit rate is to the rate applicable, by virtue of sub-paragraph (1), to a tractive unit which falls within column (3) of the table in that sub-paragraph and has a revenue weight exceeding 38,000 kilograms and not exceeding 44,000 kilograms.”
(14)Paragraph 12 (farmers’ goods vehicles and showmen’s goods vehicles) shall be omitted.
(15)In paragraph 13(1) (regulations for reducing plated weights) for the words from “its plated gross weight” to “weight specified” there shall be substituted “ its revenue weight were such lower weight as may be specified ”.
(16)In paragraph 14 (vehicles for conveying machines) sub-paragraphs (b) and (c) shall be omitted.
(17)In paragraph 17(1) (meaning of “trailer”)—
(a)at the end of paragraph (a) there shall be inserted “ or ”;
(b)paragraphs (c) to (e) (road construction vehicles, certain farming implements drawn by farmer’s goods vehicle, and certain trailers used to carry gas for propulsion, excluded from meaning of “trailer”) shall be omitted.
(18)Paragraph 17(2) (interpretation of paragraph 17(1)(e)) shall be omitted.
(19)The following shall be inserted after paragraph 17—
18(1)In this Part “island goods vehicle” means any goods vehicle which—
(a)is kept for use wholly or partly on the roads of one or more small islands; and
(b)is not kept or used on any mainland road, except in a manner authorised by sub-paragraph (2) or (3).
(2)The keeping or use of a goods vehicle on a mainland road is authorised by this sub-paragraph if—
(a)the road is one used for travel between a landing place and premises where vehicles disembarked at that place are loaded or unloaded, or both;
(b)the length of the journey, using that road, from that landing place to those premises is not more than five kilometres;
(c)the vehicle in question is one which was disembarked at that landing place after a journey by sea which began on a small island; and
(d)the loading or unloading of that vehicle is to take place, or has taken place, at those premises.
(3)The keeping or use of a goods vehicle on a mainland road is authorised by this sub-paragraph if—
(a)that vehicle has a revenue weight not exceeding 17,000 kilograms;
(b)that vehicle is normally kept at a base or centre on a small island; and
(c)the only journeys for which that vehicle is used are ones that begin or end at that base or centre.
(4)References in this paragraph to a small island are references to any such island falling within sub-paragraph (5) as may be designated as a small island by an order made by the Secretary of State.
(5)An island falls within this sub-paragraph if—
(a)it has an area of 230,000 hectares or less; and
(b)the absence of a bridge, causeway, tunnel, ford or other way makes it at all times impracticable for road vehicles to be driven under their own power from that island as far as the mainland.
(6)The reference in sub-paragraph (5) to driving a road vehicle as far as the mainland is a reference to driving it as far as any public road in the United Kingdom which is not on an island with an area of 230,000 hectares or less and is not a road connecting two such islands.
(7)In this paragraph—
“island” includes anything that is an island only when the tide reaches a certain height;
“landing place” means any place at which vehicles are disembarked after sea journeys;
“mainland road” means any public road in the United Kingdom, other than one which is on a small island or which connects two such islands; and
“road vehicles” means vehicles which are designed or adapted primarily for being driven on roads and which do not have any special features for facilitating their being driven elsewhere;
and references in this paragraph to the loading or unloading of a vehicle include references to the loading or unloading of its trailer or semi-trailer.”
15U.K.In section 17 of the 1994 Act (exceptions from charge at higher rate) the following provisions shall be omitted—
(a)subsections (3) to (5) (provisions about farmers’ goods vehicles);
(b)subsections (6) and (7) (agricultural tractors and farmers’ goods vehicles in Northern Ireland).
16(1)This Part of this Schedule shall apply in relation to licences taken out on or after 1st July 1995.U.K.
(2)This Part of this Schedule shall also apply in relation to any use after 30th June 1995 of a vehicle which—
(a)had a plated gross weight or plated train weight (or, in Northern Ireland, a relevant maximum weight or relevant maximum train weight) on that date, and
(b)at the time when it is used has a confirmed maximum weight which, if that had been its plated gross weight or plated train weight (or relevant maximum weight or relevant maximum train weight) on that date, would have brought it within a description of vehicle to which a higher rate of duty was applicable on that date.
17U.K.This Part of this Schedule (which supplements provisions of Part III of this Schedule) makes—
(a)provision for determining the revenue weight of a vehicle, and
(b)consequential amendments.
18U.K.In section 7(3) of the 1994 Act (matters that may be contained in declarations and particulars to be made or furnished by applicants for licences) for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted—
“(b)the vehicle’s revenue weight,
(ba)the place where the vehicle has been or is normally kept, and”.
19U.K.In section 15(4) of the 1994 Act (exchange of licences where higher rate becomes chargeable) at the beginning there shall be inserted “ Subject to section 7(5), ”.
20U.K.In section 16 of the 1994 Act (exceptions from charge at higher rate) in each of subsections (2)(b)(i), (4)(b)(i) and (6)(b)(i) for the words “a plated train weight (or, in Northern Ireland, a relevant maximum train weight)” there shall be substituted “ a revenue weight ”.
21U.K.In section 20 of the 1994 Act (combined road and rail transport) for subsection (3) there shall be substituted the following subsection—
“(3)In this section “relevant goods vehicle” means any vehicle the rate of duty applicable to which is provided for in Part VIII of Schedule 1 or which would be such a vehicle if Part VI of that Schedule did not apply to the vehicle.”
22U.K.In section 39 of the 1994 Act (relevant higher rate used in calculating penalty)—
(a)in subsection (2)(a) for the words “plated gross weight or plated train weight (or, in Northern Ireland, a relevant maximum weight or relevant maximum train weight)” there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”;
(b)in each of subsections (4)(a) and (5)(a) for the words “plated gross weight or plated train weight (or, in Northern Ireland, relevant maximum weight or relevant maximum train weight)” there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”;
(c)in the words after paragraph (b) of each of subsections (4) and (5) for the words “plated gross weight or plated train weight (or relevant maximum weight or relevant maximum train weight)” there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”.
23U.K.In section 40(2) of the 1994 Act (relevant period used in calculating penalty)—
(a)for the words “plated gross weight or a plated train weight (or, in Northern Ireland, a relevant maximum weight or relevant maximum train weight)” there shall be substituted “ revenue weight ”;
(b)for the words “was plated with (or rated at) the higher weight” there shall be substituted “ became a vehicle with a higher revenue weight ”.
24U.K.In section 45 of the 1994 Act (false or misleading information) after subsection (3) there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(3A)A person who, in supplying information or producing documents for the purposes of any regulations made under section 61A—
(a)makes a statement which to his knowledge is false or in any material respect misleading or recklessly makes a statement which is false or in any material respect misleading, or
(b)produces or otherwise makes use of a document which to his knowledge is false or in any material respect misleading,
is guilty of an offence.
(3B)A person who—
(a)with intent to deceive, forges, alters or uses a certificate issued by virtue of section 61A;
(b)knowing or believing that it will be used for deception lends such a certificate to another or allows another to alter or use it; or
(c)without reasonable excuse makes or has in his possession any document so closely resembling such a certificate as to be calculated to deceive,
is guilty of an offence.”
25U.K.In section 60(2) of the 1994 Act (orders subject to annulment), after “section 3(3)” there shall be inserted “ , paragraph 18(4) of Schedule 1 ”.
26U.K.Immediately before section 61 of the 1994 Act there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)Any reference in this Act to the revenue weight of a vehicle is a reference—
(a)where it has a confirmed maximum weight, to that weight; and
(b)in any other case, to the weight determined in accordance with the following provisions of this section.
(2)For the purposes of this Act a vehicle which does not have a confirmed maximum weight shall have a revenue weight which, subject to the following provisions of this section, is equal to its design weight.
(3)Subject to subsection (4), the design weight of a vehicle is, for the purposes of this section—
(a)in the case of a tractive unit, the weight which is required, by the design and any subsequent adaptations of that vehicle, not to be exceeded by an articulated vehicle which—
(i)consists of the vehicle and any semi-trailer capable of being drawn by it, and
(ii)is in normal use and travelling on a road laden;
and
(b)in the case of any other vehicle, the weight which the vehicle itself is designed or adapted not to exceed when in normal use and travelling on a road laden.
(4)Where, at any time, a vehicle—
(a)does not have a confirmed maximum weight,
(b)has previously had such a weight, and
(c)has not acquired a different design weight by reason of any adaptation made since the most recent occasion on which it had a confirmed maximum weight,
the vehicle’s design weight at that time shall be equal to its confirmed maximum weight on that occasion.
(5)An adaptation reducing the design weight of a vehicle shall be disregarded for the purposes of this section unless it is a permanent adaptation.
(6)For the purposes of this Act where—
(a)a vehicle which does not have a confirmed maximum weight is used on a public road in the United Kingdom, and
(b)at the time when it is so used—
(i)the weight of the vehicle, or
(ii)in the case of a tractive unit used as part of an articulated vehicle consisting of the vehicle and a semi-trailer, the weight of the articulated vehicle,
exceeds what, apart from this subsection, would be the vehicle’s design weight,
it shall be conclusively presumed, as against the person using the vehicle, that the vehicle has been temporarily adapted so as to have a design weight while being so used equal to the actual weight of the vehicle or articulated vehicle at that time.
(7)For the purposes of this Act limitations on the space available on a vehicle for carrying a load shall be disregarded in determining the weight which the vehicle is designed or adapted not to exceed when in normal use and travelling on a road laden.
(8)A vehicle which does not have a confirmed maximum weight shall not at any time be taken to have a revenue weight which is greater than the maximum laden weight at which that vehicle or, as the case may be, an articulated vehicle consisting of that vehicle and a semi-trailer may lawfully be used in Great Britain.
(9)A vehicle has a confirmed maximum weight at any time if at that time—
(a)it has a plated gross weight or a plated train weight; and
(b)that weight is the maximum laden weight at which that vehicle or, as the case may be, an articulated vehicle consisting of that vehicle and a semi-trailer may lawfully be used in Great Britain;
and the confirmed maximum weight of a vehicle with such a weight shall be taken to be the weight referred to in paragraph (a).
(10)Where any vehicle has a special maximum weight in Northern Ireland which is greater than the maximum laden weight at which that vehicle or, as the case may be, an articulated vehicle consisting of that vehicle and a semi-trailer may lawfully be used in Great Britain, this section shall have effect, in relation to that vehicle, as if the references to Great Britain in subsections (8) and (9) were references to Northern Ireland.
(11)For the purposes of this section a vehicle has a special maximum weight in Northern Ireland if an order under Article 29(3) of the M173Road Traffic (Northern Ireland) Order 1981 (authorisation of use on roads of vehicles and trailers not complying with regulations) has effect in relation to that vehicle for determining the maximum laden weight at which it may lawfully be used in Northern Ireland or, as the case may be, for determining the maximum laden weight at which an articulated vehicle consisting of that vehicle and a semi-trailer may lawfully be used there.”
Marginal Citations
27(1)In subsection (3) of section 61 of the 1994 Act (meaning of “appropriate plate”)—U.K.
(a)the word “ and ” shall be inserted at the end of paragraph (a); and
(b)paragraph (c) (plated weight determined by reference to section 41 of the M174Road Traffic Act 1988) and the word “and” immediately preceding it shall be omitted.
(2)After subsection (3) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(3A)Where it appears to the Secretary of State that there is a description of document which—
(a)falls to be treated for some or all of the purposes of the M175Road Traffic Act 1988 as if it were a plating certificate, or
(b)is issued under the law of any state in the European Economic Area for purposes which are or include purposes corresponding to those for which such a certificate is issued,
he may by regulations provide for references in this section to a plating certificate to have effect as if they included references to a document of that description.”
(3)Subsections (4), (5) and (7) of that section (relevant weights in Northern Ireland and definition of “design weight”) shall be omitted.
28U.K.After section 61 of the 1994 Act there shall be inserted the following section—
(1)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision—
(a)for the making of an application to the Secretary of State for the issue of a certificate stating the design weight of a vehicle;
(b)for the manner in which any determination of the design weight of any vehicle is to be made on such an application and for the issue of a certificate on the making of such a determination;
(c)for the examination, for the purposes of the determination of the design weight of a vehicle, of that vehicle by such persons, and in such manner, as may be prescribed by the regulations;
(d)for a certificate issued on the making of such a determination to be treated as having conclusive effect for the purposes of this Act as to such matters as may be prescribed by the regulations;
(e)for the Secretary of State to be entitled, in cases prescribed by the regulations, to require the production of such a certificate before making a determination for the purposes of section 7(5); and
(f)for appeals against determinations made in accordance with the regulations.
(2)Regulations under this section may provide for an adaptation of a vehicle—
(a)to be taken into account in determining the design weight of a vehicle in a case to which section 60A(6) does not apply, or
(b)to be treated as permanent for the purposes of section 60A(5),
if, and only if, it is an adaptation with respect to which a certificate has been issued under the regulations.
(3)Regulations under this section may provide that such documents purporting to be plating certificates (within the meaning of Part II of the M176Road Traffic Act 1988) as satisfy requirements prescribed by the regulations are to have effect, for some or all of the purposes of this Act, as if they were certificates issued under such regulations.
(4)Without prejudice to the generality of the preceding provisions of this section, regulations under this section may, in relation to—
(a)the examination of a vehicle on an application under the regulations, or
(b)any appeals against determinations made for the purposes of the issue of a certificate in accordance with the regulations,
make provision corresponding to, or applying (with or without modifications), any of the provisions having effect by virtue of so much of sections 49 to 51 of the M177Road Traffic Act 1988 as relates to examinations authorised by virtue of, or appeals under, any of those sections.
(5)In this section “design weight” has the same meaning as in section 60A.”
29U.K.Paragraph 16 above shall apply for the purposes of this Part of this Schedule as it applies for the purposes of Part III of this Schedule.
30(1)In section 7 of the 1994 Act (issue of vehicle licences)—U.K.
(a)in subsection (1) (regulations about applications) for “prescribed by regulations made” there shall be substituted “ specified ”;
(b)in subsection (2) for “prescribed” there shall be substituted “ specified ”.
(2)In section 11 of the 1994 Act (issue of trade licences) in subsection (1) (regulations about applications)—
(a)for “prescribed by regulations made” there shall be substituted “ specified ”;
(b)for “so prescribed” there shall be substituted “ prescribed by regulations made by the Secretary of State ”.
(3)This paragraph shall apply in relation to applications made after the day on which this Act is passed.
31(1)In section 13 of the 1994 Act (duration of trade licences) in subsection (1) at the end of paragraph (c) there shall be inserted “ and ending no later than the relevant date. ”U.K.
(2)After subsection (1) of that section there shall be inserted—
“(1A)In subsection (1)(c) “the relevant date” means—
(a)in relation to a licence taken out for a period beginning with the first day of any of the months February to June in any year, 31st December of that year;
(b)in relation to a licence taken out for a period beginning with the first day of any of the months August to December in any year, 30th June of the following year.”
(3)This paragraph shall apply in relation to licences taken out after the day on which this Act is passed.
32(1)The following section shall be inserted after section 19 of the 1994 Act—U.K.
(1)The Secretary of State may, if he thinks fit, issue a vehicle licence or a trade licence on receipt of a cheque for the amount of the duty payable on it.
(2)In a case where—
(a)a vehicle licence or a trade licence is issued to a person on receipt of a cheque which is subsequently dishonoured, and
(b)the Secretary of State sends a notice by post to the person informing him that the licence is void as from the time when it was granted,
the licence shall be void as from the time when it was granted.
(3)In a case where—
(a)a vehicle licence or a trade licence is issued to a person on receipt of a cheque which is subsequently dishonoured,
(b)the Secretary of State sends a notice by post to the person requiring him to secure that the duty payable on the licence is paid within such reasonable period as is specified in the notice,
(c)the requirement in the notice is not complied with, and
(d)the Secretary of State sends a further notice by post to the person informing him that the licence is void as from the time when it was granted,
the licence shall be void as from the time when it was granted.
(4)Section 102 of the M178Customs and Excise Management Act 1979 (payment for excise licences by cheque) shall not apply in relation to a vehicle licence or a trade licence.”
(2)The following section shall be inserted after section 35 of the 1994 Act—
(1)In a case where—
(a)a notice sent as mentioned in section 19A(2)(b) or a further notice sent as mentioned in section 19A(3)(d) requires the person to deliver up the licence within such reasonable period as is specified in the notice, and
(b)the person fails to comply with the requirement within that period,
he shall be liable on summary conviction to a penalty of an amount found under subsection (2).
(2)The amount is whichever is the greater of—
(a)level 3 on the standard scale;
(b)an amount equal to five times the annual rate of duty that was payable on the grant of the licence or would have been so payable if it had been taken out for a period of twelve months.”
(3)In section 36 of the 1994 Act (dishonoured cheques: additional liability) in subsection (1) for the words from “102” to “cheque)” there shall be substituted “ 35A ”.
(4)This paragraph shall apply in relation to licences taken out after the day on which this Act is passed.
33U.K.In section 21 of the 1994 Act (registration of vehicles) at the beginning of subsections (1) and (2) there shall be inserted “ Subject to subsection (3) ” and after subsection (2) there shall be inserted—
“(3)The Secretary of State may by regulations provide that in such circumstances as may be prescribed by the regulations a vehicle shall not be registered under this section until a fee of such amount as may be so prescribed is paid.
(4)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision about repayment of any sum paid by way of a fee mentioned in subsection (3), and the regulations may in particular include provision—
(a)that repayment shall be made only if a specified person is satisfied that specified conditions are met or in other specified circumstances;
(b)that repayment shall be made in part only;
(c)that, in the case of partial repayment, the amount repaid shall be a specified sum or determined in a specified manner;
(d)for repayment of different amounts in different circumstances;
and “specified” here means specified in the regulations.”
34(1)Section 22 of the 1994 Act (registration regulations) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) the following paragraph shall be inserted after paragraph (d)—
“(dd)require a person by whom any vehicle is sold or disposed of to furnish the person to whom it is sold or disposed of with such document relating to the vehicle’s registration as may be prescribed by the regulations, and to do so at such time as may be so prescribed.”
(3)The following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (1)—
“(1A)The Secretary of State may make regulations providing for the sale of information derived from particulars contained in the register—
(a)to such persons as the Secretary of State thinks fit, and
(b)for such price and on such other terms, and subject to such restrictions, as he thinks fit,
if the information does not identify any person or contain anything enabling any person to be identified.
(1B)Without prejudice to the generality of paragraph (d) of subsection (1) above, regulations under that paragraph may require—
(a)any person there mentioned to furnish particulars to the other person there mentioned or to the Secretary of State or to both;
(b)any person there mentioned who is furnished with particulars in pursuance of the regulations to furnish them to the Secretary of State.”
35(1)In section 31 of the 1994 Act (relevant period for purposes of additional liability) in subsection (5)(b) (case where duty or amount equal to duty has been paid) the words “(or an amount equal to the duty due)” shall be omitted.U.K.
(2)This paragraph shall apply in relation to offences committed after the day on which this Act is passed.
36(1)The following section shall be inserted after section 32 of the 1994 Act—U.K.
Schedule 2A (which relates to the immobilisation of vehicles as regards which it appears that an offence under section 29(1) is being committed and to their removal and disposal) shall have effect.”
(2)The following Schedule shall be inserted after Schedule 2 to the 1994 Act—
1(1)The Secretary of State may make regulations under this Schedule with respect to any case where an authorised person has reason to believe that, on or after such date as may be prescribed, an offence under section 29(1) is being committed as regards a vehicle which is stationary on a public road.
(2)The regulations may provide that the authorised person or a person acting under his direction may—
(a)fix an immobilisation device to the vehicle while it remains in the place where it is stationary, or
(b)move it from that place to another place on the same or another public road and fix an immobilisation device to it in that other place.
(3)The regulations may provide that on any occasion when an immobilisation device is fixed to a vehicle in accordance with the regulations the person fixing the device shall also fix to the vehicle a notice—
(a)indicating that the device has been fixed to the vehicle and warning that no attempt should be made to drive it or otherwise put it in motion until it has been released from the device;
(b)specifying the steps to be taken to secure its release;
(c)giving such other information as may be prescribed.
(4)The regulations may provide that—
(a)a vehicle to which an immobilisation device has been fixed in accordance with the regulations may only be released from the device by or under the direction of an authorised person;
(b)subject to that, such a vehicle shall be released from the device if the first and second requirements specified below are met.
(5)The first requirement is that such charge in respect of the release as may be prescribed is paid in any manner specified in the immobilisation notice.
(6)The second requirement is that—
(a)a vehicle licence is produced in accordance with instructions specified in the immobilisation notice, and the licence is one which is in force for the vehicle concerned at the time the licence is produced, or
(b)where such a licence is not produced, such sum as may be prescribed is paid in any manner specified in the immobilisation notice.
(7)The regulations may provide that they shall not apply in relation to a vehicle if—
(a)a current disabled person’s badge is displayed on the vehicle, or
(b)such other conditions as may be prescribed are fulfilled;
and “disabled person’s badge” here means a badge issued, or having effect as if issued, under any regulations for the time being in force under section 21 of the Chronically Sick and Disabled Persons Act 1970 or any regulations for the M179time being in force under section 14 of the M180Chronically Sick and Disabled Persons (Northern Ireland) Act 1978.
(8)The regulations may provide that an immobilisation notice shall not be removed or interfered with except by or on the authority of a person falling within a prescribed description.
2(1)The regulations may provide that a person contravening provision made under paragraph 1(8) is guilty of an offence and liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 2 on the standard scale.
(2)The regulations may provide that a person who, without being authorised to do so in accordance with provision made under paragraph 1, removes or attempts to remove an immobilisation device fixed to a vehicle in accordance with the regulations is guilty of an offence and liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 3 on the standard scale.
(3)The regulations may provide that where they would apply in relation to a vehicle but for provision made under paragraph 1(7)(a) and the vehicle was not, at the time it was stationary, being used—
(a)in accordance with regulations under section 21 of the M181Chronically Sick and Disabled Persons Act 1970 or regulations under section 14 of the M182Chronically Sick and Disabled Persons (Northern Ireland) Act 1978, and
(b)in circumstances falling within section 117(1)(b) of the M183Road Traffic Regulation Act 1984 or Article 174A(2)(b) of the M184Road Traffic (Northern Ireland) Order 1981 (use where a disabled person’s concession would be available),
the person in charge of the vehicle at that time is guilty of an offence and liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 3 on the standard scale.
(4)The regulations may provide that where—
(a)a person makes a declaration with a view to securing the release of a vehicle from an immobilisation device purported to have been fixed in accordance with the regulations,
(b)the declaration is that the vehicle is or was an exempt vehicle, and
(c)the declaration is to the person’s knowledge either false or in any material respect misleading,
he is guilty of an offence.
(5)The regulations may provide that a person guilty of an offence by virtue of provision made under sub-paragraph (4) is liable—
(a)on summary conviction, to a fine not exceeding the statutory maximum, and
(b)on conviction on indictment, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years or to a fine or (except in Scotland) to both.
3(1)The regulations may make provision as regards a case where—
(a)an immobilisation device is fixed to a vehicle in accordance with the regulations, and
(b)such conditions as may be prescribed are fulfilled.
(2)The regulations may provide that an authorised person, or a person acting under the direction of an authorised person, may remove the vehicle and deliver it into the custody of a person—
(a)who is identified in accordance with prescribed rules, and
(b)who agrees to accept delivery in accordance with arrangements agreed between that person and the Secretary of State;
and the arrangements may include provision as to the payment of a sum to the person into whose custody the vehicle is delivered.
(3)The regulations may provide that the person into whose custody the vehicle is delivered may dispose of it, and in particular provision may be made as to—
(a)the time at which the vehicle may be disposed of;
(b)the manner in which it may be disposed of.
(4)The regulations may make provision allowing a person to take possession of the vehicle if—
(a)he claims it before it is disposed of, and
(b)any prescribed conditions are fulfilled.
(5)The regulations may provide for a sum of an amount arrived at under prescribed rules to be paid to a person if—
(a)he claims after the vehicle’s disposal to be or to have been its owner,
(b)the claim is made within a prescribed time of the disposal, and
(c)any other prescribed conditions are fulfilled.
(6)The regulations may provide that—
(a)the Secretary of State, or
(b)a person into whose custody the vehicle is delivered under the regulations,
may recover from the vehicle’s owner (whether or not a claim is made under provision made under sub-paragraph (4) or (5)) such charges as may be prescribed in respect of all or any of the following, namely, its release, removal, custody and disposal; and “owner” here means the person who was the owner when the immobilisation device was fixed.
(7)The conditions prescribed under sub-paragraph (4) may include conditions as to—
(a)satisfying the person with custody that the claimant is the vehicle’s owner;
(b)the payment of prescribed charges in respect of the vehicle’s release, removal and custody;
(c)the production of a vehicle licence;
(d)payment of a prescribed sum where a vehicle licence is not produced.
(8)Without prejudice to anything in the preceding provisions of this paragraph, the regulations may include provision for purposes corresponding to those of sections 101 and 102 of the M185Road Traffic Regulation Act 1984 (disposal and charges) subject to such additions, omissions or other modifications as the Secretary of State thinks fit.
4(1)The regulations may provide that where—
(a)a person makes a declaration with a view to securing possession of a vehicle purported to have been delivered into the custody of a person in accordance with provision made under paragraph 3,
(b)the declaration is that the vehicle is or was an exempt vehicle, and
(c)the declaration is to the person’s knowledge either false or in any material respect misleading,
he is guilty of an offence.
(2)The regulations may provide that a person guilty of such an offence is liable—
(a)on summary conviction, to a fine not exceeding the statutory maximum, and
(b)on conviction on indictment, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years or to a fine or (except in Scotland) to both.
5(1)The regulations may make provision as regards a case where a person pays a prescribed sum in pursuance of provision made under—
(a)paragraph 1(6)(b), or
(b)paragraph 3(7)(d).
(2)The regulations may—
(a)provide for a voucher to be issued in respect of the sum;
(b)provide for setting the sum against the amount of any vehicle excise duty payable in respect of the vehicle concerned;
(c)provide for the refund of any sum;
(d)provide that where a voucher has been issued section 29(1) and any other prescribed provision of this Act shall not apply, as regards the vehicle concerned, in relation to events occurring in a prescribed period.
(3)The regulations may make provision—
(a)as to the information to be provided before a voucher is issued;
(b)as to the contents of vouchers;
(c)specifying conditions subject to which any provision under sub-paragraph (2)(b) to (d) is to have effect.
(4)The regulations may make provision as to any case where a voucher is issued on receipt of a cheque which is subsequently dishonoured, and in particular the regulations may—
(a)provide for a voucher to be void;
(b)provide that, where the sum concerned is set against the amount of any vehicle excise duty, the licence concerned shall be void;
(c)make provision under which a person is required to deliver up a void voucher or void licence.
6(1)The regulations may provide that—
(a)a person is guilty of an offence if within such reasonable period as is found in accordance with prescribed rules he fails to deliver up a voucher that is void by virtue of provision made under paragraph 5(4);
(b)a person guilty of such an offence shall be liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 3 on the standard scale.
(2)The regulations may provide that a person is guilty of an offence if within such reasonable period as is found in accordance with prescribed rules he fails to deliver up a licence that is void by virtue of provision made under paragraph 5(4), and that a person guilty of such an offence shall be liable on summary conviction to a penalty of whichever is the greater of—
(a)level 3 on the standard scale;
(b)an amount equal to five times the annual rate of duty that was payable on the grant of the licence or would have been so payable if it had been taken out for a period of twelve months.
(3)The regulations may provide that where a person is convicted of an offence under provision made by virtue of sub-paragraph (2) he must pay, in addition to any penalty, an amount found in accordance with prescribed rules.
(4)The regulations may provide that if—
(a)a voucher is void by virtue of provision made under paragraph 5(4),
(b)a person seeks to set the sum concerned against the amount of any vehicle excise duty, and
(c)he knows the voucher is void,
he is guilty of an offence and liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding level 5 on the standard scale.
(5)The regulations may provide that a person who in connection with—
(a)obtaining a voucher for which provision is made under paragraph 5, or
(b)obtaining a refund of any sum in respect of which such a voucher is issued,
makes a declaration which to his knowledge is either false or in any material respect misleading is guilty of an offence.
(6)The regulations may provide that a person is guilty of an offence if he forges, fraudulently alters, fraudulently uses, fraudulently lends or fraudulently allows to be used by another person a voucher for which provision is made under paragraph 5.
(7)The regulations may provide that a person guilty of an offence under provision made under sub-paragraph (5) or (6) is liable—
(a)on summary conviction, to a fine not exceeding the statutory maximum, and
(b)on conviction on indictment, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years or to a fine or (except in Scotland) to both.
7Without prejudice to anything in paragraphs 5(4) and 6 the regulations may include provision for purposes corresponding to those of sections 19A and 36 subject to such additions, omissions or other modifications as the Secretary of State thinks fit.
8The regulations may make provision about the proceedings to be followed where a dispute occurs as a result of the regulations, and in particular provision may be made—
(a)for an application to be made to a magistrates’ court or (in Northern Ireland) a court of summary jurisdiction;
(b)for a court to order a sum to be paid by the Secretary of State.
9As regards anything falling to be done under the regulations (such as receiving payment of a charge or other sum or issuing a voucher) the regulations may provide that it may be done—
(a)by an authorised person, or
(b)by an authorised person or a person acting under his direction.
10(1)The regulations may provide that they shall only apply where the authorised person has reason to believe that the offence mentioned in paragraph 1(1) is being committed before such date as may be prescribed.
(2)The regulations may provide that they shall only apply where the vehicle mentioned in paragraph 1(1) is in a prescribed area.
(3)Different dates may be prescribed under paragraph 1(1) or sub-paragraph (1) above in relation to different areas prescribed under sub-paragraph (2) above.
11(1)The regulations may make provision as to the meaning for the purposes of the regulations of “owner” as regards a vehicle.
(2)In particular, the regulations may provide that for the purposes of the regulations—
(a)the owner of a vehicle at a particular time shall be taken to be the person by whom it is then kept;
(b)the person by whom a vehicle is kept at a particular time shall be taken to be the person in whose name it is then registered by virtue of this Act.
12(1)The regulations may make provision as to the meaning in the regulations of “authorised person”.
(2)In particular, the regulations may provide that—
(a)references to an authorised person are to a person authorised by the Secretary of State for the purposes of the regulations;
(b)an authorised person may be a local authority or an employee of a local authority or a member of a police force or some other person;
(c)different persons may be authorised for the purposes of different provisions of the regulations.
13In this Schedule—
(a)references to an immobilisation device are to a device or appliance which is an immobilisation device for the purposes of section 104 of the M186Road Traffic Regulation Act 1984 (immobilisation of vehicles illegally parked);
(b)references to an immobilisation notice are to a notice fixed to a vehicle in accordance with the regulations;
(c)“prescribed” means prescribed by regulations made under this Schedule.”
Marginal Citations
37(1)In section 37(2) of the 1994 Act (penalty where duty at higher rate is not paid) the following shall be omitted—U.K.
(a)the words “(or, in Scotland, on indictment or on summary conviction)”, and
(b)the words “(or, in Scotland, the statutory maximum)”.
(2)In section 41(1)(b) of the 1994 Act (order in Scotland in case of offence under section 37) the words “182 or” and “183 or” shall be omitted.
(3)This paragraph shall apply in relation to proceedings begun after the day on which this Act is passed.
F9438U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F94Sch. 4 para. 38 repealed (31.1.1997) by 1995 c. 38, s. 15(2), Sch. 2 (with ss. 1(3), 6(4)(5), 14); S.I. 1996/3217, art. 2
39(1)This paragraph applies where a vehicle licence is taken out—U.K.
(a)before 1st July 1995, and
(b)at the rate applicable (at the time it is taken out) under Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act or any provision re-enacted in that Schedule.
(2)While the licence is in force duty shall not, by virtue of any provision contained in Part III or IV of this Schedule other than paragraph 16(2) above, become chargeable under section 15 of the 1994 Act (vehicle used in manner attracting higher rate).
40(1)This paragraph applies where regulations to determine the seating capacity of a hackney carriage are made, or have effect as if made, under sub-paragraph (2) of paragraph 3 of Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act (as that paragraph has effect apart from the substitution made by paragraph 8 above).U.K.
(2)The regulations shall have effect as if made under sub-paragraph (5) of paragraph 3 of that Schedule (as substituted by paragraph 8 above) to determine the seating capacity of a vehicle.
(3)This paragraph shall apply in relation to licences taken out on or after 1st July 1995.
41(1)This paragraph applies where—U.K.
(a)a vehicle licence is taken out for a vehicle on or after 1st July 1995 and before 1st July 1996,
(b)the licence is the first vehicle licence to be taken out for the vehicle on or after 1st July 1995,
(c)the vehicle would be an exempt vehicle apart from paragraph 2 above, and
(d)the amount of vehicle excise duty to be paid on the licence would (apart from this paragraph) exceed £1,000.
(2)In such a case the amount of vehicle excise duty to be paid on the licence shall be £1,000.
(3)This paragraph shall be construed in accordance with the 1994 Act.
42(1)This paragraph applies where paragraph 41 above does not apply and—U.K.
(a)a vehicle licence is taken out for a vehicle on or after 1st July 1995 and before 1st July 1996,
(b)the licence is the first vehicle licence to be taken out for the vehicle on or after 1st July 1995,
(c)apart from Part III of this Schedule, the annual rate of vehicle excise duty applicable to the vehicle would be found under any of the provisions falling within sub-paragraph (3) below, and
(d)the new amount of duty exceeds the old amount of duty by more than £1,000.
(2)In such a case the amount of vehicle excise duty to be paid on the licence shall be an amount equal to £1,000 plus the old amount of duty.
(3)The provisions falling within this sub-paragraph are—
(a)paragraph 8(1) and (2)(b) of Schedule 1 to the 1994 Act;
(b)paragraph 8(1) and (2)(c) of that Schedule;
(c)paragraph 8(1) and (2)(d) of that Schedule;
(d)paragraph 12(2) of that Schedule;
(e)paragraph 12(3) to (5) of that Schedule.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph—
(a)the new amount of duty is the amount of vehicle excise duty payable on the licence apart from this paragraph;
(b)the old amount of duty is the amount of vehicle excise duty that would be payable on the licence if Part III of this Schedule had not been enacted.
(5)This paragraph shall be construed in accordance with the 1994 Act.
Section 34.
1U.K.Part III of the M187Finance Act 1994 (insurance premium tax) shall be amended as provided by this Schedule.
2(1)Section 53 (registration of insurers) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (5) (Commissioners to cancel registration of person who ceases to receive premiums)—
(a)the word “ and ” shall be inserted after paragraph (a);
(b)paragraph (c) (person to satisfy Commissioners that no tax is unpaid) and the word “and” immediately preceding it shall be omitted.
(3)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (5)—
“(5A)In a case where—
(a)the Commissioners are satisfied that a person has ceased to receive, as insurer, premiums in the course of any taxable business, but
(b)he has not notified them under subsection (3) above,
they may cancel his registration with effect from the earliest practicable time after he so ceased.”
(4)Sub-paragraph (2) above shall apply in relation to notifications made under section 53(3) on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
3U.K.Section 53 shall be further amended by inserting the following subsection after subsection (1)—
“(1A)The register kept under this section may contain such information as the Commissioners think is required for the purposes of the care and management of the tax.”
4U.K.The following section shall be inserted after section 53—
(1)Regulations may make provision requiring a registrable person to notify the Commissioners of particulars which—
(a)are of changes in circumstances relating to the registrable person or any business carried on by him,
(b)appear to the Commissioners to be required for the purpose of keeping the register kept under section 53 above up to date, and
(c)are of a prescribed description.
(2)Regulations may make provision—
(a)as to the time within which a notification is to be made;
(b)as to the form and manner in which a notification is to be made;
(c)requiring a person who has made a notification to notify the Commissioners if any information contained in it is inaccurate.”
5(1)Section 59 (review of Commissioners’ decisions) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1)(d) (review of decision with respect to assessment) for the words “under section 56 above” there shall be substituted “ falling within subsection (1A) below ”.
(3)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (1)—
“(1A)An assessment falls within this subsection if it is an assessment under section 56 above in respect of an accounting period in relation to which a return required to be made by virtue of regulations under section 54 above has been made.”
(4)This paragraph shall apply in relation to assessments made on or after the day on which this Act is passed.
6U.K.In section 73(1) (interpretation) after the entry relating to “conduct” there shall be inserted—
““insurance business” means a business which consists of or includes the provision of insurance;”.
7(1)In Schedule 7 (information, powers, etc.) paragraphs 2(1) to (3) and 3(1) to (3) (duty to furnish information and produce documents) shall be amended as follows—U.K.
(a)for the words “a taxable business” (in each place where they occur) there shall be substituted “ an insurance business ”;
(b)for the words “taxable insurance contracts” (in each place where they occur) there shall be substituted “ contracts of insurance ”;
(c)for the words “taxable insurance contract” (in each place where they occur) there shall be substituted “ contract of insurance. ”.
(2)This paragraph shall apply in relation to contracts whether entered into before or after the passing of this Act.
8(1)In Schedule 7 the following shall be inserted after paragraph 4—U.K.
4A(1)Where, on an application by an authorised person, a justice of the peace or, in Scotland, a justice (within the meaning of section 462 of the M188Criminal Procedure (Scotland) Act 1975) is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for believing—
(a)that an offence in connection with tax is being, has been or is about to be committed, and
(b)that any recorded information (including any document of any nature whatsoever) which may be required as evidence for the purpose of any proceedings in respect of such an offence is in the possession of any person,
he may make an order under this paragraph.
(2)An order under this paragraph is an order that the person who appears to the justice to be in possession of the recorded information to which the application relates shall—
(a)give an authorised person access to it, and
(b)permit an authorised person to remove and take away any of it which he reasonably considers necessary,
not later than the end of the period of 7 days beginning on the date of the order or the end of such longer period as the order may specify.
(3)The reference in sub-paragraph (2)(a) above to giving an authorised person access to the recorded information to which the application relates includes a reference to permitting the authorised person to take copies of it or to make extracts from it.
(4)Where the recorded information consists of information contained in a computer, an order under this paragraph shall have effect as an order to produce the information in a form in which it is visible and legible and, if the authorised person wishes to remove it, in a form in which it can be removed.
(5)This paragraph is without prejudice to paragraphs 3 and 4 above.”
(2)In paragraph 5(1) of Schedule 7 (duty to provide record of anything removed in exercise of power) after the words “paragraph 4” there shall be inserted “ or 4A ”.
Marginal Citations
F959U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F95Sch. 5 para. 9 repealed (1.7.1997) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. V(2) Note; S.I. 1997/1433, art. 2
Section 39.
F961U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F96Sch. 6 para. 1 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
2U.K.In section 18(3) of that Act (Cases under Schedule D), in Case I, at the end there shall be inserted “ but not contained in Schedule A ”.
3U.K.Sections 22 and 23 of that Act (assessments to income tax under Schedule A and collection from lessees and agents) shall cease to have effect.
F974U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F97Sch. 6 para. 4 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F985U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F98Sch. 6 para. 5 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F996U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F99Sch. 6 para. 6 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F1007U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F100Sch. 6 para. 7 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F1018U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F101Sch. 6 para. 8 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in s. 85, Sch. 15 para. 9(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(11) Note
F1029U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F102Sch. 6 para. 9 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10310U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F103Sch. 6 para. 10 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10411U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F104Sch. 6 para. 11 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10512U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F105Sch. 6 para. 12 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10613U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F106Sch. 6 para. 13 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10714U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F107Sch. 6 para. 14 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10815U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F108Sch. 6 para. 15 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F10916U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F109Sch. 6 para. 16 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
17U.K.In section 368(3) and (4) of that Act (exclusion of double relief for interest), after “for the purposes of”, in each case, there shall be inserted “ Schedule A or ”.
F11018U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F110Sch. 6 para. 18 repealed (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 20 Pt. III(7) Note 4 of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 139, Sch. 20 Pt. III(7) Note 4
19(1)In Chapter I of Part X of that Act (loss relief for the purposes of income tax), before section 380, there shall be inserted the following section—U.K.
(1)Subject to the following provisions of this section, where for any year of assessment any person sustains any loss in a Schedule A business carried on by him either solely or in partnership—
(a)the loss shall be carried forward to the following year of assessment and, to the extent that it does not exceed them, set against any profits or gains of that business for the year to which it is carried forward; and
(b)where there are no profits or gains for the following year or the profits or gains for that year are exceeded by the amount of the loss, the loss or, as the case may be, the remainder of it shall be so carried forward to the next following year, and so on.
(2)Subsection (3) below shall apply where a loss is sustained in a Schedule A business for any year of assessment (“the year of the loss”) and one or both of the following conditions is satisfied, that is to say—
(a)the amount of the relevant capital allowances treated as expenses of that business in computing that loss exceeds, by any amount (“the net capital allowances”), the amount of any charges under the 1990 Act which are treated as receipts of that business in computing that loss;
(b)the Schedule A business has been carried on in relation to land that consists of or includes an agricultural estate to which allowable agricultural expenses deducted in computing that loss are attributable;
and the relevant capital allowances for the purposes of this subsection are allowances under the 1990 Act other than the whole or, as the case may be, a proportionate part of any allowances made in accordance with section 32(1B) of this Act in respect of expenditure on the provision of machinery or plant which is let, for the whole or a part of the year in question, to a person who does not use it or uses it for purposes other than those of a trade.
(3)Where the person carrying on the Schedule A business in a case to which this subsection applies makes a claim, in relation to the year of the loss or the year following that year, for relief under this subsection in respect of the loss—
(a)relief from income tax may be given, for the year to which the claim relates, on an amount of that person’s income for that year which is equal to the amount of relief available for that year in respect of the loss; and
(b)the loss which is to be or has been carried forward under subsection (1) above shall be treated as reduced (if necessary to nil) by an amount equal to the amount on which relief is given;
but a claim for relief under this subsection shall not be made after the end of twelve months from the 31st January next following the end of the year to which it relates and shall be accompanied by all such amendments as may be required by virtue of paragraph (b) above of any self-assessment previously made by the claimant under section 9 of the Management Act.
(4)Subject to subsection (5) below, the reference in subsection (3) above to the amount of the relief available for any year in respect of a loss is a reference to whichever is the smallest of the following amounts, that is to say—
(a)the amount of the relievable income for the year to which the claim relates;
(b)the loss sustained in the Schedule A business in the year of the loss; and
(c)the amount which, according to whether one or both of the conditions mentioned in subsection (2) above is satisfied in relation to the year of the loss, is equal—
(i)to the net capital allowances,
(ii)to the amount of the allowable agricultural expenses for the year of the loss, or
(iii)to the sum of the net capital allowances and the amount of those expenses.
(5)Where relief under subsection (3) above is given in respect of a loss in relation to either of the years in relation to which relief may be claimed in respect of that loss, relief shall not be available in respect of the same loss for the other year except, in a case where the relief already given is of an amount determined in accordance with subsection (4)(a) above, to the extent that the smaller of the amounts applicable by virtue of subsection (4)(b) and (c) above exceeds the amount of relief already given.
(6)For the purposes of subsection (4)(a) above the amount of relievable income for any year, in relation to any person, shall be equal to the amount of his income for that year—
(a)after effect has been given to subsection (1) above in relation to any amount carried forward to that year in respect of a loss sustained in any year before the year of the loss, and
(b)in the case of a claim under subsection (3) above in relation to the year of the loss, after effect has been given to any claim under that subsection in respect of a loss sustained in the preceding year.
(7)For the purposes of this section the loss sustained in any Schedule A business shall be computed in like manner as the profits or gains arising or accruing from such a business are computed under the provisions of the Income Tax Acts applicable to Schedule A.
(8)In this section “allowable agricultural expenses”, in relation to an agricultural estate, means any disbursements or expenses attributable to the estate which are deductible in respect of maintenance, repairs, insurance or management of the estate and otherwise than in respect of the interest payable on any loan.
(9)For the purposes of this section the amount of any disbursements or expenses attributable to an agricultural estate shall be determined as if—
(a)disbursements and expenses were to be disregarded to the extent that they would not have been attributable to the estate if it did not include the parts of it used wholly for purposes other than purposes of husbandry, and
(b)disbursements and expenses in respect of parts of the estate used partly for purposes of husbandry and partly for other purposes were to be reduced to an extent corresponding to the extent to which those parts were used for other purposes.
(10)In this section—
“agricultural estate” means any land (including any houses or other buildings) which is managed as one estate and which consists of or includes any agricultural land; and
“agricultural land” means land, houses or other buildings in the United Kingdom occupied wholly or mainly for the purposes of husbandry.”
(2)Where apart from this Act any person who carries on a Schedule A business in the year 1995-96 would have been entitled—
(a)by virtue of Part II of the Taxes Act 1988, to deduct any amount that became due before the beginning of that year from rent received in that year, being rent which is in fact brought into account in computing the profits or gains of that business, or
(b)by virtue of section 392 of that Act, to carry forward to that year the amount of any portion of a loss sustained in any transaction, being a transaction of such a nature that if it occurred in that year it would be treated as a transaction in the course of that Schedule A business,
that amount shall be treated for the purposes of income tax as if it were a loss falling, in accordance with section 379A(1) of that Act, to be carried forward from the previous year to the year 1995-96 and (in so far as not used in giving relief for that year) to subsequent years.
(3)Where—
(a)any person carrying on a Schedule A business in the year 1995-96 would, by virtue of section 355(4) of the Taxes Act 1988 (power to carry forward excess interest), have been entitled, in respect of an amount of interest representing an excess of interest over the income against which relief was available for any previous year, to be given relief against an equivalent amount of income for the year 1995-96 from the letting of any land, caravan or house-boat, and
(b)that business relates to any land, caravan or house-boat in relation to which the condition specified in section 355(1)(b) of that Act would have been fulfilled for the year 1995-96,
that amount shall be treated for the purposes of income tax as if it were a loss falling, in accordance with section 379A(1) of that Act, to be carried forward from the previous year to the year 1995-96 and (in so far as not used in giving relief for that year) to subsequent years.
(4)Section 379A(3) of that Act shall have effect for the purposes of the making of a claim in a case where the year to which the claim relates is the year 1995-96 as if the period for making such a claim ended two years after the end of that year.
F11120U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F111Sch. 6 para. 20 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11221U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F112Sch. 6 para. 21 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11322U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F113Sch. 6 para. 22 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11423U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F114Sch. 6 para. 23 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11524U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F115Sch. 6 para. 24 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11625U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F116Sch. 6 para. 25 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
26U.K.In section 692(1) of that Act (reimbursement of settlor), for the words from “the profits” onwards there shall be substituted “ either the profits of a trade carried on by the settlor or the profits of a Schedule A business so carried on ”.
27U.K.In section 779(13)(a) of that Act (definition of relevant tax relief for the purposes of anti-avoidance provisions), the words “allowable by virtue of sections 25, 26 and 28 to 31 and Schedule 1” shall be omitted.
28U.K.In section 832(1) of that Act (interpretation of the Tax Acts), after the definition of “recognised clearing system” there shall be inserted the following definition—
““Schedule A business” means any business the profits or gains of which are chargeable to income tax under Schedule A, including the business in the course of which any transaction is by virtue of paragraph 1(2) of that Schedule to be treated as entered into;”.
F11729U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F117Sch. 6 para. 29 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11830U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F118Sch. 6 para. 30 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F11931U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F119Sch. 6 para. 31 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in s. 85, Sch. 15 para. 9(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(11) Note
F12032U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F120Sch. 6 para. 32 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F12133U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F121Sch. 6 para. 33 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in s. 85, Sch. 15 para. 9(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(11) Note
F12234U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F122Sch. 6 para. 34 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F12335U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F123Sch. 6 para. 35 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F12436U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 6 para. 36 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
F12537U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F125Sch. 6 para. 37 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 38(2)(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(4) Note
38U.K.In paragraph 2(1) of Schedule 10 to the M189Finance (No. 2) Act 1992 (furnished accommodation), for “under Case I or Case VI of Schedule D (or both those Cases)” there shall be substituted “ under Schedule A or Case I of Schedule D (or under both together) ”.
Marginal Citations
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F126Sch. 7 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
Section 51.
1U.K.In section 431(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 (interpretative provisions relating to insurance companies), insert the following at the appropriate places in alphabetical order—
“pension business” has the meaning given by section 431B;
“life reinsurance business” has the meaning given by section 431C;
“overseas life assurance business” has the meaning given by section 431D;
“basic life assurance and general annuity business” has the meaning given by section 431F;
“reinsurance business” includes retrocession business.
2U.K.After section 431A of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
(1)In this Chapter “pension business” means so much of a company’s life assurance business as is referable to contracts of the following descriptions or to the reinsurance of liabilities under such contracts.
(2)The descriptions of contracts are—
(a)any contract with an individual who is, or would but for an insufficiency of profits or gains be, chargeable to income tax in respect of relevant earnings (as defined in section 623(1) and (2)) from a trade, profession, vocation, office or employment carried on or held by him, being a contract approved by the Board under section 620 or a substituted contract within the meaning of section 622(3);
(b)any contract (including a contract of insurance) entered into for the purposes of, and made with the persons having the management of, an exempt approved scheme as defined in Chapter I of Part XIV, being a contract so framed that the liabilities undertaken by the insurance company under the contract correspond with liabilities against which the contract is intended to secure the scheme;
(c)any contract made under approved personal pension arrangements within the meaning of Chapter IV of Part XIV;
(d)any annuity contract entered into for the purposes of—
(i)a scheme which is approved or is being considered for approval under Chapter I of Part XIV;
(ii)a scheme which is a relevant statutory scheme for the purposes of Chapter I of Part XIV; or
(iii)a fund to which section 608 applies,
being a contract which is made with the persons having the management of the scheme or fund, or those persons and a member of or contributor to the scheme or fund, and by means of which relevant benefits (see subsections (3) and (4) below), and no other benefits, are secured;
(e)any annuity contract which is entered into in substitution for a contract within paragraph (d) above and by means of which relevant benefits (see subsections (3) and (4) below), and no other benefits, are secured;
(f)any contract with the trustees or other persons having the management of a scheme approved under section 620 or, subject to subsection (5) below, of a superannuation fund which was approved under section 208 of the 1970 Act, being a contract which—
(i)was entered into for the purposes only of that scheme or fund or, in the case of a fund part only of which was approved under section 208, for the purposes only of that part of that fund, and
(ii)(in the case of a contract entered into or varied after 1st August 1956) is so framed that the liabilities undertaken by the insurance company under the contract correspond with liabilities against which the contract is intended to secure the scheme or fund (or the relevant part of the fund).
(3)For the purposes of subsection (2)(d) and (e) above “relevant benefits” means relevant benefits as defined by section 612(1) which correspond—
(a)where subsection (2)(d)(i) above applies, or subsection (2)(e) above applies and the contract within subsection (2)(d) was entered into for the purposes of a scheme falling within subsection (2)(d)(i), with benefits that could be provided by a scheme approved under Chapter I of Part XIV;
(b)where subsection (2)(d)(ii) above applies, or subsection (2)(e) above applies and the contract within subsection (2)(d) was entered into for the purposes of a scheme falling within subsection (2)(d)(ii), with benefits that could be provided by a scheme which is a relevant statutory scheme for the purposes of Chapter I of Part XIV;
(c)where subsection (2)(d)(iii) above applies, or subsection (2)(e) above applies and the contract within subsection (2)(d) was entered into for the purposes of a fund falling within subsection (2)(d)(iii), with benefits that could be provided by a fund to which section 608 applies.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3)(a), (b) or (c) above a hypothetical scheme or fund (rather than any particular scheme or fund), and benefits provided by a scheme or fund directly (rather than by means of an annuity contract), shall be taken.
(5)Subsection (2)(f) above shall not apply to a contract where the fund in question was approved under section 208 of the 1970 Act unless—
(a)immediately before 6th April 1980 premiums paid under the contract with the trustees or other persons having the management of the fund fell within section 323(4) of that Act (premiums referable to pension business); and
(b)the terms on which benefits are payable from the fund have not been altered since that time; and
(c)section 608 applies to the fund.
(6)In subsection (5) above “premium” includes any consideration for an annuity.
(1)In this Chapter “life reinsurance business” means reinsurance of life assurance business other than pension business or business of any description excluded from this section by regulations made by the Board.
(2)Regulations under subsection (1) above may describe the excluded business by reference to any circumstances appearing to the Board to be relevant.
(1)In this Chapter “overseas life assurance business” means life assurance business, other than pension business or life reinsurance business, which—
(a)in the case of life assurance business other than reinsurance business, is business with a policy holder or annuitant not residing in the United Kingdom, and
(b)in the case of reinsurance business, is—
(i)reinsurance of life assurance business with a policy holder or annuitant not residing in the United Kingdom, or
(ii)reinsurance of business within sub-paragraph (i) above or this sub-paragraph.
(2)Subject to subsections (5) and (7) below, in subsection (1) above the references to life assurance business with a policy holder or annuitant do not include life assurance business with a person who is an individual if—
(a)the policy holder or annuitant is not beneficially entitled to the rights conferred by the policy or contract for the business, or
(b)any benefits under the policy or contract for the business are or will be payable to a person other than the policy holder or annuitant (or his personal representatives) or to a number of persons not including him (or them).
(3)For the purposes of subsection (2) above any nomination by a policy holder or annuitant of an individual or individuals as the recipient or recipients of benefits payable on death shall be disregarded.
(4)Subject to subsections (5) and (7) below, in subsection (1) above the references to life assurance business with a policy holder or annuitant do not include life assurance business with a person who is not an individual.
(5)Subsections (2) and (4) above do not apply if—
(a)the rights conferred by the policy or contract for the business are held subject to a trust,
(b)the settlor does not reside in the United Kingdom, and
(c)each beneficiary is either an individual not residing in the United Kingdom or a charity.
(6)In subsection (5) above—
(a)“settlor” means the person, or (where more than one) each of the persons, by whom the trust was directly or indirectly created (and for this purpose a person shall, in particular, be regarded as having created the trust if he provided or undertook to provide funds directly or indirectly for the purposes of the trust or made with any other person a reciprocal arrangement for that other person to create the trust),
(b)“beneficiary” means any person who is, or will or may become, entitled to any benefit under the trust (including any person who may become so entitled on the exercise of a discretion by the trustees of the trust), and
(c)“charity” means a person or body of persons established for charitable purposes only;
and for the purpose of that subsection an individual who is a trustee (of any trust) shall not be regarded as an individual.
(7)Subsections (2) and (4) above do not apply if the policy or contract for the business was effected solely to provide benefits for or in respect of—
(a)persons all, or all but an insignificant number, of whom are relevant overseas employees, or
(b)spouses, widows, widowers, children or dependants of such persons.
(8)In subsection (7) above “relevant overseas employees” means persons who are not residing in the United Kingdom and are—
(a)employees of the policy holder or annuitant,
(b)employees of a person connected with the policy holder or annuitant, or
(c)employees in respect of whose employment there is established a superannuation fund to which section 615(3) applies;
and section 839 applies for the purposes of this subsection.
(1)The Board may by regulations make provision for giving effect to section 431D.
(2)Such regulations may, in particular—
(a)provide that, in such circumstances as may be prescribed, any prescribed issue as to whether business is or is not overseas life assurance business (or overseas life assurance business of a particular kind) shall be determined by reference to such matters (including the giving of certificates or undertakings, the giving or possession of information or the making of declarations) as may be prescribed,
(b)require companies to obtain certificates, undertakings, information or declarations from policy holders or annuitants, or from trustees or other companies, for the purposes of the regulations,
(c)make provision for dealing with cases where any issue such as is mentioned in paragraph (a) above is (for any reason) wrongly determined, including provision allowing for the imposition of charges to tax (with or without limits on time) on the insurance company concerned or on the policy holders or annuitants concerned,
(d)require companies to supply information and make available books, documents and other records for inspection on behalf of the Board, and
(e)make provision (including provision imposing penalties) for contravention of, or non-compliance with, the regulations.
(3)The regulations may—
(a)make different provision for different cases, and
(b)contain such supplementary, incidental, consequential or transitional provision as appears to the Board to be appropriate.
In this Chapter “basic life assurance and general annuity business” means life assurance business (including reinsurance business) other than pension business, life reinsurance business or overseas life assurance business.”.
3U.K.In section 432C(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 after “assets of the overseas life assurance fund” insert “ or land in the United Kingdom linked to overseas life assurance business ”.
4(1)Section 438 of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) for “life assurance fund and separate annuity fund, if any” substitute “ long term business fund ”.
(3)In subsection (8) for “431(4)(c)” substitute “ 431B(2)(c) ”.
5(1)Section 440 of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (3) for “paragraphs (a) to (d)” substitute “ paragraphs (a) to (e) ”.
(3)For subsection (4) substitute—
“(4)The categories referred to in subsections (1) to (3) above are—
(a)assets linked solely to pension business;
(b)assets linked solely to life reinsurance business;
(c)assets of the overseas life assurance fund;
(d)assets linked solely to basic life assurance and general annuity business;
(e)assets of the long term business fund not within any of the preceding paragraphs;
(f)other assets.”.
6U.K.In section 440A of the Taxes Act 1988, in subsection (2) for paragraphs (a) and (b) substitute—
“(a)so many of the securities as are identified in the company’s records as securities by reference to the value of which there are to be determined benefits provided for under policies or contracts the effecting of all (or all but an insignificant proportion) of which constitutes the carrying on of—
(i)pension business, or
(ii)life reinsurance business, or
(iii)basic life assurance and general annuity business,
shall be treated for the purposes of corporation tax as a separate holding linked solely to that business,”.
7U.K.In section 76(1)(d) of the Taxes Act 1988 after “pension business” insert “ , life reinsurance business ”.
8U.K.In Schedule 19AA to the Taxes Act 1988, in the closing words of paragraph 5(5) for “pension business or basic life assurance business” substitute “ pension business, life reinsurance business or basic life assurance and general annuity business ”.
9(1)The M190Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In section 212(2) after “pension business” insert “ or life reinsurance business ”.
(3)In section 214A(11)(a) for “any pension business or” substitute “ any pension business or life reinsurance business of that company or to ”.
Marginal Citations
F12710U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F127Sch. 8 para. 10 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
11(1)In section 431(2) of the Taxes Act 1988, for the definition of “linked assets” substitute—U.K.
““linked assets”, and related expressions, shall be construed in accordance with section 432ZA;”.
(2)After section 432 of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
(1)In this Chapter “linked assets” means assets of an insurance company which are identified in its records as assets by reference to the value of which benefits provided for under a policy or contract are to be determined.
(2)Linked assets shall be taken—
(a)to be linked to long term business of a particular category if the policies or contracts providing for the benefits concerned are policies or contracts the effecting of which constitutes the carrying on of business of that category; and
(b)to be linked solely to long term business of a particular category if all (or all but an insignificant proportion) of the policies or contracts providing for the benefits concerned are policies or contracts the effecting of which constitutes the carrying on of business of that category.
(3)Where an asset is linked to more than one category of long term business, a part of the asset shall be taken to be linked to each category; and references in this Chapter to assets linked (but not solely linked) to any category of business shall be construed accordingly.
(4)Where subsection (3) above applies, the part of the asset linked to any category of business shall be a proportion determined as follows—
(a)where in the records of the company values are shown for the asset in funds referable to particular categories of business, the proportion shall be determined by reference to those values;
(b)in any other case the proportion shall be equal to the proportion which the total of the linked liabilities of the company referable to that category of business bears to the total of the linked liabilities of the company referable to all the categories of business to which the asset is linked.
(5)For the purposes of sections 432A to 432F—
(a)income arising in any period from assets linked but not solely linked to a category of business,
(b)gains arising in any period from the disposal of such assets, and
(c)increases and decreases in the value of such assets,
shall be treated as arising to that category of business in the proportion which is the mean of the proportions determined under subsection (4) above at the beginning and end of the period.
(6)In this section “linked liabilities” means liabilities in respect of benefits to be determined by reference to the value of linked assets.
(7)In the case of a policy or contract the effecting of which constitutes a class of life assurance business the fact that it also constitutes long term business other than life assurance business shall be disregarded for the purposes of this section unless the benefits to be provided which constitute long term business other than life assurance business are to be determined by reference to the value of assets.”.
12(1)In the following provisions for “linked solely” substitute “ linked ”U.K.
(a)section 432C(1), section 432D(1) (twice) and section 432E(3)(a) and (b) and (6)(a) of the Taxes Act 1988;
F128(b). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F129(c). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2)The amendments made by paragraph 11 above do not affect the meaning of “linked assets”, and related expressions, in sections 214 and 214A of the M191Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (transitional provisions relating to changes made in 1990 and 1991).
(3)In section 432 of the Taxes Act 1988 for “class” in each place where it occurs substitute “ category ”.
Textual Amendments
F128Sch. 8 para. 12(1)(b) repealed (11.5.2001 with effect as mentioned in s. 87 of the amending Act) by 2001 c. 9, s. 110, Sch. 33 Pt. 2(12) Note
F129Sch. 8 para. 12(1)(c) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
Marginal Citations
13(1)Section 432A of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)For subsections (1) to (3) substitute—
“(1)This section has effect where in any period an insurance company carries on more than one category of business and it is necessary for the purposes of the Corporation Tax Acts to determine in relation to the period what parts of—
(a)income arising from the assets of the company’s long term business fund, or
(b)gains or losses accruing on the disposal of such assets,
are referable to any category of business.
(2)The categories of business referred to in subsection (1) above are—
(a)pension business;
(b)life reinsurance business;
(c)overseas life assurance business;
(d)basic life assurance and general annuity business which is ordinary life assurance business;
(e)basic life assurance and general annuity business which is industrial assurance business; and
(f)long term business other than life assurance business.
(3)Income arising from, and gains or losses accruing on the disposal of, assets linked to any category of business (apart from overseas life assurance business) shall be referable to that category of business.”.
(3)In subsections (5) and (6)(b)(i) for “any of the appropriate categories” substitute “ any category ”.
(4)For subsection (7) substitute—
“(7)For the purposes of subsections (5) and (6) above—
(a)income, gains or losses are directly referable to a category of business if referable to that category by virtue of subsection (3) or (4) above, and
(b)assets are directly referable to a category of business if income arising from the assets is, and gains or losses accruing on the disposal of the assets are, so referable by virtue of subsection (3) above.”.
(5)For subsection (9) substitute—
“(9)Where a company carries on overseas life assurance business—
(a)references in this section to liabilities do not include liabilities of that business, and
(b)the appropriate part of the investment reserve as defined by paragraph 4(2)(a) of Schedule 19AA shall be left out of account in determining that reserve for the purposes of this section.”.
14(1)Section 432C of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) for the words from “life assurance business” to “general annuity business” substitute “ pension business, life reinsurance business, basic life assurance and general annuity business or long term business other than life assurance business ”.
(3)In subsection (3) for “any of the appropriate categories of business” substitute “ any category of business ”.
(4)In subsection (4)(b) for “any of the appropriate categories of business” substitute “ any category of business ”.
(5)In subsection (5), omit paragraph (a).
(6)For subsection (6) substitute—
“(6)For the purposes of this section, where a company carries on overseas life assurance business “liabilities” does not include liabilities of that business.”.
15(1)Section 432D of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) for the words from “life assurance business” to “general annuity business” substitute “ pension business, life reinsurance business, basic life assurance and general annuity business or long term business other than life assurance business ”.
(3)In subsection (2) for “any of the appropriate categories of business” substitute “ any category of business ”.
(4)For subsection (3) substitute—
“(3)For the purposes of subsection (2) above “the relevant fraction”, in relation to a category of business, is the fraction of which—
(a)the numerator is the mean of the opening and closing liabilities of the relevant business so far as referable to the category, reduced by the mean of the opening and closing values of any assets of the relevant business directly referable to the category; and
(b)the denominator is the mean of the opening and closing liabilities of the relevant business, reduced by the mean of the opening and closing values of any assets of the relevant business directly referable to any category of business.
(4)For the purposes of subsections (2) and (3) above, the part of the amount brought into account as the increase or decrease in the value of assets which is directly referable to a category of business is the part referable to the category by virtue of subsection (1) above and assets are directly referable to a category of business if such part of the amount brought into account as the increase or decrease in the value of assets as is attributable to them is so referable.”.
16(1)For section 83 of the M192Finance Act 1989 substitute—U.K.
(1)The following provisions of this section have effect where the profits of an insurance company in respect of its life assurance business are, for the purposes of the Taxes Act 1988, computed in accordance with the provisions of that Act applicable to Case I of Schedule D.
(2)So far as referable to that business, the following items, as brought into account for a period of account (and not otherwise), shall be taken into account as receipts of the period—
(a)the company’s investment income from the assets of its long term business fund, and
(b)any increase in value (whether realised or not) of those assets.
If for any period of account there is a reduction in the value referred to in paragraph (b) above (as brought into account for the period), that reduction shall be taken into account as an expense of that period.
(3)In ascertaining whether or to what extent a company has incurred a loss in respect of that business any amount transferred into the company’s long term business fund from other assets of the company, or otherwise added to that fund, shall be taken into account, in the period in which it is brought into account, as an increase in value of the assets of that fund within subsection (2)(b) above.
This subsection does not apply where, or to the extent that, the amount concerned—
would fall to be taken into account as a receipt apart from this section,
is otherwise taken into account under subsection (2) above, or
is specifically exempted from tax.
(1)In section 83 “brought into account” means brought into account in an account which is recognised for the purposes of that section.
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section and to any regulations made by the Treasury, the accounts recognised for the purposes of that section are—
(a)a revenue account prepared for the purposes of the Insurance Companies Act 1982 in respect of the whole of the company’s long term business;
(b)any separate revenue account required to be prepared under that Act in respect of a part of that business.
Paragraph (b) above does not include accounts required in respect of internal linked funds.
(3)Where there are prepared any such separate accounts as are mentioned in subsection (2)(b) above, reference shall be made to those accounts rather than to the account for the whole of the business.
(4)If in any such case the total of the items brought into account in the separate accounts is not equal to the total amount brought into account in the account prepared for the whole business, there shall be treated as having been required and prepared a further separate revenue account covering the balance.
(5)Where a company carries on both ordinary long term business and industrial assurance business, the references above to the company’s long term business shall be construed as references to either or both of those businesses, as the case may require.”.
(2)In section 432B of the Taxes Act 1988—
(a)in subsection (1) for the words from “brought into account” to “1982” substitute “ brought into account, within the meaning of that section, ”; and
(b)for subsection (2) substitute—
“(2)Where for that purpose reference falls to be made to more than one account recognised for the purposes of that section, the provisions of sections 432C to 432F apply separately in relation to each account.”.
(3)In section 432E(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 for the words from “of the items referred to in subsection (1)” to “paragraph (b))” substitute “ to be taken into account in accordance with section 83(2) of the M193Finance Act 1989 (that is to say, the aggregate amount to be taken into account as receipts reduced by the aggregate amount to be taken into account as expenses) ”.
F130(4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F130(5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(6)In section 65(2) of the Finance (No.2) Act 1992 for paragraph (d) substitute—
“(d)section 83(2) of the Finance Act 1989 (amounts to be taken into account as receipts or expenses);”.
Textual Amendments
F130Sch. 8 para. 16(4)(5) repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in s. 163, Sch. 31 para. 10(2) of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(23) Note
Marginal Citations
17(1)In section 432B of the Taxes Act 1988 (apportionment of receipts brought into account)—U.K.
(a)in subsections (1) and (2) for “sections 432C to 432E” substitute “ sections 432C to 432F ”, and
(b)in subsection (3) for “section 432E applies” substitute “ sections 432E and 432F apply ”.
(2)In section 432E of the Taxes Act 1988 (section 432B apportionment: participating funds)—
(a)in subsection (1), for the words from “shall be” to the end substitute “ shall be the amount determined in accordance with subsection (2) below or, if greater, the amount determined in accordance with subsection (3) below. ”; and
(b)in subsection (5) at the end insert—
“References in this subsection to the amount determined in accordance with subsection (3) above are to that amount after making any deduction required by section 432F.”.
(3)After section 432E of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
(1)The provisions of this section provide for the reduction of the amount determined in accordance with section 432E(3) (“the subsection (3) figure”) for an accounting period in which that amount exceeds, or would otherwise exceed, the amount determined in accordance with section 432E(2) (“the subsection (2) figure”).
(2)For each category of business in relation to which section 432E falls to be applied there shall be determined for each accounting period the amount (if any) by which the subsection (2) figure, after making any reduction required by section 432E(5), exceeds the subsection (3) figure (“the subsection (2) excess”).
(3)Where there is a subsection (2) excess, the amount shall be carried forward and if in any subsequent accounting period the subsection (3) figure exceeds, or would otherwise exceed, the subsection (2) figure, it shall be reduced by the amount or cumulative amount of subsection (2) excesses so far as not previously used under this subsection.
(4)Where in an accounting period that amount is greater than is required to bring the subsection (3) figure down to the subsection (2) figure, the balance shall be carried forward and aggregated with any subsequent subsection (2) excess for use in subsequent accounting periods.”.
(4)In section 444A of the Taxes Act 1988 (transfers of business) after subsection (3) insert—
“(3A)Any subsection (2) excess (within the meaning of section 432F(2)) which (assuming the transferor had continued to carry on the business transferred after the transfer) would have been available under section 432F(3) or (4) to reduce a subsection (3) figure (within the meaning of section 432F(1)) of the transferor in an accounting period following that which ends with the day on which transfer takes place—
(a)shall, instead, be treated as a subsection (2) excess of the transferee, and
(b)shall be taken into account in the first accounting period of the transferee ending after the date of the transfer (to reduce the subsection (3) figure or, as the case may be, to produce or increase a subsection (2) excess for that period),
in relation to the revenue account of the transferee dealing with or including the business transferred.”.
(5)In section 444A(5) of the Taxes Act 1988 for “subsection (2) or (3)” substitute “ subsection (2), (3) or (3A) ”.
F13118U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 8 para. 18 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(2) Note
19(1)Section 434 of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
F132(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F133(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 8 para. 19(2) repealed (31.7.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(6) Note (with s. 3(3))
F133Sch. 8 para. 19(3) repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(2) Note
20(1)For section 434A of the Taxes Act 1988 substitute—U.K.
(1)In ascertaining whether or to what extent a company has incurred a loss on its life assurance business profits derived from investments held for the purposes of that business (including franked investment income of, and foreign income dividends arising to, a company resident in the United Kingdom) shall be treated as part of the profits of that business.
(2)Where for any accounting period the loss arising to an insurance company from its life assurance business falls to be computed in accordance with the provisions of this Act applicable to Case I of Schedule D, any loss resulting from the computation shall be reduced (but not below nil) by the aggregate of—
(a)any losses for that period under section 436, 441 or 439B, and
(b)the amount of interest and annuities treated as charges on income in computing for the period otherwise than in accordance with the provisions of this Act applicable to Case I of Schedule D the profits or losses of the company’s life assurance business.
(3)In the case of a company carrying on life assurance business, no relief shall be allowable under—
(a)Chapter II (loss relief) or Chapter IV (group relief) of Part X, or
(b)Chapter II of Part II of the Finance Act 1993 so far as it has effect in relation to losses treated as non-trading losses for the purposes of section 160 of the Finance Act 1994,
against the policy holders’ share of the relevant profits for any accounting period.
For the purposes of this subsection “the policy holders’ share of the relevant profits” has the same meaning as in section 88 of the Finance Act 1989.”.
(2)In section 65(2) of the Finance (No. 2) Act 1992, for paragraph (a) substitute—
“(a)section 434A(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (profits derived from investments held for purposes of life assurance business treated as profits of that business in ascertaining loss);”.
21[F134(1)After section 434A of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—U.K.
(1)Where the profits or losses arising to an insurance company from its life assurance business, or any class of life assurance business, fall to be computed for any purpose in accordance with the provisions of this Act applicable to Case I of Schedule D, section 337(2)(b) shall not prevent the deduction of any interest or annuity payable by the company under a liability of its long term business so far as referable to its life assurance business or any class of that business.
(2)Nothing in subsection (1) above or in section 338(2) shall be construed as preventing any such interest or annuity as is mentioned in subsection (1) above, so far as referable to the company’s basic life assurance and general annuity business, from being treated as a charge on income for the purposes of the computation of the profits or losses of that business otherwise than in accordance with Case I of Schedule D.”.]
(2)In section 88 of the Finance Act 1989, for subsection (3) substitute—
“(3)For the purposes of subsection (1) above, the relevant profits of a company for an accounting period are the income and gains of the company’s life assurance business reduced by the aggregate amount of—
(a)expenses of management falling to be deducted under section 76 of the Taxes Act 1988, and
(b)charges on income,
so far as referable to the company’s life assurance business.”.
Textual Amendments
F134Sch. 8 para. 21(1) repealed (19.3.1997 with effect in relation to accounting periods beginning after 5.3.1997) by 1997 c. 16, s. 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(6) Note
F13522U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F135Sch. 8 para. 22 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(2) Note
23F136(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .U.K.
(2)In section 75(4) of the Taxes Act 1988 omit the words “and insurance”.
(3)In section 86 of the Finance Act 1989 (spreading of relief for acquisition expenses), after subsection (5) insert—
“(5A)References in this section to expenses of management do not include any amounts treated as additional expenses of management by virtue of section 434D(6)(a) of the Taxes Act 1988 (capital allowances in respect of expenditure on management assets).”.
Textual Amendments
F136Sch. 8 para. 23(1) repealed (22.3.2001 with effect as mentioned in s. 579(1) of the amending Act) by 2001 c. 2, ss. 579(1), 580, Sch. 4
F13724U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 8 para. 24 repealed (22.3.2001 with effect as mentioned in s. 579(1) of the amending Act) by 2001 c. 2, ss. 579(1), 580, Sch. 4
25(1)In the Taxes Act 1988 omit—U.K.
(a)section 474(1)(b); and
(b)in section 475(2)(a), the words from “or,” to “life assurance business”.
(2)In section 474 of the Taxes Act 1988, at the end insert—
“(3)In this section any reference to insurance business includes a reference to insurance business of any category.”.
26U.K.After section 439 of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
If a company does not carry on life assurance business other than reinsurance business, and none of that business is of a type excluded from this section by regulations made by the Board, the profits of that business shall be charged to tax in accordance with Case I of Schedule D and not otherwise.”.
27(1)After section 439A of the Taxes Act 1988 (inserted by paragraph 26 above) insert—U.K.
(1)Where a company carries on life reinsurance business and the profits arising from that business are not charged to tax in accordance with the provisions applicable to Case I of Schedule D, then, subject as follows, those profits shall be treated as income within Schedule D and be chargeable to tax under Case VI of that Schedule, and for that purpose—
(a)that business shall be treated separately, and
(b)subject to paragraph (a) above, the profits from it shall be computed in accordance with the provisions of this Act applicable to Case I of Schedule D.
(2)Subsection (1) above does not apply to so much of reinsurance business of any description excluded from that subsection by regulations made by the Board.
Regulations under this subsection may describe the excluded business by reference to any circumstances appearing to the Board to be relevant.
(3)In making the computation referred to in subsection (1) above—
(a)sections 82(1), (2) and (4) and 83 of the Finance Act 1989 shall apply with the necessary modifications and in particular with the omission of the words “tax or” in section 82(1)(a),
(b)section 83(3) of that Act shall not apply, and
(c)there may be set off against the profits any loss, to be computed on the same basis as the profits, which has arisen from life reinsurance business in any previous accounting period beginning on or after 1st January 1995.
(4)Section 396 shall not be taken to apply to a loss incurred by a company on life reinsurance business.
(5)Nothing in section 128 or 399(1) shall affect the operation of this section.
(6)Gains accruing to a company which are referable to its life reinsurance business shall not be chargeable gains.
(7)In ascertaining whether or to what extent a company has incurred a loss on its life reinsurance business, franked investment income and foreign income dividends shall be taken into account (notwithstanding anything in section 208) as part of the profits of that business.”.
(2)In section 444A(3)(a) of the Taxes Act 1988 after “section 436(3)(c)” insert “ or 439B(3)(c) ”.
(3)In section 724(3) and (4) of the Taxes Act 1988 after “section 436” insert “ , 439B ”.
28(1)After section 440A of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—U.K.
(1)The following provisions apply where the profits of a company’s life assurance business are charged to tax in accordance with Case I of Schedule D.
(2)Section 438 applies as if in subsections (6), (6B) and (6E) for the reference to any profit arising to the company and computed under section 436 there were substituted a reference to the profit that would arise on a computation under section 436 if the profits of the company’s life assurance business were not charged to tax under Case I of Schedule D.
(3)Section 440(1) and (2) apply as if the only categories set out in subsection (4) of that section were—
(a)assets of the long term business fund, and
(b)other assets.
(4)Section 440A applies as if for paragraphs (a) to (e) of subsection (2) there were substituted—
”(a)so many of the securities as are identified in the company’s records as securities by reference to the value of which there are to be determined benefits provided for under policies or contracts the effecting of all (or all but an insignificant proportion) of which constitutes the carrying on of long term business, shall be treated for the purposes of corporation tax as a separate holding linked solely to that business, and
(b)any remaining securities shall be treated for those purposes as a separate holding which is not of the description mentioned in the preceding paragraph.”.
(5)Section 212(1) of the 1992 Act does not apply, but without prejudice to the bringing into account of any amounts deferred under section 213(1) or 214A(2) of that Act from any accounting period beginning before 1st January 1995.”.
F138(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)In section 440 of the Taxes Act 1988, after subsection (5) insert—
“(6)In a case where the profits of a company’s life assurance business are charged to tax in accordance with Case I of Schedule D this section has effect with the modification specified in section 440B(3).”.
(4)In section 440A of the Taxes Act 1988, after subsection (6) insert—
“(7)In a case where the profits of a company’s life assurance business are charged to tax in accordance with Case I of Schedule D this section has effect with the modification specified in section 440B(4).”.
(5)In section 212 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992, after subsection (7) insert—
“(7A)In a case where the profits of a company’s life assurance business are charged to tax in accordance with Case I of Schedule D subsection (1) above has effect subject to section 440B(5) of the Taxes Act.”.
Textual Amendments
F138Sch. 8 para. 28(2) repealed (31.7.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(6) Note (with s. 3(3))
F13929U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F139Sch. 8 para. 29 repealed (31.7.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(6) Note (with s. 3(3))
30U.K.In section 441(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 omit the words “resident in the United Kingdom”.
[F14031U.K.In section 441A of the Taxes Act 1988 for subsections (3) to (6) substitute—
“(3)A company shall be entitled to such a tax credit if and to the extent that regulations made by the Board so provide.
(4)Regulations under subsection (3) above may, in particular, provide for the entitlement of a company to a tax credit, and the amount to which the company is entitled, to be determined by reference to—
(a)the residence of any description of policy holders or annuitants prescribed by the regulations, or
(b)the location of any branch or agency at or through which the policy or contract for any business is effected.
(5)Subsections (2) and (3) of section 431E apply in relation to regulations under subsection (3) above as they apply in relation to regulations under subsection (1) of that section but as if any issue which falls to be decided for the purposes of the regulations under subsection (3) above were an issue such as is mentioned in subsection (2)(a) of that section.”.]
Textual Amendments
F140Sch. 8 para. 31 repealed (31.7.1997 with effect in relation to distributions made on or after 6.4.1999) by 1997 c. 58, s. 52, Sch. 8 Pt. II(10) Note (with s. 3(3))
32U.K.After section 441A of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
(1)This section applies to land in the United Kingdom which—
(a)is held by a company as an asset linked to the company’s overseas life assurance business, or
(b)is held by a company which is charged to tax under Case I of Schedule D in respect of its life assurance business as an asset by reference to the value of which benefits under any policy or contract are to be determined, where the policy or contract (or, in the case of a reinsurance contract, the underlying policy or contract) is held by a person not residing in the United Kingdom.
(2)Income arising from land to which this section applies shall be treated for the purposes of this Chapter as referable to basic life assurance and general annuity business.
(3)Where (apart from this subsection) an insurance company would not be carrying on basic life assurance and general annuity business it shall be treated as carrying on such business if any income of the company is treated as referable to such business by subsection (2) above.
(4)A company may be charged to tax by virtue of this section—
(a)notwithstanding section 439A, and
(b)whether or not the income to which subsection (2) above relates is taken into account in computing the profits of the company for the purposes of any charge to tax in accordance with Case I of Schedule D.
(5)In this section “land” has the same meaning as in Schedule 19AA.”.
33U.K.In paragraph 1(2) of Schedule 19AA to the Taxes Act 1988, at the end insert “ (including any modification of any of those provisions made by paragraph 14A of Schedule 19AC) ”.
34U.K.After section 442 of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
(1)Where an insurance company reinsures any risk in respect of a policy or contract attributable to its basic life assurance and general annuity business, the investment return on the policy or contract shall be treated as accruing to the company over the period of the reinsurance arrangement and shall be charged to tax under Case VI of Schedule D.
(2)The Board may make provision by regulations as to the amount of investment return to be treated as accruing in each accounting period during which the reinsurance arrangement is in force.
(3)The regulations may, in particular, provide that the investment return to be treated as accruing to the company in respect of a policy or contract in any accounting period shall be calculated by reference to—
(a)the aggregate of the sums paid by the company to the reinsurer during that accounting period and any earlier accounting periods by way of premium or otherwise;
(b)the aggregate of the sums paid by the reinsurer to the company during that accounting period and any earlier accounting periods by way of commission or otherwise;
(c)the aggregate amount of the net investment return treated as accruing to the company in any earlier accounting periods, that is to say, net of tax at such rate as may be prescribed; and
(d)such percentage rate of return as may be prescribed.
(4)The regulations shall provide that the amount of investment return to be treated as accruing to the company in respect of a policy or contract in the final accounting period during which the policy or contract is in force is the amount, ascertained in accordance with regulations, by which the profit over the whole period during which the policy or contract, and the reinsurance arrangement, were in force exceeds the aggregate of the amounts treated as accruing in earlier accounting periods.
If that profit is less than the aggregate of the amounts treated as accruing in earlier accounting periods, the difference shall go to reduce the amounts treated by virtue of this section as arising in that accounting period from other policies or contracts, and if not fully so relieved may be carried forward and set against any such amounts in subsequent accounting periods.
(5)Regulations under this section—
(a)may exclude from the operation of this section such descriptions of insurance company, such descriptions of policies or contracts and such descriptions of reinsurance arrangements as may be prescribed;
(b)may make such supplementary provision as to the ascertainment of the investment return to be treated as accruing to the company as appears to the Board to be appropriate, including provision requiring payments made during an accounting period to be treated as made on such date or dates as may be prescribed; and
(c)may make different provision for different cases or descriptions of case.
(6)In this section “prescribed” means prescribed by regulations under this section.”.
35(1)After paragraph 5 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 insert—U.K.
“5A(1)Where an overseas life insurance company receives a qualifying distribution made by a company resident in the United Kingdom and the distribution (or part of the distribution)—
(a)would fall within paragraph (a), (aa) or (ab) of section 11(2) but for the exclusion contained in that paragraph, and
(b)is referable to life assurance business, but not to overseas life assurance business,
then the recipient shall be treated for the purposes of the Corporation Tax Acts as entitled to such a tax credit in respect of the distribution (or part of the distribution) as it would be entitled to under section 231 if it were resident in the United Kingdom.
(2)Where part only of a qualifying distribution would fall within paragraph (ab) of section 11(2) but for the exclusion contained in that paragraph, the tax credit to which the recipient shall be treated as entitled by virtue of sub-paragraph (1) above is the proportionate part of the tax credit to which the recipient would be so treated as entitled in respect of the whole of the distribution.
5B(1)An overseas life insurance company may, on making a claim for the purpose, require that any UK distribution income for an accounting period shall for all or any of the purposes mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) below be treated as if it were a like amount of profits chargeable to corporation tax; and where it does so—
(a)the provisions mentioned in that sub-paragraph shall apply to reduce the amount of the UK distribution income, and
(b)the company shall be entitled to have paid to it the amount of the tax credits comprised in the amount of UK distribution income which is so reduced.
(2)The purposes for which a claim may be made under this paragraph are those of—
(a)the setting of trading losses against total profits under section 393A(1);
(b)the deduction of charges on income under section 338 or paragraph 5 of Schedule 4;
(c)the deduction of expenses of management under section 76;
(d)the setting of certain capital allowances against total profits under section 145(3) of the 1990 Act.
(3)Subsections (3), (4) and (8) of section 242 shall apply for the purposes of a claim under this paragraph as they apply for the purposes of a claim under that section.
(4)In this paragraph “UK distribution income” means income of an overseas life insurance company which consists of a distribution (or part of a distribution) in respect of which the company is entitled to a tax credit (and which accordingly represents income equal to the aggregate of the amount or value of the distribution (or part) and the amount of that credit).
5C(1)This paragraph applies to income from the investments of an overseas life insurance company attributable to the basic life assurance and general annuity business of the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on life assurance business.
(2)Where, in computing the income to which this paragraph applies, any interest on any securities issued by the Treasury is excluded by virtue of a condition of the issue of those securities regulating the treatment of the interest on them for tax purposes, the relief under section 76 shall be reduced so that it bears to the amount of relief which would be granted apart from this sub-paragraph the same proportion as the amount of that income excluding that interest bears to the amount of that income including that interest.”.
(2)In paragraph 2(1) of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 444D” substitute “ paragraph 5B of Schedule 19AC ”.
(3)After paragraph 6(4) of that Schedule insert—
“(4A)In that subsection the following definition shall be inserted at the appropriate place—
“UK distribution income” has the meaning given by paragraph 5B(4) of Schedule 19AC;”.
(4)In section 475(6) of the Taxes Act 1988 for “section 444E(2)” (twice) substitute “ paragraph 5C(2) of Schedule 19AC ”.
(5)In paragraph 2(2) of Schedule 8A to the Finance Act 1989 for “section 444D(4) of the Taxes Act 1988” substitute “ paragraph 5B(4) of that Schedule ”.
36U.K.In paragraph 5(1) of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988, in the notionally inserted subsection (6B)—
(a)for “242” substitute “ section 242 ”, and
(b)for “444D” substitute “ paragraph 5B of Schedule 19AC ”.
37U.K.In paragraph 6 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988, omit sub-paragraphs (3) and (4).
38U.K.After paragraph 6 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
“6AIn section 431D(1), the words “carried on through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom by an overseas life insurance company” shall be treated as inserted after the words “means life assurance business”.”.
39U.K.For paragraph 7 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 substitute—
“7(1)Section 432A has effect as if the references in subsections (3), (6) and (8) to assets were to such of the assets concerned as are—
(a)section 11(2)(b) assets,
(b)section 11(2)(c) assets, or
(c)assets which by virtue of section 11B are attributed to the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on life assurance business;
and as if the references in subsections (6) and (8) to liabilities were to such of the liabilities concerned as are attributable to the branch or agency.
Expressions used in this sub-paragraph to which a meaning is given by section 11A have that meaning.
(2)For the purposes of section 432A as it applies in relation to an overseas life insurance company, income which falls within section 11(2)(aa) or (ab), and chargeable gains or allowable losses which fall within section 11(2)(d) or (e)—
(a)shall not be referable to long term business other than life assurance business; and
(b)shall be apportioned under subsections (5) and (6) of that section separately from other income, gains and losses.
(3)For the purposes of the application of section 432A(6) in relation to such income, gains or losses as are mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) above—
(a)“liabilities” does not includes liabilities of the long term business other than life assurance business;
(b)the value of assets directly referable to any category of business does not include assets directly referable to long term business other than life assurance business; and
(c)the reference in section 432A(6)(b)(ii) to the investment reserve shall be construed as a reference to so much of the investment reserve as is not referable to long term business other than life assurance business.”.
40(1)Paragraph 8 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1)—
(a)for “paragraph 1” substitute “ paragraph 1C ”; and
(b)for “the word ’1982’” substitute “ the words ’brought into account, within the meaning of that section,’ ”.
(3)In sub-paragraph (2) for “paragraph 1(6), (7) or (8)” substitute “ any provision of paragraph 1C ”.
(4)For sub-paragraph (3) substitute—
“(3)Subsection (3) of section 432B shall have effect as if after the words “with which an account is concerned” there were inserted the words “or in respect of which items are treated as brought into account by virtue of paragraph 1C of Schedule 8A to the Finance Act 1989”; and that subsection and sections 432C to 432E shall have effect as if the reference to relevant business were to relevant business of the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on life assurance business.”.
41U.K.In paragraph 9(1) of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 in the notionally inserted section 434(1A)—
(a)after “UK distribution income of” insert “ , or foreign income dividends arising to, ”; and
(b)for the words from “as part of the profit” to the end substitute—
“(a)in any computation of profits for the purposes of section 89(7) of the Finance Act 1989, or
(b)in any computation for the purposes of section 76(2) of the tax that would have been paid if the company had been charged to tax under Case I of Schedule D in respect of its life assurance business.”.
42U.K.After paragraph 9 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
“9AIn section 434A(1)—
(a)the words “UK distribution income” shall be treated as substituted for “franked investment income”, and
(b)the words “an overseas life insurance company” shall be treated as substituted for “a company resident in the United Kingdom”.
9BIn section 434B the following subsection shall be treated as inserted after subsection (2)—
”(3)An overseas life insurance company shall not be entitled to treat as paid out of profits or gains brought into charge to income tax any part of the annuities paid by the company which is referable to its life assurance business.”.
9CIn its application to an overseas life insurance company section 434D(4) shall have effect as if the references to liabilities were only to such liabilities as are attributable to the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on the business concerned.”.
43(1)In paragraph 10(1) of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988, in the notionally inserted section 438(3A)—U.K.
(a)for “subsection (6)” substitute “ subsections (6) and (6B) ”;
(b)after “UK distribution income of” insert “ , or foreign income dividends arising to, ”;
(c)after “taken into account” insert “ —(a) ”; and
(d)after “pension business” insert—
“, or
(b)where the company is charged to tax in respect of its life assurance business under Case I of Schedule D, in computing the profits of that business.”.
(2)In paragraph 10(2) for “subsections (6) and (6A)” substitute “ subsections (6), (6A), (6D) and (6E) ”.
44U.K.After paragraph 10 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
“10AIn section 439B the following subsection shall be treated as inserted after subsection (7) of that section—
”(7A)In ascertaining whether or to what extent the company has incurred a loss on its life reinsurance business, UK distribution income of an overseas life insurance company shall be taken into account (notwithstanding anything in paragraph (a), (aa) or (ab) of section 11(2)) as part of the profits of that business.”.
10B(1)Where the company mentioned in section 440(1) is an overseas life insurance company, section 440 has effect with the following modifications.
(2)Subsection (4) shall be treated as if—
(a)in paragraphs (a), (b), (d), (e) and (f) the words “UK assets” were substituted for the words “assets”; and
(b)at the end there were inserted—
”(g)section 11C assets;
(h)non-UK assets.”.
(3)The following subsection shall be treated as inserted at the end of the section—
”(7)For the purposes of this section—
(a)UK assets are—
(i)section 11(2)(b) assets;
(ii)section 11(2)(c) assets; or
(iii)assets which by virtue of section 11B are attributed to the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on life assurance business;
(b)section 11C assets are assets—
(i)(in a case where section 11C (other than subsection (9)) applies) of the relevant fund, other than UK assets; or
(ii)(in a case where that section including that subsection applies) of the relevant funds, other than UK assets;
(c)non-UK assets are assets which are not UK assets or section 11C assets;
and any expression used in this subsection to which a meaning is given by section 11A has that meaning.”.
(4)Where one of the companies mentioned in section 440(2) is an overseas life insurance company, section 440(2)(b) shall have effect as if for the words “is within another of those categories” there were substituted “is not within the corresponding category”.
(5)Where the transferor company mentioned in section 440(2) is an overseas life insurance company, section 440 shall have effect, as regards the time immediately before the acquisition, with the modifications in sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) above.
(6)Where the acquiring company mentioned in section 440(2) is an overseas life insurance company, section 440 shall have effect, as regards the time immediately after the acquisition, with the modifications in sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) above.
10C(1)In section 440B the following subsection shall be treated as substituted for subsection (3)—
”(3)Section 440(1) and (2) have effect as if the only categories specified in subsection (4) of that section were—
(a)UK assets of the long term business fund,
(b)other UK assets,
(c)section 11C assets, and
(d)non-UK assets,
(those expressions having the meanings given by section 440(7)).”.
(2)The following subsection shall be treated as substituted for subsection (4) of that section—
”(4)Section 440A applies as if for paragraphs (a) to (e) of subsection (2) there were substituted—
”(a)so many of the UK securities as are identified in the company’s records as securities by reference to the value of which there are to be determined benefits provided for under policies or contracts the effecting of all (or all but an insignificant proportion) of which constitutes the carrying on of long term business, shall be treated for the purposes of corporation tax as a separate holding linked solely to that business,
(b)any remaining UK securities shall be treated for those purposes as a separate holding which is not of the description mentioned in the preceding paragraph,
(c)the section 11C securities shall be treated for those purposes as a separate holding which is not of any of the descriptions mentioned in the preceding paragraphs, and
(d)the non-UK securities shall be treated for those purposes as a separate holding which is not of any of the descriptions mentioned in the preceding paragraphs.”.”.
45(1)Paragraph 11 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)For sub-paragraph (1) substitute—
“(1)In section 440A(2), in paragraph (a) the words “UK securities” shall be treated as substituted for the word “securities” in the first place where it occurs.”.
(3)Omit sub-paragraph (2).
(4)In sub-paragraph (5) renumber the notionally inserted subsection as (6A).
46U.K.After paragraph 11 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
“11A(1)In section 441A, the following subsection shall be treated as inserted after subsection (1)—
”(1A)The exclusion from section 11(2)(a), (aa) and (ab) of distributions received from companies resident in the United Kingdom shall not apply in relation to a distribution in respect of any asset of the overseas life assurance fund of an overseas life insurance company.”.
(2)The following subsection shall be treated as substituted for subsections (2) and (3) of that section—
”(3)An overseas life insurance company shall be entitled to a tax credit in respect of a distribution which—
(a)is a distribution in respect of an asset of the company’s overseas life assurance fund, and
(b)is received from a company resident in the United Kingdom,
if and to the extent that regulations made by the Board so provide.”.
11BIn section 442A the following subsection shall be treated as inserted after subsection (6)—
”(7)In the case of an overseas life insurance company, the investment return treated as accruing under this section in any accounting period in relation to a policy or contract shall be treated as chargeable profits within section 11(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 where the policy or contract is one which in that accounting period gives rise, or but for the reinsurance arrangement would give rise, to such profits.”.”
47U.K.In paragraph 12(1) of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 444D” substitute “ paragraph 5B of Schedule 19AC ”.
48U.K.After paragraph 14 of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
“14A(1)In Schedule 19AA, paragraph 5(5)(c) (and the reference to it in paragraph 2(3) of that Schedule) shall be treated as omitted.
(2)The following paragraph shall be treated as inserted at the end of that Schedule—
”6In its application to an overseas life insurance company this Schedule shall have effect as if—
(a)the references in paragraphs 2 and 3 to assets of the long term business fund were to such of the assets as are—
(i)section 11(2)(b) assets;
(ii)section 11(2)(c) assets; or
(iii)assets which by virtue of section 11B are attributed to the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on life assurance business; and
(b)the references in paragraphs 2 and 4 to the liabilities of the company’s long term business were to such of those liabilities as are attributable to the branch or agency;
and any expression used in this paragraph to which a meaning is given by section 11A has that meaning.”.”.
49(1)Schedule 8A to the M194Finance Act 1989 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)For paragraph 1 substitute—
“1(1)In their application to an overseas life insurance company sections 83 and 83A of this Act shall have effect with the modifications specified in paragraphs 1A to 1C below.
(2)In those paragraphs—
(a)any reference to the Taxes Act 1988 is a reference to that Act as it has effect in relation to such a company by virtue of Schedule 19AC to that Act; and
(b)any expression to which a meaning is given by section 11A of that Act has that meaning.
1A(1)The reference in section 83(2)(a) to investment income shall be construed as a reference to such of the income concerned as is attributable to the branch or agency in the United Kingdom through which the company carries on life assurance business.
(2)The reference to assets in section 83(2)(b) (as it applies apart from subsection (3) of that section) shall be construed as a reference to such of the assets concerned—
(a)as are—
(i)section 11(2)(b) assets;
(ii)section 11(2)(c) assets; or
(iii)assets which by virtue of section 11B of the Taxes Act 1988 are attributed to the branch or agency; or
(b)as are assets—
(i)(in a case where section 11C of that Act (other than subsection (9)) applies) of the relevant fund, or
(ii)(in a case where that section including that subsection applies) of the relevant funds,
other than assets which fall within paragraph (a) above.
(3)In determining for the purposes of section 83(2) (as it applies apart from subsection (3) of that section) whether there has been any increase or reduction in the value (whether realised or not) of assets—
(a)no regard shall be had to any period of time during which an asset held by the company does not fall within paragraph (a) or (b) of sub-paragraph (2) above; and
(b)in the case of an asset which falls within paragraph (b) of that sub-paragraph, only the specified portion of any increase or reduction in the value of the asset shall be taken into account.
For the purposes of paragraph (b) above the specified portion of any increase or reduction in the value of an asset is found by applying to that increase or reduction the same fraction as would, by virtue of section 11C of the Taxes Act 1988, be applied to any relevant gain accruing to the company on the disposal of the asset.
(4)For the reference in section 83(3) to any amount being transferred into the company’s long term business fund from other assets of the company, or otherwise added to that fund, there shall be substituted a reference to assets becoming assets of the long term business fund used or held for the purposes of the company’s United Kingdom branch or agency, having immediately previously been held by the company otherwise than as assets of that fund or used or held otherwise than for those purposes.
The amount of the increase in value under section 83(2)(b), as it applies in relation to such a transfer, shall be taken to be an amount equal to the value of the assets transferred.
1BThe references in section 83A to the company’s long term business shall be construed as references to the whole of that business or to the whole of that business other than business in respect of which preparation of a revenue account for the purposes of the Insurance Companies Act 1982 is not required.
1C(1)Where for a period of account any investment income referred to in section 83(2)(a) is not otherwise brought into account within the meaning of that section, it shall be treated as brought into account for the period if it arises in the period.
(2)Where for a period of account any increase in value referred to in section 83(2)(b) (as it applies apart from subsection (3) of that section) is not otherwise brought into account within the meaning of that section, it shall be treated as brought into account for the period if it is shown in the company’s records as available to fund one or both of the following for the period, namely, bonuses to policy holders and dividends to shareholders.
(3)Where for a period of account any reduction in value referred to in section 83(2) (as it applies apart from subsection (3) of that section) is not otherwise brought into account within the meaning of that section, it shall be treated as brought into account for the period if it is shown in the company’s records as reducing sums available to fund one or both of the following for the period, namely, bonuses to policy holders and dividends to shareholders.
(4)Where in any period of account any such transfer is made as is mentioned in section 83(3) which is not otherwise brought into account within the meaning of that section, it shall be treated as brought into account for the period in which it is made.”.
(3)In paragraph 2(7) for the words following paragraph (b) substitute—
“and in paragraph (b) above “the specified portion” has the same meaning as in paragraph 1A(3)(b) above.”.
(4)After paragraph 2(7) insert—
“(7A)For the purposes of this paragraph any expression to which a meaning is given by section 11A of the Taxes Act 1988 has that meaning.”.
Marginal Citations
50U.K.In the Table in section 98 of the M195Taxes Management Act 1970 (penalties for failure to comply with notice or to furnish information etc.), the entry “ regulations under section 431E(1) or 441A(3); ” shall be inserted—
(a)in the first column after the entry relating to regulations under section 333 of the Taxes Act 1988, and
(b)in the second column after the entry relating to section 375(5) of that Act.
51(1)The Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)Before section 432 insert the heading “ Separation of different categories of business ”.
(3)In the sidenote to section 432 for “classes” substitute “ categories ”.
(4)Before section 434 insert the heading “ Miscellaneous provisions relating to life assurance business ”.
(5)In the sidenote to section 436 for “Annuity business and pension business” substitute “ Pension business ”.
52U.K.The amendment made by paragraph 43(2) above shall be deemed always to have had effect.
53(1)The amendments made by paragraph 17 above have effect in relation to accounting periods ending on or after 1st January 1994.U.K.
(2)In the first accounting period of a company ending on or after 1st January 1994 in which the subsection (3) figure for any category of business exceeds the subsection (2) figure, the subsection (2) figure shall be treated as increased by an amount not exceeding the amount or aggregate amount of any subsection (2) excesses in relation to that category of business for accounting periods beginning on or after 1st January 1990 and ending before 1st January 1994, but not so as to produce a subsection (2) excess for that period.
For this purpose the subsection (2) excess for an accounting period beginning on or after 1st January 1990 and ending before 1st January 1994 shall be determined without regard to the fact that in any other such accounting period the subsection (3) figure exceeded the subsection (2) figure.
Expressions used in this sub-paragraph have the same meaning as in section 432F of the Taxes Act 1988.
(3)Where a transfer mentioned in section 444A of the Taxes Act 1988 took place at the end of an accounting period of the transferor beginning on or after 1st January 1990 and ending before 1st January 1994, section 444A(3A) shall have effect in relation to the transfer as if it read—
“(3A)Any subsection (2) excess (within the meaning of section 432F(2)) of the transferor for an accounting period beginning on or after 1st January 1990 and ending before 1st January 1994 which (assuming the transferor had continued to carry on the business transferred after the transfer) would have been available to increase the subsection (2) figure (within the meaning of section 432F(1)) of the transferor in the first accounting period ending on or after 1st January 1994 in which the subsection (3) figure exceeded the subsection (2) figure—
(a)shall, instead, be treated as a subsection (2) excess of the transferee, and
(b)shall be taken into account to increase the subsection (2) figure of the transferee in its first accounting period ending on or after 1st January 1994 in which the subsection (3) figure exceeds the subsection (2) figure, but not so as to produce a subsection (2) excess for that period,
in relation to the revenue account of the transferee dealing with or including the business transferred.
For this purpose the subsection (2) excess for an accounting period beginning on or after 1st January 1990 and ending before 1st January 1994 shall be determined without regard to the fact that in any other such accounting period the subsection (3) figure exceeded the subsection (2) figure.”.
54U.K.The amendment made by paragraph 22 above applies in relation to distributions made by an insurance company in any accounting period ending after 30th September 1993.
55(1)Subject to sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) below, the amendments made by the following provisions of this Schedule have effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1st November 1994—U.K.
paragraph 1 so far as relating to the definition of “overseas life assurance business”,
paragraph 2 so far as relating to sections 431D and 431E of the Taxes Act 1988,
paragraphs 3, 25, 30 to 33, 37, 38 and 45(1) and (3),
paragraph 46 so far as relating to paragraph 11A of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988, and
paragraphs 48 and 50.
(2)Where the policy or contract for any life assurance business was made before 1st November 1994, the amendments made by this Schedule (and the repeals consequential on those amendments) shall not have effect for determining whether the business is overseas life assurance business.
(3)Where the policy or contract for any life assurance business effected by a company resident in the United Kingdom at or through a branch or agency outside the United Kingdom was made before 29th November 1994, subsections (2) to (8) of section 431D of the Taxes Act 1988 shall not have effect for determining whether the business is overseas life assurance business.
56U.K.The amendments made by paragraphs 41(a) and 43(1) above have effect in relation to foreign income dividends paid after 29th November 1994.
57(1)Except as provided by paragraphs 52 to 56 above, and subject to sub-paragraph (2) below, the amendments made by provisions of this Schedule have effect in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1st January 1995.U.K.
(2)Section 442A of the Taxes Act 1988 does not apply in relation to the reinsurance of a policy or contract where the policy or contract was made, and the reinsurance arrangement effected, before 29th November 1994.
58U.K.Any power to make regulations exercisable by virtue of an amendment made by any provision of this Schedule may be exercised so as to make provision having effect in relation to any accounting period in relation to which that provision has effect in accordance with paragraph 55 or 57 above.
Section 53.
1(1)In the enactments specified in sub-paragraph (2) below, for the words “section 49 of the M196Insurance Companies Act 1982”, in each place where they occur, there shall be substituted “ Part I of Schedule 2C to the Insurance Companies Act 1982 ”.U.K.
(2)The enactments mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) above are—
F141(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F141(b). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F141(c). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(d)sections F142. . ., 214(11) and 214A(7) of the M197Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (transfers of business).
(3)In section 444A(3)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988 (losses treated as losses of transferee)-
(a)after “where” there shall be inserted “ the transfer relates to any overseas life assurance business or ”; and
(b)for “overseas life assurance” there shall be substituted “ such ”.
Textual Amendments
F141Sch. 9 para. 1(2)(a)-(c) repealed (1.12.2001 with effect as mentioned in Sch. Note 1 of the amending Act) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 109, Sch. Note
F142Words in Sch. 9 para. 1(2)(d) repealed (1.12.2001 with effect as mentioned in Note 1 of the amending Act) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 109, Sch. Note
Marginal Citations
2(1)Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act 1988 (modification of Act in relation to overseas life insurance company) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)After paragraph 4 there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“4A(1)In section 12(7A), the reference to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M198Insurance Companies Act 1982 shall be treated as including a reference to a qualifying overseas transfer.
(2)In this paragraph “a qualifying overseas transfer” means so much of any transfer of the whole or any part of the business of an overseas life insurance company carried on through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom as takes place in accordance with any authorisation granted outside the United Kingdom for the purposes of Article 11 of the third long term insurance Directive.
(3)In sub-paragraph (2) above “the third long term insurance Directive” has the same meaning as in that Act of 1982.”
(3)After the paragraph 10A inserted by Schedule 8 to this Act there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“10AAIn section 440(2)(a), the reference to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M199Insurance Companies Act 1982 shall be treated as including a reference to a qualifying overseas transfer (within the meaning of paragraph 4A above).”
(4)Before paragraph 12 there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“11CIn sections 444A(1) and 460(10A), the references to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M200Insurance Companies Act 1982 shall be treated as including references to a qualifying overseas transfer (within the meaning of paragraph 4A above).”
F1433U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
4U.K.In subsection (5) of section 213 of the M201Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (spreading of gains and losses under section 212 where there is a transfer of long term business), at the beginning there shall be inserted “Subject to subsections (5A) to (7) below”; and after that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(5A)Subsection (5) above shall not apply where the transferee is resident outside the United Kingdom unless the business to which the transfer relates is carried on by the transferee, for a period beginning with the time when the transfer takes effect, through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom.”
Marginal Citations
5U.K.In subsection (7) of section 214A of that Act of 1992 (application of transitional provisions where there is a transfer of long term business), at the beginning there shall be inserted “ Subject to subsections (7A) and (8) below ”; and after that subsection there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(7A)Paragraph (b) of subsection (7) above shall not apply where the transferee is resident outside the United Kingdom unless the business to which the transfer relates is carried on by the transferee, for a period beginning with the time when the transfer takes effect, through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom.”
6(1)Schedule 7B to that Act of 1992 (modification of Act in application to overseas life insurance companies) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)After paragraph 9 there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“9AIn section 211(1), the reference to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M202Insurance Companies Act 1982 shall be treated as including a reference to any qualifying overseas transfer (within the meaning of paragraph 4A of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act).”
(3)In paragraph 11, after sub-paragraph (1) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(1A)In section 213(5), the reference to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M203Insurance Companies Act 1982 shall be treated as including a reference to any qualifying overseas transfer (within the meaning of paragraph 4A of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act).”
(4)In sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 12, after paragraph (b) of the subsection (12) which, for the purpose of modifying section 214, is set out in that sub-paragraph, there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(c)the reference in subsection (11) to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M204Insurance Companies Act 1982 were to be treated as including a reference to any qualifying overseas transfer (within the meaning of paragraph 4A of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act), and the references in that subsection to the business to which the transfer relates were to be construed accordingly;”.
(5)In paragraph 13, after sub-paragraph (2) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(2A)In subsection (7) of that section, the reference to a transfer of the whole or part of a company’s long term business in accordance with a scheme sanctioned by a court under Part I of Schedule 2C to the M205Insurance Companies Act 1982 shall be treated as including a reference to any qualifying overseas transfer (within the meaning of paragraph 4A of Schedule 19AC to the Taxes Act); and the references in that subsection and in subsection (8) of that section to the business to which the transfer relates shall be construed accordingly.”
Section 54.
1(1)Section 460 of the Taxes Act 1988 (exemption from tax in respect of life or endowment business) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In paragraph (c) of subsection (2), before sub-paragraph (ai) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(zai) where the profits relate to contracts made on or after the day on which the Finance Act 1995 was passed, of the assurance of gross sums under contracts under which the total premiums payable in any period of 12 months exceed £270 or of the granting of annuities of annual amounts exceeding £156;”.
(3)In sub-paragraph (ai) of that paragraph, after “passed” there shall be inserted “ but before the day on which the Finance Act 1995 was passed ”.
(4)In subsection (3), for the words “subsection (2)(c)(ai),” in each place where they occur, there shall be substituted “ subsection (2)(c)(zai), (ai), ”.
(5)In subsection (4A), for “the Finance Act 1991” there shall be substituted “ the Finance Act 1995 ”.
(6)In subsection (4B), for the words from “variation made” onwards there shall be substituted “variation made—
(a)in the period beginning with 25th July 1991 and ending with 31st July 1992, or
(b)in the period beginning with the day on which the Finance Act 1995 was passed and ending with 31st March 1996,
the contract shall, for the purposes of subsection (2)(c) above, be treated, in relation to any profits relating to it as varied, as made at the time of the variation. ”
2(1)Section 464 of that Act (maximum benefits payable to members) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (3), before paragraph (za) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(zza)contracts under which the total premiums payable in any period of 12 months exceed £270; or”.
(3)In paragraph (za) of that subsection, after “contracts” there shall be inserted “ made before the day on which the Finance Act 1995 was passed and ”.
(4)In subsection (4A), for “the Finance Act 1991” there shall be substituted “ the Finance Act 1995 ”.
(5)In subsection (4B), for the words from “variation made” onwards there shall be substituted “variation made—
(a)in the period beginning with 25th July 1991 and ending with 31st July 1992, or
(b)in the period beginning with the day on which the Finance Act 1995 was passed and ending with 31st March 1996,
the contract shall, for the purposes of subsection (3) above, be treated, in relation to times when the contract has effect as varied, as made at the time of the variation. ”
3U.K.In paragraph 3 of Schedule 15 to that Act (friendly society policies that are qualifying policies), sub-paragraph (2)(c) (condition limiting consideration for early surrender) shall cease to have effect.
4(1)This paragraph applies to any policy which—U.K.
(a)was issued by a friendly society, or a branch of a friendly society, in the course of tax exempt life or endowment business (as defined in section 466 of the Taxes Act 1988); and
(b)was effected by a contract made after 31st August 1987 and before the day on which this Act is passed.
(2)Where—
(a)the amount payable by way of premium under a policy to which this paragraph applies is increased by virtue of a variation made in the period beginning with the day on which this Act is passed and ending with 31st March 1996, and
(b)the variation is not such as to cause a person to become in breach of the limits in section 464 of the Taxes Act 1988,
Schedule 15 to that Act, in its application to the policy, shall have effect, in relation to that variation, with the omission of paragraph 4(3)(a) and the insertion at the end of paragraph 18(2) of the words set out in sub-paragraph (3) below.
(3)Those words are as follows, that is to say, “ and as if for paragraph 3(2)(b) above there were substituted— ”
“(b)subject to sub-paragraph (4) below, the premiums payable under the policy shall be premiums of equal or rateable amounts payable at yearly or shorter intervals—
(i)over the whole of the term of the policy as from the variation, or
(ii)where premiums are not payable for any period after the person liable to pay them or whose life is insured has attained a specified age, being an age attained at a time not less than ten years after the beginning of the term of the policy, over the whole of the remainder of the period for which premiums are payable.””
Section 58.
1(1)Chapter IV of Part XIV of the Taxes Act 1988 (personal pension schemes) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)The amendments have effect in relation to approvals, of schemes or amendments, given under that Chapter after the passing of this Act.
(3)They do not affect any approval previously given.
2(1)Section 630 (interpretation) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)Make the present provision subsection (1) and insert the following definitions at the appropriate places—
“income withdrawal” means a payment of income, under arrangements made in accordance with a personal pension scheme, otherwise than by way of an annuity;
“pension date”, in relation to any personal pension arrangements, means the date determined in accordance with the arrangements on which—
an annuity such as is mentioned in section 634 is first payable, or
the member elects to defer the purchase of such an annuity and to make income withdrawals in accordance with section 634A;
and in the definition of “personal pension scheme” after “annuities” insert “ , income withdrawals ”.
(3)After that subsection insert—
“(2)For the purposes of this Chapter the annual amount of the annuity which would have been purchasable by a person on any date shall be calculated by reference to—
(a)the value on that date, determined by or on behalf of the scheme administrator, of the fund from which income withdrawals are to be or have been made by him under the arrangements in question, and
(b)the current published tables of rates of annuities prepared for the purposes of this Chapter by the Government Actuary.
(3)The reference in subsection (2)(a) above to the value of the fund from which income withdrawals are to be or have been made under any personal pension arrangements is to the value of the accrued rights to which the person concerned is entitled conferring prospective entitlement to benefits under those arrangements.
Where a lump sum falls to be paid on the date in question, the reference is to the value of the fund after allowing for that payment.
(4)The Board may make provision by regulations as to the basis on which the tables mentioned in subsection (2)(b) above are to be prepared and the manner in which they are to be applied.”.
3(1)Section 633(1) (conditions of approval: benefits that may be provided) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In paragraph (a) (annuity to member) after “section 634” insert “ or income withdrawals with respect to which the conditions in section 634A are satisfied ”.
(3)In paragraph (c) (annuity after death of member) after “section 636” insert “ or income withdrawals with respect to which the conditions in section 636A are satisfied ”.
(4)In paragraph (d) (lump sum on death of member) for the words from “either” to the end substitute “ the conditions in section 637 (death benefit); ”.
(5)After that paragraph insert—
“(e)the payment on or after the death of a member of a lump sum satisfying the conditions in section 637A (return of contributions).”.
4U.K.After section 634 (annuity to member) insert—
(1)Where a member elects to defer the purchase of an annuity such as is mentioned in section 634, income withdrawals may be made by him during the period of deferral, subject as follows.
(2)Income withdrawals must not be made before the member attains the age of 50, unless—
(a)they are available on his becoming incapable through infirmity of body or mind of carrying on his own occupation or any occupation of a similar nature for which he is trained or fitted, or
(b)the Board are satisfied that his occupation is one in which persons customarily retire before that age.
(3)Income withdrawals must not be made after the member attains the age of 75.
(4)The aggregate amount of income withdrawals by a member in each successive period of twelve months beginning with his pension date must be not less than 35 per cent. or more than 100 per cent. of the annual amount of the annuity which would have been purchasable by him on the relevant reference date.
(5)For the purposes of this section the relevant reference date for the first three years is the member’s pension date, and for each succeeding period of three years is the first day of that period.
(6)The right to income withdrawals must not be capable of assignment or surrender.”.
5(1)Section 635 (lump sum to member) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) (date of election for lump sum), for the words from “the date on which” to the end substitute “ his pension date under the arrangements in question ”.
(3)In subsection (2) (date of payment of lump sum), for the words “when that annuity is first payable” substitute “ on the date which is his pension date under the arrangements in question ”.
(4)In subsection (3) (limit on amount of lump sum)—
(a)in paragraph (a) for “the arrangements made by the member in accordance with the scheme” substitute “ the arrangements in question ”; and
(b)in paragraph (b) for “under the scheme” substitute “ under those arrangements ”.
6U.K.In section 636 (annuity after death of member), in subsection (3) (limit on aggregate annual amount), for “vested” substitute “ been purchased ”.
7U.K.After section 636 (annuity after death of member) insert—
(1)Where a person entitled to such an annuity as is mentioned in section 636 elects to defer the purchase of the annuity, income withdrawals may be made by him during the period of deferral, subject as follows.
(2)No such deferral may be made, and accordingly income withdrawals may not be made, if the person concerned elects in accordance with section 636(5)(a) to defer the purchase of an annuity.
(3)Income withdrawals must not be made after the person concerned if he had purchased such an annuity as is mentioned in section 636 would have ceased to be entitled to payments under it.
(4)Income withdrawals must not in any event be made after the member would have attained the age of 75 or, if earlier, after the person concerned attains the age of 75.
(5)The aggregate amount of income withdrawals by a person in each successive period of twelve months beginning with the date of the member’s death must be not less than 35 per cent. or more than 100 per cent. of the annual amount of the annuity which would have been purchasable by him on the relevant reference date.
(6)For the purposes of this section the relevant reference date for the first three years is the date of the member’s death, and for each succeeding period of three years is the first day of that period.
(7)The right to income withdrawals must not be capable of assignment or surrender.”.
8U.K.For section 637 (lump sum on death of member) substitute—
The lump sum—
(a)must be payable on the death of the member before he attains the age of 75, and
(b)must be payable by an authorised insurance company.
(1)The lump sum must be payable on or after the death of the member and represent no more than the return of contributions together with reasonable interest on contributions or bonuses out of profits, after allowing for any income withdrawals.
To the extent that contributions are invested in units under a unit trust scheme, the lump sum may represent the sale or redemption price of the units.
(2)The lump sum must be payable only if—
(a)no annuity has been purchased by the member under the arrangements in question,
(b)no such annuity as is mentioned in section 636 has been purchased by the person to whom the payment is made, and
(c)the person to whom the payment is made has not elected in accordance with subsection (5)(a) of section 636 to defer the purchase of such an annuity as is mentioned in that section.
(3)Where the member’s death occurs after the date which is his pension date in relation to the arrangements in question, the lump sum must be payable not later than two years after the death.”.
9U.K.In section 638 (other restrictions on approval), after subsection (7) insert—
“(7A)The Board shall not approve a personal pension scheme unless it prohibits, except in such cases as may be prescribed by regulations made by the Board—
(a)the acceptance of further contributions, and
(b)the making of transfer payments,
after the date which is the member’s pension date in relation to the arrangements in question.”.
10U.K.In section 640 (maximum amount of deductions), in subsection (3) (maximum amount to secure death benefit) for “section 637(1)” substitute “ section 637 ”.
11U.K.In section 643 (employer’s contributions and personal pension income, &c.), after subsection (4) insert—
“(5)Income withdrawals under approved personal pension arrangements shall be assessable to tax under Schedule E (and section 203 shall apply accordingly) and shall be treated as earned income of the recipient.”.
12U.K.Omit the heading before section 648A and after that section insert—
(1)Tax shall be charged under this section on any payment to a person under approved personal pension arrangements of such a lump sum as is mentioned in section 637A in a case where the member’s death occurred after his pension date in relation to the arrangement in question.
(2)Where a payment is chargeable to tax under this section, the scheme administrator shall be charged to income tax under Case VI of Schedule D and, subject to subsection (3) below, the rate of tax shall be 35 per cent.
(3)The Treasury may by order from time to time increase or decrease the rate of tax under subsection (2) above.
(4)The tax shall be charged on the amount paid or, if the rules of the scheme permit the scheme administrator to deduct the tax before payment, on the amount before deduction of tax; and the amount so charged to tax shall not be treated as income for any other purpose of the Tax Acts.”.
Section 65.
1U.K.In this Schedule references to section 326 are to section 326 of the Taxes Act 1988 (contractual savings schemes).
2(1)The M206M207following provisions of section 326, namely—U.K.
(a)subsection (2) (schemes governed by regulations made under section 11 of National Debt Act 1972),
(b)subsection (3) (schemes with building societies), and
(c)subsection (4) (schemes with institutions authorised under Banking Act 1987),
shall be amended as mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) below.
(2)In each subsection for the M208words “a scheme” (where they first occur) there shall be substituted “ a share option linked scheme ”.
(3)This paragraph shall apply in relation to schemes not certified as mentioned in section 326(2)(c), (3)(b) or (4)(b) before 1st December 1994.
3(1)Section 326 shall be further amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) (relief for sums payable in respect of bank deposits etc.) after paragraph (c) there shall be inserted “or
(d)in respect of money paid to a relevant European institution,”.
(3)In subsection (2) (meaning of certified scheme except in relation to institutions authorised under Banking Act 1987 etc.) after “1987” there shall be inserted “ or a relevant European institution ”.
(4)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(5)In this section “certified contractual savings scheme” means, in relation to a relevant European institution, a share option linked scheme—
(a)providing for periodical contributions by individuals for a specified period, and
(b)certified by the Treasury as corresponding to a scheme certified under subsection (2) above, and as qualifying for exemption under this section.”
(5)Sub-paragraph (2) above shall apply in relation to schemes established after the day on which this Act is passed.
4(1)Section 326 shall be further amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In each of the M209following provisions, namely—
(a)subsection (3)(b) (Treasury certification of schemes with building societies),
(b)subsection (4)(b) (Treasury certification of schemes with institutions authorised under Banking Act 1987), and
(c)subsection (5)(b) (inserted by paragraph 3 above),
for the words “corresponding to a scheme certified under subsection (2) above” there shall be substituted “ fulfilling such requirements as the Treasury may specify for the purposes of this section ”.
(3)This paragraph shall apply in relation to schemes not certified as mentioned in section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) or (5)(b) before such day as the Treasury may by order made by statutory instrument appoint.
Commencement Information
I13Sch. 12 para. 4 in force at Royal Assent, but with effect from 31.7.1995 by S.I. 1995/1778, art. 2
Marginal Citations
5(1)Section 326 shall be further amended by inserting the following subsections after subsection (5) (inserted by paragraph 3 above)—U.K.
“(6)Any terminal bonus, interest or other sum payable under a scheme shall not be treated as payable under a certified contractual savings scheme for the purposes of this section if—
(a)the contract under which the sum is payable provides for contributions to be made by way of investment in a building society or to be made to an institution authorised under the Banking Act 1987 or to a relevant European institution, and
(b)neither the requirement under subsection (7) below nor that under subsection (8) below is fulfilled.
(7)The requirement under this subsection is that—
(a)when the contract is entered into there is Treasury authorisation for the society or institution concerned to enter into contracts under the scheme, and
(b)the authorisation was given without any conditions being imposed.
(8)The requirement under this subsection is that—
(a)when the contract is entered into there is Treasury authorisation for the society or institution concerned to enter into contracts under the scheme,
(b)the authorisation was given subject to conditions being met, and
(c)the conditions are met when the contract is entered into.”
(2)This paragraph shall apply in relation to schemes not certified as mentioned in section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) or (5)(b) before the day appointed under paragraph 4(3) above.
6(1)Section 326 shall be further amended by inserting the following subsection after subsection (8) (inserted by paragraph 5 above)—U.K.
“(9)Schedule 15A to this Act (which contains provisions supplementing this section) shall have effect.”
(2)The following Schedule shall be inserted after Schedule 15 to the Taxes Act 1988—
1This Schedule shall have effect for the purposes of section 326.
2(1)A share option linked scheme is a scheme under which periodical contributions are to be made by an individual—
(a)who is eligible to participate in (that is, to obtain and exercise rights under) an approved savings-related share option scheme, and
(b)who is to make the contributions for the purpose of enabling him to participate in that approved scheme.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above—
(a)“savings-related share option scheme” has the meaning given by paragraph 1 of Schedule 9, and
(b)“approved” means approved under that Schedule.
3A relevant European institution is an institution which—
(a)is a European authorised institution within the meaning of the M210Banking Co-ordination (Second Council Directive) Regulations 1992, and
(b)may accept deposits in the United Kingdom in accordance with those regulations.
4(1)The requirements which may be specified under section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) or (5)(b) are such requirements as the Treasury think fit.
(2)In particular, the requirements may relate to—
(a)the descriptions of individuals who may enter into contracts under a scheme;
(b)the contributions to be paid by individuals;
(c)the sums to be paid or repaid to individuals.
(3)The requirements which may be specified under any of the relevant provisions may be different from those specified under any of the other relevant provisions; and the relevant provisions are section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) and (5)(b).
5(1)Where a specification has been made under section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) or (5)(b) the Treasury may—
(a)withdraw the specification and any certification made by reference to the specification, and
(b)stipulate the date on which the withdrawal is to become effective.
(2)No withdrawal under this paragraph shall affect—
(a)the operation of the scheme before the stipulated date, or
(b)any contract entered into before that date.
(3)No withdrawal under this paragraph shall be effective unless the Treasury—
(a)send a notice by post to each relevant body informing it of the withdrawal, and
(b)do so not less than 28 days before the stipulated date;
and a relevant body is a society or institution authorised (whether unconditionally or subject to conditions being met) to enter into contracts under the scheme concerned.
6(1)Where a specification has been made under section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) or (5)(b) the Treasury may—
(a)vary the specification,
(b)withdraw any certification made by reference to the specification obtaining before the variation, and
(c)stipulate the date on which the variation and withdrawal are to become effective;
and the Treasury may at any time certify a scheme as fulfilling the requirements obtaining after the variation.
(2)No variation and withdrawal under this paragraph shall affect—
(a)the operation of the scheme before the stipulated date, or
(b)any contract entered into before that date.
(3)No variation and withdrawal under this paragraph shall be effective unless the Treasury—
(a)send a notice by post to each relevant body informing it of the variation and withdrawal, and
(b)do so not less than 28 days before the stipulated date;
and a relevant body is a society or institution authorised (whether unconditionally or subject to conditions being met) to enter into contracts under the scheme concerned.
7(1)The Treasury may authorise a society or institution under section 326(7) or (8) as regards schemes generally or as regards a particular scheme or particular schemes.
(2)More than one authorisation may be given to the same society or institution.
8(1)Where an authorisation has been given under section 326(7) or (8) the Treasury may withdraw the authorisation and stipulate the date on which the withdrawal is to become effective; and the withdrawal shall have effect as regards any contract not entered into before the stipulated date.
(2)No withdrawal under this paragraph shall be effective unless the Treasury—
(a)send a notice by post to the society or institution concerned informing it of the withdrawal, and
(b)do so not less than 28 days before the stipulated date.
(3)A withdrawal of an authorisation shall not affect the Treasury’s power to give another authorisation or other authorisations.
9(1)Where an authorisation has been given under section 326(7) the Treasury may—
(a)stipulate that the authorisation is to be varied by being treated as given subject to specified conditions being met, and
(b)stipulate the date on which the variation is to become effective.
(2)As regards any contract entered into on or after the stipulated date the authorisation shall be treated as having been given under section 326(8) subject to the conditions being met.
(3)No variation under this paragraph shall be effective unless the Treasury—
(a)send a notice by post to the society or institution concerned informing it of the variation, and
(b)do so not less than 28 days before the stipulated date.
10(1)Where an authorisation has been given under section 326(8) the Treasury may withdraw the conditions and stipulate the date on which the withdrawal is to become effective.
(2)As regards any contract entered into on or after the stipulated date the authorisation shall be treated as having been given under section 326(7) without any conditions being imposed.
11(1)Where an authorisation has been given under section 326(8) the Treasury may vary the conditions and stipulate the date on which the variation is to become effective; and the variation shall have effect as regards any contract entered into on or after the stipulated date.
(2)No variation under this paragraph shall be effective unless the Treasury—
(a)send a notice by post to the society or institution concerned informing it of the variation, and
(b)do so not less than 28 days before the stipulated date.
12(1)If the Treasury act as regards an authorisation under a relevant paragraph, the paragraph concerned shall have effect subject to their power to act later, as regards the same authorisation, under the same or (as the case may be) another relevant paragraph.
(2)If the Treasury act later as mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) above that sub-paragraph shall apply again, and so on however many times they act as regards an authorisation.
(3)If the Treasury act as regards an authorisation under a relevant paragraph the paragraph concerned shall have effect subject to their power to act later, as regards the same authorisation, under paragraph 8 above.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph the relevant paragraphs are paragraphs 9 to 11 above.”
Marginal Citations
7(1)Any terminal bonus, interest or other sum payable under a scheme shall not be treated as payable under a certified contractual savings scheme for the purposes of section 326 if—U.K.
(a)the scheme is not a share option linked scheme, and
(b)the contract under which the sum is payable is not entered into before 1st December 1994.
(2)Any terminal bonus, interest or other sum payable under a scheme shall not be treated as payable under a certified contractual savings scheme for the purposes of section 326 if—
(a)the contract under which the sum is payable provides for contributions to be made by way of investment in a building society or to be made to [F144a person falling within section 840A(1)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988] or to a relevant European institution,
(b)the scheme is certified as mentioned in section 326(3)(b), (4)(b) or (5)(b) before the day appointed under paragraph 4(3) above, and
(c)the contract is not entered into before that day.
(3)In this paragraph “relevant European institution” have the same meanings as in section 326. ” and “
Textual Amendments
F144Words in Sch. 12 para. 7(2)(a) substituted (1.12.2001) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 91(1)(2)
8(1)The Treasury may by regulations provide that at the beginning of the day appointed under paragraph 4(3) above Treasury authorisation shall be treated as given under section 326(7) to any specified relevant body without any conditions being imposed.U.K.
(2)The Treasury may by regulations provide that—
(a)at the beginning of the day appointed under paragraph 4(3) above Treasury authorisation shall be treated as given under section 326(8) to any specified relevant body subject to conditions being met;
(b)the conditions as regards a body shall be such as are specified in, or identified by provision contained in, the regulations as regards that body.
(3)Any authorisation treated as given as mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) or (2) above shall be treated as given as regards schemes generally; but this is subject to any provision to the contrary in the regulations.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph the following are relevant bodies—
(a)any building society;
[F145(b)any person falling within section 840A(1)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988;]
(c)any relevant European institution.
(5)In this paragraph—
(a)“relevant European institution” has the same meaning as in section 326;
(b)“specified” means specified in the regulations.
(6)Regulations under this paragraph shall be made by statutory instrument subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
Textual Amendments
F145Sch. 12 para. 8(4)(b) substituted (1.12.2001) by S.I. 2001/3629, art. 91(3)
Section 67.
1U.K.The M211Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 shall be amended as mentioned in this Schedule.
Marginal Citations
2(1)Section 150A (enterprise investment scheme) shall be amended as mentioned in sub-paragraphs (2) to (4) below; and the amendments made by sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) below shall apply in relation to shares issued on or after 1st January 1994.U.K.
(2)The following subsection shall be inserted after subsection (2)—
“(2A)Notwithstanding anything in section 16(2), subsection (2) above shall not apply to a disposal on which a loss accrues.”
(3)In subsection (3) (reduction of relief) the following paragraph shall be inserted after paragraph (a)—
“(aa)the amount of the reduction is not found under section 289A(2)(b) of that Act, and”.
(4)The following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (8) (which disapplies provisions about exchanges, reconstructions or amalgamations in certain circumstances)—
“(8A)Subsection (8) above shall not have effect to disapply section 135 or 136 where—
(a)the new holding consists of new ordinary shares carrying no present or future preferential right to dividends or to a company’s assets on its winding up and no present or future preferential right to be redeemed,
(b)the new shares are issued on or after 29th November 1994 and after the end of the relevant period, and
(c)the condition in subsection (8B) below is satisfied.
(8B)The condition is that at some time before the issue of the new shares—
(a)the company issuing them issued eligible shares, and
(b)a certificate in relation to those eligible shares was issued by the company for the purposes of subsection (2) of section 306 of the Taxes Act and in accordance with that section.
(8C)In subsection (8A) above—
(a)“new holding” shall be construed in accordance with sections 126, 127, 135 and 136;
(b)“relevant period” means the period found by applying section 312(1A)(a) of the Taxes Act by reference to the company issuing the shares referred to in subsection (8) above and by reference to those shares.”
3U.K.The following section shall be inserted after section 150A—
(1)This section has effect where section 150A(2) applies on a disposal of eligible shares, and before the disposal but on or after 29th November 1994—
(a)value is received in circumstances where relief attributable to the shares is reduced by an amount under section 300(1A)(a) of the Taxes Act,
(b)there is a repayment, redemption, repurchase or payment in circumstances where relief attributable to the shares is reduced by an amount under section 303(1A)(a) of that Act, or
(c)paragraphs (a) and (b) above apply.
(2)If section 150A(2) applies on the disposal but section 150A(3) does not, section 150A(2) shall apply only to so much of the gain as remains after deducting so much of it as is found by multiplying it by the fraction—
(a)whose numerator is equal to the amount by which the relief attributable to the shares is reduced as mentioned in subsection (1) above, and
(b)whose denominator is equal to the amount of the relief attributable to the shares.
(3)If section 150A(2) and (3) apply on the disposal, section 150A(2) shall apply only to so much of the gain as is found by—
(a)taking the part of the gain found under section 150A(3), and
(b)deducting from that part so much of it as is found by multiplying it by the fraction mentioned in subsection (2) above.
(4)Where the relief attributable to the shares is reduced as mentioned in subsection (1) above by more than one amount, the numerator mentioned in subsection (2) above shall be taken to be equal to the aggregate of the amounts.
(5)The denominator mentioned in subsection (2) above shall be found without regard to any reduction mentioned in subsection (1) above.
(6)Subsections (11) and (12) of section 150A apply for the purposes of this section as they apply for the purposes of that section.”
4(1)The following section shall be inserted after section 150B—U.K.
Schedule 5B to this Act (which provides relief in respect of re-investment under the enterprise investment scheme) shall have effect.”
(2)In section 260, after subsection (6) (no reduction in the case of certain disposals in respect of held-over gains), there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(6A)Subsection (3) above does not apply, so far as any gain accruing in accordance with paragraphs 4 and 5 of Schedule 5B is concerned, in relation to the disposal which constitutes the chargeable event by virtue of which that gain accrues.”
(3)The following Schedule shall be inserted after Schedule 5A—
1(1)This Schedule applies where—
(a)there would (apart from paragraph 2(2)(a) below) be a chargeable gain (“the original gain”) accruing to an individual (“the investor”) at any time (“the accrual time”) on or after 29th November 1994;
(b)the gain is one accruing either on the disposal by the investor of any asset or in accordance with paragraphs 4 and 5 below or paragraphs 4 and 5 of Schedule 5C;
(c)the investor makes a qualifying investment; and
(d)the investor is resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom at the accrual time and the time when he makes the qualifying investment and is not, in relation to the qualifying investment, a person to whom sub-paragraph (4) below applies.
(2)The investor makes a qualifying investment for the purposes of this Schedule if—
(a)he subscribes for any shares to which any relief given to him under Chapter III of Part VII of the Taxes Act is attributable;
(b)those shares are issued at a qualifying time; and
(c)where that time is before the accrual time, those shares are still held by the investor at the accrual time;
and in this Schedule “relevant shares”, in relation to a case to which this Schedule applies, means any of the shares which are acquired by the investor in making the qualifying investment.
(3)In this Schedule “a qualifying time”, in relation to any shares subscribed for by the investor, means—
(a)any time in the period beginning one year before and ending three years after the accrual time, or
(b)any such time before the beginning of that period or after it ends as the Board may by notice allow.
(4)This sub-paragraph applies to the investor in relation to a qualifying investment if—
(a)though resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom at the time when he makes the investment, he is regarded for the purposes of any double taxation relief arrangements as resident in a territory outside the United Kingdom, and
(b)were section 150A to be disregarded, the arrangements would have the effect that he would not be liable in the United Kingdom to tax on a gain arising on a disposal, immediately after their acquisition, of the shares acquired in making that investment.
2(1)On the making of a claim by the investor for the purposes of this Schedule, so much of the investor’s unused qualifying expenditure on relevant shares as—
(a)is specified in the claim, and
(b)does not exceed so much of the original gain as is unmatched,
shall be set against a corresponding amount of the original gain.
(2)Where an amount of qualifying expenditure on any relevant shares is set under this Schedule against the whole or part of the original gain—
(a)so much of that gain as is equal to that amount shall be treated as not having accrued at the accrual time; but
(b)paragraphs 4 and 5 below shall apply for determining the gain that is to be treated as accruing on the occurrence of any chargeable event in relation to any of those relevant shares.
(3)For the purposes of this Schedule—
(a)the investor’s qualifying expenditure on any relevant shares is so much of the amount subscribed by him for the shares as represents the amount in respect of which there is given the relief under section 289A of the Taxes Act which is attributable to those shares; and
(b)that expenditure is unused to the extent that it has not already been set under this Schedule against the whole or any part of a chargeable gain.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph the original gain is unmatched, in relation to any qualifying expenditure on relevant shares, to the extent that it has not had any other expenditure set against it under this Schedule or Schedule 5C.
3(1)Subject to the following provisions of this paragraph, there is for the purposes of this Schedule a chargeable event in relation to any relevant shares if, after the making of the qualifying investment—
(a)the investor disposes of those shares otherwise than by way of a disposal within marriage;
(b)those shares are disposed of, otherwise than by way of a disposal to the investor, by a person who acquired them on a disposal made by the investor within marriage;
(c)the investor becomes a non-resident while holding those shares and within the first relevant period;
(d)a person who acquired those shares on a disposal within marriage becomes a non-resident while holding those shares and within the first relevant period;
(e)the company that issued those shares ceases to be a qualifying company within the second relevant period; or
(f)the relief given under section 289A of the Taxes Act in respect of the amount subscribed for those shares is withdrawn or reduced in circumstances not falling within any of paragraphs (a) to (e) above.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) above—
(a)the first relevant period in the case of any relevant shares is the period found by applying section 312(1A)(a) of the Taxes Act by reference to the company that issued the shares and by reference to the shares;
(b)the second relevant period in the case of any shares is the period found by applying section 312(1A)(b) of that Act by reference to the company that issued the shares and by reference to the shares; and
(c)whether a company is a qualifying company at any given time shall be determined in accordance with section 293 of that Act.
(3)For the purposes of this Schedule there shall not be a chargeable event by virtue of sub-paragraph (1)(c) or (d) above in relation to any shares if—
(a)the reason why the person in question becomes a non-resident is that he works in an employment or office all the duties of which are performed outside the United Kingdom, and
(b)he again becomes resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom within the period of three years from the time when he became a non-resident, without having meanwhile disposed of any of those shares;
and accordingly no assessment shall be made by virtue of sub-paragraph (1)(c) or (d) above before the end of that period in a case where the condition in paragraph (a) above is satisfied and the condition in paragraph (b) above may be satisfied.
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) above a person shall be taken to have disposed of any shares if and only if there has been such a disposal as would have been a chargeable event in relation to those shares if the person making the disposal had been resident in the United Kingdom.
(5)Where in any case—
(a)the investor or a person who has acquired any relevant shares on a disposal within marriage dies, and
(b)an event occurs at or after the time of the death which (apart from this sub-paragraph) would be a chargeable event in relation to any relevant shares held by the deceased immediately before his death,
that event shall not be a chargeable event in relation to the shares so held.
4(1)On the occurrence of a chargeable event in relation to any relevant shares in relation to which there has not been a previous chargeable event—
(a)a chargeable gain shall be treated as accruing at the time of the event; and
(b)the amount of the gain shall be equal to so much of the original gain as is an amount against which there has under this Schedule been set any expenditure on those shares.
(2)Any question for the purposes of this Schedule as to whether any relevant shares to which a chargeable event relates are shares the expenditure on which has under this Schedule been set against the whole or any part of any gain shall be determined in accordance with the assumptions for which sub-paragraph (3) below provides.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) above it shall be assumed, in relation to any disposal of shares (including a disposal within marriage) that—
(a)as between qualifying shares acquired by the same person on different days, those acquired on an earlier day are disposed of by that person before those acquired on a later day; and
(b)as between qualifying shares acquired by the same person on the same day, those the expenditure on which has been set under this Schedule against the whole or any part of any gain are disposed of by that person only after he has disposed of any other qualifying shares acquired by him on that day.
(4)In sub-paragraph (3) above “qualifying shares” means any shares which—
(a)were subscribed for by a person eligible for relief in respect of those shares under Chapter III of Part VII of the Taxes Act (the enterprise investment scheme), and
(b)are shares in respect of which relief is given under section 289A of that Act in respect of the whole or any part of the amount subscribed.
(5)Where at the time of a chargeable event any relevant shares are treated for the purposes of this Act as represented by assets which consist of or include assets other than those shares—
(a)the expenditure on those shares which was set against the gain in question shall be treated, in determining for the purposes of this paragraph the amount of expenditure on each of those assets which is to be treated as having been set against that gain, as apportioned in such manner as may be just and reasonable between those assets; and
(b)as between different assets treated as representing the same relevant shares, the assumptions for which sub-paragraph (3) above provides shall apply with the necessary modifications in relation to those assets as they would apply in relation to the shares.
5(1)The chargeable gain which accrues, in accordance with paragraph 4 above, on the occurrence in relation to any relevant shares of a chargeable event shall be treated as accruing, as the case may be—
(a)to the person who makes the disposal,
(b)to the person who becomes a non-resident,
(c)to the person who holds the shares in question when the company ceases to be a qualifying company, or
(d)to the person who holds the shares in question when the circumstances arise in respect of which the relief is withdrawn or reduced.
(2)Where—
(a)sub-paragraph (1) above provides for the holding of shares at a particular time to be what identifies the person to whom any chargeable gain accrues, and
(b)at that time, some of those shares are held by the investor and others are held by a person to whom the investor has transferred them by a disposal within marriage,
the amount of the chargeable gain accruing by virtue of paragraph 4 above shall be computed separately in relation to the investor and that person without reference to the shares held by the other.
6(1)In this Schedule “non-resident” means a person who is neither resident nor ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom.
(2)In this Schedule references to a disposal within marriage are references to any disposal to which section 58 applies.
(3)Notwithstanding anything in section 288(5), shares shall not for the purposes of this Schedule be treated as issued by reason only of being comprised in a letter of allotment or similar instrument.
(4)Chapter III of Part VII of the Taxes Act shall apply for the purposes of this Schedule to determine whether and to what extent any relief under that Chapter is attributable to any shares.
(5)References in this Schedule to Chapter III of Part VII of the Taxes Act or any provision of that Chapter are to that Chapter or provision as it applies in relation to shares issued on or after 1st January 1994.”
(4)This paragraph has effect in relation to gains accruing and events occurring on or after 29th November 1994.
Section 70.
Section 71.
Section 72.
1(1)This Schedule applies where—U.K.
(a)there would (apart from paragraph 2(2)(a) below) be a chargeable gain (“the original gain”) accruing to an individual (“the investor”) at any time (“the accrual time”) on or after 6th April 1995;
(b)that gain is one accruing on the disposal by the investor of any asset or in accordance with paragraphs 4 and 5 of Schedule 5B or paragraphs 4 and 5 below;
(c)the investor makes a qualifying investment; and
(d)the investor is resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom at the accrual time and the time when he makes the qualifying investment and is not, in relation to the qualifying investment, a person to whom sub-paragraph (4) below applies.
(2)The investor makes a qualifying investment for the purposes of this Schedule if—
(a)he subscribes for any shares by reference to which he is given relief under Part I of Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act on any amount;
(b)those shares are issued at a qualifying time; and
(c)where that time is before the accrual time, those shares are still held by the investor at the accrual time;
and in this Schedule “
”, in relation to a case to which this Schedule applies, means any of the shares in a venture capital trust which are acquired by the investor in making the qualifying investment.(3)In this Schedule “a qualifying time”, in relation to any shares subscribed for by the investor, means—
(a)any time in the period beginning twelve months before the accrual time and ending twelve months after the accrual time, or
(b)any such time before the beginning of that period or after it ends as the Board may by notice allow.
(4)This sub-paragraph applies to an individual in relation to a qualifying investment if—
(a)though resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom at the time when he makes the investment, he is regarded for the purposes of any double taxation relief arrangements as resident in a territory outside the United Kingdom; and
(b)were section 151A(1) to be disregarded, the arrangements would have the effect that he would not be liable in the United Kingdom to tax on a gain arising on a disposal, immediately after their acquisition, of the shares acquired in making that investment.
2(1)On the making of a claim by the investor for the purposes of this Schedule, so much of the investor’s unused qualifying expenditure on relevant shares as—U.K.
(a)is specified in the claim, and
(b)does not exceed so much of the original gain as is unmatched,
shall be set against a corresponding amount of the original gain.
(2)Where the amount of any qualifying expenditure on any relevant shares is set under this Schedule against the whole or any part of the original gain—
(a)so much of that gain as is equal to that amount shall be treated as not having accrued at the accrual time; but
(b)paragraphs 4 and 5 below shall apply for determining the gain that is to be treated as accruing on the occurrence of any chargeable event in relation to any of those relevant shares.
(3)For the purposes of this Schedule, but subject to the following provisions of this paragraph—
(a)the investor’s qualifying expenditure on any relevant shares is the sum equal to the amount on which he is given relief under Part I of Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act by reference to those shares; and
(b)that expenditure is unused to the extent that it has not already been set under this Schedule against the whole or any part of a chargeable gain.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph the original gain is unmatched, in relation to any qualifying expenditure on relevant shares, to the extent that it has not had any other amount set against it under this Schedule or Schedule 5B.
3(1)Subject to the following provisions of this paragraph, there is for the purposes of this Schedule a chargeable event in relation to any relevant shares if, after the making of the qualifying investment—U.K.
(a)the investor disposes of those shares otherwise than by way of a disposal within marriage;
(b)those shares are disposed of, otherwise than by way of a disposal to the investor, by a person who acquired them on a disposal made by the investor within marriage;
(c)there is, in a case where those shares fall within section 151B(3)(c), such an actual or deemed exchange of those shares for any non-qualifying holdings as, under section 135 or 136, requires, or but for section 116 would require, those holdings to be treated for the purposes of this Act as the same assets as those shares;
(d)the investor becomes a non-resident while holding those shares and within the relevant period;
(e)a person who acquired those shares on a disposal within marriage becomes a non-resident while holding those shares and within the relevant period;
(f)the company in which those shares are shares has its approval as a venture capital trust withdrawn in a case to which section 842AA(8) of the Taxes Act does not apply; or
(g)the relief given under Part I of Schedule 15B to the Taxes Act by reference to those shares is withdrawn or reduced in circumstances not falling within any of paragraphs (a) to (f) above.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above—
“non-qualifying holdings” means any shares or securities other than any ordinary shares (within the meaning of section 151A) in a venture capital trust; and
“the relevant period”, in relation to any relevant shares, means the period of five years beginning with the time when the investor made the qualifying investment by virtue of which he acquired those shares.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) above there shall not be a chargeable event by virtue of sub-paragraph (1)(d) or (e) above in relation to any shares if—
(a)the reason why the person in question becomes a non-resident is that he works in an employment or office all the duties of which are performed outside the United Kingdom, and
(b)he again becomes resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom within the period of three years from the time when he became a non-resident, without having meanwhile disposed of any of those shares;
and, accordingly, no assessment shall be made by virtue of sub-paragraph (1)(d) or (e) above before the end of that period in any case where the condition in paragraph (a) above is satisfied and the condition in paragraph (b) above may be satisfied.
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) above a person shall be taken to have disposed of any shares if and only if there has been such a disposal as would, if the person making the disposal had been resident in the United Kingdom, have been a chargeable event in relation to those shares.
(5)Where in any case—
(a)the investor or a person who has acquired any relevant shares on a disposal within marriage dies, and
(b)an event occurs at or after the time of the death which (apart from this sub-paragraph) would be a chargeable event in relation to any relevant shares held by the deceased immediately before his death,
that event shall not be a chargeable event in relation to the shares so held.
(6)Without prejudice to the operation of paragraphs 4 and 5 below in a case falling within sub-paragraph (1)(f) above, the references in this paragraph to a disposal shall not include references to the disposal which by virtue of section 151B(6) is deemed to take place in such a case.
4(1)On the occurrence of a chargeable event in relation to any relevant shares in relation to which there has not been a previous chargeable event—U.K.
(a)a chargeable gain shall be treated as accruing at the time of the event; and
(b)the amount of the gain shall be equal to so much of the original gain as is an amount against which there has under this Schedule been set any expenditure on those shares.
(2)In determining for the purposes of this Schedule any question whether any shares to which a chargeable event relates are shares the expenditure on which has under this Schedule been set against the whole or any part of any gain, the assumptions in sub-paragraph (3) below shall apply and, in a case where the shares are not (within the meaning of section 151B) eligible for relief under section 151A(1), shall apply notwithstanding anything in any of sections 104, 105 and 107.
(3)Those assumptions are that—
(a)as between shares acquired by the same person on different days, those acquired on an earlier day are disposed of by that person before those acquired on a later day; and
(b)as between shares in a company that were acquired on the same day, those the expenditure on which has been set under this Schedule against the whole or any part of any gain are disposed of by that person only after he has disposed of any other shares in that company that were acquired by him on that day.
(4)Where at the time of a chargeable event any relevant shares are treated for the purposes of this Act as represented by assets which consist of or include assets other than the relevant shares—
(a)the expenditure on those shares which was set against the gain in question shall be treated, in determining for the purposes of this paragraph the amount of expenditure on each of those assets which is to be treated as having been set against that gain, as apportioned in such manner as may be just and reasonable between those assets; and
(b)as between different assets treated as representing the same relevant shares, the assumptions mentioned in sub-paragraph (3) above shall apply with the necessary modifications in relation to those assets as they would apply in relation to the shares.
5(1)The chargeable gain which accrues in accordance with paragraph 4 above on the occurrence in relation to any relevant shares of a chargeable event shall be treated as accruing, as the case may be—U.K.
(a)to the person who makes the disposal,
(b)to the person who holds the shares in question at the time of the exchange or deemed exchange,
(c)to the person who becomes a non-resident,
(d)to the person who holds the shares in question when the withdrawal of the approval takes effect, or
(e)to the person who holds the shares in question when the circumstances arise in respect of which the relief is withdrawn or reduced.
(2)Where—
(a)sub-paragraph (1) above provides for the holding of shares at a particular time to be what identifies the person to whom any chargeable gain accrues, and
(b)at that time, some of those shares are held by the investor and others are held by a person to whom the investor has transferred them by a disposal within marriage,
the amount of the chargeable gain accruing by virtue of paragraph 4 above shall be computed separately in relation to the investor and that person without reference to the shares held by the other.
6(1)In this Schedule “non-resident” means a person who is neither resident nor ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom.U.K.
(2)In this Schedule references to a disposal within marriage are references to any disposal to which section 58 applies.
(3)Notwithstanding anything in section 288(5), shares shall not for the purposes of this Schedule be treated as issued by reason only of being comprised in a letter of allotment or similar instrument.
Section 74.
1U.K.In Part XV of the Taxes Act 1988 (settlements) the following provisions are inserted (in place of sections 660 to 676 and 683 to 685) as Chapter IA—
(1)Income arising under a settlement during the life of the settlor shall be treated for all purposes of the Income Tax Acts as the income of the settlor and not as the income of any other person unless the income arises from property in which the settlor has no interest.
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section, a settlor shall be regarded as having an interest in property if that property or any derived property is, or will or may become, payable to or applicable for the benefit of the settlor or his spouse in any circumstances whatsoever.
(3)The reference in subsection (2) above to the spouse of the settlor does not include—
(a)a person to whom the settlor is not for the time being married but may later marry, or
(b)a spouse from whom the settlor is separated under an order of a court, or under a separation agreement or in such circumstances that the separation is likely to be permanent, or
(c)the widow or widower of the settlor.
(4)A settlor shall not be regarded as having an interest in property by virtue of subsection (2) above if and so long as none of that property, and no derived property, can become payable or applicable as mentioned in that subsection except in the event of—
(a)the bankruptcy of some person who is or may become beneficially entitled to the property or any derived property, or
(b)an assignment of or charge on the property or any derived property being made or given by some such person, or
(c)in the case of a marriage settlement, the death of both parties to the marriage and of all or any of the children of the marriage, or
(d)the death of a child of the settlor who had become beneficially entitled to the property or any derived property at an age not exceeding 25.
(5)A settlor shall not be regarded as having an interest in property by virtue of subsection (2) above if and so long as some person is alive and under the age of 25 during whose life that property, or any derived property, cannot become payable or applicable as mentioned in that subsection except in the event of that person becoming bankrupt or assigning or charging his interest in the property or any derived property.
(6)The reference in subsection (1) above to a settlement does not include an outright gift by one spouse to the other of property from which income arises, unless—
(a)the gift does not carry a right to the whole of that income, or
(b)the property given is wholly or substantially a right to income.
For this purpose a gift is not an outright gift if it is subject to conditions, or if the property given or any derived property is or will or may become, in any circumstances whatsoever, payable to or applicable for the benefit of the donor.
(7)The reference in subsection (1) above to a settlement does not include an irrevocable allocation of pension rights by one spouse to the other in accordance with the terms of a relevant statutory scheme (within the meaning of Chapter I of Part XIV).
(8)Subsection (1) above does not apply to income arising under a settlement made by one party to a marriage by way of provision for the other—
(a)after the dissolution or annulment of the marriage, or
(b)while they are separated under an order of a court, or under a separation agreement or in such circumstances that the separation is likely to be permanent,
being income payable to or applicable for the benefit of that other party.
(9)Subsection (1) above does not apply to income consisting of—
(a)annual payments made by an individual for bona fide commercial reasons in connection with his trade, profession or vocation; or
(b)covenanted payments to charity (as defined by section 347A(7)).
(10)In this section “derived property”, in relation to any property, means income from that property or any other property directly or indirectly representing proceeds of, or of income from, that property or income therefrom.
(1)Income arising under a settlement which does not fall to be treated as income of the settlor under section 660A but which during the life of the settlor is paid to or for the benefit of an unmarried minor child of the settlor in any year of assessment shall be treated for all the purposes of the Income Tax Acts as the income of the settlor for that year and not as the income of any other person.
(2)Where income arising under a settlement is retained or accumulated by the trustees, any payment whatsoever made thereafter by virtue or in consequence of the settlement, or any enactment relating thereto, to or for the benefit of an unmarried minor child of the settlor shall be deemed for the purposes of subsection (1) above to be a payment of income if or to the extent that there is available retained or accumulated income.
(3)There shall be taken to be available retained or accumulated income at any time when the aggregate amount of the income which has arisen under the settlement since it was made or entered into exceeds the aggregate amount of income so arising which has been—
(a)treated as income of the settlor or a beneficiary, or
(b)paid (whether as income or capital) to or for the benefit of a beneficiary other than an unmarried minor child of the settlor, or
(c)applied in defraying expenses of the trustees which were properly chargeable to income (or would have been so chargeable but for any express provisions of the trust).
(4)Where an offshore income gain (within the meaning of Chapter V of Part XVII) accrues in respect of a disposal of assets made by a trustee holding them for a person who would be absolutely entitled as against the trustee but for being a minor, the income which by virtue of section 761(1) is treated as arising by reference to that gain shall for the purposes of this section be deemed to be paid to that person.
(5)Income paid to or for the benefit of a child of a settlor shall not be treated as provided in subsection (1) above for a year of assessment in which the aggregate amount paid to or for the benefit of that child which but for this subsection would be so treated does not exceed £100.
(6)In this section—
(a)“child” includes a stepchild and an illegitimate child;
(b)“minor” means a person under the age of 18 years, and “minor child” shall be construed accordingly; and
(c)references to payments include payments in money or money’s worth.
(1)Tax chargeable by virtue of this Chapter shall be charged under Case VI of Schedule D.
(2)In computing the liability to income tax of a settlor chargeable by virtue of this Chapter the same deductions and reliefs shall be allowed as would have been allowed if the income treated as his by virtue of this Chapter had been received by him.
(3)Subject to section 833(3), income which is treated by virtue of this Chapter as income of a settlor shall be deemed for the purposes of this section to be the highest part of his income.
(1)Where by virtue of this Chapter income tax becomes chargeable on and is paid by a settlor, he is entitled—
(a)to recover from any trustee, or any other person to whom the income is payable by virtue or in consequence of the settlement, the amount of the tax so paid; and
(b)for that purpose to require an officer of the Board to furnish to him a certificate specifying the amount of income in respect of which he has so paid tax and the amount of tax so paid.
A certificate so furnished is conclusive evidence of the facts stated therein.
(2)Where a person obtains, in respect of an allowance or relief, a repayment of income tax in excess of the amount of the repayment to which he would, but for this Chapter, have been entitled, an amount equal to the excess shall be paid by him to the trustee, or other person to whom the income is payable by virtue or in consequence of the settlement, or, where there are two or more such persons, shall be apportioned among those persons as the case may require.
If any question arises as to the amount of a payment or as to an apportionment to be made under this subsection, that question shall be decided by the General Commissioners whose decision shall be final.
(3)Nothing in this Chapter shall be construed as excluding a charge to tax on the trustees as persons by whom any income is received.
(1)In the case of a settlement where there is more than one settlor, this Chapter shall have effect in relation to each settlor as if he were the only settlor, as follows.
(2)In this Chapter, in relation to a settlor—
(a)references to the property comprised in a settlement include only property originating from that settlor, and
(b)references to income arising under the settlement include only income originating from that settlor.
(3)For the purposes of section 660B there shall be taken into account, in relation to a settlor, as income paid to or for the benefit of a child of the settlor only—
(a)income originating from that settlor, and
(b)in a case in which section 660B(2) applies, payments which are under that provision (as adapted by subsection (4) below) to be deemed to be payments of income.
(4)In applying section 660B(2) to a settlor—
(a)the reference to income arising under the settlement includes only income originating from that settlor; and
(b)the reference to any payment made by virtue or in consequence of the settlement or any enactment relating thereto includes only a payment made out of property originating from that settlor or income originating from that settlor.
(5)References in this section to property originating from a settlor are references to—
(a)property which that settlor has provided directly or indirectly for the purposes of the settlement; and
(b)property representing that property; and
(c)so much of any property which represents both property so provided and other property as, on a just apportionment, represents the property so provided.
(6)References in this section to income originating from a settlor are references to—
(a)income from property originating from that settlor; and
(b)income provided directly or indirectly by that settlor.
(7)In subsections (5) and (6) above—
(a)references to property or income which a settlor has provided directly or indirectly include references to property or income which has been provided directly or indirectly by another person in pursuance of reciprocal arrangements with that settlor, but do not include references to property or income which that settlor has provided directly or indirectly in pursuance of reciprocal arrangements with another person; and
(b)references to property which represents other property include references to property which represents accumulated income from that other property.
An officer of the Board may by notice require any party to a settlement to furnish him within such time as he may direct (not being less than 28 days) with such particulars as he thinks necessary for the purposes of this Chapter.
(1)In this Chapter—
“settlement” includes any disposition, trust, covenant, agreement, arrangement or transfer of assets, and
“settlor”, in relation to a settlement, means any person by whom the settlement was made.
(2)A person shall be deemed for the purposes of this Chapter to have made a settlement if he has made or entered into the settlement directly or indirectly, and, in particular, but without prejudice to the generality of the preceding words, if he has provided or undertaken to provide funds directly or indirectly for the purpose of the settlement, or has made with any other person a reciprocal arrangement for that other person to make or enter into the settlement.
(3)References in this Chapter to income arising under a settlement include, subject to subsection (4) below, any income chargeable to income tax by deduction or otherwise, and any income which would have been so chargeable if it had been received in the United Kingdom by a person domiciled, resident and ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom.
(4)Where the settlor is not domiciled, or not resident, or not ordinarily resident, in the United Kingdom in a year of assessment, references in this Chapter to income arising under a settlement do not include income arising under the settlement in that year in respect of which the settlor, if he were actually entitled thereto, would not be chargeable to income tax by deduction or otherwise by reason of his not being so domiciled, resident or ordinarily resident.
But where such income is remitted to the United Kingdom in circumstances such that, if the settlor were actually entitled to that income when remitted, he would be chargeable to income tax by reason of his residence in the United Kingdom, it shall be treated for the purposes of this Chapter as arising under the settlement in the year in which it is remitted.”
2U.K.In section 125(3)(a) of the Taxes Act 1988, for the words from “subsection (1)(a)” to the end substitute “ section 660A(8) or (9)(a) ”.
3U.K.In section 339(1)(a) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 660(3)” substitute “ section 347A(7) ”.
4F146(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .U.K.
(2)In section 347A of the Taxes Act 1988, after subsection (6) add—
“(7)In subsection (2)(b) above “a covenanted payment to charity” means a payment made under a covenant made otherwise than for consideration in money or money’s worth in favour of a body of persons or trust established for charitable purposes only whereby the like annual payments (of which the payment in question is one) become payable for a period which may exceed three years and is not capable of earlier termination under any power exercisable without the consent of the persons for the time being entitled to the payments.
(8)For the purposes of subsection (7) above the bodies mentioned in section 507 shall each be treated as a body of persons established for charitable purposes only.”
Textual Amendments
F146Sch. 17 para. 4(1) repealed (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 20 Pt. III(6) Note of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 139, Sch. 20 Pt. III(6) Note
5U.K.In section 360A(2)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 681(4)” substitute “ Chapter IA of Part XV (see section 660G(1) and (2)) ”.
6U.K.In section 417(3)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 681(4)” substitute “ Chapter IA of Part XV (see section 660G(1) and (2)) ”.
7U.K.In section 505(6) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 660(3)” substitute “ section 347A(7) ”.
8U.K.Before section 677 of the Taxes Act 1988 insert the heading—
9(1)Section 677 of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (2)(b) after “the amount of” insert “ that income taken into account under that subsection in relation to ”.
(3)After subsection (2)(f) insert—
“(fa)any income arising under the settlement in that year or any previous year which has been treated as income of the settlor by virtue of section 660A or 660B; and”.
(4)In subsection (9) after “one of the events specified in section 673(3)” insert “ or, in the case of a sum paid on or after 6th April 1995, in one of the events specified in section 660A(4) or on the death under the age of 25 of any such person as is mentioned in section 660A(5) ”.
10U.K.In section 678 of the Taxes Act 1988, omit subsection (7).
11U.K.After section 682 of the Taxes Act 1988 insert—
(1)The provisions of sections 660E to 660G apply for the purposes of this Chapter as they apply for the purposes of Chapter IA.
(2)For the purposes of this Chapter, a body corporate shall be deemed to be connected with a settlement in any year of assessment if at any time in that year—
(a)it is a close company (or only not a close company because it is not resident in the United Kingdom) and the participators then include the trustees of the settlement; or
(b)it is controlled (within the meaning of section 840) by a company falling within paragraph (a) above.”
12U.K.For the heading before section 686 of the Taxes Act 1988 substitute—
13U.K.In section 686 of the Taxes Act 1988 (liability to income tax at rate applicable to trusts), in subsection (2) (income to which the section applies) for paragraph (b) substitute—
“(b)is not, before being distributed, either—
(i)the income of any person other than the trustees, or
(ii)treated for any of the purposes of the Income Tax Acts as the income of a settlor; and”.
14(1)Section 687 of the Taxes Act 1988 (payments under discretionary trusts) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)For subsection (1) (cases in which the section applies) substitute—
“(1)Where in any year of assessment trustees make a payment to any person in the exercise of a discretion, whether a discretion exercisable by them or by any other person, then if the payment—
(a)is for all the purposes of the Income Tax Acts income of the person to whom it is made (but would not be his income if it were not made to him), or
(b)is treated for those purposes as the income of the settlor by virtue of section 660B,
the following provisions of this section apply with respect to the payment in lieu of section 348 or 349(1).”.
(3)In subsection (2)(a) (person credited with having paid tax) after “to whom the payment is made” insert “ or, as the case may be, the settlor ”.
(4)After subsection (4) add—
“(5)References in this section to payments include payments in money or money’s worth.”.
15U.K.Omit section 689 of the Taxes Act 1988 (recovery from trustees of discretionary trusts of higher rate tax due from beneficiaries).
16U.K.In section 694(3) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “Chapters I to IV” substitute “ Chapter IA ”.
17(1)Section 720 of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (6)—
(a)for “Chapters II to IV” substitute “ Chapters IA, IB and IC ”; and
(b)for the words from “(within Chapter II)” to the end substitute “ arising under the settlement ”.
(3)In subsection (7) for “Chapters II to IV” substitute “ Chapters IA, IB and IC ”.
(4)In subsection (8)(a) for “Chapter II, III or IV of Part XV (as the case may be)” substitute “ Chapter IA of Part XV (see section 660G(1) and (2)) ”.
18U.K.In section 745(6) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 681(4)” substitute “ section 660G(1) and (2) ”.
19U.K.In section 783(10)(b) of the Taxes Act 1988, for “section 670(2)” substitute “ section 660G(1) and (2) ”.
20U.K.In section 839(3) of the Taxes Act 1988, for subsection (3) substitute—
“(3)A person, in his capacity as trustee of a settlement, is connected with—
(a)any individual who in relation to the settlement is a settlor,
(b)any person who is connected with such an individual, and
(c)any body corporate which is connected with that settlement.
In this subsection “settlement” and “settlor” have the same meaning as in Chapter IA of Part XV (see section 660G(1) and (2)).
(3A)For the purpose of subsection (3) above a body corporate is connected with a settlement if—
(a)it is a close company (or only not a close company because it is not resident in the United Kingdom) and the participators include the trustees of the settlement; or
(b)it is controlled (within the meaning of section 840) by a company falling within paragraph (a) above.”.
21U.K.In section 27(2) of the Taxes Management Act 1970, for “section 681(4)” substitute “ section 660G(1) and (2) ”.
22U.K.In section 31(3) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 [F147(including that provision as proposed to be substituted by paragraph 7 of Schedule 19 to the M212Finance Act 1994)], for “sections 660 to 685” substitute “ sections 660A to 660G or 677 to 682A ”.
Textual Amendments
F147Words in Sch. 17 para. 22 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 22 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(12) Note
Marginal Citations
23U.K.In column 1 of the Table in section 98 of the Taxes Management Act 1970, for the references to section 669 and 680 of the Taxes Act 1988 substitute “ section 660F ”.
24U.K.In section 59(1)(c) of the Finance Act 1989, for “section 660(3)” substitute “ section 347A(7) ”.
25U.K.In section 60 of the Finance Act 1989, omit subsection (3) and in subsection (4) for “subsections (2) and (3)” substitute “ subsection (2) ”.
26U.K.In section 25(12)(b) of the M213Finance Act 1990, for “section 660(3)” substitute “ section 347A(7) ”.
Marginal Citations
27U.K.For section 77 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (charge on settlor with interest in settlement), substitute—
(1)Where in a year of assessment—
(a)chargeable gains accrue to the trustees of a settlement from the disposal of any or all of the settled property,
(b)after making any deduction provided for by section 2(2) in respect of disposals of the settled property there remains an amount on which the trustees would, disregarding section 3, be chargeable to tax for the year in respect of those gains, and
(c)at any time during the year the settlor has an interest in the settlement,
the trustees shall not be chargeable to tax in respect of those but instead chargeable gains of an amount equal to that referred to in paragraph (b) shall be treated as accruing to the settlor in that year.
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section, a settlor shall be regarded as having an interest in a settlement if—
(a)any property which may at any time be comprised in the settlement, or any derived property is, or will or may become, payable to or applicable for the benefit of the settlor or his spouse in any circumstances whatsoever, or
(b)the settlor or his spouse enjoys a benefit deriving directly or indirectly from any property which is comprised in the settlement or any derived property.
(3)The references in subsection (2)(a) and (b) above to the spouse of the settlor do not include—
(a)a person to whom the settlor is not for the time being married but may later marry, or
(b)a spouse from whom the settlor is separated under an order of a court, or under a separation agreement or in such circumstances that the separation is likely to be permanent, or
(c)the widow or widower of the settlor.
(4)A settlor shall not be regarded as having an interest in a settlement by virtue of subsection (2)(a) above if and so long as none of the property which may at any time be comprised in the settlement, and no derived property, can become payable or applicable as mentioned in that provision except in the event of—
(a)the bankruptcy of some person who is or may become beneficially entitled to the property or any derived property, or
(b)an assignment of or charge on the property or any derived property being made or given by some such person, or
(c)in the case of a marriage settlement, the death of both parties to the marriage and of all or any of the children of the marriage, or
(d)the death of a child of the settlor who had become beneficially entitled to the property or any derived property at an age not exceeding 25.
(5)A settlor shall not be regarded as having an interest in a settlement by virtue of subsection (2)(a) above if and so long as some person is alive and under the age of 25 during whose life the property or any derived property cannot become payable or applicable as mentioned in that provision except in the event of that person becoming bankrupt or assigning or charging his interest in that property.
(6)This section does not apply—
(a)where the settlor dies during the year; or
(b)in a case where the settlor is regarded as having an interest in the settlement by reason only of—
(i)the fact that property is, or will or may become, payable to or applicable for the benefit of his spouse, or
(ii)the fact that a benefit is enjoyed by his spouse,
where the spouse dies, or the settlor and the spouse cease to be married, during the year.
(7)This section does not apply unless the settlor is, and the trustees are, either resident in the United Kingdom during any part of the year or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom during the year.
(8)In this section “derived property”, in relation to any property, means income from that property or any other property directly or indirectly representing proceeds of, or of income from, that property or income therefrom.”.
28U.K.In section 78 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992, in subsections (1), (2) and (3), for “section 77(2)” substitute “ section 77 ”.
29(1)Section 79 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (2) omit paragraph (b) and the word “and” preceding it.
(3)Omit subsection (4).
(4)In subsection (5)—
(a)for “subsections (3) and (4)” substitute “ subsection (3) ”; and
(b)in paragraph (a), omit the words “or income” wherever occurring.
30U.K.In section 97 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992, in subsection (7) for “section 681(4)” substitute “ section 660G(1) and (2) ”.
31U.K.In section 286 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992, for subsection (3) substitute—
“(3)A person, in his capacity as trustee of a settlement, is connected with—
(a)any individual who in relation to the settlement is a settlor,
(b)any person who is connected with such an individual, and
(c)any body corporate which is connected with that settlement.
In this subsection “settlement” and “settlor” have the same meaning as in Chapter IA of Part XV of the Taxes Act (see section 660G(1) and (2) of that Act).
(3A)For the purpose of subsection (3) above a body corporate is connected with a settlement if—
(a)it is a close company (or only not a close company because it is not resident in the United Kingdom) and the participators include the trustees of the settlement; or
(b)it is controlled (within the meaning of section 840 of the Taxes Act) by a company falling within paragraph (a) above.”.
32U.K.In Schedule 1 to the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992, in paragraph 2(7), for “section 681(4)” substitute “ section 660G(1) and (2) ”.
Section 75.
1U.K.Part XVI of the Taxes Act 1988 shall be amended as follows.
2(1)In section 695 (limited interests in residue), the words “subject to subsection (3) below” in subsection (2) shall be omitted, and the following subsection shall be substituted for subsection (3)—U.K.
“(3)Where, on the completion of the administration of the estate, there is an amount which remains payable in respect of that limited interest, that amount shall be deemed for all tax purposes to have been paid to that person as income for the year of assessment in which the administration period ends or, in the case of a sum which is deemed to be paid in respect of an interest that ceased before the end of that period, for the last year of assessment in which that interest was subsisting.”
(2)This paragraph has effect in relation to any estate the administration of which is completed on or after 6th April 1995.
3(1)In section 696 (absolute interests in residue), for subsection (3) there shall be substituted the following subsections—U.K.
“(3)When any sum has been paid during the administration period in respect of that absolute interest, that sum, except so far as it is excluded from the operation of this subsection, shall be deemed for all tax purposes to have been paid to that person as income for the year of assessment in which it was actually paid.
(3A)A payment shall be excluded from the operation of subsection (3) above to the extent (if any) that the aggregate of that sum and all the sums which—
(a)have been paid previously during the administration period in respect of that absolute interest, and
(b)fall under this section to be treated as paid to that person as income,
exceeds the aggregated income entitlement of that person for the year of assessment in which the sum is paid.
(3B)For the purposes of this section the aggregated income entitlement of that person for any year of assessment is the amount which would be the aggregate of the amounts received for that year of assessment and all previous years of assessment in respect of the interest if that person had a right in each year to receive, and had received—
(a)in the case of a United Kingdom estate, his residuary income for that year less income tax at the applicable rate for that year; and
(b)in the case of a foreign estate, his residuary income for that year.”
(2)For subsection (5) of that section there shall be substituted the following subsection—
“(5)Where, on the completion of the administration of the estate, the aggregate of all the sums which, apart from this subsection—
(a)have been paid during the administration period in respect of that absolute interest, and
(b)fall under this section to be treated as paid to that person as income,
is exceeded by the aggregated income entitlement of that person for the year of assessment in which the administration of the estate is completed, then an amount equal to the amount of the excess shall be treated for the purposes of subsections (3) to (4) above as having been actually paid, immediately before the end of the administration period, in respect of that interest.”
(3)Sub-paragraph (1) above has effect, subject to sub-paragraph (4) below, in relation to any payment made on or after 6th April 1995; and sub-paragraph (2) above shall have effect in relation to any estate the administration of which is completed on or after 6th April 1995.
(4)Where any sum is deemed by virtue of subsection (3) of section 696 of the Taxes Act 1988 (as it has effect apart from this Schedule) to have been paid to any person as income for the year 1994-95 or any previous year of assessment, that sum shall be treated for the purposes of subsections (3A) and (5) of that section (as they have effect by virtue of this Schedule) as a sum actually paid in respect of that person’s absolute interest in that year of assessment.
4(1)After subsection (1) of section 697 (calculation of residuary income) there shall be inserted the following subsection—U.K.
“(1A)For the purpose of ascertaining under subsection (1) above the residuary income of an estate for any year, where the amount of the deductions falling to be made from the aggregate income of the estate for that year (including any falling to be made by virtue of this subsection) exceeds the amount of that income, the excess shall be carried forward and treated for that purpose as an amount falling to be deducted from the aggregate income of the estate for the following year.”
(2)In subsection (2) of that section (reduction of residuary income where benefits received are less than aggregate of residuary income), for the words from “his residuary income for” onwards there shall be substituted “ section 696 shall have effect as if the amount of the deficiency were to be applied in reducing the amount taken to be his residuary income for the year in which the administration of the estate is completed and, in so far as the deficiency exceeds that income, in reducing the amount taken to be his residuary income for the previous year, and so on. ”
(3)Sub-paragraph (1) above has effect for ascertaining the residuary income of an estate for the year 1995-96 or any subsequent year of assessment; and sub-paragraph (2) above has effect in relation to any estate the administration of which is completed on or after 6th April 1995.
5(1)For subsection (2) of section 698 (special provisions as to successive interests in residue) there shall be substituted the following subsections—U.K.
“(1A)Subsection (1B) below applies where—
(a)successively during the administration period there are different persons with interests in the residue of the estate of a deceased person or in parts of such a residue;
(b)the later interest or, as the case may be, each of the later interests arises or is created on the cessation otherwise than by death of the interest that precedes it; and
(c)the earlier or, as the case may be, earliest interest is a limited interest.
(1B)Where this subsection applies, this Part shall have effect in relation to any payment made in respect of any of the interests referred to in subsection (1A) above—
(a)as if all those interests were the same interest so that none of them is to be treated as having ceased on being succeeded by any of the others;
(b)as if (subject to paragraph (c) below) the interest which is deemed to exist by virtue of paragraph (a) above (“the deemed single interest”) were an interest of—
(i)except in a case to which sub-paragraph (ii) below applies, the person in respect of whose interest or previous interest the payment is made;
(ii)in a case where the person entitled to receive the payment is any other person who has or has had an interest which is deemed to be comprised in the deemed single interest, that other person;
and
(c)in so far as any of the later interests is an absolute interest as if, for the purposes of section 696(3A) to (5)—
(i)the earlier interest or interests had never existed and the absolute interest had always existed;
(ii)the sums (if any) which were deemed in relation to the earlier interest or interests to have been paid as income for any year of assessment to any of the persons entitled thereto were sums previously paid during the administration period in respect of the absolute interest; and
(iii)those sums were sums falling to be treated as sums paid as income to the person entitled to the absolute interest.
(2)Where successively during the administration period there are different persons with absolute interests in the residue of the estate of a deceased person or in parts of such a residue, the aggregate payments and aggregated income entitlement referred to in subsections (3A) and (3B) of section 696 shall be computed for the purposes of that section in relation to an absolute interest subsisting at any time (“the subsequent interest”)—
(a)as if the subsequent interest and any previous absolute interest corresponding to the subsequent interest, or relating to any part of the residue to which the subsequent interest relates, were the same interest; and
(b)as if the residuary income for any year of the person entitled to the previous interest were residuary income of the person entitled to the subsequent interest and any amount deemed to be paid as income to the person entitled to the previous interest were an amount deemed to have been paid to the person entitled to the subsequent interest.”
(2)This paragraph has effect in relation to any payment made on or after 6th April 1995 and, so far as it relates to the operation of section 695(3) or 696(5) of the Taxes Act 1988, in relation to any estate the administration of which is completed on or after that date.
6U.K.After subsection (4) of section 700 (adjustments and information) there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(5)It shall be the duty of a personal representative of a deceased person, if a request to do so is made in writing by a person who has, or has had, an absolute or limited interest in the residue of the estate of the deceased or by a person to whom any of the income of the residue of that estate has been paid in the exercise of any discretion, to furnish the person making the request with a statement in writing setting out—
(a)in respect of every amount which has been, or is treated as having been, actually paid to that person in respect of that interest or in the exercise of that discretion, the amount (if any) deemed under this Part to have been paid to him as income for a year of assessment; and
(b)the amount of any tax at the applicable rate which any amount falling within paragraph (a) above is deemed to have borne;
and, where an amount deemed to have been paid as income to any person for any year of assessment is deemed for any of the purposes of this Part to have borne tax on different parts of it at different applicable rates, the matters to be set out in pursuance of paragraphs (a) and (b) above shall be set out separately as respects each part of that amount.
(6)The duty imposed by subsection (5) above shall be enforceable at the suit or instance of the person making the request.”
7U.K.Subsection (14) of section 701 (cases where residuary income has borne income tax at the additional rate) shall cease to have effect.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F148Sch. 19 repealed (19.3.1997 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 10 para. 7(1) of the amending Act) by 1997 c. 16, ss. 76, 113, Sch. 18 Pt. VI(10) Note 1; S.I. 1997/991, art. 2
Section 107(11).
1U.K.In Schedule 1A to the Management Act (claims etc. not included in returns), in sub-paragraph (5) of paragraph 2 (making of claims), for paragraph (b) there shall be substituted the following paragraphs—
“(b)such information as is reasonably required for the purpose of determining whether and, if so, the extent to which the claim is correct;
(bb)the delivery with the claim of such accounts, statements and documents, relating to information contained in the claim, as are reasonably required for the purpose mentioned in paragraph (b) above;”.
2U.K.After paragraph 2 of that Schedule there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
2A(1)Any person who may wish to make a claim in relation to a year of assessment or other period shall—
(a)keep all such records as may be requisite for the purpose of enabling him to make a correct and complete claim; and
(b)shall preserve those records until the end of the relevant day.
(2)In relation to a claim, the relevant day for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) above is whichever of the following is the latest, namely—
(a)where enquiries into the claim or any amendment of the claim are made by an officer of the Board, the day on which, by virtue of paragraph 7(4) below, those enquiries are treated as completed; and
(b)where no enquiries into the claim or any amendment of the claim are so made, the day on which such an officer no longer has power to make such enquiries.
(3)The duty under sub-paragraph (1) above to preserve records may be discharged by the preservation of the information contained in them; and where the information is so preserved a copy of any document forming part of the records shall be admissible in evidence in any proceedings before the Commissioners to the same extent as the records themselves.
(4)Any person who fails to comply with sub-paragraph (1) above in relation to any claim which is made for a year of assessment or accounting period shall be liable to a penalty not exceeding £3,000.”
3U.K.In paragraph 3 of that Schedule (amendments of claims), in sub-paragraph (1)(a), for the word “return” there shall be substituted the word “ claim ”.
4(1)At the beginning of sub-paragraph (1) of paragraph 4 of that Schedule (giving effect to claims and amendments) there shall be inserted the words “ Subject to sub-paragraphs (1A) and (3) below and to any other provision in the Taxes Acts which otherwise provides, ”.U.K.
(2)After that sub-paragraph there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(1A)In relation to a claim which would otherwise fall to be taken into account in the making of deductions or repayments of tax under section 203 of the principal Act, sub-paragraph (1) above shall apply as if for the word “shall” there were substituted the word “may”.”
(3)At the beginning of sub-paragraph (2) of that paragraph there shall be inserted the words “ Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, ”.
(4)After the said sub-paragraph (2) there shall be inserted the following sub-paragraph—
“(3)Where any such claim or amendment as is mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) or (2) above is enquired into by an officer of the Board—
(a)that sub-paragraph shall not apply until the day on which, by virtue of paragraph 7(4) below, the officer’s enquiries are treated as completed; but
(b)the officer may at any time before that day give effect to the claim or amendment, on a provisional basis, to such extent as he thinks fit.”
5U.K.In paragraph 5 of that Schedule (power to enquire into claims), for sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) there shall be substituted the following sub-paragraphs—
“(2)The period referred to in sub-paragraph (1) above is whichever of the following ends the latest, namely—
(a)the period ending with the quarter day next following the first anniversary of the day on which the claim or amendment was made;
(b)where the claim or amendment relates to a year of assessment, the period ending with the first anniversary of the 31st January next following that year; and
(c)where the claim or amendment relates to a period other than a year of assessment, the period ending with the first anniversary of the end of that period;
and the quarter days for the purposes of this sub-paragraph are 31st January, 30th April, 31st July and 31st October.
(3)A claim or amendment which has been enquired into under sub-paragraph (1) above shall not be the subject of—
(a)a further notice under that sub-paragraph; or
(b)if it is subsequently included in a return, a notice under section 9A(1), 11AB(1) or 12AC(1) of this Act.”
Section 116(1).
1U.K.Section 7 of the Management Act (notice of liability) shall have effect as respects the year 1995-96 as if the reference in subsection (7) to a self-assessment made under section 9 of that Act in respect of that year were a reference to assessments made more than six months after the end of that year.
2(1)Section 59A of that Act (payments on account of income tax) shall have effect as respects the year 1996-97 with the modifications made by sub-paragraphs (2) to (7) below.U.K.
(2)The references in subsections (1)(a) and (4A) to a person being assessed to income tax under section 9 of that Act shall be construed as references to his being assessed to income tax under section 29 of that Act.
(3)The reference in subsection (1)(b) to the assessed amount shall be construed as a reference to the difference between that amount and the aggregate of the following, namely—
(a)so much of any income tax charged at a higher rate on any income—
(i)from which tax has been deducted otherwise than under section 203 of the Taxes Act 1988, or
(ii)from or on which income tax is treated as having been deducted or paid,
as is attributable to the difference between that rate and the basic rate; and
(b)so much of any income tax charged at a higher rate on any income chargeable under Schedule F as is attributable to the difference between that rate and the lower rate.
(4)The reference in subsection (1)(c) to the relevant amount shall be construed as a reference to the difference between that amount and the amount of any income tax charged under Schedule E which—
(a)has not been deducted under section 203 of the Taxes Act 1988; and
(b)is not charged by an assessment made under regulation 103 of the M214Income Tax (Employments) Regulations 1993.
(5)Subsection (2) shall have effect as if it required—
(a)the first payment on account to be of an amount equal to the aggregate of—
(i)such part of the relevant amount as represents tax charged under Schedule A or any of Cases III to VI of Schedule D; and
(ii)50 per cent. of the remaining part of the relevant amount, and
(b)the second payment on account to be of an amount equal to 50 per cent. of that remaining part.
(6)Subsection (4) shall have effect as if it provided that, in the circumstances there mentioned—
(a)the amount of the first payment on account should be, and should be deemed always to have been, equal to the aggregate of—
(i)such part of the stated amount as represents tax charged under Schedule A or any of Cases III to VI of Schedule D; and
(ii)50 per cent. of the remaining part of the stated amount, and
(b)the amount of the second payment on account should be, and should be deemed always to have been, equal to 50 per cent. of that remaining part.
(7)Subsection (4A) shall have effect as if it provided that, in the circumstances and subject as there mentioned—
(a)the amount of the first payment on account should be, and should be deemed always to have been, equal to the aggregate of—
(i)such part of the relevant amount (as determined on the basis of the assessment or, as the case may be, the assessment as amended) as represents tax charged under Schedule A or any of Cases III to VI of Schedule D; and
(ii)50 per cent. of the remaining part of the relevant amount, as so determined, and
(b)the amount of the second payment on account should be, and should be deemed always to have been, equal to 50 per cent. of that remaining part.
(8)In this paragraph “higher rate” means a rate other than the basic rate or the lower rate.
Marginal Citations
3(1)This paragraph applies in the case of a partnership whose trade, profession or business is set up and commenced before 6th April 1994.U.K.
(2)Section 32 of the Management Act (relief for double assessments to tax) shall have effect, as respects each partner and the year 1996-97, as if the partnership had not been assessed to income tax for that year.
(3)Section 59B of that Act (payment of income tax and capital gains tax) shall have effect, as respects each partner and that year, as if his share of any income tax to which the partnership is assessed for that year were income tax which in respect of that year had been deducted at source.
Section 123.
1(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of a trade, profession or vocation carried on by any person—U.K.
(a)paragraph 2(2) of Schedule 20 to the M215Finance Act 1994 applies without the modification made by paragraph 2(3) of that Schedule; and
(b)any amount which is included in the profits or gains of the transitional period would not have been so included if—
(i)any relevant change made by that person had not been made; or
(ii)any relevant transaction entered into by that person had not been entered into.
(2)Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, the said paragraph 2(2) shall have effect as if the reference to the appropriate percentage of the aggregate of the amounts there mentioned were a reference to the aggregate of—
(a)that percentage of each of those amounts; and
(b)1.25 times the complementary percentage of each of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above.
(3)Sub-paragraph (2) above does not apply where—
(a)the aggregate of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above is less than such amount as may be prescribed by regulations made by the Board;
(b)the proportion which the aggregate of those amounts bears to the aggregate of the amounts mentioned in the said paragraph 2(2) is less than such proportion as may be so prescribed; or
(c)the appropriate percentage of the turnover for the transitional period is less than such amount as may be so prescribed;
and regulations under this sub-paragraph may make as respects trades or professions carried on by persons in partnership provision different from that made as respects trades, professions or vocations carried on by individuals.
(4)In this paragraph—
“the appropriate percentage” means the following expressed as a percentage, that is, 365 divided by the number of days in the transitional period;
“the complementary percentage” means the difference between 100 per cent. and the appropriate percentage;
“the transitional period” means the basis period for the year 1996-97 and the relevant period (within the meaning of paragraph 2 of Schedule 20 to the M216Finance Act 1994) taken together.
2(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of a trade or profession carried on by persons in partnership—U.K.
(a)paragraph 2(2) of Schedule 20 to the Finance Act 1994 applies without the modification made by paragraph 2(3) of that Schedule;
(b)a claim is made under section 353 of the Taxes Act 1988 (relief for interest: general provision) in respect of interest on a loan to defray money contributed or advanced by a partner to the partnership; and
(c)sub-paragraph (2) below applies to any of the money so contributed or advanced.
(2)This sub-paragraph applies to money so contributed or advanced unless it was contributed or advanced wholly or mainly—
(a)for bona fide commercial reasons; or
(b)for a purpose other than the reduction of the partnership’s borrowings for a relevant period.
(3)Subject to sub-paragraph (4) below, the amount eligible for relief under the said section 353 in respect of interest paid by the partner in respect of the transitional period on money to which sub-paragraph (2) above applies shall not exceed the appropriate percentage of that interest.
(4)Sub-paragraph (3) above does not apply where—
(a)the loan was made before 1st April 1994; or
(b)the aggregate amount of interest paid as mentioned in that sub-paragraph is less than such amount as may be prescribed by regulations made by the Board.
(5)Where relief under the said section 353 in respect of interest on any loan (“the original loan”) is restricted by sub-paragraph (3) above, relief under that section in respect of interest on any other loan used to defray money applied in paying off the original loan shall be restricted to the same extent as if that other loan were the original loan.
(6)In this paragraph—
“the appropriate percentage” and “the transitional period” have the same meanings as in paragraph 1 above;
“relevant period” means a period the whole or part of which falls within the transitional period.
3(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of a trade, profession or vocation carried on by any person—U.K.
(a)paragraph 2(4) of Schedule 20 to the M217Finance Act 1994 applies; and
(b)any amount which is included in the transitional overlap profit would not have been so included if—
(i)any relevant change made by that person had not been made; or
(ii)any relevant transaction entered into by that person had not been entered into.
(2)Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, the said paragraph 2(4) shall have effect as if the reference to the transitional overlap profit were a reference to the amount (if any) by which that profit exceeds 1.25 times the aggregate of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above.
(3)Sub-paragraph (3) of paragraph 1 above shall apply for the purposes of this paragraph as it applies for the purposes of that paragraph but subject to the following modifications, namely—
(a)the reference to the aggregate of the amounts mentioned in the said paragraph 2(2) shall have effect as a reference to the transitional overlap profit; and
(b)the reference to the appropriate percentage of the turnover for the transitional period shall have effect as a reference to the appropriate percentage of the turnover for the transitional overlap period.
(4)In this paragraph—
“the appropriate percentage” means the following expressed as a percentage, that is, 365 divided by the number of days in the transitional overlap period;
“the transitional overlap period” means the period beginning immediately after the end of—
the basis period for the year 1996-97; or
in the case of a trade or profession carried on by any person in partnership with other persons, the basis period of the partnership for that year,
and (in either case) ending with 5th April 1997;
“the transitional overlap profit” means the amount mentioned in the said paragraph 2(4).
4(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of a trade or profession carried on by any person in partnership with other persons—U.K.
(a)that person (“the retiring partner”) ceases to carry on the trade or profession at any time in the transitional overlap period; and
(b)if he had not so ceased, paragraph 3(2) above would have applied in relation to him.
(2)The retiring partner shall for the year 1996-97 be chargeable to income tax under Case I or II of Schedule D on 1.25 times the aggregate of the amounts which would have fallen within paragraph 3(1)(b) above.
(3)In this paragraph “the transitional overlap period” has the same meaning as in paragraph 3 above.
5(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of a trade or profession carried on by any person in partnership with other persons—U.K.
(a)paragraph 2(4) of Schedule 20 to the M218Finance Act 1994 applies with or without the modification made by paragraph 3(2) above;
(b)a claim is made under section 353 of the Taxes Act 1988 (relief for interest: general provision) in respect of interest on a loan to defray money contributed or advanced by him (“the partner”) to the partnership; and
(c)sub-paragraph (2) below applies to any of the money so contributed or advanced.
(2)This sub-paragraph applies to money so contributed or advanced unless it was contributed or advanced wholly or mainly—
(a)for bona fide commercial reasons; or
(b)for a purpose other than the reduction of the partnership’s borrowings for a relevant period.
(3)Subject to sub-paragraph (4) below, the said paragraph 2(4) shall have effect as if the reference to the transitional overlap profit were a reference to the difference between that profit and the amount of interest paid by the partner in respect of the transitional overlap period on money to which sub-paragraph (2) above applies.
(4)Sub-paragraph (3) above does not apply where—
(a)the loan was made before 1st April 1994; or
(b)the aggregate amount of interest paid as mentioned in that sub-paragraph is less than such amount as may be prescribed by regulations made by the Board.
(5)In this paragraph—
“relevant period” means a period the whole or part of which falls within the transitional overlap period;
“the transitional overlap period” has the same meaning as in paragraph 3 above;
“the transitional overlap profit” means the amount mentioned in the said paragraph 2(4) (whether having effect with or without the modification made by paragraph 3(2) above).
6(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of any income derived by any person from the carrying on by him of a trade, profession or vocation—U.K.
(a)paragraph 6(2)(a) of Schedule 20 to the M219Finance Act 1994 applies; and
(b)any amount which is included in the income arising within the years 1995-96 and 1996-97 would not have been so included if—
(i)any relevant change made by that person had not been made; or
(ii)any relevant transaction entered into by that person had not been entered into.
(2)Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, the said paragraph 6(2)(a) shall have effect as if the reference to 50 per cent. of the aggregate of the amounts there mentioned were a reference to the aggregate of—
(a)50 per cent. of each of those amounts; and
(b)62.5 per cent. of each of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above.
(3)Sub-paragraph (3) of paragraph 1 above shall apply for the purposes of this paragraph as it applies for the purposes of that paragraph but subject to the following modifications, namely—
(a)the reference to the said paragraph 2(2) shall have effect as a reference to the said paragraph 6(2)(a); and
(b)the reference to the appropriate percentage of the turnover of the transitional period shall have effect as a reference to 50 per cent. of the turnover of the years 1995-96 and 1996-97.
7(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of any income derived by any person from the carrying on by him of a trade, profession or vocation—U.K.
(a)paragraph 6(4) of Schedule 20 to the M220Finance Act 1994 applies; and
(b)any amount which is included in the transitional overlap profit would not have been so included if—
(i)any relevant change made by that person had not been made; or
(ii)any relevant transaction entered into by that person had not been entered into.
(2)Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, the said paragraph 6(4) shall have effect as if the reference to the transitional overlap profit were a reference to the amount (if any) by which that profit exceeds 1.25 times the aggregate of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above.
(3)Sub-paragraph (3) of paragraph 1 above shall apply for the purposes of this paragraph as it applies for the purposes of that paragraph but subject to the following modifications, namely—
(a)the reference to the aggregate of the amounts mentioned in the said paragraph 2(2) shall have effect as a reference to the transitional overlap profit; and
(b)the reference to the appropriate percentage of the turnover for the transitional period shall have effect as a reference to the appropriate percentage of the turnover for the transitional overlap period.
(4)In this paragraph—
“the appropriate percentage” means the following expressed as a percentage, that is, 365 divided by the number of days in the transitional overlap period;
“the transitional overlap period” means the period beginning immediately after the end of—
the basis period for the year 1996-97; or
in the case of any income derived by any person from the carrying on by him of a trade or profession in partnership with other persons, the basis period of the partnership for that year,
and (in either case) ending with 5th April 1997;
“the transitional overlap profit” means the amount mentioned in the said paragraph 6(4).
8(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of any income derived by any person from the carrying on by him of a trade or profession in partnership with other persons—U.K.
(a)that person (“the retiring partner”) ceases to carry on the trade or profession at any time in the transitional overlap period; and
(b)if he had not so ceased, paragraph 7(2) above would have applied in relation to him.
(2)The retiring partner shall for the year 1996-97 be chargeable to income tax under Case IV or V of Schedule D on 1.25 times the aggregate of the amounts which would have fallen within paragraph 7(1)(b) above.
(3)In this paragraph “the transitional overlap period” has the same meaning as in paragraph 7 above.
9(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of any interest arising to any person from any source—U.K.
(a)paragraph 4(2) or 6(2)(a) of Schedule 20 to the M221Finance Act 1994 applies; and
(b)any amount which is included in the interest arising within the years 1995-96 and 1996-97 would not have been so included if any relevant arrangements made between that person and another had not been made.
(2)Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, the said paragraph 4(2) or 6(2)(a) shall have effect as if the reference to 50 per cent. of the aggregate of the amounts there mentioned were a reference to the aggregate of—
(a)50 per cent. of each of those amounts; and
(b)62.5 per cent. of each of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above.
(3)Sub-paragraph (2) above does not apply where—
(a)the aggregate of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above is less than such amount as may be prescribed by regulations made by the Board; or
(b)the proportion which the aggregate of those amounts bears to the aggregate of the amounts mentioned in the said paragraph 4(2) or 6(2)(a) is less than such proportion as may be so prescribed.
10(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of any income (other than income falling within paragraph 6 or 9 above) arising to any person from any source—U.K.
(a)paragraph 4(2) or 6(2)(a) of Schedule 20 to the M222Finance Act 1994 applies; and
(b)any amount which is included in the income arising within the years 1995-96 and 1996-97 would not have been so included if—
(i)any relevant arrangements made between that person and another had not been made; or
(ii)any relevant transaction entered into by that person had not been entered into.
(2)Subject to sub-paragraph (3) below, the said paragraph 4(2) or 6(2)(a) shall have effect as if the reference to 50 per cent. of the aggregate of the amounts there mentioned were a reference to the aggregate of—
(a)50 per cent. of each of those amounts; and
(b)62.5 per cent. of each of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) above.
(3)Sub-paragraph (3) of paragraph 9 above shall apply for the purposes of this paragraph as it applies for the purposes of that paragraph.
11(1)Nothing in subsection (2) or (3) of section 29 of the Management Act (as substituted by section 191 of the M223Finance Act 1994) shall prevent an assessment being made under subsection (1) of that section in any case where—U.K.
(a)the loss of tax there mentioned is attributable to any failure to give effect to any of paragraphs 1, 2, 4, 6 and 8 to 10 above; and
(b)at the time when the assessment is made, the condition mentioned in sub-paragraph (3) below is fulfilled.
(2)Nothing in subsection (3) or (4) of section 30B of the Management Act (amendment of [F149partnership return] where loss of tax discovered) shall prevent an amendment being made under subsection (1) of that section in any case where—
(a)the omission, deficiency or excess there mentioned is attributable to any failure to give effect to any of paragraphs 1, 2, 4, 6 and 8 to 10 above; and
(b)at the time when the amendment is made, the condition mentioned in sub-paragraph (3) below is fulfilled.
(3)The condition referred to in sub-paragraphs (1) and (2) above is that either—
(a)[F150a return under section 8 or 8A of the Management Act (personal or trustee return)] or, as the case may require, a [F151partnership return] has been made for the year 1997-98 and that [F152return] is still capable of being amended; or
[F153(b) no such return has been so made.]
Textual Amendments
F149Words in Sch. 22 para. 11(2) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(1)(2)
F150Words in Sch. 22 para. 11(3)(a) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(1)(3)(a)(i)
F151Words in Sch. 22 para. 11(3)(a) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(1)(3)(a)(ii)
F152Words in Sch. 22 para. 11(3)(a) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(1)(3)(a)(iii)
F153Sch. 22 para. 11(3)(b) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(1)(3)(b)
Marginal Citations
12(1)An officer of the Board shall not so amend [F154a return under section 8 or 8A of the Management Act (personal or trustee return)] as to give effect to paragraph 3, 5 or 7 above unless a notice stating—U.K.
(a)in the case of paragraph 3 or 7 above, the aggregate of the amounts falling within sub-paragraph (1)(b) of that paragraph; and
(b)in the case of paragraph 5 above, the aggregate amount of interest paid as mentioned in sub-paragraph (3) of that paragraph,
is given by such an officer at a time when the condition mentioned in sub-paragraph (2) below is fulfilled.
(2)The condition referred to in sub-paragraph (1) above is that either—
(a)[F155a return under section 8 or 8A of the Management Act (personal or trustee return)] has been made for the year 1998-99 and [F156that return] is still capable of being amended; or
[F157(b)no such return has been so made.]
(3)Subject to sub-paragraph (4) below, a notice under sub-paragraph (1) above shall be conclusive of the matters stated in it.
(4)An appeal may be brought against a notice under sub-paragraph (1) above at any time within the period of 30 days beginning with the date on which the notice is given.
(5)Subject to sub-paragraph (6) below, the provisions of the Management Act relating to appeals shall have effect in relation to an appeal under sub-paragraph (4) above as they have effect in relation to an appeal against an assessment to tax.
(6)On an appeal under sub-paragraph (4) above, section 50(6) to (8) of the Management Act (procedure on appeals) shall not apply but the Commissioners may—
(a)if it appears to them that the matters stated in the notice under sub-paragraph (1) above are correct, confirm the notice; or
(b)if it does not so appear to them, set aside or modify the notice accordingly.
Textual Amendments
F154Words in Sch. 22 para. 12(1) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(4)
F155Words in Sch. 22 para. 12(2)(a) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(5)(a)(i)
F156Words in Sch. 22 para. 12(2)(a) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(5)(a)(ii)
F157Sch. 22 para. 12(2)(b) substituted (11.5.2001) by 2001 c. 9, s. 88, Sch. 29 para. 37(5)(b)
13(1)Where a relevant return (as originally made) states—U.K.
(a)that paragraph 1, 3 or 4 above applies in the case of a trade, profession or vocation carried on by any person; or
(b)that paragraph 7 or 8 above applies in the case of any income derived by any person from the carrying on by him of a trade, profession or vocation,
sub-paragraph (2) of that paragraph shall have effect, in its application to any amounts stated in the return (as so made) to fall within sub-paragraph (1)(b) of that paragraph or, in the case of paragraph 4 or 8 above, to be amounts which would have fallen within sub-paragraph (1)(b) of the preceding paragraph, as if the words “1.25 times” were omitted.
(2)Where a relevant return (as originally made) states—
(a)that paragraph 6 above applies in the case of any income derived by any person from the carrying on by him of a trade, profession or vocation; or
(b)that paragraph 9 or 10 above applies in the case of any income arising to any person from any source,
sub-paragraph (2) of that paragraph shall have effect, in its application to any amounts stated in the return (as so made) to fall within sub-paragraph (1)(b) of that paragraph, as if for the words “62.5 per cent.” there were substituted the words “ 50 per cent ”.
(3)In this paragraph—
“relevant return” means a return which, for the relevant year, is made under section 8, 8A or 12AA of the Management Act in respect of the trade, profession or vocation or, as the case may be, the source of the income;
“the relevant year” means—
in relation to paragraph 1, 6, 9 or 10 above, the year 1996–97;
in relation to paragraph 3, 4, 7 or 8 above, the year 1997–98.
14(1)Any accounting change or change of business practice is a relevant change for the purposes of paragraphs 1, 3, 6 and 7 above unless—U.K.
(a)the change is made exclusively for bona fide commercial reasons; or
(b)the obtaining of a tax advantage is not the main benefit that could reasonably be expected to arise from the making of the change.
(2)In this paragraph “accounting change”—
(a)does not include any change of accounting date which brings the end of the basis period for the year 1996-97 closer to 5th April 1997; but
(b)subject to that, means any change of accounting date or other modification of an accounting policy or any substitution of one such policy for another.
(3)In this paragraph “change of business practice” means any change in an established practice of trade, profession or vocation carried on by any person—
(a)as to the timing of any of the following, namely—
(i)the supply of goods or services, the invoicing of customers or clients and the collection of outstanding debts; and
(ii)the obtaining of goods or services, the incurring of business expenses and the settlement of outstanding debts; or
(b)as to the obtaining or making of payments in advance or payments on account.
15U.K.Any self-cancelling transaction or transaction with a connected person is a relevant transaction for the purposes of paragraphs 1, 3, 6 and 7 above unless—
(a)the transaction is entered into exclusively for bona fide commercial reasons; or
(b)the obtaining of a tax advantage is not the main benefit that could reasonably be expected to arise from the entering into of the transaction.
16(1)An agreement by which the person by whom a trade, profession or vocation is carried on agrees to sell or transfer trading stock or work in progress is a self-cancelling transaction for the purposes of paragraph 15 above if by the same or any collateral agreement that person—U.K.
(a)agrees to buy back or re-acquire the trading stock or work in progress; or
(b)acquires or grants an option, which is subsequently exercised, for him to buy back or re-acquire the trading stock or work in progress.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) above—
“trading stock” has the same meaning as in section 100 of the Taxes Act 1988;
“work in progress”, in relation to a profession or vocation, means—
any services performed in the ordinary course of the profession or vocation, the performance of which is wholly or partly completed at the time of the sale or transfer and for which it would be reasonable to expect that a charge would have been made on their completion if the sale or transfer had not been effected; and
any article produced, and any such material as is used, in the performance of any such services,
and references in that sub-paragraph to the sale or transfer of work in progress shall include references to the sale or transfer of any benefits and rights which accrue, or might reasonably be expected to accrue, from the carrying out of the work.
17(1)For the purposes of paragraph 15 above, any question whether the person by whom a trade, profession or vocation is carried on is connected with another person shall be determined in accordance with sub-paragraphs (2) to (5) below.U.K.
(2)An individual carrying on a trade, profession or vocation is connected with another person if they are connected with each other within the meaning of section 839 of the Taxes Act 1988 (disregarding for this purpose the exception in subsection (4) of that section).
(3)Persons carrying on a trade or profession in partnership are connected with an individual if he controls the partnership.
(4)Persons carrying on a trade or profession in partnership are connected with a company if the company controls the partnership or the same person controls both the company and the partnership.
(5)Persons carrying on a trade or profession in partnership are connected with persons carrying on another trade or profession in partnership if the same person controls both partnerships.
(6)In this paragraph—
(a)“control” shall be construed—
(i)in relation to a company, in accordance with section 416 of the Taxes Act 1988;
(ii)in relation to a partnership, in accordance with section 840 of that Act; and
(b)any reference to a person controlling a company or partnership is a reference to his doing so either alone or with one or more persons connected with him.
18(1)Any arrangements under which—U.K.
(a)interest arises at irregular intervals during the years 1994-95 to 1997-98, or
(b)there are artificial variations in the rate of interest applicable during those years,
are relevant arrangements for the purposes of paragraph 9 above unless the obtaining of a tax advantage is not the main benefit that could reasonably be expected to arise from the making of the arrangements.
(2)Any variations in the rate of interest applicable during the years 1994-95 to 1997-98 are artificial variations for the purposes of this paragraph unless they are based on variations in a variable rate of interest the values of which from time to time are regularly published.
19U.K.Any arrangements under which income arises at irregular intervals during the years 1994-95 to 1997-98 are relevant arrangements for the purposes of paragraph 10 above unless—
(a)the arrangements are made exclusively for bona fide commercial reasons; or
(b)the obtaining of a tax advantage is not the main benefit that could reasonably be expected to arise from the making of the arrangements.
20(1)Any transaction with a connected person is a relevant transaction for the purposes of paragraph 10 above unless—U.K.
(a)the transaction is entered into exclusively for bona fide commercial reasons; or
(b)the obtaining of a tax advantage is not the main benefit that could reasonably be expected to arise from the entering into of the transaction.
(2)A person is connected with another person for the purposes of this paragraph if they are connected with each other within the meaning of section 839 of the Taxes Act 1988.
21(1)In this Schedule “turnover”, in relation to a trade, profession or vocation, means the amounts derived from the provision of goods or services falling within its ordinary activities, after deduction of trade discounts and value added tax.U.K.
(2)Obtaining a tax advantage shall not be regarded as a bona fide commercial reason for the purposes of this Schedule.
Section 126.
1(1)Subject to the following provisions of this Schedule, the provisions of the Tax Acts, of the M224Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 and of any subordinate legislation made under the Tax Acts or that Act of 1992, so far as they—U.K.
(a)make provision for or in connection with the assessment, collection and recovery of tax, or of interest on any tax, and
(b)apply in any case for purposes connected with the taxation of any amounts in relation to which the non-resident has a UK representative,
shall have effect in that case with respect to tax chargeable on, and interest payable by, the non-resident as if the obligations and liabilities of the non-resident by virtue of those provisions were also obligations and liabilities of the UK representative.
(2)In this paragraph “subordinate legislation” has the same meaning as in the M225Interpretation Act 1978.
2U.K.Subject to the following provisions of this Schedule—
(a)the discharge by the non-resident’s UK representative or by the non-resident himself of an obligation or liability which is or corresponds to one to which that representative is subject under this Schedule shall be treated as discharging the corresponding obligation or liability to which the other is subject; and
(b)the non-resident shall be bound, as if they were his own, by any acts or omissions of his UK representative in the discharge of the obligations and liabilities imposed on that representative by this Schedule.
3U.K.Where any obligation or liability such as is mentioned in paragraph 2 above arises only if the person on whom it is imposed has been given or served with a notice or other document or has received a request or demand, that obligation or liability shall not by virtue of this Schedule be treated as having been imposed on the non-resident’s UK representative unless the notice or document, or a copy of it, was given to or served on that representative, or he was notified of the request or demand.
4(1)The obligations relating to the furnishing of information which are imposed by this Schedule on the non-resident’s UK representative in a case where that representative is his independent agent shall not require that representative to do anything except so far as it is practicable for the representative to do so by acting to the best of his knowledge and belief after having taken all reasonable steps to obtain the necessary information.U.K.
(2)Paragraph 2 above shall not have the effect—
(a)of discharging the non-resident from any obligation to furnish information in a case where that obligation has been discharged by his UK representative by virtue only of sub-paragraph (1) above; or
(b)of requiring the non-resident to be bound by any error or mistake contained, otherwise than as a result of—
(i)any act or omission of the non-resident himself, or
(ii)any act or omission to which he consented or in which he connived,
in information furnished by his UK representative in compliance, so far as required by sub-paragraph (1) above, with any obligation imposed by virtue of this Schedule on that representative.
(3)In this paragraph “information” includes anything contained in any return, self-assessment, account, statement or report that is required to be provided to the Board or any officer of the Board, and references to furnishing information shall be construed accordingly.
5(1)A person shall not by virtue of this Schedule be guilty of a criminal offence except where he committed the offence himself or consented to, or connived in, its commission.U.K.
(2)An independent agent of the non-resident shall not by virtue of this Schedule be liable, in respect of any act or omission, to any civil penalty or surcharge if—
(a)the act or omission is neither an act or omission of the agent himself nor an act or omission to which he consented or in which he connived, and
(b)he is able to show that he will not, after being indemnified for his other liabilities by virtue of this Schedule, be able to recover the amount of the penalty or surcharge out of any such sums as are mentioned in paragraph 6 below.
6U.K.An independent agent of the non-resident shall be entitled—
(a)to be indemnified in respect of the amount of any liability of the non-resident which is discharged by that agent by virtue of paragraph 2 above; and
(b)to retain, out of any sums otherwise due from that agent to the non-resident, or received by that agent on behalf of the non-resident, amounts sufficient for meeting any liabilities by virtue of that paragraph which have been discharged by the agent, or to which he is subject.
7(1)In this Schedule “independent agent”, in relation to the non-resident, means any person who is the non-resident’s UK representative in respect of any agency from the non-resident in which he was acting on the non-resident’s behalf in an independent capacity.U.K.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph a person shall not be regarded as acting in an independent capacity on behalf of the non-resident unless, having regard to its legal, financial and commercial characteristics, the relationship between them is a relationship between persons carrying on independent businesses that deal with each other at arm’s length.
Section 130.
1U.K.F158. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F158Sch. 24 para. 1 repealed (with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act (c. 23), s. 141, {Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10)} Note 2
2U.K.F159. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F159Sch. 24 para. 2 repealed (with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act (c. 23), s. 141, {Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10)} Note 2
3U.K.F160. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F160Sch. 24 para. 3 repealed (with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act (c. 23), s. 141, {Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10)} Note 2
F1614U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F161Sch. 24 para. 4 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
F1625U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F162Sch. 24 para. 5 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
F1636U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F163Sch. 24 para. 6 repealed (29.4.1996 with effect as mentioned in ss. 80-105 of the amending Act) by 1996 c. 8, s. 205, Sch. 41 Pt. V(3) Note
7U.K.Paragraphs 8 to 12 below shall be deemed to have come into force on [F16423rd March 1995]
Textual Amendments
F164Words substituted (with effect as mentioned in s. 79(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 79, Sch. 23 para. 22(3) (with Sch. 23 para. 25)
8U.K.In section 87A of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (interest on overdue tax) in subsection (4A) (claims under section 131(5) or (6) of the M226Finance Act 1993)—
(a)for paragraph (c) there shall be substituted—
“(c)if the claim had not been made, there would be an amount or, as the case may be, an additional amount of corporation tax for the earlier period which would carry interest in accordance with this section,”, and
(b)for the words from “then” to the end there shall be substituted “ then, for the purposes of the determination at any time of whether any interest is payable under this section or of the amount of interest so payable, the amount mentioned in paragraph (c) above shall be taken to be an amount of unpaid corporation tax for the earlier period except so far as concerns interest for any time after the date on which any corporation tax for the later period became (or, as the case may be, would have become) due and payable as mentioned in subsection (1) above. ”
F1659U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F165Sch. 24 para. 9 repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(2) Note
10U.K.In section 91 of the M227Taxes Management Act 1970 (effect on interest of reliefs) in subsection (1B) (provisions to which section 91(1A) is subject) after the words “section 87A(4)” there shall be inserted “ , (4A), (4B), ”.
11U.K.In section 826 of the Taxes Act 1988 (interest on tax overpaid) in subsection (7C) (claims under section 131(5) or (6) of the M228Finance Act 1993)—
(a)at the end of paragraph (c) there shall be inserted “ or of income tax in respect of a payment received by the company in that accounting period ”, and
(b)for the words from “repayment of corporation tax” to “resulting from” there shall be substituted “ repayment referred to in paragraph (c) above, no account shall be taken of so much of the amount of the repayment as falls to be made as a result of ”.
Marginal Citations
12F166(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .U.K.
F166(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)In section 102 of the Finance Act 1989 (surrender of company tax refund etc. within group) in subsection (4A) (cases where any of subsections (7) to (7C) of section 826 of the M229Taxes Act 1988 applies) for “(7C)” there shall be substituted “ (7CA) ”.
F166(4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F166(5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F166Sch. 24 para. 12(1)(2)(4)(5) repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 3 of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(2) Note
Marginal Citations
Section 133.
1U.K.In this Schedule—
(a)paragraph 2 contains an amendment designed to secure that in certain cases the chargeable profits of a company resident outside the United Kingdom are to be computed and expressed in the currency used in its accounts;
(b)the other paragraphs contain amendments connected with that amendment.
2U.K.The following section shall be inserted after section 747 of the Taxes Act 1988—
(1)Subsection (2) below applies where for the purposes of this Chapter a company’s chargeable profits fall to be determined for—
(a)the first relevant accounting period of the company, or
(b)any subsequent accounting period of the company.
(2)Notwithstanding any other rule (whether statutory or otherwise) the chargeable profits for any such period shall be computed and expressed in the currency used in the accounts of the company for its first relevant accounting period.
(3)Subsection (4) below applies where for the purposes of this Chapter a company’s chargeable profits fall to be determined for any accounting period of the company which—
(a)begins on or after the appointed day, and
(b)falls before the company’s first relevant accounting period.
(4)Notwithstanding any other rule (whether statutory or otherwise) the chargeable profits for any such period shall be computed and expressed in the currency used in the accounts of the company for the accounting period concerned.
(5)For the purposes of this section the first relevant accounting period of the company shall be found in accordance with subsections (6) to (8) below.
(6)Where a direction has been given under section 747 as regards an accounting period of the company which begins before its commencement day, its first relevant accounting period is its accounting period which begins on its commencement day.
(7)Where the company is a trading company and subsection (6) above does not apply, its first relevant accounting period is its first accounting period which begins on or after its commencement day and as regards which a direction has been given under section 747.
(8)Where the company is not a trading company and subsection (6) above does not apply, its first relevant accounting period is its first accounting period which begins on or after its commencement day and as regards which—
(a)a direction has been given under section 747, or
(b)it can reasonably be assumed that a direction would have been given under section 747 but for the fact that it pursued, within the meaning of Part I of Schedule 25, an acceptable distribution policy.
(9)For the purposes of this section—
(a)a company’s commencement day is the first day of its first accounting period to begin after the day preceding the appointed day;
(b)the appointed day is such day as may be appointed under section 165(7)(b) of the M230Finance Act 1993 (which relates to exchange gains and losses).
(10)References in this section to the accounts of a company—
(a)are to the accounts which the company is required by the law of its home State to keep, or
(b)if the company is not required by the law of its home State to keep accounts, are to the accounts of the company which most closely correspond to the individual accounts which companies formed and registered under the M231Companies Act 1985 are required by that Act to keep;
and for the purposes of this subsection the home State of a company is the country or territory under whose law the company is incorporated or formed.”
3U.K.In section 747 of the Taxes Act 1988 (imputation of chargeable profits and creditable tax of controlled foreign companies) the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(4A)Where by virtue of section 747A a company’s chargeable profits for an accounting period are to be computed and expressed in a currency other than sterling, for the purposes of subsection (4)(a) above the apportioned amount shall be taken to be the sterling equivalent of the apportioned amount found in the currency other than sterling.
(4B)The translation required by subsection (4A) above shall be made by reference to the London closing exchange rate for the two currencies concerned for the last day of the accounting period concerned.”
4U.K.In section 748 of the Taxes Act 1988 (limitations on direction-making power) the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (3)—
“(4)Where by virtue of section 747A a company’s chargeable profits for an accounting period are to be computed and expressed in a currency other than sterling, for the purposes of subsection (1)(d) above its chargeable profits for the period shall be taken to be the sterling equivalent of its chargeable profits found in the currency other than sterling.
(5)The translation required by subsection (4) above shall be made by reference to the London closing exchange rate for the two currencies concerned for the last day of the accounting period concerned.”
5U.K.In section 750 of the Taxes Act 1988 (territories with a lower level of taxation) the following subsections shall be inserted after subsection (4)—
“(5)Subsections (6) and (7) below apply where by virtue of section 747A a company’s chargeable profits for an accounting period are to be computed and expressed in a currency other than sterling.
(6)For the purposes of subsection (2) above the company’s chargeable profits for the period shall be taken to be the sterling equivalent of its chargeable profits found in the currency other than sterling.
(7)In applying section 13 for the purposes of making the determination mentioned in subsection (3) above, any reference in section 13 to the amount of the company’s profits for the period on which corporation tax falls finally to be borne shall be construed as a reference to the sterling sum found under subsection (6) above.
(8)Any translation required by subsection (6) above shall be made by reference to the London closing exchange rate for the two currencies concerned for the last day of the accounting period concerned.”
6(1)Schedule 24 to the Taxes Act 1988 (assumptions for calculating chargeable profits etc.) shall be amended as mentioned in sub-paragraphs (2) to (5) below; and—U.K.
(a)the amendment made by sub-paragraph (2) below shall be deemed always to have had effect, and
(b)paragraph 1(4) of Schedule 16 to the M232Finance Act 1984 shall be deemed always to have had effect subject to the same amendment.
(2)In paragraph 1 (general assumptions for calculating chargeable profits etc.) in sub-paragraph (4) (assumption for certain purposes that a direction has been given) before the words “it shall be assumed” there shall be inserted “ in determining the chargeable profits of the company for the accounting period mentioned in paragraph (a) above ”.
(3)Paragraph 4A (computation of basic profits or losses of a trade) shall be deemed never to have been inserted.
(4)The following paragraph shall be inserted after paragraph 11—
“11A(1)This paragraph applies where by virtue of section 747A the company’s chargeable profits for an accounting period (the period in question) are to be computed and expressed in a currency (the relevant foreign currency) other than sterling.
(2)For the purposes of making in relation to the period in question any calculation which—
(a)falls to be made under the enactments relating to capital allowances, and
(b)takes account of amounts arrived at under those enactments in relation to accounting periods falling before the company’s commencement day (within the meaning given by section 747A(9)),
it shall be assumed that any such amount is the equivalent, expressed in the relevant foreign currency, of the amount expressed in sterling.
(3)For the purposes of the application in relation to the period in question of paragraph 11(1)(c) above, it shall be assumed that the company’s chargeable profits for the period are the sterling equivalent of its chargeable profits found in the relevant foreign currency.
(4)For the purposes of the application of section 34, 35 or 96 of the 1990 Act (motor cars and dwelling-houses) in relation to expenditure incurred in the period in question, it shall be assumed that any sterling sum mentioned in any of those sections is the equivalent, expressed in the relevant foreign currency, of the amount expressed in sterling.
(5)The translation required by sub-paragraph (2) above shall be made by reference to the London closing exchange rate for the two currencies concerned for the first day of the period in question.
(6)The translation required by sub-paragraph (3) above shall be made by reference to the London closing exchange rate for the two currencies concerned for the last day of the period in question.
(7)The translation required by sub-paragraph (4) above shall be made by reference to the London closing exchange rate for the two currencies concerned for the day on which the expenditure concerned was incurred.”
(5)F167. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F167Sch. 25 para. 6(5) repealed (with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 141, Sch. 40 Pt 3(10) Note 2
Marginal Citations
7U.K.F168. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F168Sch. 25 para. 7 repealed (with effect as mentioned in Sch. 40 Pt. 3(10) Note 2 of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2002 (c. 23), s. 141, Sch. 40 Pt 3(10) Note 2
Section 135.
1U.K.The Taxes Act 1988 shall have effect subject to the amendments in paragraphs 2 to 4 below.
2U.K.After section 768A there shall be inserted the following sections—
(1)This section applies where there is a change in the ownership of an investment company and—
(a)after the change there is a significant increase in the amount of the company’s capital; or
(b)within the period of six years beginning three years before the change there is a major change in the nature or conduct of the business carried on by the company; or
(c)the change in the ownership occurs at any time after the scale of the activities in the business carried on by the company has become small or negligible and before any considerable revival of the business.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1)(a) above, whether there is a significant increase in the amount of a company’s capital after a change in the ownership of the company shall be determined in accordance with the provisions of Part I of Schedule 28A.
(3)In paragraph (b) of subsection (1) above “major change in the nature or conduct of a business” includes a major change in the nature of the investments held by the company, even if the change is the result of a gradual process which began before the period of six years mentioned in that paragraph.
(4)For the purposes of this section—
(a)the accounting period of the company in which the change in the ownership occurs shall be divided into two parts, the first the part ending with the change, the second the part after;
(b)those parts shall be treated as two separate accounting periods; and
(c)the amounts in issue for the accounting period being divided shall be apportioned to those parts.
(5)In Schedule 28A—
(a)Part II shall have effect for identifying the amounts in issue for the accounting period being divided; and
(b)Part III shall have effect for the purpose of apportioning those amounts to the parts of that accounting period.
(6)Any sums which—
(a)are disbursed or treated as disbursed as expenses of management in the accounting period being divided, and
(b)under Part III of Schedule 28A are apportioned to either part of that period,
shall be treated for the purposes of section 75 as disbursed in that part.
(7)Any charges which under Part III of Schedule 28A are apportioned to either part of the accounting period being divided shall be treated for the purposes of sections 338 and 75 as paid in that part.
(8)Any allowances which under Part III of Schedule 28A are apportioned to either part of the accounting period being divided shall be treated for the purposes of section 28 of the 1990 Act and section 75(4) as falling to be made in that part.
(9)In computing the total profits of the company for an accounting period ending after the change in the ownership, no deduction shall be made under section 75 by reference to—
(a)sums disbursed or allowances falling to be made for an accounting period beginning before the change; or
(b)charges paid in such an accounting period.
(10)To the extent that a payment of interest made by the company represents excess overdue interest, the payment shall not be deductible under section 338(1) from the total profits for the accounting period in which it is made.
(11)Whether a payment of interest made by the company represents excess overdue interest, and if so to what extent, shall be determined in accordance with the provisions of Part IV of Schedule 28A.
(12)Subject to the modification in subsection (13) below, subsections (6) to (9) of section 768 shall apply for the purposes of this section as they apply for the purposes of that section.
(13)The modification is that in subsection (6) of section 768 for the words “relief in respect of a company’s losses has been restricted” there shall be substituted “deductions from a company’s total profits have been restricted”.
(14)In this section “investment company” has the same meaning as in Part IV.
(1)This section applies where—
(a)there is a change in the ownership of an investment company (“the relevant company”);
(b)none of paragraphs (a) to (c) of section 768B(1) applies;
(c)after the change in the ownership the relevant company acquires an asset from another company in circumstances such that section 171(1) of the 1992 Act applies to the acquisition; and
(d)a chargeable gain (“a relevant gain”) accrues to the relevant company on a disposal of the asset within the period of three years beginning with the change in the ownership.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1)(d) above an asset acquired by the relevant company as mentioned in subsection (1)(c) above shall be treated as the same as an asset owned at a later time by that company if the value of the second asset is derived in whole or in part from the first asset, and in particular where the second asset is a freehold and the first asset was a leasehold and the lessee has acquired the reversion.
(3)For the purposes of this section—
(a)the accounting period of the relevant company in which the change in the ownership occurs shall be divided into two parts, the first the part ending with the change, the second the part after;
(b)those parts shall be treated as two separate accounting periods; and
(c)the amounts in issue for the accounting period being divided shall be apportioned to those parts.
(4)In Schedule 28A—
(a)Part V shall have effect for identifying the amounts in issue for the accounting period being divided; and
(b)Part VI shall have effect for the purpose of apportioning those amounts to the parts of that accounting period.
(5)Subsections (6) to (8) of section 768B shall apply in relation to the relevant company as they apply in relation to the company mentioned in subsection (1) of that section except that any reference in those subsections to Part III of Schedule 28A shall be read as a reference to Part VI of that Schedule.
(6)Subsections (7) and (9) below apply only where, in accordance with the relevant provisions of the 1992 Act and Part VI of Schedule 28A, an amount is included in respect of chargeable gains in the total profits for the accounting period of the relevant company in which the relevant gain accrues.
(7)In computing the total profits of the relevant company for the accounting period in which the relevant gain accrues, no deduction shall be made under section 75 by reference to—
(a)sums disbursed or allowances falling to be made for an accounting period of the relevant company beginning before the change in ownership, or
(b)charges paid in such an accounting period,
from an amount of the total profits equal to the amount which represents the relevant gain.
(8)For the purposes of this section, the amount of the total profits for an accounting period which represents the relevant gain is—
(a)where the amount of the relevant gain does not exceed the amount which is included in respect of chargeable gains for that period, an amount equal to the amount of the relevant gain;
(b)where the amount of the relevant gain exceeds the amount which is included in respect of chargeable gains for that period, the amount so included.
(9)To the extent that a payment of interest made by the relevant company in the accounting period in which the relevant gain accrues represents excess overdue interest, the payment shall not be deductible under section 338(1) from such part of the total profits for that accounting period as represents the relevant gain.
(10)Whether a payment of interest made by the relevant company represents excess overdue interest, and if so to what extent, shall be determined in accordance with the provisions of Part IV of Schedule 28A.
(11)Subsections (8) and (9) of section 768 shall apply for the purposes of this section as they apply for the purposes of that section.
(12)In this section—
“the relevant provisions of the 1992 Act” means section 8(1) of and Schedule 7A to that Act; and
“investment company” has the same meaning as in Part IV.”
3U.K.After Schedule 28 there shall be inserted—
1The provisions referred to in section 768B(2) for determining whether there is a significant increase in the amount of a company’s capital after a change in the ownership of the company are as follows.
2There is a significant increase in the amount of a company’s capital if amount B—
(a)exceeds amount A by at least £1 million; or
(b)is at least twice amount A.
3(1)Amount A is the lower of—
(a)the amount of the company’s capital immediately before the change in the ownership; and
(b)the highest 60 day minimum amount for the pre-change year, found in accordance with sub-paragraphs (2) to (6) below.
(2)Find the daily amounts of the company’s capital over the pre-change year.
(3)Take the highest of the daily amounts.
(4)Find out whether there was in the pre-change year a period of 60 days or more in which there was no daily amount lower than the amount taken.
(5)If there was, the amount taken is the highest 60 day minimum amount for the pre-change year.
(6)If there was not, take the next highest of the daily amounts and repeat the process in sub-paragraph (4) above; and so on, until the highest 60 day minimum amount for the pre-change year is found.
(7)In this Part of this Schedule “the pre-change year” means the period of one year ending immediately before the change in the ownership of the company in question.
4(1)Amount B is the highest 60 day minimum amount for the post-change period (finding that amount for that period in the same way as the highest 60 day minimum amount for the pre-change year is found).
(2)In this paragraph “the post-change period” means the period of three years beginning with the change in the ownership of the company in question.
5(1)The capital of a company consists of the aggregate of—
(a)the amount of the paid up share capital of the company;
(b)the amount outstanding of any debts incurred by the company which are of a description mentioned in any of paragraphs (a) to (c) of section 417(7); and
(c)the amount outstanding of any redeemable loan capital issued by the company.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) above—
(a)the amount of the paid up share capital includes any amount in the share premium account of the company (construing “share premium account” in the same way as in section 130 of the M233Companies Act 1985); and
(b)the amount outstanding of any debts includes any interest due on the debts.
(3)Amounts of capital shall be expressed in sterling and rounded up to the nearest pound.
6The amounts in issue referred to in section 768B(4)(c) are—
(a)the amount of any sums (including commissions) actually disbursed as expenses of management for the accounting period being divided, except any such expenses as would (apart from section 768B) be deductible in computing profits otherwise than under section 75;
(b)the amount of any charges which are paid in that accounting period wholly and exclusively for the purposes of the company’s business;
(c)the amount of any excess carried forward under section 75(3) to the accounting period being divided;
(d)the amount of any allowances falling to be made for that accounting period by virtue of section 28 of the 1990 Act which would (apart from section 768B) be added to the expenses of management for that accounting period by virtue of section 75(4);
(e)any other amounts by reference to which the profits or losses of that accounting period would (apart from section 768B) be calculated.
7(1)Subject to paragraph 8 below, the apportionment required by section 768B(4)(c) shall be made—
(a)in the case of the sums and charges mentioned in paragraph 6(a) and (b) above, by reference to the time when the sum or charge is due to be paid;
(b)in the case of the excess mentioned in paragraph 6(c) above, by apportioning the whole amount of the excess to the first part of the accounting period being divided;
(c)in the case of the amounts mentioned in paragraph 6(d) and (e) above, by reference to the respective lengths of the parts of the accounting period being divided.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a) above, in the case of any charge consisting of interest, the interest shall be assumed to become due on a day to day basis as it arises.
8If it appears that any method of apportionment given by paragraph 7 above would work unreasonably or unjustly for any case for which it is given, such other method shall be used for that case as appears just and reasonable.
9(1)The provisions referred to in sections 768B(11) and 768C(10) for determining whether a payment of interest made by the company or, as the case may be, the relevant company represents excess overdue interest, and if so to what extent, are set out in paragraphs 10 to 12 below.
(2)In those paragraphs—
(a)“overdue interest” means interest due to be paid by the company or, as the case may be, the relevant company before the change in the ownership and still unpaid at the end of the actual accounting period in which the change occurs;
(b)“amount C” means the amount of all the overdue interest; and
(c)“amount P” means the amount of the profits for the accounting period ending with the change in the ownership.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) above—
(a)interest shall be assumed to become due on a day to day basis as it arises;
(b)the reference to the profits is a reference to the profits after making all deductions and giving all reliefs that for the purposes of corporation tax are made or given against the profits, including deductions and reliefs which under any provision are treated as reducing them for those purposes.
10(1)A payment of interest does not represent excess overdue interest except to the extent that it discharges a liability to pay overdue interest.
(2)For the purposes of this Part of this Schedule, a payment of interest on a debt shall be treated as discharging any liability to pay overdue interest before it is treated to any extent as discharging a liability to pay interest which is not overdue interest.
11Where amount C does not exceed amount P, no payment of interest represents excess overdue interest.
12(1)Where amount C exceeds amount P—
(a)find the amount by which amount C exceeds amount P (amount X);
(b)take all the payments and parts of payments which discharge any liability to pay overdue interest;
(c)treat those payments and parts of payments as cancelling out amount X before any other part of amount C.
(2)A payment of interest represents excess overdue interest to the extent that, in accordance with sub-paragraph (1) above, it is treated as cancelling out amount X.
13(1)The amounts in issue referred to in section 768C(3)(c) are—
(a)the amount which would in accordance with the relevant provisions of the 1992 Act (and apart from section 768C) be included in respect of chargeable gains in the total profits for the accounting period being divided;
(b)the amount of any sums (including commissions) actually disbursed as expenses of management for the accounting period being divided except any such expenses as would (apart from section 768C) be deductible in computing total profits otherwise than under section 75;
(c)the amount of any charges which are paid in that accounting period wholly and exclusively for the purposes of the company’s business;
(d)the amount of any excess carried forward under section 75(3) to the accounting period being divided;
(e)the amount of any allowances falling to be made for that accounting period by virtue of section 28 of the 1990 Act which would (apart from section 768C) be added to the expenses of management for that accounting period by virtue of section 75(4); and
(f)any other amounts by reference to which the profits or losses of the accounting period being divided would (apart from section 768C) be calculated.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1)(a) above “the relevant provisions of the 1992 Act” means section 8(1) of and Schedule 7A to that Act.
14The apportionment required by section 768C(3)(c) shall be made as follows.
15In the case of the amount mentioned in paragraph 13(1)(a) above—
(a)if it does not exceed the amount of the relevant gain, the whole of it shall be apportioned to the second part of the accounting period being divided;
(b)if it exceeds the amount of the relevant gain, the excess shall be apportioned to the first part of the accounting period being divided and the relevant gain shall be apportioned to the second part.
16(1)Subject to paragraph 17 below, the apportionment shall be made—
(a)in the case of the sums and charges mentioned in paragraph 13(1)(b) and (c) above, by reference to the time when the sum or charge is due to be paid;
(b)in the case of the excess mentioned in paragraph 13(1)(d) above, by apportioning the whole amount of the excess to the first part of the accounting period being divided;
(c)in the case of the amounts mentioned in paragraph 13(1)(e) and (f) above, by reference to the respective lengths of the parts of the accounting period being divided.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a) above, in the case of any charge consisting of interest, the interest shall be assumed to become due on a day to day basis as it arises.
17If it appears that any method of apportionment given by paragraph 16 above would work unreasonably or unjustly for any case for which it is given, such other method shall be used for that case as appears just and reasonable.”
4(1)Section 769 (rules for ascertaining change in ownership of company) shall be amended in accordance with sub-paragraphs (2) to (4) below.U.K.
(2)In subsections (1), (2)(d) and (5) for “sections 767A, 768 and 768A” there shall in each case be substituted “ sections 767A, 768, 768A, 768B and 768C ”.
(3)After subsection (3) there shall be inserted—
“(3A)Subsection (3) above shall apply for the purposes of sections 768B and 768C as if the reference to the benefit of losses were a reference to the benefit of deductions.”
(4)In subsection (4) for “section 768 or 768A” there shall be substituted “ section 768, 768A, 768B or 768C ”.
5U.K.This Schedule shall apply in relation to a change in ownership occurring on or after 29th November 1994 other than a change occurring in pursuance of a contract entered into before that date.
Section 139.
1[F169(1)In subsection (1) of section 559 of the Taxes Act 1988 (payments from which deductions are made), for “subsection (2) below” there shall be substituted “ subsections (2) and (3A) below ”.]U.K.
(2)Subsection (3) of that section (limit on payments exempted where a guarantee has been given or the recipient is a school leaver) shall not apply in relation to payments made to a person in any case where that person’s certificate under section 561 of that Act is one issued or renewed with respect to a period beginning on or after the appointed day.
(3)Before subsection (4) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(3A)Subsection (1) above shall not apply to a payment made under any contract if such conditions as may be prescribed in regulations made by the Board are satisfied in relation to the payment and the person making it.”
(4)Sub-paragraphs (1) and (3) above shall have effect in relation to payments made on or after the appointed day.
Textual Amendments
F169Sch. 27 para. 1(1) repealed (31.7.1998 with effect as mentioned in s. 55(3) of the amending Act) by 1998 c. 36, s. 165, Sch. 27 Pt. III(7) Note
Commencement Information
I14Sch. 27 para. 1 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect from 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 3 (see s. 139(3))
2(1)In subsection (2) of section 560 of that Act (persons who are contractors)—U.K.
(a)after paragraph (a) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(aa)any public office or department of the Crown (including any Northern Ireland department);”; and
(b)after paragraph (e) there shall be inserted the following paragraph—
“(ea)any such body, being a body (in addition to those falling within paragraphs (aa) to (e) above) which has been established for the purpose of carrying out functions conferred on it by or under any enactment, as may be designated as a body to which this subsection applies in regulations made by the Board;”.
(2)In paragraph (f) of that subsection and in subsection (3) of that section (persons to be contractors where average annual expenditure on construction exceeds £250,000), for “£250,000”, wherever it occurs, there shall be substituted “ £1,000,000 ”.
(3)This paragraph applies in relation to any payments made on or after the appointed day.
Commencement Information
I15Sch. 27 para. 2 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect from 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 3 (see. s. 139(3))
3(1)In subsection (2)(b) of section 561 of that Act (condition of certificate for a member of a firm), for “563” there shall be substituted “ 562 ”.U.K.
(2)In subsection (10) of that section (offence in connection with obtaining certificate), for “on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding £5,000” there shall be substituted “ to a penalty not exceeding £3,000 ”.
(3)In subsection (11) of that section (offences in connection with certificates, vouchers etc.)—
(a)after “section 566(2)(j)” there shall be inserted “ or who is in possession of any form or other document supplied to him by the Board for use in connection with any regulations under this Chapter ”; and
(b)for “on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding £5,000” there shall be substituted “ to a penalty not exceeding £3,000 ”.
Commencement Information
I16Sch. 27 para. 3 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect for the purposes of para. 3(2)(3)(b) on 23.11.1998 and para. 3(1) on 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, arts. 2, 3 (see s. 139(3))
4(1)Section 562 of that Act (conditions for grant of exemption certificate to be satisfied by individuals) shall be amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) (applications to which section applies)—
(a)the words “(otherwise than as a partner in a firm)” shall be omitted; and
(b)at the end there shall be inserted “ except that, where the application is for the issue of that certificate to that individual as a partner in a firm, this section shall have effect with the omission of subsections (2) to (2B). ”
(3)After subsection (2) there shall be inserted the following subsections—
“(2A)The applicant must satisfy the Board, by such evidence as may be prescribed in regulations made by the Board, that the carrying on of the business mentioned in subsection (2) above is likely to involve the receipt, annually in the period to which the certificate would relate, of an aggregate amount by way of relevant payments which is not less than the amount specified in regulations made by the Board as the minimum turnover for the purposes of this subsection.
(2B)In subsection (2A) above “relevant payments” means the following payments, other than so much of them as would fall, as representing the direct cost to any person of any materials, to be disregarded in calculating the amount of any deductions under subsection (4) of section 559, that is to say—
(a)payments from which such deductions would fall to be made if the certificate is not granted; and
(b)payments which would be such payments but for any regulations under subsection (3A) of that section.”
(4)Subsections (3) to (7) (which relate to the period for which an individual has carried on his business) shall cease to have effect.
(5)In subsection (9) (compliance by companies of which the applicant has had control), for “has the meaning given by section 840” there shall be substituted “ shall be construed in accordance with section 416(2) to (6) ”.
(6)In subsection (11) (persons who have been out of the United Kingdom), for the words from the beginning to the word “Board”, in the second place where it occurs, there shall be substituted—
“(11)Where the applicant states, for the purpose of showing that he has complied with all obligations imposed on him as mentioned in subsection (8) above, that he was not subject to any of one or more obligations in respect of any period ending within the qualifying period—
(a)he must satisfy the Board of that fact by such evidence as may be prescribed in regulations made by the Board; and
(b)if for that purpose he states that he has been outside the United Kingdom for the whole or any part of the qualifying period, he must also satisfy them, by such evidence as may be so prescribed,”.
(7)For subsection (14) (meaning of “qualifying period”) there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(13A)Subject to subsection (10) above, a person shall not be taken for the purposes of this section to have complied with any such obligation or request as is referred to in subsections (8) to (11) above if there has been a contravention of a requirement as to the time at which, or the period within which, the obligation or request was to be complied with.
(14)In this section “the qualifying period”, in relation to an application for the issue of a certificate under section 561, means the period of three years ending with the date of the application.”
Commencement Information
I17Sch. 27 para. 4 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect from 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 3 (see s. 139(3))
5U.K.Section 563 of that Act (conditions to be satisfied by individuals who are partners) shall cease to have effect.
Commencement Information
I18Sch. 27 para. 5 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect from 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 3 (see s. 139(3))
6U.K.For subsections (3) to (5) of section 564 of that Act there shall be substituted the following subsections—
“(2A)The partners must satisfy the Board, by such evidence as may be prescribed in regulations made by the Board, that the carrying on of the firm’s business is likely to involve the receipt, annually in the period to which the certificate would relate, of an aggregate amount by way of relevant payments which is not less than whichever is the smaller of—
(a)the sum specified in subsection (2B) below; and
(b)the amount specified for the purposes of this paragraph in regulations made by the Board;
and in this subsection “relevant payments” has the meaning given by section 562(2B).
(2B)The sum referred to in subsection (2A)(a) above is the sum of the following amounts, that is to say—
(a)the amount obtained by multiplying the number of partners in the firm who are individuals by the amount specified in regulations as the minimum turnover for the purposes of section 562(2A); and
(b)in respect of each partner in the firm who is a company (other than one to which section 565(2A)(b) would apply), the amount equal to what would have been the minimum turnover for the purposes of section 565(2A) if the application had been for the issue of a certificate to that company.
(3)Subject to subsection (4) below, each of the persons who are partners at the time of the application must have complied, so far as any such charge to income tax or corporation tax is concerned as falls to be computed by reference to the profits or gains of the firm’s business—
(a)with all obligations imposed on him by or under the Tax Acts or the Management Act in respect of periods ending within the qualifying period; and
(b)with all requests to him as such a partner to supply to an inspector accounts of, or other information about, the firm’s business or his share of the profits or gains of that business.
(4)Where a person has failed to comply with such an obligation or request as is referred to in subsection (3) above the firm shall nevertheless be treated, in relation to that partner, as satisfying that condition as regards that obligation or request if the Board are of the opinion that the failure is minor and technical and does not give reason to doubt that the condition mentioned in subsection (5) below will be satisfied.
(5)There must be reason to expect that each of the persons who are from time to time partners in the firm will, in respect of periods ending after the end of the qualifying period, comply with such obligations and requests as are referred to in subsection (3) above.
(6)Subject to subsection (4) above, a person shall not be taken for the purposes of this section to have complied with any such obligation or request as is referred to in subsection (3) above if there has been a contravention of a requirement as to the time at which, or the period within which, the obligation or request was to be complied with.
(7)In this section “the qualifying period”, in relation to an application for the issue of a certificate under section 561, means the period of three years ending with the date of the application.”
Commencement Information
I19Sch. 27 para. 6 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect from 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 3 (see. s. 139(3))
7(1)After subsection (2) of section 565 of that Act there shall be inserted the following subsections—U.K.
“(2A)The company must either—
(a)satisfy the Board, by such evidence as may be prescribed in regulations made by them, that the carrying on of its business is likely to involve the receipt, annually in the period to which the certificate would relate, of an aggregate amount by way of relevant payments which is not less than the amount which is the minimum turnover for the purposes of this subsection; or
(b)satisfy the Board that the only persons with shares in the company are companies which are limited by shares and themselves excepted from section 559 by virtue of a certificate which is in force under section 561;
and in this subsection “relevant payments” has the meaning given by section 562(2B).
(2B)The minimum turnover for the purposes of subsection (2A) above is whichever is the smaller of—
(a)the amount obtained by multiplying the amount specified in regulations as the minimum turnover for the purposes of section 562(2A) by the number of persons who are relevant persons in relation to the company; and
(b)the amount specified for the purposes of this paragraph in regulations made by the Board.
(2C)For the purposes of subsection (2B) above a person is a relevant person in relation to the company—
(a)where the company is a close company, if he is a director of the company (within the meaning of Chapter II of Part V) or a beneficial owner of shares in the company; and
(b)in any other case, if he is such a director of the company.”
(2)After subsection (8) of that section there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(8A)Subject to subsection (4) above, a company shall not be taken for the purposes of this section to have complied with any such obligation or request as is referred to in subsections (3) to (7) above if there has been a contravention of a requirement as to the time at which, or the period within which, the obligation or request was to be complied with.”
Commencement Information
I20Sch. 27 para. 7 in force at Royal Assent but shall have effect from 1.8.1999 by S.I. 1998/2620, art. 3 (see s. 139(3))
8(1)Except in the case of paragraph 3(2) and (3) above, paragraphs 3 to 7 above shall have effect in relation to any application for the issue or renewal of a certificate under section 561 of the Taxes Act 1988 which is made with respect to any period beginning on or after the appointed day.U.K.
(2)Paragraph 3(2) and (3)(b) above shall have effect in relation to contraventions of section 561(10) or (11) occurring on or after the appointed day; and paragraph 3(3)(a) above shall have effect in relation to forms and other documents in a person’s possession at any time after the passing of this Act.
9U.K.In section 566 of that Act (general powers to make regulations), after subsection (2) there shall be inserted the following subsection—
“(3)Any power under this Chapter to make regulations prescribing the evidence required for establishing what is likely to happen at any time shall include power to provide for such matters to be presumed (whether conclusively or unless the contrary is shown in the manner provided for in the regulations) from evidence of what has previously happened.”
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F170Sch. 28 repealed (27.7.1999 with effect as mentioned in Sch. 20 Pt. VII Notes 1, 2 of the amending Act) by 1999 c. 16, s. 139, Sch. 20 Pt. VII Notes 1, 2
Section 162.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1979 c. 4. | The Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979. | In section 55A(1), the words “exceeding 1.2 per cent, but”. Section 60(1A). Section 63(2). |
1988 c. 39. | The Finance Act 1988. | In Schedule 1, in Part II, paragraph 8 and in paragraph 9 the words from “and after” to the end. |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 1 of this Act.
Chapter or Number | Citation | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1979 c. 4. | The Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979. | Section 6A. Section 45. Section 60(1) and (2). Section 63(1). |
1988 c. 39. | The Finance Act 1988. | In Schedule 1, paragraph 2. |
1991 c. 31. | The Finance Act 1991. | In Schedule 2, paragraph 12. |
SI 1992/3158. | The Excise Duty (Amendment of the Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 and the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979) Regulations 1992. | Regulation 2(4). |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1979 c. 4. | The Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979. | In section 1(2), the words “but does not include methylated spirits”. In section 2— (a) in subsection (1), the words “methylated spirits”; (b) in subsection (7), the words “or in any methylated spirits” and the words “or methylated spirits”; and (c) in subsection (8), the words “or methylated spirits”. In section 4(1), the definition of “methylated spirits”. Section 9. Section 77(1)(b). |
1979 c. 5. | The Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979. | In section 27(3), in the Table, the words “ “methylated spirits””. |
1990 c. 29. | The Finance Act 1990. | Section 8. |
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | Section 8. |
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | In Schedule 4, paragraph 47. In Schedule 5, in paragraph 3— (a) in sub-paragraph (1)(o), the words “methylated spirits and”; and (b) in sub-paragraph (2), the words “methylated spirits”. |
The powers in section 5(6) and (7) of this Act shall apply in relation to these repeals as they apply in relation to the provisions of that section and Schedule 2 to this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1979 c. 5. | The Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979. | Section 8(7). |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1981 c. 63. | The Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981. | Sections 28(4) and 29(4). In section 33(1), in the definition of “gaming”, the words “(except where it refers to a machine provided for gaming)”. In Schedule 4, paragraph 13. |
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | Section 16(8). |
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | In Schedule 3, paragraph 3(8). |
1.These repeals, except the repeals of sections 28(4) and 29(4) of the Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981, have effect in accordance with section 14 of this Act.
2.The repeals of sections 28(4) and 29(4) of that Act come into force with the passing of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | In Schedule 5, in paragraph 9, the word “and” immediately preceding sub-paragraph (d). |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 16 of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 22. | The Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994. | In Schedule 2, paragraphs 1, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17 and 21. |
1968 c. xxxii. | The Port of London Act 1968. | In section 199, paragraph (a) of the proviso to each of subsections (3) and (5). |
These repeals come into force on 1st July 1995.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 22. | The Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994. | Section 17(3) to (7). In section 61, in subsection (3), paragraph (c) and the word “and” immediately preceding it, and subsections (4), (5) and (7). In section 62(1) the definitions of “built-in road construction machinery”, “farmer’s goods vehicle”, “road construction machinery” and “road construction vehicle” In Schedule 1— (a) paragraph 4(2)(a), (b) and (f) and (3); (b) paragraph 8; (c) in paragraph 10, in each of sub-paragraphs (2) and (3), the words “(or relevant maximum weight)”, and sub-paragraph (4); (d) paragraphs 12, 14(b) and (c) and 17(1)(c) to (e) and (2). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with Parts III, IV and IX of Schedule 4 to this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 22. | The Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994. | In section 31(5)(b) the words “(or an amount equal to the duty due)”. In section 37(2) the words “(or, in Scotland, on indictment or on summary conviction)” and “(or, in Scotland, the statutory maximum)”. In section 41(1)(b) the words “182 or” and “183 or”. |
1.The repeal in section 31(5)(b) applies in relation to offences committed after the day on which this Act is passed.
2.The repeals in sections 37(2) and 41(1)(b) apply in relation to proceedings begun after the day on which this Act is passed.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 23. | The Value Added Tax Act 1994. | In Schedule 13, paragraph 7. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 21 of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 23. | The Value Added Tax Act 1994. | In section 47(3), the words “goods or”. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 23(4)(b) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 23. | The Value Added Tax Act 1994. | Section 32. |
This repeal comes into force on the day appointed by an order under section 24(2) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 23. | The Value Added Tax Act 1994. | In section 84(2) the words “, except in the case of an appeal against a decision with respect to the matter mentioned in section 83(l),”. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 31 of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | In section 53(5), paragraph (c) and the word “and” immediately preceding it. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with paragraph 2 of Schedule 5 to this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | Sections 22 and 23. Section 34(9). In section 354(2)(a), the words “or any of the other payments mentioned in section 25(1)”. In section 779(13)(a), the words “allowable by virtue of sections 25, 26 and 28 to 31 and Schedule 1”. |
1989 c. 26. | The Finance Act 1989. | Section 170(1). |
1990 c. 1. | The Capital Allowances Act 1990. | In section 9(6), paragraph (a) and, in paragraph (b), the words “if it is a charge to corporation tax”. In section 92(2), paragraph (a) and, in paragraph (b), the words “if it is a charge to corporation tax”. In section 132(4), paragraph (a) and, in paragraph (b), the words “if it is a charge to corporation tax”. |
1991 c. 31. | The Finance Act 1991. | In Schedule 15, paragraph 18. |
These repeals come into force in accordance with section 39(4) and (5) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 353— (a) in subsection (1A), paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding that paragraph; (b) in subsection (1B), paragraph (b) and the word “or” immediately preceding that paragraph; (c) subsections (1C) and (1D); and (d) in subsection (1E), the words “the following factors, that is to say”, and paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding that paragraph. Section 354(4). In section 355— (a) in subsection (1), the words from “or” at the end of paragraph (a) to the end of the subsection; and (b) subsection (4). In section 356A(3), the words “or but for section 353(1C)(a) would be”. In section 356D(1), the words from “in a case” to “358”. In section 357(1), the words from “in a case” to “358”. Section 358(4A). In section 366(1)(c), the words “355(4) or”. In section 370— (a) in subsection (6), in paragraph (a), the words “in paragraph (a)”, and paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it; (b) subsection (6A); and (c) in subsection (7), in paragraph (a), the words from “and paragraph (b)” to “omitted”, and in paragraph (aa), sub-paragraph (ii). |
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | In Schedule 9, paragraphs 4 to 6, 7(2) to (4) and 8. |
These repeals come into force in accordance with section 42(3) to (5) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | Section 160(5)(b). |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 45(5) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1992 c. 12. | The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992. | In section 175(1), the words from “(unless” to the end. |
This repeal has effect where the acquisition of, or of the interest in, the new assets is on or after 29th November 1994.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 75(4), the words “and insurance”. In section 241(5), the words from “(that is to say,” to “otherwise be liable)”. In section 242(1)(b), the words “for purposes of section 241(3)”. In section 242(9), the words “by virtue of section 241(5)”. In section 431(2), the definitions of “general annuity business” and “pension business”, “annuity fund”, “basic life assurance business”, “basic life assurance and general annuity business”, “offshore income gain” and “overseas life assurance business”, the word “and” following the definition of “overseas life insurance company” and the definition of “UK distribution income”. Section 431(2A) to (6). Section 431AA. Section 432C(5)(a). Section 434(2) and (7). In section 436(3)(d), from the word “and” following sub-paragraph (i) to the end of the paragraph. Section 437(6). In section 441, in subsection (1), the words “resident in the United Kingdom” and subsection (7). Sections 444C to 444E. In section 474(1), paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding it. In section 475(2)(a), the words from “or,” to “life assurance business”. In Schedule 19AC, paragraphs 2(2), 3(4), 4(2), 5(2), 6(3), (4) and (6), 7(3), 8(4), 9(2) and (3), 10(3), 11(2) and (6), 12(2), 13(3), 14(3) and 15(2). In Schedule 28, in Part I, paragraph 3(4). |
1989 c. 26. | The Finance Act 1989. | In Schedule 6, paragraph 2. In Schedule 8, paragraph 4. In Schedule 8A, paragraph 2(11). |
1990 c. 29. | The Finance Act 1990. | Section 45(8). In Schedule 6— (a) paragraph 1(2)(a); (b) in paragraph 1(2)(b), the definitions of “basic life assurance business”, “linked assets” and “overseas life assurance business”; and (c) paragraph 1(3) and (4). In Schedule 7, paragraph 7. |
1991 c. 31. | The Finance Act 1991. | In Schedule 7, paragraphs 2, 3, 6 and 10. |
1992 c. 12. | The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992. | In Schedule 10, paragraph 14(63)(b)(iv). |
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | Section 99. Section 100(1) and (2)(a). |
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | Section 143. Section 176(1). In Schedule 16, paragraph 5(2) and (3). In Schedule 17, paragraph 4. |
1.The following repeals have effect in accordance with paragraph 55 of Schedule 8 to this Act—
the repeal of the definitions of “offshore income gain” and “overseas life assurance business” in section 431(2) of the Taxes Act 1988,
the repeal in section 441(1) of that Act,
the repeal of section 444C of that Act so far as it relates to subsection (2)(a) of that section,
the repeals in sections 474 and 475 of that Act,
the repeals of paragraphs 6(3) and (4) and 11(2) of Schedule 19AC to that Act,
the repeal in Schedule 28 to that Act,
the repeal of the definition of “overseas life assurance business” in paragraph 1(2)(b) of Schedule 6 to the Finance Act 1990 and the repeal in Schedule 7 to that Act,
the repeal of paragraph 10 of Schedule 7 to the Finance Act 1991, and
the repeal in the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992.
2.The repeals other than those listed above have effect in accordance with paragraph 57 of Schedule 8 to this Act.
3.The repeal of the definitions of “general annuity business” and “basic life assurance business” in Chapter I of Part XII of the Taxes Act 1988 does not affect the meaning of those expressions in paragraph 16 or 17 of Schedule 7 to the Finance Act 1991 or section 214 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (transitional provisions relating to changes in 1991).
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In Schedule 15, paragraph 3(2)(c). |
1992 c. 48. | The Finance (No. 2) Act 1992. | In Schedule 9, paragraph 19(3). |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In Schedule 14, in paragraph 7(1), the words “and paragraphs 9 and 10 of Schedule 15”. In Schedule 15, paragraphs 21, 22 and, in paragraph 24, in sub-paragraph (3), the word “first” and sub-paragraph (4). |
These repeals come into force, in accordance with section 55(1) to (5) of this Act, on 5th May 1996.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 347A(2)(b), the words “within the meaning given by section 660(3)”. Sections 660 to 676. Section 678(7). Sections 679 to 681. Sections 683 to 685. Section 689. In Schedule 29, in paragraph 32, the entry relating to section 27(2) of the Taxes Management Act 1970. In Schedule 30, paragraphs 10 to 12. |
1988 c. 39. | The Finance Act 1988. | In Schedule 3, paragraph 20. |
1989 c. 26. | The Finance Act 1989. | Section 60(3). Sections 108 and 109(1) to (3). |
1990 c. 29. | The Finance Act 1990. | Section 82. |
1991 c. 50. | The Age of Legal Capacity (Scotland) Act 1991. | In Schedule 1, paragraph 48. |
1992 c. 12. | The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992. | Section 6(1) and (2)(b). In section 79(2), paragraph (b) and the word “and” preceding it. Section 79(4). In section 79(5)(a), the words “or income” wherever occurring. |
1992 c. 48. | The Finance (No. 2) Act 1992. | In section 19(3), the words “683(2), 684(2), 689(2)”. Section 23(2). Section 27. |
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | In Schedule 6— (a) in paragraph 1, the words “683(2), 684(2)”; (b) in paragraph 6, the word “689(2)”; (c) paragraph 24. |
These repeals have effect for the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 129(1), the words “has contracted to sell securities, and to enable him to fulfil the contract, he”. |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 695, in subsection (2), the words “subject to subsection (3) below”. In section 701, subsection (14). |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 481(5)(k), the word “that” before sub-paragraph (i). |
This repeal comes into force in accordance with section 86 of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 209(2)(e), sub-paragraphs (iv) and (v). |
These repeals come into force in accordance with section 87(7) and (8) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | Section 63(12). |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 88(4) and (5) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1970 c. 9. | The Taxes Management Act 1970. | In section 9(3), the words “the following provisions of”. Section 11A. In section 12B(2), the words from “or, where a return” to the end. In section 42(11), paragraph (b) and the word “and” immediately preceding that paragraph. |
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | Section 73. In section 206, the words “under Schedule E”. In section 536, in subsection (2), the words “are shown on a claim to” and, in subsection (4), the words from “and in that case” to the end. In section 537B, in subsection (2), the words “are shown on a claim to” and, in subsection (4), the words from “and in that case” to the end. In Schedule 3, in paragraph 6E, sub-paragraphs (1) and (3). |
1992 c. 12. | The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992. | Section 7. |
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | Section 198. |
1.The repeal of section 11A of the Taxes Management Act 1970 has effect in accordance with section 115(13) of this Act.
2.The other repeals, except that in the Finance Act 1994, have effect in accordance with section 103(7) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | Section 114(3). Section 401(2). |
1.The repeal of section 114(3) has effect in accordance with section 218(1) of the Finance Act 1994.
2.The other repeal has effect in accordance with section 120(2) of this Act.
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1970 c. 9. | The Taxes Management Act 1970. | Sections 78 to 85. |
1985 c. 54. | The Finance Act 1985. | Section 50. |
1987 c. 51. | The Finance (No. 2) Act 1987. | In Schedule 6, paragraph 7. |
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | Section 43. In section 115(7), the words “this section and”. In section 510A, in subsection (6), the words “Subject to subsection (7) below”, and subsections (7) and (8). In Schedule 29, in the Table in paragraph 32, the entries relating to section 78(1) and (5) of the Taxes Management Act 1970. |
1989 c. 26. | The Finance Act 1989. | In section 182(3)(c), the words “for the purposes of section 80(3) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 or”. |
1991 c. 31. | The Finance Act 1991. | Section 81. |
1992 c. 12. | The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992. | In section 59, paragraph (c) and the word “and” immediately preceding it. In Schedule 10, paragraph 2(2), the words “78(3)(b)”. |
1994 c. 9. | The Finance Act 1994. | In section 215(5), paragraph (b), and the word “and” immediately preceding it. |
1.The repeal of section 43 of the Taxes Act 1988 comes into force in accordance with section 40(3) of this Act.
2. The repeals in sections 115(7) of the Taxes Act 1988 and of section 59(c) of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 shall have effect in relation to any cases in relation to which section 112 of the Taxes Act 1988 has effect as amended by section 125 of this Act.
3.The repeals in section 510A of the Taxes Act 1988 have effect as respects the year 1997-98 and subsequent years of assessment and also, in relation to groupings whose trades or professions were set up and commenced on or after 6th April 1994, as respects the years 1995-96 and 1996-97.
4.The repeal of section 215(5)(b) of the Finance Act 1994 has effect in accordance with section 125(1) of this Act for the year 1995-96 and subsequent years of assessment.
5.The other repeals come into force—
(a) for the purposes of income tax and capital gains tax, in relation to the year 1996-97 and subsequent years of assessment, and
(b) for the purposes of corporation tax, in relation to accounting periods beginning after 31st March 1996.
This repeal has effect in accordance with Schedule 24 to this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | In section 129(8)(b) the words “or the circumstances are such that a charge would be so allowed if the duty were settled”. |
Paragraph 4A of Schedule 24 to the Taxes Act 1988 is deemed never to have been inserted, and section 96 of the Finance Act 1993 is deemed never to have been enacted. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In Schedule 24, paragraph 4A. |
1993 c. 34. | The Finance Act 1993. | Section 96. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 136 of this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In Schedule 8, in paragraph 19(6), paragraphs (g) to (k). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 137 of this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In Schedule 8, paragraph 8(a). In Schedule 9, in paragraph 27(4) the words from “who is required” to the end. |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | The Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | Section 559(3). In section 561— (a) in subsection (1), the words “subsection (5) below or”; (b) in subsection (3), the words “563”; (c) subsections (4) and (5); (d) in subsection (6), the words from “(not being” to “apply).”; and (e) subsection (12). In section 562— (a) in subsection (1), the words “(otherwise than as a partner in a firm)”; and (b) subsections (3) to (7). Section 563. |
1988 c. 39. | The Finance Act 1988. | Section 28. |
1.The repeal of sections 559(3) and 561(4) and (5) of the Taxes Act 1988, and the repeal in section 561(1) of that Act, have effect in relation to payments made to a person in any case where that person’s certificate under section 561 of that Act is one issued or renewed with respect to a period beginning on or after the appointed day.
2.The repeal of section 561(12) of the Taxes Act 1988 comes into force in accordance with paragraph 8(2) of Schedule 27 to this Act.
3.The other repeals in the Taxes Act 1988 have effect in relation to any application for the issue or renewal of a certificate under section 561 of that Act which is made with respect to a period beginning on or after the appointed day.
4.The repeal of section 28 of the Finance Act 1988 has effect in relation to payments made on or after the appointed day.
5.In Notes 1, 3 and 4 above, “the appointed day” has the same meaning as in section 139 of this Act.
These repeals have effect in relation to payments made after the passing of this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1988 c. 1. | Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988. | In section 3(1)(c), the words “119 or”. In section 74(1)(q), the words “119 or”. In section 119(1), the words from “and, subject to subsection (2) below, shall be subject to deduction of income tax” to the end. In section 119(2), the words from “instead of” to “subsection (1) above”. In section 122(1), the words from “but without prejudice” to the end. In section 348(2)(b), the words “119 or”. In section 349(1)(c), the words “119 or”. In section 821(3)(c), the words “119 or”. |
1992 c. 12. | Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992. | In section 201(2), the words from “but without prejudice” to the end. |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 147 of this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1975 c. 22. | The Oil Taxation Act 1975. | In Schedule 8, in paragraph 4, in sub-paragraph (1), the words from “and the date” to the end of the sub-paragraph and, in sub-paragraph (2), the words “within the time allowed for making the original claim”. |
These repeals have effect in accordance with sections 149 and 150 of this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1930 c. 28. | The Finance Act 1930. | In section 42(3) the words from “with the substitution” to the end. |
1954 c. 23 (N.I.). | The Finance Act (Northern Ireland) 1954. | In section 11(3A) the words from “with the substitution” to the end. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 155 of this Act. | ||
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1984 c. 51. | The Inheritance Tax Act 1984. | In section 116(2) the word “either”. |
Chapter | Short title | Extent of repeal |
---|---|---|
1989 c. 26. | The Finance Act 1989. | Section 178(2)(n). |
1990 c. 29. | The Finance Act 1990. | Sections 115 to 120. |
1991 c. 52. | The Ports Act 1991. | Section 41(3). |
The Whole Act you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.
Would you like to continue?
The Whole Act you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download.
Would you like to continue?
The Whole Act you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.
Would you like to continue?
The Whole Act without Schedules you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.
Would you like to continue?
The Schedules you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.
Would you like to continue?
Latest Available (revised):The latest available updated version of the legislation incorporating changes made by subsequent legislation and applied by our editorial team. Changes we have not yet applied to the text, can be found in the ‘Changes to Legislation’ area.
Original (As Enacted or Made): The original version of the legislation as it stood when it was enacted or made. No changes have been applied to the text.
Point in Time: This becomes available after navigating to view revised legislation as it stood at a certain point in time via Advanced Features > Show Timeline of Changes or via a point in time advanced search.
Geographical Extent: Indicates the geographical area that this provision applies to. For further information see ‘Frequently Asked Questions’.
Show Timeline of Changes: See how this legislation has or could change over time. Turning this feature on will show extra navigation options to go to these specific points in time. Return to the latest available version by using the controls above in the What Version box.
Access essential accompanying documents and information for this legislation item from this tab. Dependent on the legislation item being viewed this may include:
This timeline shows the different points in time where a change occurred. The dates will coincide with the earliest date on which the change (e.g an insertion, a repeal or a substitution) that was applied came into force. The first date in the timeline will usually be the earliest date when the provision came into force. In some cases the first date is 01/02/1991 (or for Northern Ireland legislation 01/01/2006). This date is our basedate. No versions before this date are available. For further information see the Editorial Practice Guide and Glossary under Help.
Use this menu to access essential accompanying documents and information for this legislation item. Dependent on the legislation item being viewed this may include:
Click 'View More' or select 'More Resources' tab for additional information including:
The data on this page is available in the alternative data formats listed: